DIGSI5 Onlinehelp enUS PDF
DIGSI5 Onlinehelp enUS PDF
DIGSI5 Onlinehelp enUS PDF
C53000-D5040-C001-H
NOTE
i For your own safety, observe the warnings and safety instructions contained in this document, if available.
Target Audience
Protection system engineers, commissioning engineers, persons entrusted with the setting, testing and main-
tenance of automation, selective protection and control equipment, and operational crew in electrical installa-
tions and power plants.
Scope
This manual applies to the SIPROTEC 5 device family.
Additional Support
For questions about the system, contact your Siemens sales partner.
Training Courses
Inquiries regarding individual training courses should be addressed to our Training Center:
Siemens AG Phone: +49 (911) 433-7415
Siemens Power Academy TD Fax: +49 (911) 433-7929
Humboldtstrasse 59 E-mail: [email protected]
90459 Nuremberg Internet: www.siemens.com/poweracademy
Germany
Notes on Safety
This document is not a complete index of all safety measures required for operation of the equipment (module
or device). However, it comprises important information that must be followed for personal safety, as well as
to avoid material damage. Information is highlighted and illustrated as follows according to the degree of
danger:
! DANGER
DANGER means that death or severe injury will result if the measures specified are not taken.
² Comply with all instructions, in order to avoid death or severe injuries.
! WARNING
WARNING means that death or severe injury may result if the measures specified are not taken.
² Comply with all instructions, in order to avoid death or severe injuries.
! CAUTION
CAUTION means that medium-severe or slight injuries can occur if the specified measures are not taken.
² Comply with all instructions, in order to avoid moderate or minor injuries.
NOTICE
NOTICE means that property damage can result if the measures specified are not taken.
² Comply with all instructions, in order to avoid property damage.
NOTE
i Important information about the product, product handling or a certain section of the documentation
which must be given attention.
The product contains, among other things, Open Source Software developed by third parties. The Open
Source Software used in the product and the license agreements concerning this software can be found in the
Readme_OSS. These Open Source Software files are protected by copyright. Your compliance with those
license conditions will entitle you to use the Open Source Software as foreseen in the relevant license. In the
event of conflicts between Siemens license conditions and the Open Source Software license conditions, the
Open Source Software conditions shall prevail with respect to the Open Source Software portions of the soft-
ware. The Open Source Software is licensed royalty-free. Insofar as the applicable Open Source Software
License Conditions provide for it you can order the source code of the Open Source Software from your
Siemens sales contact – against payment of the shipping and handling charges – for a period of at least 3
years after purchase of the product. We are liable for the product including the Open Source Software
contained in it pursuant to the license conditions applicable to the product. Any liability for the Open Source
Software beyond the program flow intended for the product is explicitly excluded. Furthermore any liability
for defects resulting from modifications to the Open Source Software by you or third parties is excluded. We
do not provide any technical support for the product if it has been modified.
When using DIGSI 5 in online mode, you are provided with the option to go to the main menu Show open
source software information and read and display the Readme_OSS file containing the original license text
and copyright information.
To do this, the following steps are necessary:
NOTE
i To read the Readme_OSS file, a PDF viewer must be installed on the computer.
In order to operate SIPROTEC 5 devices, a valid DIGSI 5 license is required.
Preface.......................................................................................................................................................... 3
1 Introduction................................................................................................................................................31
1.1 What is DIGSI 5?................................................................................................................ 32
1.2 Information Scope of the DIGSI 5 Help...............................................................................33
2 First Steps................................................................................................................................................... 35
2.1 Important Information in Advance.....................................................................................36
2.1.1 Features of the Different DIGSI 5 Variants ....................................................................36
2.1.2 User Interface, Project, and Project Tree ...................................................................... 38
2.1.3 Working Offline and Online .........................................................................................39
2.1.4 Languages in DIGSI 5................................................................................................... 40
2.1.5 Role-Based Views in DIGSI 5......................................................................................... 40
2.1.6 Deleting Saved Login Credentials................................................................................. 44
2.1.7 Saving or Forgetting Login Credentials......................................................................... 44
2.2 Adjust DIGSI 5................................................................................................................... 46
2.2.1 Starting DIGSI 5........................................................................................................... 46
2.2.2 Selecting the User Interface Language......................................................................... 46
2.2.3 Defining Start Settings................................................................................................. 47
2.2.4 Defining Storage Locations.......................................................................................... 48
2.2.5 Defining Storage Locations for Data Exchange............................................................. 48
2.2.6 Selecting a Standard Unit System.................................................................................49
2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers..............................................................................................49
2.2.8 Managing Device Drivers............................................................................................. 51
2.2.9 Exit DIGSI 5..................................................................................................................53
2.2.10 Using DIGSI 5 Licenses................................................................................................. 53
2.3 Switching from DIGSI 4 to DIGSI 5..................................................................................... 55
2.3.1 Where Do I Find the DIGSI 4 Manager?......................................................................... 55
2.3.2 What Happened to the MLFB (Order Number)?.............................................................55
2.3.3 How Do I Open a SIPROTEC 5 Device for Editing?.......................................................... 55
2.3.4 How Do I Set the Functional Scope of a SIPROTEC 5 Device?......................................... 55
2.3.5 Why Can I Not Route to CFC and the Display in the Information Routing?...................... 56
2.3.6 How Do I Edit the Basic Display and the Control Display?.............................................. 56
3 Basic Operation.......................................................................................................................................... 57
3.1 Getting to Know the User Interface....................................................................................58
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface.................................................................................................. 58
3.1.2 Project Tree................................................................................................................. 59
4 Assistance................................................................................................................................................... 91
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System.....................................................................92
4.2 Using DIGSI 5 Help............................................................................................................ 94
4.3 Icons in the Project Tree.................................................................................................... 96
4.4 Icons in the Info Tab..........................................................................................................98
4.5 Identifying and Eliminating Inconsistencies....................................................................... 99
4.6 Copying and Deleting Messages...................................................................................... 100
4.7 Using the Status Dialog................................................................................................... 101
5 Projects..................................................................................................................................................... 103
5.1 Managing Projects.......................................................................................................... 104
5.1.1 Overview of Projects.................................................................................................. 104
5.1.2 Creating a Project...................................................................................................... 104
5.1.3 Opening a Project...................................................................................................... 105
5.1.4 Converting a Project.................................................................................................. 105
5.1.5 Saving a Project......................................................................................................... 106
5.1.6 Archiving/Retrieving a Project.................................................................................... 107
5.1.7 Closing a Project........................................................................................................ 109
5.1.8 Deleting a Project...................................................................................................... 109
5.1.9 Printing Project Data.................................................................................................. 110
5.1.10 Project Data in Windows Explorer...............................................................................110
5.2 Working with Multilingual Projects.................................................................................. 111
5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts....................................................... 111
5.2.2 Opening the Project-Language Selection View............................................................111
5.2.3 Selecting or Deselecting Project Languages................................................................ 112
5.2.4 Defining the Editing Language and the Reference Language...................................... 112
6 Devices..................................................................................................................................................... 117
6.1 Managing Devices in Projects.......................................................................................... 118
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices................................................................................ 118
6.1.2 Offline Configuration.................................................................................................121
6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code.................................. 124
6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device.............................................. 128
6.1.5 Renaming a SIPROTEC 5 Device.................................................................................. 130
6.1.6 Setting the On-Site Operation Panel Language........................................................... 130
6.1.7 Deleting a SIPROTEC 5 Device.................................................................................... 131
6.1.8 Printing Device Data.................................................................................................. 131
6.1.9 Opening Device Information...................................................................................... 132
6.1.10 Opening Device Settings............................................................................................132
6.2 Managing Devices in a Folder Structure........................................................................... 134
6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5......................................................................134
6.2.2 Creating a Folder Structure........................................................................................ 134
6.2.3 Adding a Device in the Folder Structure......................................................................134
6.2.4 Deleting a Folder Structure........................................................................................ 135
6.2.5 Moving Folders in the Folder Structure.......................................................................135
6.2.6 Moving Devices in the Folder Structure...................................................................... 135
6.2.7 Copying a Folder Structure.........................................................................................135
6.2.8 Copying Devices in the Folder Structure..................................................................... 136
6.2.9 Renaming a Folder Structure......................................................................................136
6.3 Configuring Device Hardware..........................................................................................137
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure.......................................................................... 137
6.3.2 Opening the Device View...........................................................................................141
6.3.3 Scaling the View in the Device View........................................................................... 142
6.3.4 Changing between Different Device Configurations................................................... 143
6.3.5 Showing and Hiding Hardware-Component Designations........................................... 143
6.3.6 Using the Clipboard................................................................................................... 144
6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware Catalog.......................................144
6.3.8 Searching for a Hardware Component in the Hardware Catalog..................................146
6.3.9 Moving a Hardware Component................................................................................ 146
6.3.10 Copying a Hardware Component............................................................................... 147
6.3.11 Deleting a Hardware Component............................................................................... 148
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values........................................................... 148
6.3.13 Printing the Hardware Configuration..........................................................................149
6.4 Synchronizing Device Hardware with DIGSI......................................................................150
6.4.1 Overview of Device Hardware Synchronization...........................................................150
6.4.2 Synchronizing Device Hardware with DIGSI................................................................ 151
6.5 Processing Display Pages................................................................................................. 153
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages......................................................................................... 153
7 Single-Line Configuration.........................................................................................................................185
7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration.......................................................................186
7.2 Basic Procedures............................................................................................................. 187
7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration..........................................................................187
7.2.2 Printing the Offline and Online Single-Line Configuration........................................... 187
7.2.3 Scaling the Single-Line Configuration View................................................................ 188
7.2.4 Saving the Single-Line Configuration as a Vector Graphic........................................... 189
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS..............................................................................................................447
12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS.............................................................................................................. 448
12.2.10 Non-Linear................................................................................................................ 449
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP.................................................................................................................. 449
12.2.10.2 NL_MV.................................................................................................................450
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ.................................................................................................................. 452
12.2.11 Other........................................................................................................................ 454
12.2.11.1 CONNECT.............................................................................................................454
12.2.11.2 CON_ACD............................................................................................................ 455
12.2.11.3 CON_ACT............................................................................................................. 456
12.2.11.4 CHART_STATE...................................................................................................... 456
12.2.11.5 LOOP................................................................................................................... 458
12.2.11.6 SUBST_B.............................................................................................................. 459
12.2.11.7 SUBST_BQ............................................................................................................ 460
12.2.11.8 SUBST_D.............................................................................................................. 461
12.2.11.9 SUBST_R.............................................................................................................. 462
12.2.11.10 SUBST_XQ............................................................................................................463
12.2.12 Persistency................................................................................................................ 464
12.2.12.1 MEMORY_D..........................................................................................................464
12.2.12.2 MEMORY_R.......................................................................................................... 465
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM...........................................................................................................466
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM......................................................................................................... 467
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM......................................................................................................... 467
12.2.13 Selection................................................................................................................... 468
12.2.13.1 MIN_D................................................................................................................. 468
12.2.13.2 MIN_R..................................................................................................................469
12.2.13.3 MAX_D................................................................................................................ 469
12.2.13.4 MAX_R.................................................................................................................470
12.2.13.5 MUX_D................................................................................................................ 470
12.2.13.6 MUX_R.................................................................................................................471
12.2.13.7 HOLD_D............................................................................................................... 472
12.2.13.8 HOLD_R............................................................................................................... 472
12.2.14 Timer and Counter.....................................................................................................473
12.2.14.1 TSHORT................................................................................................................473
12.2.14.2 TLONG................................................................................................................. 474
12.2.14.3 TOF......................................................................................................................475
12.2.14.4 TON..................................................................................................................... 476
12.2.14.5 TP........................................................................................................................ 477
12.2.14.6 BLINK...................................................................................................................478
12.2.14.7 ALARM.................................................................................................................479
12.2.14.8 CTD..................................................................................................................... 480
12.2.14.9 CTU..................................................................................................................... 481
12.2.14.10 CTUD................................................................................................................... 482
12.3 Function Charts (CFC) Cross-Reference List...................................................................... 485
12.4 Analyzing Function Charts (CFC)......................................................................................488
12.5 Configuring Function Subcharts and Templates............................................................... 495
12.5.1 Brief Introduction to Function Subcharts and Templates............................................. 495
12.5.2 Adding a Subchart..................................................................................................... 495
12.5.3 Opening a Subchart................................................................................................... 497
12.5.4 Defining the Interfaces of a Subchart ........................................................................ 497
12.5.5 Creating a Master Copy of a Subchart.........................................................................500
12.5.6 Replacing a Subchart................................................................................................. 502
12.6 Configuring CFC Trend View............................................................................................503
12.6.1 Brief Introduction to CFC Trend View..........................................................................503
14 Communication........................................................................................................................................ 541
14.1 Overview Communication............................................................................................... 542
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots...................................................................................542
14.1.2 Communication Modules........................................................................................... 542
14.1.3 Communication Using Protection Interfaces............................................................... 544
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet................................................................................. 544
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards............................................................................................ 545
14.2 Configuring Ethernet Network.........................................................................................548
14.2.1 Opening Network View..............................................................................................548
14.2.2 Scaling the Network View.......................................................................................... 548
14.2.3 Showing and Hiding IP Addresses in Network View.....................................................549
14.2.4 Connecting Interfaces Using a New Subnetwork.........................................................549
14.2.5 Connecting an Interface to an Existing Subnetwork....................................................550
14.2.6 Changing Connections...............................................................................................551
14.2.7 Setting Ethernet Addresses ....................................................................................... 552
14.3 Selecting Device IP Address for Communication...............................................................554
14.4 Defining Functionality of the Integrated Ethernet Interface..............................................556
14.5 Selecting and Configuring Protocols................................................................................ 558
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol................................................ 558
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols.............................................................559
14.5.3 Selecting and Configuring a Redundancy Protocol...................................................... 559
14.5.4 Selecting and Configuring a Service Protocol..............................................................560
14.6 Set Time Settings............................................................................................................ 561
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization............................................................................. 561
14.6.2 Time Sources............................................................................................................. 562
14.6.3 Processing Time Settings........................................................................................... 564
14.6.4 Displaying Time Information...................................................................................... 565
14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device........................................................ 566
14.6.6 Configuring Time Synchronization of the Protection Interface.................................... 566
14.6.7 Configuring Time Synchronization Using SNTP........................................................... 568
14.6.8 Configuring Time Synchronization Using IEEE 1588....................................................568
14.7 Configuring Communication via Protection Interface....................................................... 570
14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication....................................................... 570
14.7.2 Inserting a Communication Module in the SIPROTEC 5 Device.................................... 571
14.7.3 Configuring the Communication Channel as a Protection Interface.............................572
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication....................................................... 573
14.7.5 Mapping Signals for Protection Interface.................................................................... 574
15 IEC Stations...............................................................................................................................................597
15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5.........................................................................598
15.2 Adding an IEC Station......................................................................................................599
15.3 Opening an IEC Station................................................................................................... 600
15.4 Viewing the Properties of an IEC Station.......................................................................... 601
15.5 Renaming an IEC Station................................................................................................. 602
15.6 Selecting the IEC 61850 Edition.......................................................................................603
15.7 Viewing Devices in an IEC Station.................................................................................... 605
15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station ............................................................. 606
15.9 Removing the Assignment between a SIPROTEC 5 Device and an IEC Station ................... 607
15.10 Deleting an IEC Station....................................................................................................608
15.11 Associating a System Configurator Project with the DIGSI 5 IEC Station............................ 609
15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator Project ................... 610
15.13 Transferring the IEC 61850 System Configurator Project Configuration to a DIGSI 5
IEC station ......................................................................................................................612
15.14 Migrating the IEC 61850 Configuration from earlier DIGSI 5 Versions............................... 613
15.15 Later Binding.................................................................................................................. 614
15.16 System Implementation Conformance Statement (SICS).................................................. 616
15.17 GOOSE Supervision......................................................................................................... 619
16 Process-Bus Configuration........................................................................................................................621
16.1 Merging Unit.................................................................................................................. 622
16.2 Process-Bus Client........................................................................................................... 624
16.3 Sample Value (SV) Supervision........................................................................................ 627
17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications ......................... 678
17.5.2.3 Activating the Auto-scrolling Behavior for the Indications Table............................ 679
17.5.2.4 Deleting Spontaneous Indications from a SIPROTEC 5 Device................................ 679
17.5.2.5 Specifying an Indication as Reference for Relative Time ........................................680
17.5.2.6 Creating Snapshots of Spontaneous Indications.................................................... 680
17.5.2.7 Opening Indication-Snapshots Table and Selecting and Showing Snapshots.......... 681
17.5.2.8 Saving Indications in a File................................................................................... 681
17.5.3 Fault Record.............................................................................................................. 682
17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording.................................................................................682
17.5.3.2 Configuring and Setting Parameters for Fault Recording .......................................684
17.5.3.3 Configuring the Signal Order for Fault Recording.................................................. 685
17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table...................................................................................693
17.5.3.5 Displaying Saved Fault Records.............................................................................695
17.5.3.6 Reading Fault Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device .............................................. 695
17.5.3.7 Reading Fast and Slow Scan Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device (7KE)................ 696
17.5.3.8 Reading Continuous Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device (7KE)............................696
17.5.3.9 Reading Trend Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device (7KE).................................... 697
17.5.3.10 Downloading Fault Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device ......................................697
17.5.3.11 Downloading Fast and Slow Scan Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device................. 698
17.5.3.12 Downloading Continuous Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device ............................ 698
17.5.3.13 Downloading Trend Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device .....................................699
17.5.3.14 Triggering Test Fault Records................................................................................700
17.5.3.15 Opening Fault Records for Viewing Only............................................................... 700
17.5.3.16 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating .............................................. 702
17.5.3.17 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating (7KE)...................................... 703
17.5.3.18 Exporting Fault Records........................................................................................703
17.5.3.19 Saving Fault Record Information in a File ............................................................. 705
17.5.3.20 Deleting Fault Records Saved in the Offline Configuration.....................................706
17.5.3.21 Deleting Fault Records from a SIPROTEC 5 Device .................................................706
17.5.4 Logs.......................................................................................................................... 708
17.5.4.1 Overview of Logs................................................................................................. 708
17.5.4.2 Configuring Logging............................................................................................ 710
17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table........................................................................................710
17.5.4.4 Displaying Indications Logs Saved in the Offline Configuration..............................711
17.5.4.5 Reading Indications Logs from the SIPROTEC 5 Device...........................................711
17.5.4.6 Specifying an Indication as reference for relative time ..........................................712
17.5.4.7 Deleting Indications Logs Saved in the Offline Configuration.................................712
17.5.4.8 Deleting Indications Logs from a SIPROTEC 5 Device............................................. 713
17.5.4.9 Saving Indications Logs and Indications in a File................................................... 713
17.6 Updating Device Functionality......................................................................................... 715
17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality.......................................................... 715
17.6.2 Determining the Serial Number of the SIPROTEC 5 Device.......................................... 716
17.6.3 Determining the Function-Points Class Required.........................................................717
17.6.4 Selecting the Device Functionality..............................................................................718
17.6.5 Loading the Device Functionality into the SIPROTEC 5 Device..................................... 719
17.7 Updating Firmware......................................................................................................... 721
17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols..........................................................721
17.7.2 Downloading Device Driver and Importing into DIGSI 5.............................................. 722
17.7.3 Opening Firmware and Communication-Module Selection and Adjusting the View..... 723
17.7.4 Preparing Loading Firmware and Protocols.................................................................724
17.7.5 Loading Firmware and Protocols in the SIPROTEC 5 Device(s)..................................... 725
17.8 Using Confirmation IDs and Connection Password........................................................... 727
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password ........................................... 727
17.8.2 Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor.......................................... 728
19 Documentation.........................................................................................................................................767
19.1 Designing Document Template....................................................................................... 768
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents........................................................768
19.1.2 Opening the Document Information Editor................................................................ 768
19.1.3 Opening the Frames Editor........................................................................................ 768
19.1.4 Opening the Cover Pages Editor................................................................................. 769
19.1.5 Using Document Information.....................................................................................769
19.1.6 Customizing View......................................................................................................770
19.1.6.1 Scaling the Document.......................................................................................... 770
19.1.6.2 Using the Hand Mode...........................................................................................771
19.1.6.3 Setting the Unit of Measurement..........................................................................772
19.1.6.4 Using the Grid...................................................................................................... 772
19.1.6.5 Using the Ruler.................................................................................................... 774
19.1.7 Managing Templates................................................................................................. 774
19.1.7.1 Opening a Template.............................................................................................774
19.1.7.2 Adding a Template............................................................................................... 775
19.1.8 Processing a Template............................................................................................... 776
19.1.8.1 Inserting Placeholders for Metadata......................................................................776
19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box.............................................................................. 777
19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image............................................................................779
19.1.8.4 Marking an Object................................................................................................781
19.1.8.5 Changing the Sequence of Objects....................................................................... 782
19.1.8.6 Deleting, Copying, or Pasting Objects................................................................... 783
19.2 Printing Data...................................................................................................................784
19.2.1 Starting the Printing.................................................................................................. 784
19.2.2 Determining the Scope of Printing............................................................................. 785
19.2.3 Selecting Print Options.............................................................................................. 785
19.2.4 Printing Labels for LEDs, Push-Buttons, and Function Keys from DIGSI ........................786
19.3 Using Print Preview......................................................................................................... 788
19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview.................................................................................... 788
19.3.2 Opening the Print Preview......................................................................................... 788
19.3.3 Determining the Preview Scope................................................................................. 789
19.3.4 Selecting Preview Options......................................................................................... 789
19.3.5 Scaling a View........................................................................................................... 790
19.3.6 Navigating in the Print Preview.................................................................................. 791
19.3.7 Starting the Printout.................................................................................................. 793
21 Properties................................................................................................................................................. 809
21.1 Project............................................................................................................................ 810
21.1.1 Project.......................................................................................................................810
21.1.2 IEC 61850 Station......................................................................................................811
21.1.3 User Information....................................................................................................... 811
21.2 Device and Hardware...................................................................................................... 813
21.2.1 Device – Details......................................................................................................... 813
21.2.2 Settings.....................................................................................................................814
21.2.3 Input/Output Module – Details................................................................................... 816
21.2.4 Current Transformer – Details.................................................................................... 816
21.2.5 On-Site Operation Panel Base Module – Details.......................................................... 817
21.2.6 On-Site Operation Panel Expansion Module – Details..................................................817
21.2.7 LED Settings.............................................................................................................. 817
21.2.8 Binary Input – Settings ..............................................................................................818
21.2.9 Binary Output – Settings ........................................................................................... 818
21.2.10 Function Key - parameter ..........................................................................................819
21.3 Display Pages.................................................................................................................. 820
21.3.1 Display Page – Details ............................................................................................... 820
21.3.2 Graphical Element – Details....................................................................................... 820
21.3.3 Dynamic Field – Details..............................................................................................821
21.4 Function Charts (CFC)..................................................................................................... 823
21.4.1 Function Chart – General........................................................................................... 823
21.4.2 Time Stamp............................................................................................................... 824
21.4.3 Sidebars/Layout......................................................................................................... 824
21.4.4 Text Box – General.....................................................................................................825
21.4.5 Text...........................................................................................................................826
21.4.6 Block – General Properties......................................................................................... 826
21.4.7 Parameters................................................................................................................ 827
21.4.8 Invisible Interconnections.......................................................................................... 828
21.4.9 Resources.................................................................................................................. 829
21.4.10 Terminal – General.................................................................................................... 829
21.4.11 Interconnection......................................................................................................... 830
21.4.12 Signal – General........................................................................................................ 831
21.5 Communication Modules and Network............................................................................832
21.5.1 Module Information...................................................................................................832
21.5.2 Serial Module - Channel x Protocols........................................................................... 832
21.5.3 Ethernet Module Communication Protocol ................................................................ 834
21.5.4 Ethernet Addresses....................................................................................................836
21.5.5 Ethernet Interface Protocols ......................................................................................837
21.5.6 Subnet – Details........................................................................................................ 838
21.6 Communication and Network Protocol............................................................................ 839
21.6.1 SNMP Settings........................................................................................................... 839
21.6.2 SNTP Settings............................................................................................................ 839
21.10.2 Quality Processing/Affected by the User for Received GOOSE Values........................... 887
22.3 Matrices..........................................................................................................................937
22.3.1 Communication Mapping.......................................................................................... 937
22.3.2 Information Routing.................................................................................................. 940
22.3.3 Trigger Routing..........................................................................................................942
22.3.4 Function-Group Connections..................................................................................... 943
22.3.5 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Group........................................................ 944
22.3.6 Connecting Function Group to Circuit-Breaker Groups................................................ 945
22.3.7 Connecting Protection-Function Group to Protection-Function Group......................... 945
22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing.......................................................................................... 945
22.3.9 Current-Measuring Points.......................................................................................... 946
22.3.10 Voltage-Measuring Points.......................................................................................... 947
22.3.11 Circuit-Breaker Interaction......................................................................................... 948
22.3.12 Merging-Unit Routing................................................................................................ 949
22.4 Tables............................................................................................................................. 950
22.4.1 Log............................................................................................................................950
22.4.2 Records..................................................................................................................... 950
22.4.3 Indications................................................................................................................ 951
22.4.4 Indication Snapshot................................................................................................... 952
22.4.5 Measurements.......................................................................................................... 952
22.4.6 Measured-Value Snapshot......................................................................................... 954
22.5 Entry, Selection, and Display Areas.................................................................................. 956
22.5.1 Project-Language Selection........................................................................................956
22.5.2 Print Preview............................................................................................................. 956
22.5.3 Device Information.................................................................................................... 957
22.5.4 Device Information ................................................................................................... 957
22.5.5 Resource Consumption.............................................................................................. 959
22.5.6 IO Consumption........................................................................................................ 960
22.5.7 Logs.......................................................................................................................... 961
22.5.8 Time Information.......................................................................................................961
22.5.9 Diagnostic Information.............................................................................................. 962
22.5.10 Device Settings..........................................................................................................963
22.5.11 Time Settings............................................................................................................ 970
22.5.12 Settings.....................................................................................................................972
22.5.13 General .................................................................................................................... 972
22.5.14 DIGSI 5 User Preferences............................................................................................974
22.5.15 Print Options............................................................................................................. 975
22.5.16 Device Comparison.................................................................................................... 976
22.5.17 Firmware Selection....................................................................................................977
22.5.18 Configuration Selection............................................................................................. 978
22.5.19 Upgrade Project Devices............................................................................................ 978
22.5.20 Info........................................................................................................................... 979
22.5.21 General..................................................................................................................... 979
22.5.22 Compile.....................................................................................................................980
22.5.23 Inconsistencies.......................................................................................................... 981
22.6 Dialogs........................................................................................................................... 982
22.6.1 No License.................................................................................................................982
Index.......................................................................................................................................................1033
• For simple applications using individual SIPROTEC 5 devices, select DIGSI 5 Compact. With this variant,
you deal with most standard tasks such as setting parameters or reading out process data. In addition,
this variant also includes the CFC editor and the DIGSI 5 test suite for testing SIPROTEC 5 devices and
functions. CFC offline and online debugging is supported to verify the created logic before downloading
it to the device.
• The DIGSI 5 Standard variant has an extended scope of functions. This variant includes, among others, a
display editor which you can now also use to create your own symbols. With DIGSI 5 Standard, you simu-
late the topology of a system as a 1-phase representation and you configure hardware and networks on a
graphical basis. DIGSI 5 Standard offers full IEC 61850 support, including system configuration.
• DIGSI 5 Premium is the high-end variant of DIGSI 5. You analyze fault records with SIGRA and you use
the advantages of flexible engineering and functional naming for IEC 61850.
You will find a detailed overview of the features of the 3 variants in the Help topic entitled Features of the
Different DIGSI 5 Variants.
Related Topics
2.1.1 Features of the Different DIGSI 5 Variants
• Introduction
The current topic is part of this topic block, where you also find out more about the DIGSI 5 information
system. Further topics are Using DIGSI 5 Help and Safety notes.
• First Steps
This topic block allows you to get to know DIGSI 5 for the first time. For example, you are informed about
the diverse DIGSI 5 variants and you get answers to questions on how to migrate from DIGSI 4 to DIGSI 5.
• Basic Operation
This topic block provides the information you need to quickly familiarize yourself with the newly
designed DIGSI 5 user interface. It includes not only explanations of the basic structure of the user inter-
face and how to adapt it to your requirements, but also information on working with projects and libra-
ries.
• Projects
In this topic block, you find all the information for creating a project and for other actions that are neces-
sary for working with projects.
• Devices
This topic block contains information about inserting offline configurations in the project for the
SIPROTEC 5 devices. You find out how to configure the hardware of SIPROTEC 5 devices and how to
generate display pages for them.
• Single-Line Configuration
In this topic block, you learn how to map a system as a single-line configuration using the single-line
editor. With the symbol editor, you can also generate your own symbols for the single-line configuration.
• Signals
This topic block provides an overview to signals such as measured values or commands. Additionally, you
will receive information about other actions that are necessary for working with signals.
• Information Routing
In this topic block, you will learn how to route information on device components, such as inputs and
outputs on a buffer.
• Test Sequences
The test sequences test the protection functions. This topic block provides the information for generating
and editing test sequences.
• Communication
Besides describing general communication characteristics of SIPROTEC 5 devices, this topic block also tells
you how to configure a communication connection and communicate with a SIPROTEC 5 device. Atten-
tion is focused particularly on communication in compliance with IEC 61850.
• Documentation
DIGSI 5 includes an extensive documentation function. This topic block is therefore devoted to designing
and printing the project documentation.
• Properties
This topic block informs you about global elements and characteristics that are not unique to one specific
device type. For example, these can be communication settings or characteristics of library elements.
• User Interface
The descriptions of all user interface elements are grouped together in this topic block. Here, you find out
all you need to know about editors, tabs in the task card, matrices, tables, various input, and selection
areas and also dialogs and icon bars.
Related Topics
1.1 What is DIGSI 5?
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
4.2 Using DIGSI 5 Help
The following table provides an overview of the features of the 3 DIGSI 5 variants in detail.
Compact Standard Premium
Project Editing
Working simultaneously with several – X X
SIPROTEC 5 devices in one project
Incorporating new SIPROTEC 5 devices with o X X
product code One SIPROTEC 5 device Unrestricted Unrestricted
per project
Graphical hardware and network configuration o X X
Device view only Network and device Network and device
view view
Copying and pasting all elements X X X
Multilingual support X X X
Single-Line Configuration and Display Pages
Graphical single-line editor – X X
Graphical connection of voltage and current – X X
transformers
ANSI and IEC libraries available – X X
Ready-made templates for protection and – X X
control scenarios
Automatic creation of display pages based on – X X
single-line configurations
Creating display pages and display icons – X X
Setting Parameters and Routing Information
Routing information X X X
Intelligent filtering and sorting X X X
All settings visible and modifiable X X X
Graphical display of protection settings – X X
Compare device configurations (offline/offline - o X X
online/offline) online/offline only offline/offline and offline/offline and
online/offline online/offline
Graphically Configurable Functions (CFC)
Function chart (CFC) editor with IEC 61131 X X X
support
CFC offline and online analysis X X X
Communication
Communication mapping for all protocols X X X
Network view – X X
Support of Editions 1 and 2 of IEC 61850 – o X
Basic Advanced
Configuration of GOOSE messages – X X
IEC 61850 – Flexible engineering and func- – – X
tional naming
Device access via Ethernet and USB interface X X X
Legend
Feature available X
Feature available, but with restrictions. Restrictions are described. o
Feature not available –
Related Topics
1.1 What is DIGSI 5?
1 The number of SIGRA licenses is identical to the number of DIGSI licences (1 PC, 5 PCs, or 10 PCs).
Everything you need to configure and operate SIPROTEC 5 devices is seamlessly integrated in the user inter-
face of DIGSI 5. The interface consists of several windows.
[sc_digsi_user_interface, 3, en_US]
DIGSI 5 displays all editing tools such as the Function chart (CFC) editor or the Display editor within the
working area. You use buttons in the object bar to switch between the open tools by clicking with the mouse.
You see the task card on the right-hand side of the user interface. This is where you find context-related tasks
or functions. The Libraries task card has a special significance. The library contains a large number of
elements that you can drag and drop into the project. Among other things, such elements can be function
blocks for a function chart or also icons for equipment that you need for a single-line configuration or a display
page.
Inspector and information cards will help you further if you are interested more in a specific element.
Depending on the element selected, these windows immediately provide you with the suitable display and
input options without any need to open any additional dialogs.
Project
DIGSI 5 manages the components of a system and all the data associated with it in relation to the project.
Topology, SIPROTEC 5 devices, settings values, communication settings, process data and much more are
grouped together and saved under a project name. In other words, you only open one project file to have
access to all data. Conversely, all changes are saved simply by saving the project file.
Project Tree
The project tree is positioned on the left side of the user interface and is the central element when working
with DIGSI 5. Its individual icons give you access to all data and tools. One double click each suffices, and you
will display settings of protection functions, start actions such as loading firmware into SIPROTEC 5 devices or
open one of the editors.
Related Topics
5.1.2 Creating a Project
5.1.3 Opening a Project
• Routing information
• Transmitting settings values from the SIPROTEC 5 device to DIGSI 5 and saving them in files
• Transmitting indications, measured values, and fault records from the SIPROTEC 5 device to DIGSI 5 and
saving them in files
• Controlling equipment
Related Topics
17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
• Project Language
Select the languages to be used as project language from a series of country-specific languages. The
languages in which a project is to be later edited are designated as project languages.
• Editing Language
Define a language as an editing language from the selected project languages. All newly entered or
edited texts are then also saved together with the texts of the editing language currently set.
• Reference Language
Define a language as reference language from the selected project languages. This language serves as a
reference basis when compiling project texts.
Related Topics
2.2.2 Selecting the User Interface Language
5.2.3 Selecting or Deselecting Project Languages
5.2.4 Defining the Editing Language and the Reference Language
6.1.6 Setting the On-Site Operation Panel Language
With this feature in DIGSI 5, the UI display adapts to the respective roles with which the user has logged in to
the Windows session. When you launch DIGSI 5, your user name as per the Windows login session and your
supported role(s) are displayed on the top right side of the DIGSI 5 UI. This feature is best suited for the user
accounts that are centrally managed in a Microsoft Active Directory domain controller. A centrally managed
user account can be added to one or more centrally defined user groups that translate to the roles that DIGSI 5
recognizes.
The roles are generally configured by the Security Administrator in the Active Directory (AD). The following
group names must be used while configuring different roles in the Active Directory:
DIGSI Active Directory (AD)
Administrator SIEMENS ADMIN
Engineer IEC ENGINEER
Security Administrator IEC SECADM
Installer IEC INSTALLER
Viewer IEC VIEWER
If the Windows supported role (user groups in Active Directory) on your PC matches with the following list of
roles predefined in DIGSI 5, then the respective role name is displayed along with the user name:
• Administrator:
In this role, the user is able to view the DIGSI 5 UI in its entirety (which is the only UI option available in
versions of DIGSI 5 prior to V7.90).
• Engineer:
In this role, the user has access to all functions except for managing security, firmware and device
drivers.
• Installer:
In this role, the user has access to all functions except for managing security options.
• Security Administrator:
In this role, the user can manage the security options but can only view the rest of the device settings.
• Viewer:
In this role, the user can only view the device configuration but cannot edit them or access the security
settings.
If the Windows supported role does not match any of the predefined roles supported by DIGSI 5, then the role
name Administrator is displayed by default. If you still want to restrict your access to DIGSI 5 functionalities to
prevent unintended changes to the project, you may do so by manually selecting a specific role for your
current DIGSI 5 session. You can click the user name or the supported role to open the Select role(s) dialog
and select the required role. The permissions associated with each role are mentioned in the Select role(s)
dialog.
[sc_digsi_user_roles, 1, en_US]
The selected roles are then enforced on the DIGSI 5 UI in the same way that the device enforces them on the
HMI (read-only, read and write, hide).
The following figure shows the difference in UI display when a user logs in with different supported roles
(Administrator and Engineer). The user logged in as Engineer does not have access to security settings and
also cannot manage firmware or device drivers.
[sc_digsi_admin_engineer_view, 1, en_US]
Legend
Y Yes
N No
W Write access
R Read-only
Switching the Supported Roles between the Offline and Online Configuration
• Regardless of what roles are applied for/by the user while working with DIGSI 5 offline, once the user
successfully logs on to an RBAC-enabled device, DIGSI 5 reconfigures its UI if necessary to match the
role(s) as determined by the device for the logged-on user. After a connection is established with any
RBAC-enabled device, the project tree and menus/toolbar buttons state is updated based on the online
supported role(s) and all the opened Editors are closed. Further, the online supported role is displayed on
the top right side of the DIGSI UI.
• When the user deletes the saved online credentials in DIGSI 5 or when the online session times out, the
online roles of the user are retained.
Related Topics
2.1.6 Deleting Saved Login Credentials
20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control
It can be cumbersome for users to log in to each device they need to interact with, in a DIGSI 5 session by
providing the credentials each time a device is connected to. To make the access control less cumbersome,
DIGSI 5 securely remembers the last successfully used credentials of a user for the duration that the applica-
tion is still running. These credentials are not persisted on the disk drive and are lost once the DIGSI 5 applica-
tion is ended or terminated. Once DIGSI 5 caches the users credentials, DIGSI 5 uses these credentials to log in
on behalf of the user for all subsequent connection attempts to RBAC-enabled devices.
DIGSI 5 allows you to delete the credentials of the user previously logged in from the cache via the Online
menu option Delete saved login credentials and prompts you to log in again. By default, the cache is cleared
if DIGSI 5 is inactive for 30 min.
Related Topics
² 2.1.5 Role-Based Views in DIGSI 5
² 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control
DIGSI 5 securely remembers the last successfully used credentials of a user for the duration that the applica-
tion is still running. These credentials are not persisted on the disk drive and are lost once the DIGSI 5 applica-
tion is ended or terminated. Once DIGSI 5 caches the users credentials, DIGSI 5 uses these credentials to log in
on behalf of the user for all subsequent connection attempts to RBAC-enabled devices.
You can ensure that DIGSI 5 saves or forgets the login credentials via the following toggle-menu options avail-
able for Security:
Related Topics
² 2.1.5 Role-Based Views in DIGSI 5
² 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control
NOTE
i Use of DIGSI 5 is based on single-user licenses in various versions. If you do not possess a valid license, or if
your license is damaged, the 22.6.1 No License dialog is displayed during the start of DIGSI 5. With this
dialog, you can decide how to proceed.
NOTE
i DIGSI 5 needs an active internet connection to verify the status of the installed DIGSI 5 version.
Related Topics
² 2.2.10 Using DIGSI 5 Licenses
² 2.1.2 User Interface, Project, and Project Tree
² 2.2.2 Selecting the User Interface Language
² 2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
² 2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers
The installation language selected when installing DIGSI 5 is set as the default UI language after a newly
created project is opened. The user interface is available in different languages. You can select one of these
languages as the user interface language. The designations of all device-independent operating elements and
information are then displayed in the selected language.
Related Topics
² 2.1.4 Languages in DIGSI 5
DIGSI 5 can execute various actions when starting up. You can define these actions with the aid of various
options:
Related Topics
² 2.2.4 Defining Storage Locations
You can save the storage locations for new projects and libraries in DIGSI 5. Thus, you avoid manual selection
of storage locations when creating projects and libraries.
Related Topics
² 2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
You can select the storage locations for data exchange in DIGSI 5.
Related Topics
² 2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
The units of all values can be displayed in compliance with the US standard or SI standard.
In the basic settings of DIGSI 5, you can select one of both unit systems. SIPROTEC 5 devices newly added to
the project and all existing SIPROTEC 5 devices take over the selected unit system.
You can change the unit system of each individual SIPROTEC 5 device separately.
For you to be able to incorporate and edit SIPROTEC 5 devices of a specific type in a project, install a device
driver for this type. Device drivers are files in the DDD (DIGSI 5 Device Driver) format.
One DDD file can contain various data:
• Parameter set
• Communication protocols
• Communication mappings
• Library elements
Before installation, you can use a preview function to check whether you have selected the right elements. If
so, then start installation. As soon as you have installed a device driver, an entry for the associated device type
is created in the global DIGSI 5 library. You can then access the associated data of the device type in all proj-
ects.
NOTE
i Using DIGSI 5 V6.00 or later, you can import a maximum number of 15 DDD files at a time. An error
message is displayed if the Device drivers exceed the allowed import limit.
NOTE
i While installing DIGSI 5 V7.80, you can maintain the already installed DDDs with an older version of the
DIGSI 5 setup and restore them with the newly installed version. Further, it is possible to define the backup
path for DDDs during setup.
NOTE
i At least 1 element must be selected to start the import. You can only select elements that have not yet
been imported. Icons on the right of the entries indicate that an element has already been imported.
Device drivers are files in the DDD format (DIGSI 5 Device Driver). You can manage imported device drivers by
viewing the status of the DDD information. The status of the DDDs is displayed as Installed or Withdrawn in
the 22.1.33 Manage Device Drivers View editor.
You can also view the status of the withdrawn DDD information under the following conditions:
• DIGSI startup
During DIGSI startup, a dialog appears displaying the list of withdrawn DDDs that are currently installed in
DIGSI. For additional information about the withdrawn DDDs displayed in this dialog, you can refer to the
22.1.33 Manage Device Drivers View editor.
• Updating firmware
Upon opening the Load firmware to devices (standard view), the withdrawn firmware components are
indicated with a warning icon. Additionally, a tooltip at the warning icon displays the relevant informa-
tion regarding the withdrawn DDD. If the firmware components under the current version are displayed
as Withdrawn, you can schedule a version which is not withdrawn and you can update the firmware.
NOTE
i Any DDD (for example, Protocol or Protection) can be uninstalled individually. Individual uninstallation of
the Protocol DDD can lead to inconsistencies.
Selecting the option Select all withdrawn DDD(s) uninstalls the DDDs which are not supported by DIGSI 5.
Using the Preview button in the Uninstall device drivers dialog, you can preview the list of all affected
devices (part of the device driver).
² Click Uninstall.
The selected DDDs in DIGSI are uninstalled.
NOTE
i DIGSI 5 PC needs an active internet connection to update the status of the imported DDDs.
Related Topics
² 2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers
² 2.2.1 Starting DIGSI 5
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 22.6.5 Add New Device
² 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
² 22.5.19 Upgrade Project Devices
² 22.7.25 Toolbar Editor Upgrade Project Devices
Exit DIGSI 5
² In the Project menu, click Exit.
If you have changed the project since the last save, the confirmation prompt is displayed. Select one of the
following options.
² To save changes in the current project and to close DIGSI 5, click Yes.
- or -
² To close DIGSI 5 without saving the last changes in the project, click No.
- or -
² Click Cancel if you wish to cancel the exit operation. In this case DIGSI 5 remains open.
NOTE
i A security query also appears if you have made changes to online devices and have not yet saved them.
Related Topics
² 5.1.5 Saving a Project
Licenses control the scope of DIGSI 5 functions that you can use. For example, you do not need a license if you
work with DIGSI 5 Compact. However, you can only use a considerably restricted scope of functions. If you
need the functional scope of DIGSI 5 Standard or DIGSI 5 Premium, install the relevant license on your
computer. You can then use the additional functionality immediately. Like when using the different variants of
DIGSI 5, also activate some optional functions and features with additional licenses. SIGRA is an example of
this.
You install, update, transfer, or delete licenses with the Automation License Manager. This is installed on your
computer together with DIGSI 5. Automation License Manager has its own help files, which inform you in
detail about the possibilities and methods.
Use of DIGSI 5 is based on single-user licenses. You cannot use one single DIGSI 5 license concurrently on
several computers. You can, however, transfer a license from one computer to another. You can do that via a
network or with a USB stick (flash drive).
NOTE
i If you do not have a license, you can activate the Premium variant of DIGSI 5 with a test license. This test
license is valid for 30 days and can only be used once. The 22.6.1 No License dialog is displayed if DIGSI 5
does not detect a valid license on starting. Use this dialog to select the next steps.
NOTE
i Unlike with DIGSI 4, you cannot correct loss of a license by calling Siemens. Damaged licenses can be
repaired, however. As a transitional measure, you can use an emergency license in the event of a defect or
a loss of a license. This emergency license is valid for 14 days and can only be used once. The 22.6.1 No
License dialog is displayed if DIGSI 5 does not detect a valid license on startup. Use this dialog to select the
next steps.
Related Topics
² 2.2.1 Starting DIGSI 5
In DIGSI 4, the Manager is the initial platform for editing individual devices, modem connections and more.
Instead of the DIGSI 4 Manager, DIGSI 5 has a common user interface for all required tools. Working with
several overlapping cards is now a thing of the past. The 3.1.2 Project Tree is now your control center.
If you prefer a similar representation as in the DIGSI 4 Manager, open the 3.1.6 Overview Window. You can
view the individual objects with details, as a list or as icons.
NOTE
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
Instead of an MLFB (machine-readable product designation), SIPROTEC 5 devices have a product code, in both
a long and a short form.
The long product code corresponds to the order number of a SIPROTEC 5 device. You find this number in your
order documents. DIGSI 5 can directly interpret this long product code, as every character of the code can be
assigned uniquely to a property of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
For easier handling, there is the short product code, which uniquely identifies a long product code. The short
product code can be configured directly in DIGSI 5. You can find the short product code on the name plate of
the SIPROTEC 5 device and it is also available during ordering.
Related Topics
6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code
To edit a device in DIGSI 4, you had to open this device with the device editing function. This is no longer
necessary in DIGSI 5.
In the 3.1.2 Project Tree, you find one entry for each SIPROTEC 5 device offline configuration. This entry
summarizes all actions and access points that you need to edit this offline configuration.
Thus, for example, you display the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix by double-clicking to route information
in the working area. This also works parallel for several offline configurations.
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
In DIGSI 4, you had to open a device for editing and you had to adapt the scope of functions of the device in
the DIGSI 4 device editing function. This is now no longer necessary. In DIGSI 5, you already select a so-called
application template (Standard and User-defined) when adding a new SIPROTEC 5 device.
Application templates which are either standard or user-defined make further project planning simpler for a
SIPROTEC 5 device. Each template contains the most important functions that are required for a specific appli-
cation. Examples of such applications are line protection, motor, and transformer protection.
Selecting a certain application template consequently determines the basic functional scope of a SIPROTEC 5
device. You can change this by adding and removing functions. You can do this with drag and drop in
22.1.2 Single-Line Editor, in the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix or also within the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
2.3.5 Why Can I Not Route to CFC and the Display in the Information Routing?
In DIGSI 4, you must route to CFC in the matrix the information that you need for a CFC function, or which is
generated as a result of a CFC function. The same applies to information that you need in the display.
All information that is listed in the information routing is automatically at your disposal in the 22.1.11 Func-
tion-Chart (CFC) Editor and the 22.1.14 Display Editor of DIGSI 5. It is no longer necessary to route to CFC or
the display.
The columns for CFC and for the display in the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix serve only to indicate
whether an item of information is used within a function chart (CFC) or the display. The display appears auto-
matically as soon as you link an item of information with a function block or an element on a display page.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
2.3.6 How Do I Edit the Basic Display and the Control Display?
There is no longer any distinction between the main display and the control display, and there are now only
display pages in SIPROTEC 5 and DIGSI 5.
In DIGSI 5 Standard and DIGSI 5 Premium, for every SIPROTEC 5 device you can generate up to 10 display
pages with graphics, text and measured values and can save them into the SIPROTEC 5 device. You use the
Display editor to generate this. You yourself decide for which operating state you use which display page.
Related Topics
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Everything you need to configure and operate SIPROTEC 5 devices is seamlessly integrated in the user inter-
face of DIGSI 5. The user interface of DIGSI 5 consists of several windows.
The following figure shows an example of the components of the DIGSI 5 user interface:
[sc_digsi_ui, 3, en_US]
• 22.2.5 Signals
• 22.2.1 Tasks
• 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog
• 22.2.3 Libraries
• 22.2.6 Online
Certain tabs contain the Information palette. If you highlight an
element, for example in the library, this palette shows detailed
information about this element.
10 Task card The 3.1.5 Task Card contains the contents of various tabs
depending on the content of the working area. These tabs enable
actions such as searching, or contain structured elements in libra-
ries and catalogs, for example blocks for function charts (CFC).
11 Inspector window The 3.1.4 Inspector Window shows additional information about
an element highlighted in the working area or on actions
executed. This information includes the properties of an element,
for example.
12 Object bar The 3.1.7 Object Bar contains buttons for all open editors, tables,
input and output areas. You can switch swiftly between open tools
with these buttons.
Related Topics
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
DIGSI 5 manages the components of a system and all the data associated with it in relation to the project. The
project tree gives you access to all data and tools. The following figure shows the project tree.
[sc_digsi_projectree, 4, en_US]
The figure shows the symbol for a SIPROTEC 5 device of the type 6MD86. Further entries are subordinate to
this, giving you access to device data. Double-clicking on the symbol in the lowermost level of a branch opens
an editor or a setting sheet or executes a certain action in the working area.
• The Single-line configuration entry is an access point to an editor. Double clicking this entry opens the
22.1.2 Single-Line Editor.
• The entries in the Settings area are access points to function settings. Double-clicking one of these
entries opens the setting sheet associated with the function.
• The Add new device entry is an action. This lets you open a dialog enabling you to add a new
SIPROTEC 5 device.
Among other things, you can perform the following actions with the project-tree function:
• Open the 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor to create the topology of a system and to define the functional scope
of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Open the 22.1.7 Device View to configure the hardware of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Display the link 22.1.9 Settings Editor to define individual function settings.
• Open the 22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor to configure additional functions such as interlockings.
• Transfer indications, measured values, and fault records from the SIPROTEC 5 device to a PC.
• Control equipment
[digscree-281011-17, 2, en_US]
• Devices
You can sort the devices in chronological/alphanumeric order via the Sort devices by context menu
options of the project node. You can sort according to the following information:
– Date created
– Name
– Ascending
– Descending
[sc_digsi_sort_devices, 2, en_US]
By default, the newly created device is always inserted at the bottom of the list.
• Test sequences
The test sequences are sorted automatically in alphanumeric order while performing the following
actions:
– Opening the project
– Adding a new test sequence
– Renaming the test sequence
– Importing a test sequence
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
5.1.1 Overview of Projects
The tools that you open to edit elements are displayed within the working area:
• Editors
• Overview window
You can open several tools simultaneously in the working area. The 3.1.7 Object Bar then contains one button
for each opened tool. You can switch between the individual tools with these buttons.
You can split the working area horizontally or vertically. In this way, you can display 2 tools simultaneously in
the working area. You find more information about this under 3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area.
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
Additional information about a selected element or actions executed is displayed in the Inspector window.
The following figure shows the components of the Inspector window:
[digscree-281011-07.png, 2, en_US]
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
Depending on the object edited or selected, tabs are available in the task card for execution of further actions.
Here are a few examples:
[digscree-281011-20.tif, 2, en_US]
The following tabs are available depending on the relevant working situation:
• 22.2.5 Signals
• 22.2.1 Tasks
• 22.2.3 Libraries
• 22.2.6 Online
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
The overview window supplements the 3.1.2 Project Tree. When the overview window is open, the content of
the folder currently selected in project tree is displayed in the 3.1.3 Working Area.
You can perform the following actions in the overview window:
• Opening objects
• Renaming objects
[digscree-281011-18, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
The object bar contains one button for each tool opened in the 3.1.3 Working Area. In certain cases, the object
bar groups several buttons into one single button, for example when you have opened several display pages.
A list box expands when you click such a button. Out of this list box, you can then select the required content
and display it in the working area.
The following figure shows an example of the object bar:
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
3.2.1 Adjusting Working Area
The object displayed in the working area before clicking, and the object that corresponds to the next button in
the object toolbar are displayed among each other.
The object displayed in the working area before clicking, and the object that corresponds to the next button in
the object toolbar are displayed among each other.
Related Topics
² 3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
You can adjust the columns and rows of tables and matrices in different ways:
[digsicon-281011-08.png, 3, en_US]
[digsicon-281011-11.png, 2, en_US]
[digsicon-281011-07.png, 2, en_US]
[digsicon-281011-10.png, 2, en_US]
Related Topics
² 3.2.3 Sorting Column Content
² 3.2.4 Filtering Column Content
You can sort the content of tables and matrices. To do this, select a column as the reference. You can select an
alphabetically ascending or descending sort order for the content of this column. The order of the rest of the
column content is adjusted automatically. You cannot sort columns independently from one another.
Related Topics
² 3.2.4 Filtering Column Content
² 3.2.2 Adjusting Rows and Columns
You can filter the content of tables and matrices. Filtered tables and matrices show only the rows that comply
with the selected criteria. Each column has a column filter of its own. You can therefore filter the entire data
on the basis of several columns. The filters are additive. This means that each column filter used further
restricts the subset of the data.
You have the following possibilities for filtering the content of a column:
NOTE
i It is not possible to filter according to the user-defined criteria via the 22.6.25 Custom Filter option in the
22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor. The filters are AND-connected.
Canceling Filtering
² In the column you wish to filter, click in the cell underneath the column header.
The cell changes to a list box.
Related Topics
² 3.2.5 Creating a User-Defined Filter
² 3.2.3 Sorting Column Content
² 3.2.2 Adjusting Rows and Columns
In the case of a table or a matrix, you can select 3.2.4 Filtering Column Content, also with a user-defined filter.
To do this, create column-specific filters with the Custom filter dialog. A filter consists at least of a condition
and a value which, together, result in a so-called expression. Examples of such expressions are Equal to 20
and Does not contain block.
You can select from the following conditions:
• Equals
• Begins with
• Ends with
• Contains
² If you wish to add a further expression to the filter, select a further condition and an associated value as
described in the previous sections.
² Select the operator with which you wish to combine the new expression with the existing ones.
² Click Add to filter.
The expression is displayed in the Filter expression field in combination with the selected operator plus the
existing expressions.
Deleting Expressions
² Click Clear filter.
All expressions in the Filter field are deleted.
Applying a Filter
² Click OK.
The Create user-defined filter dialog closes. The display of the content is updated in relation to the filter you
have created.
NOTE
i The OK button is not active until you have created at least one expression and have added it to the filter.
Related Topics
² 3.2.4 Filtering Column Content
If you wish to copy data within DIGSI 5 or into other applications such as Excel, you must mark these data. In a
table or matrix, you can select cells, ranges, rows, or columns.
You have the following possibilities:
² Press the left mouse button when the mouse pointer changes to a vertical arrow.
The marking is extended.
² Release the shift button.
Libraries allow you to work efficiently in DIGSI 5. They contain elements that you drag and drop to a specific
destination in your project. For example, this destination can be a function chart (CFC), the single-line configu-
ration or a display page. Libraries are grouped together on the 22.2.3 Libraries tab. This tab is part of the task
card.
Library Types
DIGSI 5 distinguishes 2 library types:
• Project Library
Each project has its own library. The elements in this library are available only within the open project.
The project library allows you to store function charts (CFC) for a project-internal reuse. The project
library is always opened, saved, and closed together with the current project.
Related Topics
3.3.2 Opening the Libraries Tab
3.3.6 Filtering the View
3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
3.3.5 Using Elements of the Global DIGSI 5 Library
3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries
There are several ways you can open the 22.2.3 Libraries tab:
• You can open it with the aid of the tab bar on the right-hand edge of the task area.
• You can open it with the aid of the context menus out of the 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor or the
22.1.14 Display Editor.
Related Topics
² 3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
² 3.3.6 Filtering the View
² 3.3.5 Using Elements of the Global DIGSI 5 Library
² 3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
² 3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
² 22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries
The user-defined global DIGSI 5 library allows you to save the complete device configuration as a device
master copy in the DIGSI 5 library. Further, the user-defined global DIGSI 5 library with the respective device
master copies can be stored on any storing device (for example, a USB stick or a network drive) and trans-
ferred to a new location. It can be opened from any project from where the storage path is accessible.
[sc_digsi_globallibraries, 1, en_US]
²
In the 22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries, click the button.
[sc_digsi_createnewlibrary, 2, en_US]
This dialog displays the default value for Library name, Path, Author and an empty text box for the Comment
field.
² Enter the desired values.
² Click Create.
The Creating library dialog displays the progress status of the creation of the library. After successful comple-
tion, the library is created and displayed in the Global libraries palette with 3 subfolders (Types, Master
copies, and Common data).
[sc_digsi_library, 1, en_US]
[sc_digsi_openlibrary, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i To edit and work with the library file, uncheck the option Open as read-only before opening any library
file.
² Click Open.
The Loading library dialog displays the progress status of the opening of the library file. After completion, the
library file is successfully added and displayed in the Global libraries palette.
Creating a Device Master Copy of the Project Device/CFC Chart/Display Symbol/Documentation Templates
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Select any project device, CFC chart, display symbol (standard or user-defined), or user-defined documen-
tation template (Document information, Frames, Cover pages) under Documentation settings in the
project tree.
² Drag and drop the project device, CFC chart, display symbol (standard or user-defined), and/or user-
defined documentation template over the desired user-defined library in the Master copies folder.
- or -
² Copy the project device, CFC chart, display symbol (standard or user-defined), and/or user-defined docu-
mentation template from the project tree and paste it in the Master copies folder using the context
menu.
The Insert master copy dialog displays the progress status and after completion, the device master copy of
the project device/CFC chart/display symbol/documentation template is created and displayed in the Global
libraries palette.
[sc_digsi_create_mastercopy, 3, en_US]
NOTE
i You can select only one project device at a time for creating the respective device master copy. It is possible
to select multiple CFC charts at a time in the project tree and to paste them as a single device master copy
with the context menu Paste as a single master copy.
Adding a Device in the Project Tree from the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Select the desired device master copy from the Master copies folder under the user-defined library.
² Drag and drop the device master copy from the Master copies folder to the project tree.
- or -
² Copy the device master copy from the Master copies folder and paste it in the project tree using the
context menu.
The device is added and displayed in the project tree with the default name.
Deleting a Master Device Copy from the User-Defined DIGSI 5 Global Library
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette which contains the user-defined libraries with the device master
copies.
² Right-click the device master copy from the Master copies folder in the user-defined library.
² Click Delete in the context menu.
A confirmation prompt appears to confirm deletion.
² Click Yes.
The Delete dialog displays the progress status of deletion. After completion, the device master copy is
deleted.
Related Topics
² 3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
² 3.3.6 Filtering the View
² 3.3.5 Using Elements of the Global DIGSI 5 Library
All graphical elements, for example for the single-line configuration or the display pages, can be displayed in
compliance with either the ANSI or IEC standard. You can select at any time which of the 2 representations are
to be active. However, both of them can never be active at the same time.
You make a cross-project selection. It affects display of the elements in the libraries, but also those inserted in
the single-line configuration. By contrast, icons on display pages do not change. This enables you to create
display pages for 2 different standards.
Related Topics
² 3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
You use the elements of a library at different points in a project, for example in the 22.1.11 Function-Chart
(CFC) Editor or in the 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor.
If you mark an element in a library, the information window will show detailed information on this element.
Using Elements
² Open the global DIGSI 5 library so that you can see the elements of the library.
² Select the applicable element in it and drag it to the required point of use.
If insertion is not allowed at this position, the mouse pointer changes to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button.
The element is inserted if the selected point of use is permitted.
Related Topics
² 3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
² 3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries
You can apply a context-related filter to the display to increase the clarity of extensive libraries. In this way,
you reduce the display to those elements that you need for the object that is currently active in the working
area. When you are editing a display page, for example, and context-related filtering is active, the library
shows the elements for single-line configuration and display pages only.
Related Topics
² 3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
² 3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
² 22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries
Related Topics
² 4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
• Information window, which displays details about elements from the library or from the catalogs
• Search function in the task area for finding information in editors, tables, and matrices
• Tutorial with visual explanations for all SIPROTEC 5 and DIGSI 5 core areas
DIGSI 5 Help
In the form of the Help function, DIGSI 5 offers you an extensive information package that describes the func-
tionality of all modules. DIGSI 5 Help also contains more in-depth reference information and practically
oriented examples. To launch DIGSI 5 Help, select the Show help menu item in the Help menu.
DIGSI 5 Help opens in a window that does not cover up the working area. You can vary the size of this
window. You can display a table of contents or an index in addition to the content. To find information about
a module or an activity, you can search through the Help for a topic or a keyword. You find more information
about this under 4.2 Using DIGSI 5 Help.
Info Tab
The 22.5.20 Info tab displays messages with which you can monitor states, sequences, and results of actions.
An icon classifies each message in the Info tab. You find more information about this icons under 4.4 Icons in
the Info Tab.
The messages in the Info tab are divided thematically into 5 further tabs:
• 22.5.21 General
• 22.5.22 Compile
• Cross-references
• 22.5.23 Inconsistencies
• Search results
Information Window
If you mark an element, for example in the library, the Information window displays detailed information
about this element.
The information window is available for the following task-card tabs:
• Libraries
• Hardware catalog
• Signal catalog
Status Dialog
When certain procedures, for example, the transmission of configurations, are completed, the 22.6.26 Status
Dialog opens.. This dialog displays information about the completed procedure. You find more information
about this under 3.4 Using the Status Dialog.
Tutorial
On the SIPROTEC 5 and DIGSI 5 Tutorial DVD, you find a detailed animated Start-Up for DIGSI 5. Ask your
Siemens contact person for this DVD.
- or -
²
To redisplay help topics already displayed, click the button in the DIGSI 5 help toolbar and .
- or -
²
To get to the Help homepage, click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
² To exclude Help topics that contain a certain word from the search, place the NOT operator before the
word.
Printing Information
² Click the Print button.
The table of contents opens in a window of its own.
² In Print help topics dialog, mark the folders and help topics you want to print with a checkmark.
² Click the Print button.
The marked information is printed.
Related Topics
² 4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
² 1.2 Information Scope of the DIGSI 5 Help
• Icon
This icon indicates a change to the offline configuration since the last time it was transferred into the
SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is displayed in the project next to the name of the offline configuration.
After a successful transmission of the offline configuration into the associated SIPROTEC 5 device, the
icon disappears. When you make the first change to the offline configuration, the icon reappears.
• Icon
This icon indicates inconsistencies in an offline configuration. The icon is displayed in the project next to
the name of the offline configuration.
To find out in which areas inconsistencies exist, open the offline configuration. All folders and functions
that contain inconsistencies are each identified with their own icon.
• Icon
This icon indicates an operational and active online access. The icon is displayed in the list of online
accesses next to the name of the online access.
• Icon
This icon indicates an online access that is not operational. The icon is displayed in the list of online
accesses next to the name of the online access.
• Icon
This icon indicates an active connection between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is displayed
in the list of online accesses next to the name of the online configuration belonging to the SIPROTEC 5
device.
If you manually disconnect the connection, the icon is hidden. If, for example, an error in the line inter-
rupts the connection, the icon is replaced by the icon .
• Icon
This icon indicates an interrupted connection between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is
displayed in the list of online accesses next to the name of the online configuration belonging to the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
When you reactivate the connection, the icon is replaced by the icon .
• Icon
This icon indicates a change in the device and security configurations since the last time they were trans-
ferred into the SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is displayed for the device in the project tree.
After loading the device and security configurations to the device successfully, the icon disappears.
• Icon
This icon indicates a change in the device configuration since the last time it was transferred into the
SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is displayed for the device in the project tree.
After loading the device configuration to the device successfully, the icon disappears.
• Icon
This icon indicates a change in the device and security configurations since the last time they were trans-
ferred into the SIPROTEC 5 device. A warning symbol is displayed if the same communication module is
used for RSTP and DIGSI 5 connection. The icon is displayed for the device in the project tree.
The icon disappears in the following scenarios:
– After selecting different communication modules for RSTP and DIGSI 5 connection
– After loading the device and security configurations to the device successfully
• Icon
This icon indicates a change in the security configuration since the last time it was transferred into the
SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is displayed for the device in the project tree.
After loading the security settings to the device successfully, the icon disappears.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
• Icon
This icon indicates the message pertaining to a total action that is completed normally. An example of
such a message is Project Manhatten South opened. The icon is used in the 22.5.21 General tab and in
the 22.5.22 Compile tab.
• Icon
This icon indicates the message to a partial action. The partial action can occur successfully. An example
is Device 7SL87 is added to life list via USB. The partial action can also occur unsuccessfully. An
example is Fallback language is not available. The icon, however, always identifies a non-critical proce-
dure or state. The icon is used in the General, Compile, and Search results tabs.
• Icon
This icon indicates the message to a critical procedure or state. An example of such a message is The
number of used function points (404) exceeds the available limit (200). The icon is used in the
General and Compile tabs.
• Icon
This icon indicates a group that pools all messages belonging to a SIPROTEC 5 device. The icon is used in
the 22.5.23 Inconsistencies tab.
• Icon
This icon indicates an inconsistency message or a location where a search result can be found. An
example of an inconsistency message is Invalid measuring point routing voltage (3ph). An example of
a location is Routing. The icon is used in the Inconsistencies and Search results tabs.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
• Missing hardware
To do so, click button in the toolbar of DIGSI 5. When no icons are displayed in the project tree and no
messages are displayed in the Inconsistencies tab, the offline configurations are consistent.
DIGSI 5 checks the offline configuration once more directly before loading into the SIPROTEC 5 device. If the
offline configuration is inconsistent, DIGSI 5 aborts the loading process.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
Related Topics
² 4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
Related Topics
² 4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
DIGSI 5 manages the components of a system and all the data associated with it in relation to the project.
Topology, SIPROTEC 5 devices, settings values, communication settings, process data, and much more are
grouped together and saved under a project name. In other words, only open 1 project file to have access to
all data. Conversely, all changes are saved simply by saving the project file. If you have opened a project, the
project will be displayed in a hierarchical structure in the 3.1.2 Project Tree. The symbols and text boxes in the
project tree provide you with access to all of the project data and the actions associated with it.
• You can compare and copy the data of several SIPROTEC 5 devices within a project.
Related Topics
5.1.2 Creating a Project
5.1.3 Opening a Project
5.1.5 Saving a Project
5.1.8 Deleting a Project
5.1.9 Printing Project Data
5.1.10 Project Data in Windows Explorer
You require a project to be able to edit data relating to devices and systems. You can create as many projects
as you wish.
The Create a New Project dialog opens. For additional information, refer to 22.6.2 Create a New Project.
² Enter the desired project name and path or accept the data suggested.
² Click Create.
A new project is created and saved in the standard directory for projects. The project is then displayed in the
3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
Open the relevant project to be able to edit data relating to devices and systems.
NOTE
i You can never open more than one project at a time with 1 DIGSI 5. If you open a project, another project
currently open will be closed. However, you can open several instances of DIGSI 5 and in this way work on
several projects simultaneously.
Opening a Project
² In the Project menu, click Open.
- or -
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
The Open project dialog opens. This contains a list box of the projects last used. For additional information,
refer to 22.6.3 Open Project.
² Mark a project name in this list box and click Open.
- or -
² If the desired project is not in the list box, click Browse.
A standard file dialog is opened.
² Navigate to the desired project folder and open the project file with the file extension .dp5vx. x indicates
the DIGSI 5 version number. Project files in DIGSI 5 version V1 have the file extension .dp5v1.
The project opens in the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
NOTE
i If DIGSI 5 has not yet started, you can also double-click a project file with the file extension .dp5vx. DIGSI 5
then starts and the project opens.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
NOTE
i An IEC station is not assigned automatically to the System configurator project. You must select the path of
the SCD file used by the System configurator in the related project. This project and SCD file should be
created before the project conversion starts.
Projects created using older DIGSI versions before V6.00 do not contain the IEC Stations node in the project
tree. The IEC Stations node is created automatically during project conversion. If the converted project
contains IEC enabled devices, these devices are automatically added to the new IEC station.
The project converter feature enables you to upgrade a project created with an older version to the current
installed DIGSI 5 version. This upgrade makes the project structure compatible to work on projects that were
created using earlier versions.
DIGSI 5 versions earlier than DIGSI 5 V6.00 also served as system configurator. The projects created with such
versions also contained the complete IEC 61850 configurations for their devices. Starting from V6.00,
however, DIGSI 5 does not support this functionality. Instead, an external system configurator tool (IEC System
Configurator) is used for managing the IEC 61850 configurations.
Apart from this, new elements like the IEC 61850 stations folder, and IEC station is introduced in V6.00 to
group the IEC configured devices for the system configurator. Each station can be assigned to a System
Configurator project in order to provide a smooth interaction between DIGSI 5 and IEC 61850 System Configu-
rator tool to maintain the configuration.
Converting a Project
² In the Project menu, click Open.
- or -
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
The Open project dialog appears displaying a list of the projects recently used. For additional information,
refer to 22.6.3 Open Project.
² Mark any project name which is created using earlier version than the current version from this list and
click Open.
- or -
² If the desired project is not displayed in this list, click Browse.
A standard file dialog opens.
² Navigate to the desired project folder and open the project file which is created using earlier version.
² Click Open.
Any currently opened project in DIGSI is closed and the Upgrade project dialog appears for confirmation.
² Click OK.
The conversion starts and the Upgrade log dialog displays the upgrade progress status. After successful
conversion, the newly created project is ready to be used in the current DIGSI 5 version installed on your PC. If
the earlier project had IEC, another dialog appears when the newly converted project is opened. Here, you
must attach the IEC Station to a System Configurator project. Else, the DIGSI 5 project is closed again. During
the conversion process, the station folder and station node are created and all IEC configured devices are
added to the IEC station. A confirmation prompt appears to register IEC station to a System Configurator
project.
NOTE
i Only the projects created with DIGSI 5 V7.00 or a higher version are supported for conversion in the current
installed DIGSI 5 version on your PC. If you select any other source project for conversion, which is not
compatible with the current installed version, an error message is displayed.
To open a project created with any version from DIGSI 5 V4.00 to DIGSI 5 V6.20, you must first open and
upgrade the project with DIGSI 5 V7.00, DIGSI 5 V7.20, or DIGSI 5 V7.30. After successful upgrade, you can
perform a further upgrade with the same project using the current installed DIGSI 5 version on your PC and
work on it.
To open any project created with DIGSI 5 V3.00, you must first open and upgrade the project with DIGSI 5
V4.00 or DIGSI 5 V5.00 and perform the upgrade mentioned in the preceding sections to proceed further.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 15.14 Migrating the IEC 61850 Configuration from earlier DIGSI 5 Versions
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
You can save a project at any time either with the same name or any another name. You can also save projects
that still contain erroneous elements.
Saving a Project
² In the Project menu, click Save.
- or -
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
All changes in the project are saved under the current project name.
Save Project As
² In the Project menu, click Save as.
The Save current project as dialog is opened.
² Select the desired project folder from the Save in list box.
² Enter the new project name in the File name text box.
² Click Save.
The project is saved under the new name.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
In order to save a project as a backup file and retrieve it later, you can archive the project created in DIGSI
under the same name or any another name in the desired location. Further, after archiving any currently
opened project in DIGSI, you can continue working on the project without closing it. At any point of time, you
can always retrieve the archived version of the project and start working on it, if necessary.
Archiving a Project
² In the Project menu, click Archive.
The Archive dialog opens displaying the Name and Source path of the currently opened project.
[sc_digsi_archive, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You can also archive the desired project file by navigating to the source path via the icon and selecting
the file with extension .dp5vx.
² Enter the desired project name in the File name text box in the standard file dialog.
² Click Archive.
A progress dialog appears displaying the archive status and the archived project file is saved in the desired
location with the file extension .dz5.
The Open project dialog opens. This contains a list box of the projects last used. For additional information,
refer to 22.6.3 Open Project.
² Click Browse.
A standard file dialog is opened.
² Navigate to the desired project folder and open the project file with the file extension .dz5.
The project opens in the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
NOTE
i If DIGSI 5 has not yet started, you can also double-click a project file with the file extension.dz5. DIGSI 5
then starts and the project opens.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 5.1.3 Opening a Project
You can close a project during any phase of the project planning.
Closing a Project
² In the Project menu, click Close.
If you have changed the project since last saving it, a confirmation prompt appears. Select one of the
following options:
² If you save changes in the current project and wish to close the project, click Yes.
- or -
² If you wish to close the project without saving the last changes in the project, click No.
- or -
² If you wish to cancel closing the project, click Cancel. In this case the project remains open.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
You can delete projects with all the data they contain. A project that is to be deleted must not be open.
NOTE
i All the data associated with it are lost irrecoverably when deleting a project. You cannot undo the action of
deleting a project.
Deleting a Project
² In the Project menu, click Delete project.
The dialog Delete project opens. This contains a list of the projects last used. For additional information, refer
to 22.6.4 Delete Project.
² Select the project name from the list box.
- or -
² If the desired project is not in the list box, click Search. In the file-selection dialog that opens then, navi-
gate to the desired project folder and select the project file with the file extension .dp5vx. x indicates the
DIGSI 5 version number. Project files in DIGSI 5 version V1 have the file extension .dp5v1.
² When you have selected a project from the list or via the file-selection dialog, click Delete.
A confirmation prompt opens.
² If you really wish to delete the project, click Yes.
- or -
² If you do not wish to delete the project, click No.
If you have responded to the confirmation prompt with Yes, the entire project folder will be deleted from the
file system.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
You can print out all project data or data from individual categories.
Before starting the printing process, you can create and adapt print templates with the Documentation func-
tion. You can prepare project data as a standardized circuit manual and give it a uniform layout. Read the
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents to learn more about this.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
Projects are structured as folders in Windows. You can find the project folders under My Files\Automation. A
folder with the name of the project is created for each project. If you open a folder, you find the project file
with the file extension .dv5vx where x stands for the DIGSI 5 version number. Project files in DIGSI 5 version
V1 have the file extension .d5v1. This file is used to open a project.
This type of structuring allows a range of options:
• You can compress project folders in a zip file and then send them by email, for example.
• You can create a link to the project file with the file extension .dv5vx on the Windows desktop. You can
start DIGSI 5 by double-clicking the project file.
However, you must not delete or move any files within the project structure.
Related Topics
5.1.1 Overview of Projects
Categories
The project texts include the following texts:
• Comments
• Select the languages to be used as project languages from a series of country-specific languages. The
languages in which a project is to be later edited are designated as project languages.
• Define a language as an editing language from the selected project languages. All project texts are then
displayed in this language in DIGSI 5. All newly entered or edited texts are then also saved together with
the texts of the editing language currently set.
• Define a language as reference language from the selected project languages. This language serves as a
reference basis when compiling project texts.
Related Topics
5.2.2 Opening the Project-Language Selection View
5.2.3 Selecting or Deselecting Project Languages
5.2.4 Defining the Editing Language and the Reference Language
5.2.5 Opening the Project-Texts Editor
5.2.6 Adapting the View in the Project Texts Editor
5.2.7 Editing Texts
5.2.8 Finding Texts in the Project
The 22.5.1 Project-Language Selection allows you to carry out the following actions:
Related Topics
² 5.2.3 Selecting or Deselecting Project Languages
² 5.2.4 Defining the Editing Language and the Reference Language
² 5.2.5 Opening the Project-Texts Editor
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
The installation language selected when installing DIGSI 5 is set as the default project language after a newly
created project is opened. Since the project language and the user interface language are coupled, the
selected language is also set as the user interface language. You can select other languages as project
languages and deselect them again. At least one project language must always be selected. The
22.5.1 Project-Language Selection must be open in order to select or deselect a project language.
Related Topics
² 5.2.4 Defining the Editing Language and the Reference Language
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
If you have selected further project languages after creating a new project, you can define another language
as an editing language or reference language.
• Editing Language
All project texts are displayed in the language selected as the editing language in DIGSI 5. All newly
entered or edited texts are then also saved together with the texts of the editing language currently set.
• Reference Language
The texts in the language selected as reference language serve as a basis for comparison when trans-
lating the project texts. If, for example, the project texts are completed in German and are to be trans-
lated into English, select German as the reference language.
The 22.5.1 Project-Language Selection must be open in order to select the editing and reference language.
Related Topics
² 5.2.3 Selecting or Deselecting Project Languages
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
The 22.1.8 Project Texts Editor displays a table containing all of the texts of all selected project languages. All
texts in a given language are displayed in the same column.
To open the Project-texts editor, use the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
² 5.2.6 Adapting the View in the Project Texts Editor
² 5.2.7 Editing Texts
² 5.2.8 Finding Texts in the Project
² 5.2.2 Opening the Project-Language Selection View
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
You can use the 22.1.8 Project Texts Editor to combine identical texts in groups in the reference language
column. At the same time, the text group is reduced to display a single instance of the text occurring multiple
times. You can then edit the content in the combined cells.
You can also filter out the text lines containing empty text cells. Which lines are hidden depends on the
column marked.
Identical texts in the column of the reference language are combined to form a group. If texts are currently
combined in groups, split up the grouping by your action.
All lines containing an empty text cell in the highlighted column are hidden. If lines are currently hidden, you
show these again by your action.
Related Topics
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
The left column of the 22.1.8 Project Texts Editor table always contains the texts of the reference language. If
different languages are set for the editing language and reference language, the column of the editing
language is identified with a pen symbol.
You can edit all texts in any order. To save time, you can group identical texts in the column of the reference
language. That means you can edit these texts at the same time.
NOTE
i The entered texts are not checked for orthography or their language. For example, you can also enter
German texts in the column for English texts.
Entering Text
² Double-click in the cell in which you wish to enter text.
² Enter the text.
² Click outside the cell.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
These 2 actions confirm your entry.
The text entered is accepted.
Identical texts in the column of the reference language are combined to form a group.
Related Topics
² 5.2.8 Finding Texts in the Project
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
You can switch directly from the 22.1.8 Project Texts Editor to the location where a text is used.
Related Topics
² 5.2.7 Editing Texts
² 5.2.1 Overview of Project Languages and Project Texts
A SIPROTEC 5 device in a DIGSI 5 project corresponds to the offline parameter set of a SIPROTEC 5 device. An
entry in the 3.1.2 Project Tree represents this parameter set within the project. This entry is the access point to
all data and actions related to the SIPROTEC 5 device.
• You can add a SIPROTEC 5 device using a valid product code. Everything specified by this product code is
created later in DIGSI 5.
• You can decide for manual configuration while adding. With this option, a basic configuration of a
SIPROTEC 5 device is added to the project. Extend the hardware of this basic configuration afterwards.
• You can import preconfigured SIPROTEC 5 devices data from another project that was exported from
DIGSI 5 in DEX5 format.
You can add a SIPROTEC 5 device using the UAT file.
Product Code
Each SIPROTEC 5 device has a long and short product code. A SIPROTEC 5 device is specified completely in
DIGSI 5 by entering one of the 2 codes. After selecting an application template, you can immediately start to
parameterize the SIPROTEC 5 device. Further changes to the configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device are not
necessary.
The long product code corresponds to the order number of a SIPROTEC 5 device. You will find this long
product code in your order documents. You also receive a long product code if you configure a SIPROTEC 5
device with the SIPROTEC 5 configurator. You can copy this product code and paste it into DIGSI 5. DIGSI 5 can
directly interpret the long product code, as every character of the code can uniquely be assigned to a property
of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
A short product code is provided to make things easier. The short product code refers uniquely to a long
product code. The SIPROTEC 5 configurator automatically creates a short product code for each new long
product code. You can find this short product code on the name plate of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
CPU Type
NOTE
i From DIGSI 5 V7.80 on, it is not possible to change the CPU type of the device via the Device information
tab. If you have added the device using DDDs with V7.80 or a higher version, you cannot change the CPU
type of the configured project device from CP300 to CP200 or vice versa using the list-box option CPU type
in the 22.5.4 Device Information editor.
From DIGSI 5 V7.00 on, a new CPU type known as the CP300 is introduced for all modular devices except for
the 7SA84 and 7SD84 devices. By default, the CP300 device is created when you drag and drop any modular
device from the 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog into the 22.1.6 Network View. You can add the modular devices
with the CPU type CP200 or CP300 using the respective product code via the 22.6.5 Add New Device dialog
only for devices created with DDDs version older than V7.80. It is not possible to change the CPU-type of any
online device displayed under the Online access folder in the project tree.
The following scenarios explain the respective behavior on modifying the CPU type in DIGSI for devices created
with DDDs with a version older than V7.80:
• For any communication workflow, the CPU type of the target device should match the CPU type of the
configured device in DIGSI. If you change the CPU type from CP200 to CP300, then the communication
with the CP200 target device is not possible. If you change the CPU type from CP300 to CP200, then the
communication with the CP300 target device is not possible. If the CPU type mismatch occurs, the
Product code mismatch dialog is displayed during the communication workflow.
• For a CP300 device activated with GOOSE on Port J, if the CPU type is changed to CP200, then the Port J
functionality of the device will be downgraded from GOOSE to IEC 61850 reporting only.
• For a CP300 device activated only with IEC 61850 reporting on Port J, if the CPU type is changed to
CP200, then there is no change in the Port J functionality.
• For a CP200 device activated only with IEC 61850 reporting on Port J, if the CPU type is changed to
CP300, then there is no change in the Port J functionality, but an additional option DIGSI 5 connection
and IEC 61850 inclusive GOOSE is listed in the list-box option Integrated Ethernet interface (port J) in
the 22.5.10 Device Settings editor.
NOTE
i Henceforth, from DIGSI 5 V7.00, 7KE devices with CPU type CP200 are not supported.
Basic Configuration
To configure a SIPROTEC 5 device manually, select a device type and the basic configuration from the Hard-
ware catalog of the 22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor. Examples of device types are 7SD86 and 7SL87. There
are different basic configurations for each device type.
Selecting a certain basic configuration consequently determines the basic hardware scope of a SIPROTEC 5
device. You can change this during the project planning by adding or deleting hardware components. In this
way, you can customize the hardware of the SIPROTEC 5 device precisely to your requirements by deleting
hardware components in the device view of the 22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor.
Application Template
Standard Application Template:
The Global DIGSI 5 library provides application templates for the applications of the devices. The following are
some of the functions of the application template:
• Adapt the application template to your specific use (check/adapt default settings, delete/add functions).
• Check the routing of binary outputs regarding fast and normal relays.
• Check the CFC charts for the group-warning indications and group-fault indications.
Application templates make further project planning simpler for a SIPROTEC 5 device. Each template contains
the most important functions required for a specific application. The line protection is an example of such
applications. Selecting a certain application template consequently determines the basic functional scope of a
SIPROTEC 5 device. You can change this during the project planning by adding or deleting functions.
User-Defined Application Template:
• This new functionality in DIGSI 5 provides the ability to create a custom template from any device that is
configured. You can select one of the active user-defined application templates and use it in the same
way as the standard templates for creating a new device. The new device has the same configuration as
the original device the template was created from, as far as the hardware configuration of the new
device allows it. The User-defined template can then be used to create new devices (similar or different
hardware configuration) with the same configuration for the respective device type.
• The template can be stored anywhere in the file system. It contains the complete device configuration
(for example, CFC charts, display pages, protocols with protocol mappings, (unbound) IEC 61850 config-
uration, and test sequences).
• Special cases
– Difference in device types:
The device types (first 5 Product-code places) of the template and the new device to create from it
differs. It is still possible to create the device from this template as long as both device types are
contained in the same DDD. A template with a device type from a different DDD is not displayed in
the Add new device dialog in the User-defined template tab, so it cannot be selected to create the
new device from. If you select a user-defined template with a different device type (from the same
DDD), the device can be created, but there may be elements of the template configuration that are
not supported for the device type of the new device. Such elements are still created,but they are
marked as inconsistent (after calling the Advanced Consistency Check). You must remove those
inconsistencies before loading to the device is possible. On clicking the OK button in the Add new
device dialog, a respective message is displayed via the message box.
– Significant feature downgrade:
It is possible to create a new device from a template with a different significant feature. If the new
significant feature is higher than the one from the template, nothing special happens. The new
device is created in the same way as always. If, however, the new significant feature is lower than
the one in the template (significant feature downgrade), some elements of the template configura-
tion may no longer be supported in the new device. On clicking the OK button in the Add new
device dialog, a respective message is displayed via the message box and the elements that are no
longer supported are marked as inconsistent.
– Difference in communication modules and protocols:
It is possible to create a new device from a template with different communication modules. The
communication modules from the template configuration may be missing in the new device. In this
case, they are created and the protocol mapping is imported. If the communication modules are
there but in different ports, you can specify which protocol configuration to import to which
communication module. You can do so via the usual list (list box in the channel settings of the
communication module), where not only the standard communication mappings/protocols are
displayed, but also those from the user-defined template.
– Difference in function-point class:
It is possible to create a new device with a different function-point class. If the new function-point
class is lower than the one from the template, the function point used in the new device may
exceed the new lower limit. This is marked as inconsistency in the usual way. You can fix this by
removing the unnecessary instances or by getting more function points.
NOTE
i The availability of certain settings and setting options depends on the device type and on the functions
available in the device.
Related Topics
6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code
6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
6.1.5 Renaming a SIPROTEC 5 Device
6.1.6 Setting the On-Site Operation Panel Language
The offline configuration is the configuration saved in a project for a real SIPROTEC 5 device. Each SIPROTEC 5
device added to the project has its own offline configuration, represented by a device icon with the project-
specific name for the device. Data and actions associated with the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5
device are structured within this folder.
You can transmit the offline configuration into the applicable real SIPROTEC 5 device. For additional informa-
tion regarding this topic, refer to 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations.
Offline Configuration
The offline configuration contains the following entries in the 3.1.2 Project Tree:
• Device information
With this entry, you open the 22.5.3 Device Information of the SIPROTEC 5 device associated with the
offline configuration. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 6.1.9 Opening Device Infor-
mation.
• Measuring-points routing
With this entry, you open the 22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing matrix. With this matrix, you route logic
measuring points of the application to the physical power and voltage inputs of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points.
• Function-group connections
With this entry, you open the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix. For additional information
regarding this topic, refer to 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections.
• Information routing
With this entry, you open the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix. With this matrix, you assign information
to sources and destinations. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 11.1 Overview for
Information Routing.
• Communication mapping
With this entry, you open the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix. With this matrix, you assign
internal signals to serial protocols in order to transmit them via the communication interfaces of a
SIPROTEC 5 device. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 14.9.1 Overview of Communi-
cation Mapping.
• Settings
This folder contains the following entries:
– Device settings
With this entry, you open the 22.5.10 Device Settings. The device settings summarize different
device-specific settings and actions (for example, rated frequency, OSOP language). For additional
information regarding this topic, refer to 6.1.10 Opening Device Settings.
– Time settings
With this entry, you open the 22.5.11 Time Settings. With the time settings, you can select various
14.6.2 Time Sources. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 14.6.3 Processing Time
Settings.
– Power System
This folder contains 1 entry for general settings and 1 entry for each measuring point. With these
entries, you open the 22.1.9 Settings Editor. With this Editor, you edit the general settings or the
settings of the measuring points. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to
8.1.5.4 Selecting a Measuring Point for Setting Parameters.
– Recording
With this entry, you open the 22.1.9 Settings Editor. With this Editor, you edit the settings of the
fault recorder. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 17.5.3.2 Configuring and
Setting Parameters for Fault Recording .
– <Several function groups>
Each function group folder contains 1 entry for each function associated with the function group.
With these entries, you open the 22.1.9 Settings Editor. With this Editor, you edit the settings of a
selected function. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Func-
tion for Setting Parameters.
• Function charts
This folder contains entries to add new function charts and to open existing function charts:
– Add new chart
With this entry, you open the dialog 22.6.7 Add New Chart. With this dialog, you add a new function
chart. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 12.1.2.1 Adding a CFC.
– <Several function charts>
With this entry, you open the 22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor showing an existing function
chart. With this Editor, you edit this function chart. For additional information regarding this topic,
refer to 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC.
• Display pages
This folder contains entries to add new display pages and to open existing display pages. There is another
entry for the fault-display configuration.
– Add new display page
With this entry, you open the 22.1.14 Display Editor showing a new display page. With this Editor,
you edit the new display page. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to
6.5.2.2 Adding a Display Page and 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages.
– <Several display pages>
With these entries, you open the 22.1.14 Display Editor showing an existing display page. With this
Editor, you edit the existing display page. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to
6.5.2.1 Opening a Display Page.
– Fault-display configuration
With this entry, you open the 22.1.17 Fault-Display Configuration Editor. With this Editor, you
configure 1 fault display for each circuit breaker in the application. For additional information
regarding this topic, refer to 6.5.7.2 Opening the Fault Display Editor and Adjusting the View and
6.5.7.1 Overview of Fault Displays.
• Test sequences
This folder contains entries to add new test sequences and to open existing test sequences.
– Add new test sequence
With this entry, you open the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor showing a new test sequence. With this
Editor, you edit the new test sequence. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to
13.2.2 Adding a Test Sequence and 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences.
– <Several test sequences>
With these entries, you open the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor showing an existing test sequence.
With this Editor, you edit the existing test sequence. For additional information regarding this topic,
refer to 13.2.1 Opening the Test Sequence.
• Process data
This folder contains entries for the various process data.
– Open Browser
With this entry, you can open the browser-based monitoring tool (comprehensive commissioning
and monitoring tool that provides an easy-to-understand display of the most important measured
data). For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 17.1.9 Opening a Web Browser using
Link from DIGSI 5. For detailed information about the functionality, refer to chapter Operation
Using a Browser-Based User Interface in the SIPROTEC 5 Operating manual.
– Get all data from device
With this entry, you transmit the device configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 device connected online
into the DIGSI 5 PC. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 17.2.4 Transmitting the
Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC.
– Logs
This folder contains other entries for the various logs:
– Operational log
– Fault log
– Ground fault log
– Setting-history log
– User log 1
– User log 2
With these entries, you open the table 22.4.1 Log for displaying the log contents. For additional
information regarding this topic, refer to 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table.
– Records
With this entry, you open the table 22.4.2 Records for displaying the fault records. For additional
information regarding this topic, refer to 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table.
– Indication snapshots
With this entry, you open the table 22.4.3 Indications for displaying the indications. For additional
information regarding this topic, refer to 17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Sponta-
neous Indications .
– Measured-value snapshots
This folder contains 1 entry for each function group. With these entries, you open the table
22.4.5 Measurements for displaying the measured and metered values. For additional information
regarding this topic, refer to 17.5.1.3 Opening the Measured Value Table and Reading Values.
Related Topics
2.1.3 Working Offline and Online
17.1.5 Online Configuration
If you know the product code for a real SIPROTEC 5 device, you can create the offline configuration using this
product code and add the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGSI 5.
With this method, the following options are available to add any device in DIGSI 5:
• You can add any device using the 3.1.2 Project Tree. You can use this option irrespective of which tool is
currently active in the working area.
• If the single-line configuration is displayed in the working area, you can use it together with the global
DIGSI 5 library to add any device. The advantage of this option is that the SIPROTEC 5 device is placed at
the correct position in the single-line configuration after being added.
The further procedure is identical for both options: Enter the product code and select an application template.
You can specify the SIPROTEC 5 device with the long or the short product code (TNS). If you use the short
product code, DIGSI 5 searches in the short product code (TNS) list for the associated long product code. If
DIGSI 5 cannot find an appropriate long product code, this list is possibly no longer current. In this case,
update the list. For this, the DIGSI 5 PC requires an active Internet connection.
Selecting the highest significant feature of the variant while specifying the product code to add a busbar
device (for example, 7SS device type), allows you to configure and work with the lower significant feature
variants. Whereas, you cannot work with highest significant feature variants, if you add a lower significant
variant. By default, DIGSI verifies the type of variants with significant features depending on the entered
product code. The device hardware is displayed accordingly.
NOTE
i If you have entered a short product code, DIGSI 5 searches for the corresponding long product code. If the
long product code is not found, an error message is displayed. In this case, enter the long product code.
² Click Verify.
The product code entered is checked. If the product code is valid, the Select application template list box is
activated. If the product code is invalid, you receive specific error indications. Correct the product code in
accordance with the error indications.
² Select the User-defined tab.
² Select the name of the application to be used as a basis for your project planning in the Application-
template selection list box.
You can select one of the active user-defined application templates and use it in the same way as the
standard templates for creating a new device.
NOTE
i The User-defined templates are displayed and active only in the following scenarios:
• The template must be available directly in the folder path selected. Subdirectories are not considered.
• The DDDs with which the template was created must be installed.
• The product code of the new device to create and the product code contained in the template (the
original device the template was created from) must match in some basic places (for example, the
device type and the significant feature must be the same).
² Click OK.
The Add new device dialog closes. The required device data is loaded and the specified SIPROTEC 5 device is
added to the project. The required device data is loaded and the specified SIPROTEC 5 device is added to the
project. The new device has the same configuration as the original device with which the template was
created as far as the hardware configuration of the new device allows it. You can now find the device icon for
the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device added in the project tree. A symbol for the SIPROTEC 5 device is also
placed in the single-line configuration and in the 22.1.6 Network View.
NOTE
i If you have entered a short product code, DIGSI 5 searches for the corresponding long product code. If this
is not found, an error message is displayed. In this case, enter the long product code.
Related Topics
² 6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
If you have not previously decided on a definite device variant, you will not yet have a product code. The hard-
ware of the SIPROTEC 5 device must be configured manually so that a SIPROTEC 5 device can also be added to
a project, wherein DIGSI creates the product code based on your selection.
With this method, the following options are available to start adding a device in DIGSI 5:
• You can start adding any device with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. You can use this option irrespective of which
tool is currently active in the working area.
• If the single-line configuration is displayed in the working area, you can use it together with the library to
start adding any device.
• If the 22.1.6 Network View is displayed in the working area, you can use it together with the
22.2.4 Hardware Catalog to start adding any device.
The further procedure is identical for all options:
• Select a basic configuration using the Hardware catalog. The names of all basic configurations are
arranged in a hierarchical tree structure in the Hardware catalog. The highest level is designated with
SIPROTEC 5. The level below arranges all SIPROTEC 5 devices regarding their application area, for
example, Overcurrent protection or Line differential protection. A level further lower contains the
device types available for each application, for example, 7SL87 or 7SD86. Each device type is represented
by a folder with the name of the basic configurations that can be selected.
• Use dialog 22.6.5 Add New Device to specify the device characteristics and select an application
template.
• Configure the hardware of the SIPROTEC 5 device and extend it by the components still missing. You
require the 22.1.7 Device View for this. Here too, use the Hardware catalog, which structures the names
of all configurable components.
² Mark the SIPROTEC 5 element and drag this element into the working area with the mouse button
pressed.
² Release the mouse button.
The Add new device dialog opens.
² Click Configure.
The Add new device dialog closes. The Network view is displayed in the working area. In the Hardware
catalog tab of the task card, the folder SIPROTEC 5 is displayed.
² Select a basic configuration, specify the device characteristics, and select an application template.
Adding a Device Using the Network View and the Hardware Catalog
² Click in the Network view with the right mouse button.
² In the context menu, click Show catalog.
In the Hardware catalog tab of the task card, the folder SIPROTEC 5 is displayed.
² Select a basic configuration, specify the device characteristics, and select an application template.
Selecting Basic Configuration, Specifying Device Characteristics, and Selecting Application Template
² In the Hardware catalog, open in succession the SIPROTEC 5 folder, and then the folder with the device
types.
The names of the basic configurations possible for these device types are displayed.
² Select the name of the basic configuration you wish to use as a basis for your project planning.
A figure as well as a descriptive text for the basic configuration selected is shown as help in the Information
area.
² Drag the marked name to the Network view with the mouse button pressed.
² Release the mouse button.
The Add new device dialog opens.
² Specify the device characteristics using the list boxes in Select device characteristics.
² Mark the name of the application you wish to use as a basis for your configuration in the Select applica-
tion template list box. If you cannot find a template suitable for your application in the list, select the
best matching application template. You can then add functions that are missing or delete superfluous
ones.
² Click OK.
The Add new device dialog closes. The required device data is loaded and the specified SIPROTEC 5 device is
added to the project. You will now find a folder for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the project tree. A symbol for the
SIPROTEC 5 device is also placed in both the single-line configuration and in the Network view.
Related Topics
² 6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
A SIPROTEC 5 device is given a name when added to the project. This name comprises the designation of the
device type and a consecutive numbering, that is, for example 7SL82_1. You can change the name of a
SIPROTEC 5 device in the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
The display of the SIPROTEC 5 device shows information in the country-specific language, which is set as the
on-site operation panel language. The default operation panel language is English. This information includes
designations of entries in the menu tree as well as the names of settings and their values. You can select
different languages for operation at the SIPROTEC 5 device. You can set the language for each SIPROTEC 5
device separately.
Language Selection
² In 3.1.2 Project Tree, open the folder of the offline configuration for which you want to set the on-site
operation panel language.
² Double-click Device information in this folder.
Several options are displayed in the working area.
² Select the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
² Select the Properties tab.
² Select the option Settings under the group General in the Properties tab.
The device settings are displayed under the Device settings area.
² Open the Operation-panel language list box and select a language from this list.
Transmit the device settings from DIGSI 5 to the SIPROTEC 5 device so that the selected language is used to
display texts in the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
² 2.1.4 Languages in DIGSI 5
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
SIPROTEC 5 devices are always deleted from a project with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. You can also delete several
SIPROTEC 5 devices at once during this process.
NOTE
i When deleting a SIPROTEC 5 device, all device-relevant data is lost. For example, all settings and all data
involving relations to other SIPROTEC 5 devices is also lost. This includes connections within the GOOSE
communication and network connections.
Related Topics
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² Determine the scope of printing with this dialog. You find more information about this under
19.2.2 Determining the Scope of Printing.
² Click Print.
The Print dialog closes.
The printout starts.
Related Topics
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
Various information and setting options are assigned to each SIPROTEC 5 device, which is summarized as
22.5.3 Device Information.
For the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device, the information and settings are distributed on the
following tabs:
• 22.5.7 Logs
Related Topics
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 17.4.8 Reading Device-Diagnosis and Security Log
² 14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.4.9 Reading Diagnostics Information
The 22.5.10 Device Settings summarizes different device-specific settings and actions.
To open the device settings, depending on your current working situation, you have the following options:
• You can open the device settings with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. The device settings are then displayed with
the 22.1.9 Settings Editor in the working area.
• If you have already opened the Parameter editor for editing a function, you can open the device settings
directly from the Parameter editor. The device settings are then displayed with the Parameter editor in
the working area.
• You can open the device settings using the device symbols in the single-line configuration, in the
22.1.7 Device View, or in the 22.1.6 Network View. The device settings then appear in the Inspector
window.
Related Topics
² 6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
DIGSI 5 enables you to manage devices in a project in the desired manner by creating a folder structure. This
folder structure makes it easy for you to keep an overview over your substation configuration or to search a
specific device in the project. SIPROTEC 5 devices which contain the settings values, communication settings,
process data, and much more can be grouped together and saved under a folder name in a project.
In other words, you can open only 1 folder in a project to have access to all the devices in a particular project.
Conversely, all changes done in the folder are saved simply by saving the project file. If you have opened a
project, the folder structure in the project will be displayed in a hierarchical structure in the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
The symbols and text boxes in the project tree provide you with access to the project data, folders, and the
actions associated with it.
Related Topics
6.2.2 Creating a Folder Structure
6.2.3 Adding a Device in the Folder Structure
6.2.4 Deleting a Folder Structure
6.2.5 Moving Folders in the Folder Structure
6.2.6 Moving Devices in the Folder Structure
6.2.7 Copying a Folder Structure
6.2.8 Copying Devices in the Folder Structure
6.2.9 Renaming a Folder Structure
You can create folder structure in a project to manage devices in the desired manner.
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
NOTE
i If there are any conflicts, you can rename and paste the folder or replace the existing folder and move the
folder structure.
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
² In the 3.1.2 Project Tree, select any device you wish to move from one folder another folder.
² Drag and drop the selected device over the target folder.
The device is moved and displayed in the destination folder in the project tree.
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
NOTE
i If there are any conflicts, you can rename and paste the folder or replace the existing folder and copy the
folder structure.
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
² In the 3.1.2 Project Tree, right-click any folder you wish to rename.
The context menu appears.
² Select Rename.
The name is displayed in a text box and is highlighted in color.
² Enter a new name for the folder.
² Click outside the text box.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
These 2 actions confirm your entry.
The name entered is accepted if it is unique at its level, else an error prompt is displayed to indicate that the
name is not unique.
Related Topics
² 6.2.1 Overview of Folder Structure in DIGSI 5
• Module size
• Type of construction
• Plug-in modules
The modules are available in 2 sizes:
• Flush-mounting devices with on-site operation panel fitted directly on the device
[sc_digsi_front_view, 1, --_--]
[sc_digsi_rear_view, 1, --_--]
• Module size:
1/3 of 19 inches
• Type of construction:
Flush-mounting devices with on-site operation panel fitted directly on the device
You can select one of the following variants of on-site operation panels:
process connections of a basic or expansion module depend on the choice of a particular input/output
module. The modular system contains a large number of different input/output modules.
If you require additional communication connections, you can use the CB202 expansion module. The CB202
expansion module does not have any direct process connections, but it has 3 slots for additional plug-in
modules instead. You can equip the CB202 expansion module with 2 communication modules and 1 plug-in
module for measured-value conversion.
For information about the ETH-BD-2FO Ethernet communication module, refer to the chapter Ethernet
Modules in the SIPROTEC 5 Hardware manual.
The IO 230 and IO 233 expansion modules enhance the capability of the SIPROTEC device to configure many
binary inputs. It allows you to configure up to 48 binary inputs (12 groups with each group containing 4 chan-
nels) in a single IO module. Similarly, the IO 231 expansion module enhances the capability of the SIPROTEC
device to configure many binary inputs and binary outputs. It allows you to configure 24 binary inputs
(6 groups with each group containing 4 channels) and 24 binary outputs in a single IO module.
For the IO 230 or IO 231 expansion modules, the threshold value applied to the first channel of any group is
also applied to the other 3 channels of the same group. The IO 233 and IO 216 expansion modules have fixed
threshold values and they do not change even if you change the value for the Binary input threshold option
in the 22.5.10 Device Settings Editor. The threshold value in the Properties tab of the 22.3.2 Information
Routing Editor in the 22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor is always read-only. Any or all of the available 9 IO
slots that are numbered from 3 to 6 or 8 to 12 can be configured with the IO 230, IO 231, or with the IO 233
expansion module. In the hardware configuration, you can create a device with this module by using the
product code, or you can drag and drop the IO 230, IO 231, or the IO 233 expansion module from the Hard-
ware catalog to the available IO slots. After hardware synchronization, you can configure the binary inputs
and/or the binary outputs for the respective IO modules in the 22.3.2 Information Routing editor.
By expanding your device hardware with an IO 240 expansion module, the function group Analog units is
automatically added in the project tree to the device under the Settings folder. After instantiating the LPIT
module IO 240, select the type of LPIT sensor at parameter GIS-LPIT type ( :20821:119 ). If the GIS-LPIT type is
configured to LPIT 3-phase, you must configure the LPIT Production ID ( _:20821:120 ) which would auto-
parameterize the LPIT Sensor function block settings. If the LPIT Production ID is missing or auto-parameteri-
zation fails, an error message is displayed. Similarly, if the GIS-LPIT type is configured to LPIT 1-phase, you
must configure the LPIT Production ID ( _:20851:102, _:20852:102, _:20853:102 ), individually for the LPIT
Sensor function blocks. While routing the current or voltage measuring points for IO 240 expansion module,
the Connection type is set to 3-phase for current and to 3-phase to ground for voltage by default.
NOTE
i On switching the configuration options, the device becomes inconsistent and a confirmation prompt
appears to synchronize the device with the hardware. To proceed further, synchronize the device with the
hardware.
The on-site operation panel with push buttons is equipped with 8 LEDs and 8 function keys. It can be used as
an on-site operation panel by all IO modules except for IO 230, IO231, and IO 233. The push-button module
must be mounted in the first row at position 3. If the device has a key switch, it must be mounted at posi-
tion 4. 1 push-button module is allowed per device.
For expansion modules, you can select one of the following 4 variants of the on-site operation panels:
Plug-In Modules
Each base module and the expansion module CB202 has slots for plug-in modules. Plug-in modules allow you
to optimally integrate a SIPROTEC 5 device in a system environment and adapt it to the relevant process situa-
tion.
Plug-in modules are available for the areas of communication and measured-value acquisition.
Related Topics
6.3.2 Opening the Device View
You can check and change the configuration of an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in the 22.1.7 Device View.
The following options are available to open the Device view:
• You can open the Device view with the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
• You can change to the Device view from the 22.1.6 Network View.
• You can open the Device view from the 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor.
The Device view is shown in the working area for all alternatives.
Related Topics
² 6.3.3 Scaling the View in the Device View
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
You can change the display size of the 22.1.7 Device View and hence adapt it to the relevant working situa-
tion.
The following options are available for scaling the view:
NOTE
i The relevant button becomes inactive once the maximum or minimum display size is reached.
The front and rear views of the SIPROTEC 5 device are shown larger or smaller.
² Select a percentage.
- or -
² Enter an integral percentage value from 50 to 500 in the entry field of the list box.
² Click outside the entry field.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
The front and rear views of the SIPROTEC 5 device are shown in the selected or entered percentage size.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
The 22.1.7 Device View always only shows the configuration of an individual SIPROTEC 5 device. Use the list
box in the 22.7.5 Toolbar Device View to change between the configurations of different SIPROTEC 5 devices.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
Base modules, expansion modules, and on-site operation panels have designations. You can show or hide
designations jointly for all these hardware components in the 22.1.7 Device View.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
Below the 22.7.5 Toolbar Device View is an area referred to as the clipboard. You can temporarily store hard-
ware components that are not being used in the clipboard.
The following options are available with the clipboard:
• You can move hardware components from the Hardware catalog or device configuration to the clip-
board.
• You can move hardware components from the clipboard to the device configuration.
• You can copy hardware components from the clipboard to the device configuration.
The advantage of this is that all settings for a hardware component are retained. You can even change the
settings for a hardware component while it is on the clipboard. For example, you can place a hardware
component that is required repeatedly on the clipboard, set parameters there, and then copy it to the respec-
tive installation positions in the device configuration.
The clipboard is hidden as standard. You can show the clipboard and hide it again.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
The Hardware catalog contains hardware components with which you can expand the current device configu-
ration.
The following options are available for adding a hardware component from the 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog of
the device configuration or clipboard:
• You can add the hardware component with Copy and Paste.
The Hardware catalog must be open for adding any component.
If you highlight an element in the Hardware catalog, the Information window shows detailed information on
this element. This information is provided in text and also graphic form, for example as a diagram of a
communication module.
- or -
² Right-click on the device in the Device view.
² In the context menu, click Display catalog.
The Hardware catalog is displayed in the task card.
NOTE
i If you do not mark an installation position, the hardware component will be placed in the first free installa-
tion position suitable for the hardware component.
² In the Device view, mark a free installation position suitable for the hardware component or mark the
clipboard.
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar. This button is only active if the mounting position is permis-
sible or if you wish to insert the hardware component into the clipboard.
In both cases, the hardware component is placed in the desired installation position or in the clipboard.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
If you know the name of the hardware component to be inserted, the search function will help you find the
hardware component in the 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog.
If you have clicked the button, the catalog will be searched from the top down. If you have clicked the
button, the catalog will be searched from the bottom up. If a hardware component with the name
entered is present in the catalog, the catalog directory opens at the corresponding point with the name high-
lighted.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
NOTE
i If you move a connected communication module to the clipboard or another SIPROTEC 5 device, the
module is disconnected from the network. However, the settings are retained, for example the selection of
a particular protocol.
Moving Hardware Components within a SIPROTEC 5 Device or between the SIPROTEC 5 Device and the Clipboard
² Select the hardware component you wish to move in the clipboard or in a SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Drag the hardware component to the new installation position in the SIPROTEC 5 device or to the clip-
board, keeping the mouse button pressed.
If adding at a point is not permitted, the mouse pointer will change to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button at a permissible installation position or in the area of the clipboard.
The hardware component is placed in the desired installation position or on the clipboard.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
NOTE
i If you copy a connected communication module to the clipboard or another SIPROTEC 5 device, the copied
module is disconnected from the network. However, the settings are retained, for example the selection of
a particular protocol.
Copying Hardware Components within a SIPROTEC 5 Device or from the SIPROTEC 5 Device to the Clipboard
² Select the hardware component you wish to copy in the clipboard or in a SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Keep the <Ctrl> key pressed and drag the marked hardware component to the new installation position
in the SIPROTEC 5 device or to the clipboard, keeping the mouse button pressed.
If adding at a point is not permitted, the mouse pointer will change to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button and the <Ctrl> key at a permissible installation position or in the area of the
clipboard.
The hardware component is placed in the desired installation position or on the clipboard.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
You can delete hardware components that are installed in the SIPROTEC 5 device or located on the clipboard.
You can also delete several hardware components at the same time.
You can delete the following hardware components:
• Communication modules
• Current terminals
NOTE
i When deleting a hardware component, all data relating to the hardware component is lost, for example all
settings of a communication module. All data involving connections with other hardware components or
SIPROTEC 5 devices is also lost. This includes connections within the GOOSE communication and network
connections.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
Each hardware component has properties whose values you can check or change.
The following list shows a few examples:
Accessing Properties
² Select the hardware component whose properties you wish to check or edit in the clipboard or a
SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Open the 3.1.4 Inspector Window.
² Select the Properties tab.
² Select the desired group.
The properties and their values are displayed.
² Check the current values and change these, if necessary.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
You can print the hardware-configuration information displayed in the 22.1.7 Device View.
Before starting the printing process, you can create and adapt print templates with the Documentation func-
tion. In this way, you can ensure a uniform layout for the printout. Read the 19.1.1 Overview for Designing
and Printing Documents to learn more about this.
Related Topics
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
This feature enables you to synchronize changes made in device hardware with DIGSI. The inconsistencies in
the device hardware and DIGSI can occur due to the changes made in the hardware.
You can synchronize the hardware changes made in DIGSI using any of the following editors in the
3.1.2 Project Tree:
• Device information
With this entry, you open the 22.5.3 Device Information of the SIPROTEC 5 device associated with the
offline configuration. You find more information about this under 6.1.9 Opening Device Information. If
you have done any changes in the hardware, this editor is displayed in the working area with an orange
color bar with a warning message and an option Synchronize hardware. Click Synchronize hardware in
the orange bar to start hardware synchronization.
• Measuring-points routing
With this entry, you open the 22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing matrix. With this matrix, you route logic
measuring points of the application to the physical power and voltage inputs of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
You find more information about this under 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points. If you have done any
changes in the hardware, this editor is displayed in the working area with an orange color bar with a
warning message and an option Synchronize hardware. Click Synchronize hardware in the orange bar
to start hardware synchronization..
• Function-group connections
With this entry, you open the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix. You find more information
about this under 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections. If you have done any changes in the hardware, this
editor is displayed in the working area with an orange color bar with a warning message and an option
Synchronize hardware. Click Synchronize hardware in the orange bar to start hardware synchroniza-
tion.
• Information routing
With this entry, you open the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix. With this matrix, you assign information
to sources and destinations. You find additional information about measured values, process signals, and
so on, under 11.1 Overview for Information Routing. If you have done any changes in the hardware, this
editor is displayed in the working area with an orange color bar with a warning message and an option
Synchronize hardware. Click Synchronize hardware in the orange bar to start hardware synchroniza-
tion.
• Communication mapping
With this entry, you open the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix. With this matrix, you assign
internal signals to serial protocols in order to transmit them over the communication interfaces of a
SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about this under 14.9.1 Overview of Communication
Mapping. If you have done any changes in the hardware, this editor is displayed in the working area with
an orange color bar with a warning message and an option Synchronize hardware. Click Synchronize
hardware in the orange bar to start hardware synchronization.
• Task Card
Open the 22.2.5 Signals tab in the task card of the 22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor or
22.1.14 Display Editor. If you have done any changes in the hardware, this editor is displayed in the
working area with an orange color bar with a warning message and an option Synchronize hardware.
Click Synchronize hardware in the orange bar to start hardware synchronization.
Related Topics
22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor
22.5.3 Device Information
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing
22.3.4 Function-Group Connections
22.3.2 Information Routing
22.3.1 Communication Mapping
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
22.1.14 Display Editor
² Open the folder of the offline configuration whose device configuration has been changed.
² Double-click any routing editor.
The editor is displayed in the working area with an orange color bar with a warning message and an option
Synchronize hardware. You can also view the warning message in the Inconsistencies tab under Info tab in
the Inspector window.
NOTE
i The inconsistencies can occur, if you modify any I/O module, terminal block or communication module
configured with routings or if any changes are done in the hardware. The editors with inconsistencies are
not available for editing until synchronization is done.
² Click Synchronize hardware in the orange color bar in the working area.
Synchronizing hardware dialog opens for confirmation.
² Click Yes.
- or -
² Open the Inconsistencies tab under Info tab in the Inspector window.
The Inconsistencies tab under Info tab displays an inconsistency warning message.
² Double-click this error message
Synchronizing hardware dialog opens for confirmation.
² Click Yes.
A progress window Synchronizing DIGSI with hardware opens indicating synchronization progress. After
synchronization is complete, orange color bar is cleared and synchronization is complete.
NOTE
i If there are further any inconsistencies, you must resolve the inconsistency warnings from the Inconsisten-
cies tab automatically or manually in the corresponding editor.
• Text
• Signals
Related Topics
6.5.2.1 Opening a Display Page
6.5.5.1 Opening the Symbol Editor
3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.2.3 Renaming a Display Page
² 6.5.2.4 Changing a Sequence of Display Pages
² 6.5.2.5 Defining a Display Page as Standard Page
• You can change the name in the properties of the display page.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
NOTE
i In the SIPROTEC 5 device, you can switch between the available display pages in a defined sequence using
forward and backward keys. The sequence of the names in the project tree defines this display sequence.
Modifying the sequence of the names in the project tree also modifies the display sequence in the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
NOTE
i Each display page automatically contains a page number that identifies the exact position in the sequence.
You can check this page number in the properties of a display page in the 21.2.1 Device – Details group.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.2.5 Defining a Display Page as Standard Page
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.2.4 Changing a Sequence of Display Pages
NOTE
i If you have unintentionally deleted one or more display pages, you can close the project without saving to
recover those display pages. After you have opened the project, the display pages will be present again.
However, all changes to data that you made since the last time you saved the project will have been lost.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
²
In the 22.7.8 Toolbar Editor Display and Symbol, click the button.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
NOTE
i The symbols on the display page correspond to the standard that is selected during creation, that is, ANSI
or IEC. If you select the other standard, the symbols on the display pages will not change. This enables you
to create display pages for 2 different standards. For more information, see 3.3.4 Displaying Elements
According to ANSI or IEC.
[sc_digsi_sle_display_elements, 2, en_US]
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.3.5 Connecting Graphical Elements in a Display Page with a Signal
² 6.5.4.6 Connecting Display Elements
² 6.5.3.6 Creating Display Pages from a Single-Line Configuration
² 6.5.3.3 Inserting Text to a Display Page
² 6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
² 6.5.3.2 Inserting a Graphical Element in a Display Page
• You insert a dynamic field into the display page and then connect this field to the desired signal.
• You drag the signal directly onto the display page. With this method, a dynamic field is automatically
created and connected to the signal.
Displaying in different colors assists you when you connect a dynamic field to a signal:
• The color red identifies a free dynamic field that is not connected to any signal.
• The color green indicates all dynamic fields that are suitable as a target as soon as you drag a signal onto
the display page.
• The color blue indicates that a dynamic field is already connected to a signal.
You can insert signals from the signal catalog in the display page with drag and drop. If the SIPROTEC 5 device
currently being worked on is able to communicate with other SIPROTEC 5 devices through the GOOSE service
of IEC 61850, the signal catalog also contains the signals from these other SIPROTEC 5 devices. In a list box,
you select a SIPROTEC 5 device whose signals will be displayed in the signal catalog. Without the GOOSE
service, the signal catalog only contains the signals of the SIPROTEC 5 device currently being worked on.
The signals are structured in a hierarchical manner. Like in the project tree, you can navigate through the
structure and show or hide individual levels. With 2 list boxes, you can filter the displayed signals according to
signal names and signal types.
NOTE
i If you connect a signal from a different SIPROTEC 5 device, a GOOSE connection will automatically be
created. You find more information about this under 9.6.4 External Signals in the Signal Catalog.
Deleting a Connection
² Right-click a dynamic field that is connected to a signal.
² Click Disconnect signal in the context menu.
The connection between the dynamic field and the signal will be deleted. The 4 rhombuses will appear red.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
• You cannot connect a graphical element having only one state to signals.
• You can connect a graphical element having 2 states only to signals of type SPC or SPS.
• You can connect a graphical element having 4 states only to signals of type DPC or DPS.
Display in different colors helps you when you connect a graphical element to a signal:
• The color red identifies a free graphical element that is not connected to any signal.
• The color green indicates all dynamic fields that are suitable as a target as soon as you drag a signal onto
the display page.
• The color blue indicates that a graphical element is already connected to a signal.
You can insert signals from the signal catalog in the display page with drag and drop.
The signals are structured in a hierarchical manner. Like in the project tree, you can navigate through the
structure and show or hide individual levels. With 2 list boxes, you can filter the displayed signals according to
signal names and signal types.
Deleting a Connection
² Right-click a graphical element that is connected to a signal.
² Click Disconnect signal in the context menu.
The connection between the graphical element and the signal will be deleted. The graphical element appears
in red.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
• You can generate one display page for one selected bay. The bay must be connected to a SIPROTEC 5
device.
• You can generate one display page each for all bays connected to a SIPROTEC 5 device.
If at least one element of the bay is connected to a busbar, the busbar will also be included on the display
page.
NOTE
i The symbols on the display page conform to the standard that is selected during creation, that is, ANSI or
IEC. If you select the other standard, the symbols on the display pages will not change. This enables you to
create display pages for 2 different standards. For more information, see 3.3.4 Displaying Elements
According to ANSI or IEC.
In the Display pages folder of the relevant SIPROTEC 5 device, a new display page will be added and displayed
in the working area. The display page contains the elements and connections of the selected bay. If at least
one element of the bay is connected to a busbar, the display page will also contain the busbar.
In the Display pages folder of the selected SIPROTEC 5 device, one or more new display pages will be added
and displayed in the working area. The number of display pages corresponds to the number of bays connected
to the SIPROTEC 5 device. The display pages contain the elements and connections of the bays. If at least one
element of a bay is connected to a busbar, the display page in question will also contain the busbar.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 6.5.3.3 Inserting Text to a Display Page
² 6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
² 6.5.3.2 Inserting a Graphical Element in a Display Page
• You can change the name in the properties of the graphical element.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Deselecting
² Click an unselected area of the display page.
- or -
² Select a different element.
NOTE
i You can mark additional elements or remove an existing selection. To do so, hold down the <Ctrl> key
while you click the elements in question.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
NOTE
i Elements of the type busbar cannot be rotated. Instead, one horizontal and one vertical busbar is available
as separate elements in the library.
Only the symbol of the equipment item is rotated, not the associated text box with the element names.
Rotating an Element
² Right-click a single rotatable element.
² In the context menu, click either Rotate element 90 degrees counterclockwise or
Rotate element 90 degrees clockwise.
- or -
² Select a single rotatable element.
²
In the 22.7.8 Toolbar Editor Display and Symbol, click either of the 2 buttons or .
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.4.2 Marking a Display Element
NOTE
i You cannot move elements beyond the boundaries of the display page.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.4.2 Marking a Display Element
• Copy
• Paste
• Delete
Copying Elements
² Select an individual element.
² Right-click a selected element and then select Copy from the context menu.
- or -
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
Pasting Elements
² Right-click the desired insertion position on the display page.
² Select Paste from the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
All elements from the clipboard are inserted in the display page.
NOTE
i You can paste elements copied from one display page to another display page of the same device, or
another device, and also from one project to another project opened in another instance of DIGSI.
Deleting Elements
² Select an individual element or a group of elements.
² Right-click a selected element and then select Delete from the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
NOTE
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.4.2 Marking a Display Element
Drawing a Line
² Position the mouse pointer on the connection point of an element. This connection point marks the start
of the line.
The mouse pointer is in the correct position when it changes to a hand.
² Press the left mouse button and drag a direct line to the connection point of a 2nd element. This connec-
tion point marks the end of the line.
As soon as you come close to the connection point, the line will snap to the element. Busbars are highlighted
by a border.
² Release the mouse button.
If the desired connection is permissible, a line will be drawn horizontally and/or vertically.
Changing a Connection
² Click the existing connecting line.
The line will be selected with colored connection points at both ends.
² Place the mouse pointer on the connection point of the line end that you want to connect to a different
connector.
The mouse pointer is in the correct position when it changes to a hand.
² Press the left mouse button and drag the line end to the new connection point.
As soon as you come close to the connection point, the line will snap to the element. Busbars are highlighted
by a border.
² Release the mouse button.
If the connection is permissible, the line will be redrawn.
Canceling Drawing
² To cancel drawing a line, release the mouse button outside the snap-to area of a connection point.
Deleting a Line
² Right-click the line that you wish to delete.
² Select Delete from the context menu.
- or -
² Select the line that you want to delete.
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
• You can modify the symbols of an element inserted on the display page.
• You can copy and paste a symbol from one state to another state.
The Symbol editor opens in the working area. The editing areas for the individual symbols are empty.
NOTE
i Your entries in the 22.1.16 Symbol Editor will not be applied, until you close the Symbol editor by clicking
OK. You can also leave all the states empty without including any elements.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
NOTE
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Renaming an Element
² Enter a name for the element in the Name text box.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
[sc_digsi_texttool, 1, en_US]
• Save the symbol: The symbol preserves the relative size and position of the text element when exported
to the display pages.
• Edit the text as per your convenience (No limit on the text length)
Related Topics
² 6.5.5.5 Editing Text Size in a Symbol Editor
² 22.7.8 Toolbar Editor Display and Symbol
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
² 6.5.3.2 Inserting a Graphical Element in a Display Page
NOTE
i The list box next to the icon is enabled only when the text box is selected.
² Select the desired font size via the list box. By default, the text size is displayed as 11. It is possible to
select the available font sizes from 9 to 15.
² Click outside the text box.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
You confirm your entry with these 2 actions. The size of the text element is changed according to the selec-
tion.
NOTE
i On saving the symbol, the text elements maintain their proportions in the Display pages editor as well.
You can navigate from the Display pages editor to the Symbol editor and continue to edit the text
elements and their size within the Symbol editor any number of times.
Related Topics
² 6.5.5.4 Text Tool in a Symbol Editor
² 22.7.8 Toolbar Editor Display and Symbol
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
² 6.5.3.2 Inserting a Graphical Element in a Display Page
NOTE
i You can modify the number of states at any time. For example: If an element has 4 symbols and you select
the Static Element option, states 2 through 4 will be ignored. In this case, the basic state will automatically
have the value Off. The other states to which settings are assigned, however, are not lost.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Defining the Size for the Element and All 4 Drawing Areas
² Select a value for the width of the graphical element from the Width list box.
² Select a value for the height of the graphical element from the Height list box.
The same size that you selected is now set in all 4 plotting areas.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² Click the starting point of the line inside the symbol area.
² Drag the mouse pointer to the end point of the line.
² Release the mouse button.
² Click the starting point of the ellipse inside the symbol area.
² Drag an ellipse while holding the mouse button.
- or -
² To draw a circle, additionally hold the SHIFT key down while dragging open the ellipse.
² Release the mouse button.
² Click the starting point of the rectangle inside the symbol area.
² Drag open the rectangle, holding the mouse button down.
- or -
² To draw a square, additionally hold the SHIFT key down while dragging open the rectangle.
² Release the mouse button.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.13 Inserting Connection Points
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.13 Inserting Connection Points
If the mouse pointer has its regular arrow shape, selection mode is active.
Deselecting
² Click a free area of the symbol area.
- or -
² Select a different symbol part.
NOTE
i You can select additional symbol parts or remove an existing selection. To do so, hold down the <Ctrl> key
while you click the symbol parts in question.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.10 Marking Symbol Parts
- or -
² Select a filled symbol part by left-clicking it.
²
Click in the 22.7.8 Toolbar Editor Display and Symbol on the button .
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.10 Marking Symbol Parts
² Click the position at which you want to place the connection point in one of the 4 symbol areas.
A connection point is inserted at the nearest intersection point of the grid lines.
NOTE
i Connection points must always be located at one of the edges of a symbol. For that reason, a connection
point is automatically positioned at the edge nearest to the position on which you clicked.
NOTE
i You cannot move symbol parts beyond the boundaries of the symbol area.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.10 Marking Symbol Parts
• Copy
• Paste
• Delete
In either case, all selected symbol parts will be copied into the clipboard.
In either case, all symbol parts will be inserted from the clipboard into the symbol area.
NOTE
i You can insert the symbol parts into another symbol of the same element or into a symbol of another
element.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.10 Marking Symbol Parts
In either case, the symbol will be rotated 22.5 degrees, either counterclockwise or clockwise.
NOTE
i If you perform the action described 16 times, the symbol part will return full circle to its original position.
Related Topics
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.5.10 Marking Symbol Parts
In order to support the control functionality in the browser-based monitoring tool of the configured display
pages, it is possible to configure a display page in DIGSI 5 from V8.30 even if there is no front panel with
display. The monitoring tool is a comprehensive commissioning and monitoring tool that provides an easy-to-
understand display of the most important measured data.
Related Topics
² 22.5.10 Device Settings
² 6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
² 6.5.2.2 Adding a Display Page
² 6.5.2.3 Renaming a Display Page
• Pickup Indication
If you select an indication, the name of the function stage that was picked first, in the event of a fault, is
displayed. The displayed indication can also contain additional information for phases, grounding, and
direction.
• T Pickup
If you select these measured values, the entire pickup duration of the fault is displayed.
• Operate Indication
If you select this indication, the name of the position level that was picked up first. in the event of a fault,
is displayed. The displayed indication can also contain additional information for phases.
• T Tripping
If you select this measured value, the operate time is related to the start of the fault (pickup start)
• Fault Distance
If you select this measured value, then the measured distance to the fault location is displayed.
With the parameter Fault display, you specify a criterion for the fault display. You can select if fault displays
should be displayed at every pickup or only for pickup with trip command. You will find more information on
this under 6.5.7.4 Selecting a Criterion for a Fault Display.
Related Topics
6.5.7.2 Opening the Fault Display Editor and Adjusting the View
6.5.7.2 Opening the Fault Display Editor and Adjusting the View
With the 22.1.17 Fault-Display Configuration Editor, you configure 1 fault display each for every circuit
breaker configured in the application.
The following standard functions are available to adapt the view of the Fault-display editor:
Related Topics
² 6.5.7.1 Overview of Fault Displays
² 6.5.7.3 Configuring Fault Displays
• Select the circuit breaker, for which a fault display will be displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device display.
• For each of the 5 display lines, select within the fault display one of the specified information lines, that is
indications or measured values.
If a check box is marked, then a fault display can be displayed for the applicable circuit breaker. You do not
need to highlight the check box. In this case, no fault displays are displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device display.
Related Topics
² 6.5.7.1 Overview of Fault Displays
Selecting a Criterion
² Open the device settings.
² Select the setting from the Fault display list box.
Related Topics
² 6.5.7.1 Overview of Fault Displays
• With DIGSI 5
To acknowledge fault displays with DIGSI 5, use the function to reset the LEDs. Here all fault displays are
acknowledged.
NOTE
i Resetting the LEDs will also lead to resetting all binary device-output contacts.
With DIGSI 5
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the list of online accesses, open the online device which represents the affected SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Double-click Device information.
The device information is displayed in the working area.
²
Click in the 22.7.26 Toolbar Device Information the button .
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes. The LEDs, the binary inputs, and all fault displays are reset.
The display page visible last before the fault displays is shown.
Related Topics
² 6.5.7.1 Overview of Fault Displays
Essential Steps
The following list shows the essential steps:
• Using the Single-line editor, you position various elements on a drawing pane. These elements represent
equipment such as busbars or circuit breakers.
• You set parameters for the equipment directly in the single-line configuration.
Elements
Each element has a symbol, a name, and further properties. You will find a large selection of predefined
elements in the global DIGSI 5 library. This library also contains ready-made templates for various standard
configurations, for example, for the 1 1/2 circuit-breaker layout. You insert these templates from the library
into the single-line configuration by drag and drop exactly as you would with individual elements. You can
then adapt the templates to your requirements.
All elements for the single-line configuration can be displayed according to ANSI or according to IEC. You can
switch between these 2 types of display at any time. If you modify the display, the change will not only affect
the element symbols in the library. All symbols in the single-line configuration are also adapted to the selected
standard.
An element is automatically inserted into the single-line configuration for each SIPROTEC 5 device within the
project. This element represents not only the SIPROTEC 5 device but also the application of the SIPROTEC 5
device. To make the connection between the application and the substation, connect the function groups of
an application with the equipment. The device element has different connections for this purpose.
Related Topics
3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
7.6 Setting Parameters for Equipment and Synchronizing Current or Voltage-Transformer Values
To open a single-line configuration, use the 3.1.2 Project Tree. The single-line configuration will be shown in
the working area.
NOTE
i A new project initially does not contain a single-line configuration. An empty space will be shown in the
working range instead.
Related Topics
² 7.2.3 Scaling the Single-Line Configuration View
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
Starting Print Process in the Offline Mode Selecting the Print Options
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project, mark the entry Single-line configuration.
² From the Project menu, select Print.
The 22.6.24 Print dialog opens.
² Use this dialog to select a printer, a document template, and a cover page. You can find more informa-
tion about this dialog under 19.2.3 Selecting Print Options.
² Click Print.
The Print dialog is closed and the selected data is printed.
Starting Print Process in the Online Mode Selecting the Print Options
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project tree with the configured 7SS device under the Online access folder, double-click Single-
line supervision.
The configured topology is displayed in the Single-line supervision view.
² In the Project menu, select Print.
The 22.6.24 Print dialog opens.
² Use this dialog to select a printer, a document template, and a cover page. You can find more informa-
tion about this dialog under 19.2.3 Selecting Print Options.
² Click Print.
The Print dialog is closed and the selected data is printed.
Starting Print Process in the Offline Mode without Selecting the Print Options
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project tree, mark the entry Single-line configuration.
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
Starting Print Process in the Online Mode without Selecting the Print Options
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project tree with configured 7SS device under the Online access folder, double-click Single-line
supervision.
The configured topology is displayed in the Single-line supervision view.
² In the project tree, mark the entry Single-line supervision.
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
You can change the display size of the single-line configuration and thus adjust it to the particular situation.
You can scale the view in one of the following ways:
NOTE
i If you select an element before scaling, this element will remain positioned in the center of the scaled area.
NOTE
i If the maximum or minimum display size has been reached, the corresponding menu item and button will
be inactive.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
You can save the current view of the single-line configuration in the working area as a vector graphic. The
view will be saved in WMF (Windows Metafile) format. In this format, you can import the single-line configu-
ration into many other programs, for example, into text processors such as Microsoft Word. This program can
open WMF files without any problem and include them in text documents. This provides you with another way
of creating substation documentation.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
The global DIGSI 5 library contains elements that represent equipment and which you can insert into the
single-line configuration. These elements also include busbars. The global DIGSI 5 library contains one
element each for a vertical and a horizontal busbar. After insertion, you can modify the length of a busbar.
You can insert a busbar from the global DIGSI 5 library into the single-line configuration in one of the
following ways:
NOTE
i If you insert an element from the library, the element symbol will be shown in the currently set standard,
ANSI or IEC. If you select the other standard, the selection not only affects the element symbols in the
library. All symbols in the single-line configuration are also adapted to the selected standard. For more
information, see 3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC.
Scaling a Busbar
² Left-click the start or end point of the busbar and hold the mouse button down.
² Drag the mouse pointer horizontally or vertically, depending on the orientation of the busbar.
² When the busbar has the length you require, release the mouse button.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.3.2 Inserting Further Equipment from the Library
² 7.3.4 Using a Template from the Library
You insert equipment such as disconnector switches or circuit breakers from the global DIGSI 5 library into the
single-line configuration by drag and drop, in exactly the same way as busbars. Before you can do this, the
global DIGSI 5 library must be open.
If you select an element in the DIGSI 5 library, the information window will show you detailed information on
this element. This information is provided in text and also graphical form, for example, as a diagram of an
equipment.
You can insert an equipment into an existing bay or create a new bay as you insert it. A bay is identified by a
colored area in the single-line configuration. All elements within the colored area belong to the same bay.
Busbars cannot be part of a bay. Like an equipment, a bay has a name that you can modify.
NOTE
i If you insert an element from the library, the element symbol will be shown in the currently set standard,
ANSI or IEC. If you select the other standard, the selection not only affects the element symbols in the
library. All symbols in the single-line configuration are also adapted to the selected standard. For more
information, see 3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.3.1 Inserting and Scaling a Busbar from the Library
² 7.3.4 Using a Template from the Library
A device symbol is shown in the single-line configuration for each offline configuration in the project. This
symbol represents the SIPROTEC 5 device and its application and gives direct access to further data.
Function Groups
The device symbol contains the function groups that represent a part of the primary equipment, for example,
a line or a circuit breaker. There are also further function groups, for example, for fault recording, but these
are not shown in the device symbol. Each function group is represented by a rectangle and the name of the
function group. Clicking the arrow icon reduces an opened function group to its name. If the function group is
connected to equipment, reducing the function group in this way causes the lines to be shown shortened. A
further click the arrow icon opens the rectangle of the function group again, showing the name of all the
functions contained in it. Tie lines are then again shown in their entirety.
Functions
Each rectangle that represents a function group contains the names of all functions that are part of this func-
tion group. Clicking the arrow icon next to the function name shows the names of the associated function
blocks. A further click on the arrow icon reduces the function to its name.
Function Blocks
A function can consist of multiple function blocks. For example, a function block can be a stage, but also a
zone.
Interfaces
Different functions require measured values as input signals or provide commands as output signals. Function
groups have interfaces to enable you to connect these input and output signals to the corresponding equip-
ment.
A function group can have the following interfaces:
device and the analog inputs are connected to the logical measuring points. These measuring points are then
assigned to the interfaces of the function groups.
You can make the assignment between the measuring point and the function group, for example, directly in
the function group. In list boxes, you can select the measuring point from which the interface is to receive the
measurand. You can find out more about this in the chapter Configuring Applications.
By assigning a measuring point, you create the condition for synchronizing transformer data in the single-line
configuration with the transformer data in the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
7.6 Setting Parameters for Equipment and Synchronizing Current or Voltage-Transformer Values
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
Several templates for complete bays are available to you to speed up your work. You can insert these into a
single-line configuration and adapt them to your requirements. You will find all the templates in the global
DIGSI 5 library. Before you can insert a template, the global DIGSI 5 library must be open.
NOTE
i If you insert an element from the library, the element symbol will be shown in the currently set standard,
ANSI or IEC. If you select the other standard, the selection not only affects the element symbols in the
library. All symbols in the single-line configuration are also adapted to the selected standard. For more
information, see 3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.3.1 Inserting and Scaling a Busbar from the Library
² 7.3.2 Inserting Further Equipment from the Library
You can select an individual element or a group of elements. In this case, the elements include equipment,
bays, and devices. Colored borders identify the selected elements.
Undoing a Selection
² Click an unselected area of the single-line configuration.
- or -
² Select a different element.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
You can rotate elements of equipment inserted into the single-line configuration 90 degrees clockwise or
counterclockwise.
NOTE
i Elements of the type busbar cannot be rotated. Instead, one horizontal and one vertical busbar are avail-
able as separate elements in the library.
Only the symbol of the equipment is rotated, not the associated text box with the element names.
Rotating an Element
² Right-click a single rotatable element.
² In the context menu, click either Rotate element left or Rotate element right.
- or -
² Select a single rotatable element.
²
In the 22.7.2 Toolbar Single-Line Editor, click either of the 2 buttons or .
In either case, the symbol will be rotated 90 degrees, either counterclockwise or clockwise.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.1 Marking Single-Line Elements
You can reverse the grounding direction of the symbol towards line or bus of a current transformer in the
single-line configuration.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.1 Marking Single-Line Elements
You can move, and therefore reposition, elements such as equipment, bays, and devices within a single-line
configuration. Tie lines between the elements will be adapted automatically. You can move the name of an
equipment independently of the symbol. The symbol and the name remain a single unit.
There are 2 ways of moving elements:
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.1 Marking Single-Line Elements
You can apply the following standard edit functions to the elements of a single-line configuration:
• Copy
• Cut
• Paste
• Delete
Copying Elements
² Select an individual element or a group of elements.
² Right-click a selected element and then select Copy from the context menu.
- or -
²
In the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar, click the button.
Cutting Elements
² Select an individual element or a group of elements.
² Right-click a selected element and then select Cut from the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
Inserting Elements
² Right-click on the desired insertion position in the template.
² Select Add from the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
All elements from the clipboard are inserted in the display page.
NOTE
i You can also paste elements that you copy in the single-line configuration into a display page.
Deleting Elements
² Select an individual element or a group of elements.
² Right-click a selected element and then select Delete from the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar .
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.1 Marking Single-Line Elements
You can give every element, whether it is an equipment or bay, an individual name.
You can change the name of an element in one of the following ways:
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.1 Marking Single-Line Elements
An automatic connection function is active while you insert elements into the single-line configuration. As
soon as you have placed a new element into the adjacent cell of an existing element connection, this function
connects the symbols of the 2 elements. The automatic connection function considers whether a connection
between the 2 elements is meaningful. To complete the single-line configuration, interconnect manually all
unconnected elements. This includes interconnecting individual equipment, such as circuit breakers, discon-
nector switches, or busbars. Connect the elements with lines. Define which elements are to be intercon-
nected. The line routing is defined automatically and will be updated when you move elements.
Drawing a Line
² Position the mouse pointer on the connection point of an element. This connection point marks the start
of the line.
The mouse pointer is in the correct position when it changes to a hand.
² Press the left mouse button and drag a direct line to the connection point of a 2nd element. This connec-
tion point marks the end of the line.
As soon as you come close to the connection point, the line will snap to the element. Busbars are highlighted
by a border.
² Release the mouse button.
If the desired connection is permissible, a line will be drawn horizontally and/or vertically.
Canceling Drawing
² To cancel drawing a line, release the mouse button outside the snap-to area of a connection point.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.9 Connecting Single-Line Element with SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 7.4.10 Adjusting a Single-Line Connection
A function group must be connected to measuring points to supply the functions within a function group,
with current and voltage values. For this purpose, you select a measuring point for each interface of a function
group. The interfaces are represented with colored connection points.
You have the following options for connecting the function groups to measuring points:
• You can use the 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor. The description is given in the following section.
• You can use the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix. You can find more information under
8.1.4.4 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Groups.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
² 8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
It is not only necessary to interconnect elements but also to connect certain equipment to SIPROTEC 5 devices.
For this purpose, the SIPROTEC 5 devices have logical inputs and outputs in the single-line configuration. The
current and voltage transformers can be connected to the SIPROTEC 5 devices via inputs. Circuit breakers and
other controllable equipment can be connected to the SIPROTEC 5 devices via the outputs.
You make the connections between the elements with lines. You define which elements are to be intercon-
nected. The line routing is defined automatically and will be updated when you move elements. Moreover,
different colors and line types are used for currents, voltages, and control signals.
While connecting more than 2 elements using connection lines, a junction point in the shape of a square is
created. From this junction point, all the links are connected to the respective elements. You can move the
junction point to the desired location using the mouse or the keyboard. With the keyboard, you can select and
move the junction point precisely by holding down the <CTRL>, <SHIFT>, and <ARROW> keys together or
move the junction point swiftly by using only the <ARROW> keys. The connection is possible only from an
element to an existing connection line and not from the junction point to an element. Upon selection, the
connection line that connects connecting points is highlighted in green color. By default, a newly created
connection line is also highlighted in green color.
Drawing a Line
² Position the mouse pointer on the connection point of an element. This connection point marks the start
of the line.
The mouse pointer is in the correct position when it changes to a hand.
² Press the left mouse button and drag a direct line to the connection point on the SIPROTEC 5 device. This
connection point marks the end of the line.
If the connection point is suitable for the connection, the line will snap to the connection point. The connec-
tion point will also be highlighted in color.
² Release the mouse button.
If the desired connection is permissible, a line will be drawn horizontally and/or vertically. The selected line is
highlighted in green color to identify the connection.
NOTE
i Connection points on the input side (green or turquoise) each correspond to one transformer. If a trans-
former with connection points corresponds to multiple function groups, lines will also be drawn to these
connection points.
Canceling Drawing
² To cancel drawing a line, release the mouse button outside the snap-to area of a connection point.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.10 Adjusting a Single-Line Connection
² 7.4.7 Connecting Single-Line Elements Among Each Other
Moving a Line
² Click the relevant tie line.
The line will be selected with colored connection points at both ends.
² Place the mouse pointer in the center of the line.
The mouse pointer is in the correct position when it changes to a two-headed arrow.
² Press the mouse button here and drag the line section horizontally or vertically.
² Release the mouse button.
The actual degree of freedom you have when moving the line will depend on the current line route.
Deleting a Line
² Right-click the line that you wish to delete.
² Select Delete from the context menu.
- or -
² Select the line that you want to delete.
²
Click in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar on the button.
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.9 Connecting Single-Line Element with SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 7.4.7 Connecting Single-Line Elements Among Each Other
The topology presents another view of a single-line configuration and provides an overview of the hierarchical
structure of the station. The topology is updated as soon as you modify the single-line configuration. You
cannot change the topology directly. However, you can change the name of the topology elements and add
user labels to each individual topology element. You can also set parameters for equipment with the topology.
Structure
The topology is embedded in a 3-column table:
• Name
This column contains the name and symbols of all topology elements in a hierarchical arrangement.
These include, for example, voltage levels and bays. You can show or hide levels of the topology tree
with the arrow icons.
• Path
This column shows, for each topology element within a bay, whether the element is connected to one or
more function groups or not. The connection to a function group is shown in the form <device name>/
<function group name>. If the topology element is not connected to any function group, the cell is
empty.
• Comment
In this column, you can enter a comment on each topology element.
Elements
The topology elements can be divided into 4 categories:
• Substation
In DIGSI 5, one project corresponds to 1 station. For that reason, the station is the top level of the
topology. All other topology elements are subordinate to this level.
• Voltage level
The topology tree contains a voltage level for each busbar arrangement. For example, if you have config-
ured 2 independent busbar arrangements in the single-line configuration, the topology will contain 2
voltage levels.
• Bay
A bay is assigned to the voltage level to which it was first connected. Let us look at an example to explain
this. A bay contains both circuit breakers QB1 and QB2. First connect circuit breaker QB2 with busbar
arrangement 1 and then circuit breaker QB1 with busbar arrangement 2. Then the bay is subordinate to
the voltage level of busbar arrangement 1. If a bay is not connected to any busbar arrangement, it is in
the topology on the same hierarchic level as the voltage levels.
• Equipment
Busbars are always directly subordinate to the voltage level. All other equipment is assigned to a bay.
Related Topics
7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
7.6 Setting Parameters for Equipment and Synchronizing Current or Voltage-Transformer Values
7.5.2 Displaying Topology
The topology is part of the single-line configuration and is a different view of the single-line configuration. You
can switch directly between the single-line configuration and the topology. The topology will be displayed in
form of a table in the working area.
NOTE
i If the single-line configuration does not contain any elements, the table in the Topology tab will remain
empty.
Display Topology
² If the single-line configuration is not open, double-click Single-line configuration in the project tree.
The single-line configuration will appear in the working area.
² Click the 22.1.4 Topology Information tab.
The table with the topology will be shown in the working area.
Related Topics
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
NOTE
i You cannot rename the voltage level element in the single-line configuration.
Related Topics
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
You can add an individual comment to each topology element. The comment will be displayed directly next to
the path name in the topology table.
You can add a comment in one of the following ways:
• You can add the comment in the properties of the topology element.
If there is a corresponding element for the topology element in the single-line configuration, a comment will
be added for this, too.
Related Topics
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
Related Topics
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
NOTE
i You can configure multiple bays and function groups according to the significant feature of the variants in
the Single-Line Editor.
NOTE
i It is not possible to edit the list box or select multiple colors from the list view. If you export/import the TEA-
X file or copy and paste any busbar, then the respective busbar retains the color assigned to it. If the color
of the busbar available in any file imported by DIGSI is not available in the list of 56 colors in the list view,
then the Online color list box displays the color in the RGB color format with no preview of the colors.
The change in normalizing current can be verified or viewed in measured value boxes in the Busbar protection
(BBP) offline view. The normalization current can be set independently from the existing feeder rated currents,
and if no setting is done, the largest feeder rated current is assumed as the normalization current.
Related Topics
² 7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.3.4 Using a Template from the Library
² 7.4.9 Connecting Single-Line Element with SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
• Disconnector image
NOTE
i The list box to see the filtered BBP view is visible only if you add any busbar device in the 22.1.2 Single-Line
Editor. You cannot edit any value in the filtered BBP view. You must reset the filter to make the desired
changes.
If the configuration is invalid, an error message is displayed in the Inconsistencies tab view under the Info
tab. You must resolve the inconsistencies to proceed further.
- or -
² Select Connect to device and retrieve data from the context menu.
NOTE
i You can view the busbar color that is assigned in the Single-Line Editor (offline mode). The extent of the
color displayed for a bus zone depends on the state of the switches and the current-transformer functions
connected to the respective busbar. You can view the current status of the switches (for example, circuit
breakers and disconnectors) in the Single-line monitoring view, if the binary input is assigned or config-
ured for those switches in the 22.3.2 Information Routing editor.
NOTE
i It is possible to view the ongoing status of the current values in the following measured value boxes:
• Check zone
• Coupler zone
• Bus zone
Related Topics
² 7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration
² 7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
² 7.4.9 Connecting Single-Line Element with SIPROTEC 5 Devices
² 7.5.1 Overview of Topology
² 17.2.2 Loading the Offline Configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
With the new application-oriented functional concept, you have to select an application template at the start
of the project configuration, for example, line protection. With this, you have defined the entire functional
scope of the SIPROTEC 5 device. For in many cases, you can use the selected application without any changes.
But in addition you have the means to optimize the functional scope of the application, and thus of the
SIPROTEC 5 device, exactly to fit your specific needs. For many functions, you can also determine the number
of steps. Thus you adapt the functions exactly to individual protection concepts.
Details on Applications
In one application, individual functions are grouped together to form logic function groups. A function group
usually reflects a part of the primary installation, for example, a line, circuit breaker, or a transformer. But a
function group does not necessarily have to contain protection functions. Function groups also exist for fault
records or installation data. Every function group has interfaces for raising and clearing information. With
these interfaces, the function groups, and thus the functions, can exchange information among each other.
But an application not only defines the scope of the functions and their connections among each other. An
application is only really complete when it has logical measuring points. These measuring points serve as
interfaces to the process and conduct the current and voltage values supplied by the transformers to the func-
tion groups. You can freely configure the connections between measuring points and function groups. Thus
the measured values of each function are available within a function group. There is no more permanent
wiring between input and function.
Optimizing Applications
If your application requires it, add new function groups to the application template. In doing so, you can rely
on predefined function groups such as Line or Circuit breaker. You can also set up the same function group
several times within one application. You can thereby now protect several pieces of equipment, which you
previously each had to protect with one device, with only a single SIPROTEC 5 device.
However, a function group itself is not a rigid structure as such. You can copy or shift functions from one func-
tion group to another. And you can add additional functions. SIPROTEC 5 puts a number of modular functions
at your disposal. From of this supply of functions, you select the functions that you need to supplement your
application.
In SIPROTEC 5, the same functions are structured identically in all device types. For example, the Overcurrent
protection function works in a 7SL exactly like in a 7SD. This gives you the possibility to copy already parame-
terized functions from one device to another.
Related Topics
8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
Functions
You can supplement your SIPROTEC 5 device by individual functions, or remove functions from the device. For
this purpose add functions to the respective offline configuration in DIGSIG 5, or delete functions from the
offline configuration. If you transmit an offline configuration processed this way to the SIPROTEC 5 device,
then the changed functional scope is effective in the device.
If you delete or add functions, points are credited to or deducted from your function-point account. The
current function-points status of an offline configuration can be read in the 22.5.5 Resource Consumption tab.
Function Groups
A function group is assigned to a primary object, for example, a line, a transformer or circuit breaker.
The function groups bundle functions regarding the following basic tasks:
• Assigning functions via measuring points to current and/or voltage transformers and thus to the safety
installation
Function-Points
In SIPROTEC 5, you do not buy a rigid function package, but so-called function-points. Because with
SIPROTEC 5, functions have a certain value, which is expressed in function-points.
For example: To configure a function A, you require 5 function-points, while, on the other hand, 10 points are
required for function B. In total, you need to have at least 15 points on your function-points account. For this
you can also configure a function C, which has a value of 15 points.
If your function-point account is depleted, you can order new function-points.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.2.3 Adding a Function
8.1.2.2 Adding a Function Group
8.1.2.4 Adding a User-defined Function Block
8.1.2.6 Copying Function Group, Function, or Function Block
8.1.2.7 Deleting Functions or Functions Groups
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
NOTE
i For certain function group types there is also a maximum number permitted within one application. If
insertion of a function group is not allowed at this position, the mouse pointer will change to a crossed-out
circle.
Opening the Global DIGSI 5 Library and Marking the Function-Group Element
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open one folder at a time for the device type and function group you want to insert.
Other folders with functions and an element are displayed for the function group. The function-group element
is found at the top position and has the name of the function group, for example Cable.
² Mark the function-group element.
² Position the function-group element in the area of the already existing function groups.
² Release the mouse button.
If insertion is permissible at the selected position, the new function group will be added into the application.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
² 8.1.2.5 Renaming Functions or Function Groups
² 8.1.2.7 Deleting Functions or Functions Groups
² 8.1.2.3 Adding a Function
NOTE
i Not every function type can be inserted in any function group. For certain function types there is also a
maximum number permitted within one function group. If insertion of a function is not allowed at this
position, the mouse pointer will change to a crossed-out circle.
Opening the Global DIGSI 5 Library and Marking the Function Element
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open one folder at a time for the device type, the function group, and the function you want to insert.
An element for the function is displayed. The function element is named after the function, for example, 47
overcurrent protection.
² Mark this function element.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
² 8.1.2.5 Renaming Functions or Function Groups
² 8.1.2.7 Deleting Functions or Functions Groups
² 8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
Opening the Global DIGSI 5 Library and Marking the Function Block
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open the folder User-defined functions.
The element User-defined function block is displayed.
² Mark this element.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
• You can copy the function group, function, or the function block within an offline configuration.
• You can copy the function group, function, or the function block between offline configurations.
Depending on your respective working situation, you can copy the function group, function, or the function
block in different areas:
NOTE
i Using the context menu option or the drag and drop option, you can copy the function group or the func-
tion from the project tree and paste it in the desired destination in the project tree, the 22.3.2 Information
Routing editor, or the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping editor. You can copy and paste the function block in
the 22.3.2 Information Routing editor or in the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping editor only via the context
menu option.
Copying the Function Group, Function, or the Function Block within an Offline Configuration
² Right-click the marked function group, function, or the function block.
² Click Copy in the context menu.
The marked function group, function, or the function block is copied to the clipboard.
² Right-click the respective destination under the Settings folder.
² Click Paste in the context menu.
A copy of the original function group, function, or the function block is inserted in the selected destination
respectively.
Copying the Function Group, Function, or the Function Block between Offline Configurations
² Right-click the marked function group, function, or the function block.
NOTE
i If you copy and paste a function group, a function, or a function block, the GOOSE inputs configured will
also be copied and displayed in the Unassigned folder under the External Signals folder. The name of the
GOOSE inputs will not change.
The following rules apply for the IEC 61850 system configurator properties while copying and pasting a
device:
Action
Configura- Copy Device Device Master Remove Device Include in DEX
tion Copy from IEC Station Export
Reporting Copy Copy Delete Yes
GOOSE source Copy Copy Delete Yes
GOOSE inputs in Copy Copy Keep Yes
DIGSI V07.50 or
higher
GOOSE inputs in Delete Delete Delete No
DIGSI V07.50 or
higher, link to
GOOSE source
GOOSE inputs in Delete Delete Delete No
DIGSI V07.40 or
lower
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
NOTE
i If you delete one function or a function group, inconsistencies can be created in the application and the
parameterization.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
required for your application. Siemens delivers the SIPROTEC 5 device along with the acquired function-point
class.
Base+200 is an example of a function-point class. Base indicates that the basic functionality specified through
the device type is covered. 200 is the number of function-points, which you purchase. This function-point
number corresponds to your function-point credit. This function-point credit is available to you for the expan-
sion of the SIPROTEC 5 device by additional functions.
One advantage of this method is that the additional functionality does not have to be determined in detail
during product selection. You can add every required additional function in the later engineering phase. For
this, you insert the required functions from the global DIGSI 5 library into the offline configuration of the
SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGSI 5. Then, you load the offline configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 device.
An offline configuration can only be loaded within the function-point credit available in the SIPROTEC 5
device. The more functions you use for your application the higher the need for function-points in the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
If the required number of points of the configured function scope is larger than the function-point credit, you
cannot load the affected offline configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 device. You must either remove functions
or upgrade the function-point credit of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about this under
17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality.
With DIGSI 5, you can configure the functional scope regardless of the actual function-point credit. You can
order missing function-points later on.
Related Topics
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
8.1.3.2 Determining the Function-Point Class for a SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.3 Determing the Function-point Class for the Offline Configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.5 Ordering Function-points and Loading Them into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
Related Topics
8.1.3.1 Overview of Function Points
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
8.1.3.3 Determing the Function-point Class for the Offline Configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.5 Ordering Function-points and Loading Them into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.3 Determing the Function-point Class for the Offline Configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 Device
When inserting a SIPROTEC 5 device into the project, you determine the function-point class for the offline
configuration of this device. The function-point classes in the SIPROTEC 5 device and the associated offline
configuration must match. If you require a higher function-point class, you can order function-points later on
and load them in the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about this under 17.6.1 Overview of
Updating the Device Functionality.
To determine the function-point class for the offline configuration, you have the following possibilities:
• Determine Manually
If you manually configure the SIPROTEC 5 device during inserting, you can also manually determine the
function-point class. You can select it with the selection list Select function-point class in the dialog Add
new device. The minimum function-point class is Base. When you select this function-point class, your
function-point credit equals 0. You can only use the basic functionality of the SIPROTEC 5 device. The
maximum function-point class that can be selected for adding a device with the version V4.00 DDDs is
Base+1400, whereas, for adding a device with the DDDs prior to the version V4.00, the maximum func-
tion-point class that can be selected is Base+500. The device is credited with the function-points based
on the selection of the function-point class.
Regardless of the determined function-point class and the actual function-point credit, you can configure the
function scope any way you like with DIGSI 5. But if the required number of points of the configured function
scope is larger than the function-point credit, you cannot load the affected offline configuration into the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
8.1.3.1 Overview of Function Points
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
8.1.3.2 Determining the Function-Point Class for a SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.5 Ordering Function-points and Loading Them into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
² 8.1.3.1 Overview of Function Points
² 8.1.3.5 Ordering Function-points and Loading Them into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.5 Ordering Function-points and Loading Them into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
If the current number of function-points is inadequate for the device application, you can purchase additional
function-points for the SIPROTEC 5 device. With the SIPROTEC 5 configurator, you select a higher function-
points class for this purpose. You do not select additional points individually, but instead, a function-points
class that covers the number of function-points required. However, you need to pay only for the difference
between the new and the current function-points class.
After the payment, you receive a signed license file with the additional device functionality either by down-
loading it or via e-mail. Use the DIGSI 5 to load the license file with the device functionality into the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
You find more information about this procedure under 17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality.
Related Topics
8.1.3.1 Overview of Function Points
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
Connection Categories
You can freely define the following connections in an application:
Circuit-Breaker Interaction
If a Protection group is connected with a Circuit-breaker function group, then you can configure this connec-
tion in detail. For this purpose, specify individually which functions or function blocks of the Protection group
have an effect on the Circuit-breaker function group. You find more information about this under
8.1.4.6 Configuring the Circuit-Breaker Interaction for Protection Groups.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.2 Opening a Function-Group Connection Matrix and Adjusting a View
All column filters are reset and the standard view is restored. Here the columns are set to the original width.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
² 8.1.4.4 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Groups
² 8.1.4.5 Connecting Protection Groups with Circuit-Breaker Functions Groups
NOTE
i The instantiated frequency tracking group must be assigned to any measuring point. By default, the value
of Freq tracking group ID in the General group for the Settings editor of Power system is always 1.
NOTE
i You can modify the frequency tracking group ID only via the Function-group connections editor.
If you have activated several frequency tracking groups during engineering and you delete a frequency
tracking group later, the assigned ID is also deleted and a respective error message is displayed for the
corresponding measuring point. All other frequency tracking groups retain their assigned IDs. If possible try
to avoid ID discontinuity by deleting the frequency tracking group with the highest ID.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
² 8.1.4.4 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Groups
² 8.1.4.5 Connecting Protection Groups with Circuit-Breaker Functions Groups
² 8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
² In the window Connect measuring points with function groups, check if a measuring point can or
must be routed to a function group. If the common cell of the measuring point line and the target
column is light gray, then the measuring point can be routed to the column. If the common cell is dark
gray, the measuring point cannot be routed on the relevant column.
If one or more lines in a column are not consistent, then one more measuring point must be routed on
this column.
² Right-click in the editable cell.
² Click X (Routed) in the context menu.
The value X is entered into the cell and the measuring point is connected to the function group.
- or -
² Click X (Routed – CT neutr. point towards object) in the context menu to route a 3-phase current meas-
uring point to the protection function group.
The value X is entered into the cell and the measuring point is connected in a direction towards protection
function group.
- or -
² Click I (Routed – CT neutr. point away from the object) in the context menu to route a 3-phase current
measuring point to the protection function group.
The value I is entered into the cell and the measuring point is connected in a direction away from the protec-
tion function group.
NOTE
i The context menu options X (Routed – CT neutr. point towards object) and I (Routed – CT neutr. point
away from the object) are available for selection only if you are routing a 3-phase current measuring point
to the protection function group.
² Repeat this process for all other measuring points to be connected and the function groups.
As soon as the measuring points are correctly routed, the color-highlighting is hidden.
NOTE
i You find more options for routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for removing routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
² 8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
• Starting of the Circuit-breaker failure protection function if it is configured in the Circuit-breaker func-
tion group.
• Starting of the Automatic reclosing function if it is available in the Circuit-breaker function group.
You cannot change the specified connections. If you have added new function groups, you can also produce
new connections between function groups.
For adjusting the connections, use the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix. In the 22.3.6 Connecting
Function Group to Circuit-Breaker Groups window of this matrix, every Circuit-breaker function group is
presented by a column. Every measuring point is presented by a line. If you route, in this window, a Protection
group to the column of a Circuit-breaker function group, then both functions groups are connected to each
other.
You can configure the connection between a Protection group and a Circuit-breaker function group. In detail,
you can find more information about this under 8.1.4.6 Configuring the Circuit-Breaker Interaction for Protec-
tion Groups.
NOTE
i If you add a new Circuit-breaker function group, it is automatically connected to the existing Protection
groups. This also applies in reverse, if you add a new Protection group.
NOTE
i You find more options for routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for removing routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
NOTE
i A newly added function is automatically routed to all Circuit-breaker function groups. All existing functions
are automatically routed to a newly added Circuit-breaker function group.
You can adjust the view of the Circuit-breaker interactions matrix. For this purpose, you have the following
standard functions available:
NOTE
i You find more options for routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for removing routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
² 8.1.4.5 Connecting Protection Groups with Circuit-Breaker Functions Groups
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.5.2 Opening the Measuring-Point Routing and Adjusting the View
8.1.5.3 Routing Measuring Points to Physical Inputs
8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
The measuring-point routing is device-oriented. Therefore, the measuring-point routing inside the project
structure is always assigned to the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can adjust the view of the Measuring-point routing matrix. For this purpose, you have the following
standard functions available:
All column filters are reset and the standard view is restored. Here the columns are set to the original width.
Related Topics
² 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
² 8.1.5.3 Routing Measuring Points to Physical Inputs
² 8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
You route the inputs as usual using the context menu. In the context menu the descriptions of the possible
measuring point inputs are visible, for example, IA, IB, and IC. The Measuring-point routing only allows unit
routings. If routing an already routed measuring point input to another physical input, then the original
routing is automatically removed.
NOTE
i You find more options for routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for removing routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
Related Topics
² 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
Opening the Global DIGSI 5 Library and Marking the Measuring-Point Element
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open the folder for the device type.
² Open the 2 folders measuring points one by one.
1 folder for each of the measuring points types Voltage 1-phase, Voltage 3-phase, Current 1-phase, and
Current 3-phase is displayed.
² Open the folder of the required measuring point type.
An element for the measuring point is displayed.
² Mark this measuring-point element.
² Position the measuring-point element on the name of the function group System data.
- or -
² If the function group opens, position the measuring-point element at any place within the indicated func-
tion group contents.
² Release the mouse button.
If insertion is allowed at the selected position, the new measuring-point element will be added into the appli-
cation.
NOTE
i For 7SS device types, the measuring points are routed automatically to the physical inputs of the
SIPROTEC 5 device depending on the allowed count limit and existing configuration.
Related Topics
² 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
Related Topics
² 8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
NOTE
i You can also drag measuring points from the project tree to one of the matrices mentioned above.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
NOTE
i If you delete a measuring point, inconsistencies be created in the application and the settings assignment.
Related Topics
² 8.1.2.1 Overview of Functions and Function Groups
Related Topics
8.2.1.2 Changing the Number of Settings Groups
8.2.1.3 Activating a Settings Group
8.2.1.4 Copying a Settings Group
8.2.3.5 Selecting a Settings Group for Comparison or Editing
NOTE
i Each time you decrease the number of settings groups, the last settings group in the list of available
settings groups will be deleted. All the settings in this settings group will be lost.
To change the number of settings groups, first open the 22.5.10 Device Settings. You find more information
about this under 6.1.10 Opening Device Settings.
Related Topics
² 8.2.1.1 Overview of Settings Groups
Related Topics
² 8.2.1.1 Overview of Settings Groups
Related Topics
² 8.2.1.1 Overview of Settings Groups
parameters as favorite settings. If you have set the marking, the color of the icon changes to yellow indi-
cating the parameters are set as favorites and included in the Favorite settings editor. All functionalities of
the Settings group are also available in the Favorite settings editor. This allows a better overview about the
selected favorite settings, as all other settings are not visible in the Favorite settings editor.
[sc_digsi_favorite_settings, 1, en_US]
NOTE
• It is not possible to set the device settings and time settings as favorites.
• It is possible to export the favorite settings in TEAX, DEX, and UAT format and the favorite settings are
available in the device after the respective imports.
Related Topics
22.1.10 Favorite Settings Editor
22.1.9 Settings Editor
8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
8.2.4.2 Showing and Hiding Graphics Window
8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
The editor opens with the icon displayed for the individual parameters.
²
Click the icon for the respective parameters that you wish to set as favorites.
The color of the icon changes from white to yellow and the respective parameter is displayed in the
Favorites settings editor.
² Click the icon for the parameters that you wish to remove as favorites from the Favorites settings
editor.
The color of the icon changes from yellow to white and the respective parameter is removed from
the Favorites settings editor.
Related Topics
² 8.2.2.1 Overview of Favorite Settings
² 22.1.10 Favorite Settings Editor
² 22.1.9 Settings Editor
• Copying the favorite settings between devices with the same device type:
On copying the favorite settings from one device to another device with the same device type, all the
settings are copied. All the favorite settings are also copied as similar to the first device.
• Copying favorite settings and merging existing favorite settings (same device type):
On copying the favorite settings from one device to another device (already having favorite settings) with
the same device type, all the settings are copied from the source device and pasted under the favorite
settings in the target device. All the existing favorite settings are also copied and merged to the existing
favorite settings.
Related Topics
² 8.2.2.4 Viewing the Favorite Settings
² 8.2.2.2 Marking or Unmarking a Setting as a Favorite
² 8.2.2.1 Overview of Favorite Settings
² 22.1.10 Favorite Settings Editor
² 22.1.9 Settings Editor
The editor opens with the icon displayed for the parameters that are set as favorites.
NOTE
i Any inconsistency happening in any settings also reflects in the Favorite settings editor (provided the
setting is marked as favorite). The Favorite settings folder also appears as inconsistent in the project tree.
On clicking the error message in the Inconsistency tab, the actual Setting editor opens. However, the
inconsistency can also be cleared from the Favorite settings editor.
• You can select the function with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. Settings and values of the function will then be
displayed with the 22.1.9 Settings Editor in the working area. You can then switch to the preceding or to
the next function in the same function group using the navigation arrows. Functions so far not selected
open automatically and are shown with the Settings editor.
• If the single-line configuration is shown in the working area, you can use it to select a function block.
Depending on the procedure, settings and values of the function block are shown with the Settings
editor in the working area or as properties in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window.
For this version, only Protection function groups and Circuit-breaker function group can be selected for
parameter setting.
To use this version, open the single-line configuration in 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor. You find more infor-
mation about this under 7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration.
• If the Information routing or Communication mapping is shown in the working area, you can use it to
select a function. Settings and values of the function will then be displayed as properties in the
3.1.4 Inspector Window.
To use this version, open the matrix 22.3.2 Information Routing or the matrix 22.3.1 Communication
Mapping. You find more information about this under 14.9.3 Opening the Communication Mapping
Matrix and under 11.3.1 Opening the Information Routing Matrix.
If the settings are shown in the Settings editor, all edit functions for settings are available for you to use them.
• Copying settings
• Printing settings
The names of all function blocks contained in this function group are displayed.
² Select the function block that you want to edit.
² Open the Inspector window.
² Go to the Properties tab.
² Go to the Settings group.
The settings and values of the active settings group will be shown for the selected function block.
The settings and values of the preceding function inside the current function group will be displayed in the
Settings editor. If the settings of the first function are already displayed when you click, clicking will have no
effect.
- or -
²
Click the button in the toolbar of the Settings editor.
The settings and values of the next function inside the current function group will be displayed in the Settings
editor. If the settings of the last function are already displayed when you click, clicking will have no effect.
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.3 Selecting between Secondary Values, Primary Values, or Percentage Values
² 8.2.3.5 Selecting a Settings Group for Comparison or Editing
² 8.2.3.2 Editing Text and Decimal Parameters
² 8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
² 8.2.3.6 Adding or Deleting a Function Block
² 8.2.3.7 Copying Settings
² 8.2.3.8 Printing Settings
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
² 8.2.3.3 Selecting between Secondary Values, Primary Values, or Percentage Values
² 8.2.3.5 Selecting a Settings Group for Comparison or Editing
² 8.2.3.7 Copying Settings
² 8.2.3.8 Printing Settings
Selecting a Mode
² Open the device settings.
² Open the Edit Mode list box and select one of the modes Primary, Secondary, or Percent.
The selected edit mode is immediately active. The name of the mode will be displayed in the 22.7.12 Toolbar
of the Settings/Favorite Settings Editor.
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
If the settings numbers were previously hidden, they will be shown. If the settings numbers were previously
shown, they will be hidden.
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
NOTE
i You can only add matching function-block types to a function. There is also a maximum number of func-
tion blocks within a function. If insertion of a function block is not allowed at this position, the mouse
pointer will change to a crossed-out circle.
If there are addable function blocks for the selected function, you see a further folder. For example, it can
have the name Step types or Zone types.
² Open this folder.
One or more elements for the function blocks are displayed. Every function-block element has the name of its
type, for example Zone [MHO 3-pole].
NOTE
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
² 8.1.2.3 Adding a Function
² 8.1.2.2 Adding a Function Group
• Copying Setting Values of a Function Block between the Settings Groups of an Offline Configura-
tion
With the 22.1.9 Settings Editor, you copy the values of a complete function block from the reference
settings group into the same function block of the settings group selected for editing. As a condition, the
number of settings groups used must be greater than 1.
Copying Setting Values of a Function Block between the Settings Groups of an Offline Configuration
² With the Settings Editor open, you can copy the setting values of a function block between settings
groups.
² From the Values for comparison list box, select the settings group from which you wish to copy values.
This defines the source for the copy operation. The values of the reference settings group will be shown.
² From the Values for change list box, select the settings group into which you wish to copy the values.
This defines the target for the copy operation. The values of the settings to be edited will be shown.
² Select the function block whose values you want to copy. This is done by clicking a place inside the gray
area at which no operating elements are located.
The function block is framed.
²
In the 22.7.12 Toolbar of the Settings/Favorite Settings Editor, click the button.
The settings of the selected function block will be copied from the comparison settings group into the target
settings group. The updated values will be shown in the function block of the target settings group.
All settings from the source-settings group will be copied into the target-settings group.
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.5 Selecting a Settings Group for Comparison or Editing
Selecting Functions
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project, open the offline configuration for which you want to print the function settings.
² In this offline configuration, double-click Settings.
The names of all available function groups are listed.
² To print the settings of a single function, open the function group in the project tree and select the name
of the function.
- or -
² To print several functions, select the names of these functions in the project tree. This is done by holding
down either the shift key or the <CTRL> key, depending on the selection method.
- or -
² To print all settings of a function group, select the name of this function group in the project tree.
- or -
² To print the settings of several function groups, select the names of these function groups in the project
tree. This is done by holding down either the shift key or the <CTRL> key, depending on the selection
method.
- or -
² To print all settings, select the Settings folder in the project tree.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
• Zone diagrams
• Operate curves
The graphics are displayed in the Graphics window of the Settings editor. The Graphics window is anchored on
the right-hand side of the Settings editor. You can modify the width of the Graphics window. You can also
hide the Graphics window completely.
Related Topics
8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
8.2.4.6 Copying or Saving Graphics in Graphics Window
8.2.4.7 Printing a Graphic in the Graphics Window
8.2.4.4 Showing and Hiding Grids in the Graphics Window
8.2.4.5 Scaling View in the Graphics Window
8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
If the Graphics window is hidden, your action will show the Graphics window. If the Graphics window is
shown, your action will hide the Graphics window.
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
² 8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
² 8.2.4.4 Showing and Hiding Grids in the Graphics Window
² 8.2.4.5 Scaling View in the Graphics Window
• You can modify the width of the Graphics window in defined steps.
If you zoom in on the Graphics window, it will cover the settings area of the Settings editor.
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
² 8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
² 8.2.4.5 Scaling View in the Graphics Window
If the grid is hidden, your action will show the grid. If the grid is shown, your action will hide the grid.
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
NOTE
i If the maximum display size has been reached, the corresponding menu item and button will be inactive.
NOTE
i If the minimum display size has been reached, the corresponding menu item and button will be inactive.
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
² 8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
² 8.2.4.7 Printing a Graphic in the Graphics Window
Printing Graphics
²
Click the button in the 22.7.13 Toolbar Graphics Window .
Related Topics
² 8.2.4.1 Overview of Graphical Representation of Functions
² 8.2.4.6 Copying or Saving Graphics in Graphics Window
The comparing-parameters feature allows you to compare the parameters of 2 devices of the same device
type in the offline-offline, offline-online, online-offline, and online-online mode.
You can compare and view the differences with respect to the following parameters:
• Settings
• Protocols
• CFC
• Information routing
• Device information
• Measuring-points routing
• Function-group connections
• Circuit-breaker interaction
DIGSI 5 allows you to print/preview the comparison results in the PDF format via the button in the
22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar or the following Project menu options:
• Print...
• Print preview...
NOTE
i If there are no devices of the same device type available for comparison, a respective message is displayed
in the device list box of the Compare with field. Retrieve the process data of any online device before
initiating the comparison.
² Select the desired device for comparison from the device list box.
² In the Content of comparison field, select the desired parameters (for example, Settings, Protocols,
CFC, Information routing, IEC 61850 structure, Device information, and Safety and security) for
comparison.
² Click OK to start the compare operation.
The Compare devices dialog opens and displays the progress status of the comparison.
After successful comparison, the result is displayed in the 22.5.16 Device Comparison view.
The General tab under the Info tab displays the status message and the number of differences based on the
result of the comparison in the Device comparison view.
NOTE
i If you change the IEC settings in an offline configuration of the device without activating the IEC 61850
protocol and then load the configuration to the device, the settings are not transferred to the online
device. In this scenario, the 22.5.16 Device Comparison view will not display any differences for IEC
settings between the offline configuration and the online configuration in the compare result as the IEC
settings are not loaded.
NOTE
i The Device comparison view only displays the latest comparison result. It does not save the result.
²
Click to save the value of the comparison result.
Related Topics
² 22.5.10 Device Settings
² 22.6.6 Compare Devices
² 22.5.16 Device Comparison
You can edit the device data of an offline configuration. The device data include the following settings:
• Rated frequency
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.2 Editing Text and Decimal Parameters
² 8.2.3.4 Showing or Hiding Settings Numbers
Equipment connected to binary inputs can generate binary signals based on faults that constantly change
their states. Chatter blocking detects and blocks such binary signals. Chatter blocking thus prevents genera-
tion of indications in the SIPROTEC 5 device that cannot be evaluated.
You can control the effect of the chatter blocking with the following settings:
Related Topics
² 8.2.3.2 Editing Text and Decimal Parameters
² 8.2.3.4 Showing or Hiding Settings Numbers
The LEDs of the base modules can optionally be red or green when they light up. You can define one of the 2
colors for each LED in DIGSI 5. This is done with the matrix 22.3.2 Information Routing.
Related Topics
² 6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
² 6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
• Measured values
• Metered values
• Indications
• Commands
For every signal category there are different signal types. Examples of signal types are the double command
(DPC) in the Commands category or the single-point indication (SPS) in the Indications category.
Signal Names
For every signal there are 3 different signal names:
• Original name
The original name identifies the original signal. An example for this is >Block function. You cannot
change the original name. With help from the original name you can always identify the original signal,
even if the name of the signal has changed.
• Name
The name of a signal is identical in the original state to the original name. In the example shown, the
name is therefore >Block function. You can change the name of a signal to distinguish several signals
with the same original name.
You can change the name of all signals, for example, the name of predefined as well as user-defined
signals. A changed signal name is only visible in the signal list and thus in the following areas:
– In the signal catalog of the 22.2.5 Signals tab
– In the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix
– In the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix
• Alternative name
You can define alternative names for signals under the Alternative name column in the Information
routing Editor. The allowed character limit to enter the alternative signal name differs based on the
language selected because the limit is calculated based on the number of bytes used by the character. In
this case, the maximum allowed limit of the byte size is 64 bytes. Each character can range from 1 bytes
to 4 bytes depending on the language. For example, in English, each character is equal to a single byte,
whereas, in Chinese, each character is equal to 3 bytes to 4 bytes. While entering the alternative name,
the count of characters is displayed on the right side of the text box. A rollout displays the relevant
message on exceeding the allowed limit.
If you select the check box Use Signal alternative names in the 22.7.36 Toolbar Matrix Information
Routing, the defined alternative names for the signals are used in the logs and records instead of the
hierarchical names. Using the icon, you can show or hide the Alternative name column. Alternative
names are always unique in the respective device.
– The alternative name defined in one language for any signal remains the same in the other
languages on changing the user-interface language if the corresponding alternative name is not
defined in other languages.
– If the alternative name is defined for a signal in more than one language, then the respective alter-
native name is displayed on changing the user interface language.
– By default, the alternative name defined for a signal is displayed in English language on changing
the user interface language if the alternative names are not defined in other languages.
You can delete the alternative names by selecting the option Delete alternative names in the context
menu of the Alternative name column.
The alternative name of the signal is displayed in the following areas:
– In the Properties tab of the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix
– Under the Alternative name column and in the Properties tab of the 22.3.2 Information Routing
matrix
– Under the Alternative name column and in the Properties tab of the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor
matrix
– In the Properties tab of the 22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor matrix
Related Topics
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
9.5.3 Deleting Signals from the Application
9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
9.6.2 Open the Signal Catalog and Adjust View
• Name
• Original name
• Parameter number
• Type
• Description
NOTE
• Sequence (SEQ)
This signal type describes a sequence. The group 21.9.17 SEQ – Details contains the properties of a signal
of type SEQ.
NOTE
i The harmonics signal types (HMV, HWYE, and HDEL) cannot be used in the Communication mapping and in
the Communication protocols. However, you can add a new signal under the Harmonics function block in
the communication mapping Editor. Also, these signals cannot be used in CFC, Display pages, and Test
sequences. So these signals are not visible in the Signal task card as well. The tooltip indicates whether a
particular signal is supported or not.
Setting Types
NOTE
i The SIPROTEC 5 device setting which contains a time value is an integer (ING) type, but is displayed as
floating-point numbers in the DIGSI Settings Editor. For example, Operate delay in SIPROTEC 5 is displayed
as 0.30 ms in DIGSI. In a function chart, the integer values are not converted to floating-point numbers,
they are used as integer values only, as in the IEC 61850 device.
You can add user-defined signals of the following types to the application:
NOTE
i From the current version on, the primary value is always considered instead of the percentage value for
CFC charts created with signals of type Measured value (MV). For signals of type Measured value (MV)
defined via an older version, you must upgrade the CFC chart to the DIGSI version currently installed on
your PC to ensure the use of the primary value of the signals in CFC instead of the percentage value. Using
the current version, you can create new user-defined signals of type MV, CMV, DEL, and WYE. You can also
create CFC charts with the new blocks to process the user-defined signals (MV, CMV, DEL, and WYE).
Depending on your respective work situation, you can add a user-defined signal in different areas:
² Select the tab 22.2.3 Libraries in the task card and open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open the User-defined signals folder.
² In this folder, highlight the signal type that you want to add.
² Drag the highlighted element in the IEC 61850 structure editor and there to a logical node.
- or -
² Using the mouse button, drag the highlighted element into the Information routing matrix and there to
a function group, a function, or a function block.
If insertion is not allowed at this position, the cursor will change to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button.
If insertion is allowed at the selected position, the new signal will be added to the application. You can now
rename the signal. You will find more information about this under 9.5.2 Renaming a Signal.
Related Topics
² 9.1 Overview of Signals
² 9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
² 9.5.3 Deleting Signals from the Application
There are different signal names for each signal: You find more information about this under 9.1 Overview of
Signals.
You can change the following signal names:
• Name
You can change the name of a predefined or user-defined signal.
NOTE
i Every signal has an original name. You cannot change the original name. The length of the function block
name and the name of any subordinated signal together must not exceed 42 characters.
Depending on your respective work situation, you can rename a signal name in different areas:
Related Topics
² 9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
You can delete every user-defined signal. You can only delete predefined signals together with the respective
function or function group, or the respective function block. More information can be found under
8.1.2.7 Deleting Functions or Functions Groups and under 8.2.3.6 Adding or Deleting a Function Block.
Depending on your respective work situation, you can delete a user-defined signal in different areas:
NOTE
i If you delete a signal, inconsistencies may be created in the application and the parameterization.
Related Topics
² 9.1 Overview of Signals
² 9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
² 9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
The signal catalog contains the application signals and settings of all offline configurations in the project. The
signals and settings are structured hierarchically by function groups and functions. As in the project tree, you
can navigate through the structure and show or hide the individual levels.
The signal catalog also contains external signals created by the GOOSE communication. These external signals
are structured hierarchically by offline configurations.
They require the signal catalog for the following tasks:
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.6.2 Open the Signal Catalog and Adjust View
9.6.3 Selecting a Signal or a Setting in the Signal Catalog
9.6.4 External Signals in the Signal Catalog
The signal catalog is part of the 22.2.5 Signals tab. This tab is available if one of the following project compo-
nents is opened in the working area:
Related Topics
² 9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
² 9.6.3 Selecting a Signal or a Setting in the Signal Catalog
In order to use a signal in a display page or a function chart, you must select the signal from the signal catalog
in the 22.2.5 Signals tab. Use drag and drop to add signals from the signal catalog to the display page or the
function chart. A setting can be used only in a function chart. You can find information about this in the
following topics:
Related Topics
² 9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
² 9.6.4 External Signals in the Signal Catalog
In an offline configuration A, if you use a signal from an offline configuration B, the offline configuration A
generates a signal automatically. This signal represents the signal used from offline configuration B. The newly
generated signal using IEC 61850 System Configurator is described as an external signal.
Processes
An external signal is always generated, when you manually generate a GOOSE connection. The source signal
is from offline configuration B, the destination node is from offline configuration A.
Requirement
To generate a GOOSE connection between 2 different offline configurations, a GOOSE capable communica-
tion connection must be projected in the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool. This communication connection
must have the following features:
• For each connected interface, the communication protocol IEC 61850-8-1 must be set.
Example
The following example illustrates the mechanism when generating external signals using IEC 61850 System
Configurator. For this purpose a signal from the offline configuration B is connected with a building block in a
function chart of the offline configuration A:
• A GOOSE connection is generated in the GOOSE application. The signal from the offline configuration B is
the source, a node from the offline configuration A is the target.
• An external signal is generated in offline configuration as a representative for the signal from offline
configuration B.
• If no external signals are available in offline configuration A, the folder External signals is created. This
folder is found in the signal list of the offline configuration A on the function-group level. You can find
this folder in the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix, in the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix and
in the signal catalog of the 22.2.5 Signals tab.
• In the External signal folder another folder is created with the name of the offline configuration B. The
newly generated external signal is stored in this folder. If you generated more connections with signals
from the offline configuration, the applicable external signals are also filed in this folder. If you generate
connections with signals from other offline configurations, new folders are created for these external
signals.
• If you delete the GOOSE connection or the complete GOOSE application, the external signal will be
deleted too. If no other signal exists in the folder of the offline configuration, this folder will also be
deleted. If no other signal exists in the folder External signals, this folder will also be deleted.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
9.6.2 Open the Signal Catalog and Adjust View
9.6.3 Selecting a Signal or a Setting in the Signal Catalog
9.7 Quality
The IEC 61850 standard defines certain quality attributes for data objects (DO). The SIPROTEC 5 system auto-
matically processes these quality attributes. In order to satisfy different applications, you can influence certain
quality attributes and also the values of the data objects depending on these quality attributes.
For more information about processing quality in the CFC charts, refer to 12.1.1.8 Processing Quality in Func-
tion Charts (CFC).
• Validity
The Validity quality attribute uses the values good or invalid.
The Validity quality attribute shows if an object transferred through a GOOSE message is received (valid)
or not received (invalid). The invalid state can be suppressed in the receiver device by setting a substitute
value for the object not received. The substitute value is forwarded to the functions.
The values reserved and questionable are not created in the SIPROTEC 5 system and are not processed
further. If the device receives one of these values, it is replaced by the invalid value and processed
further as invalid.
If a detailed quality attribute has the value TRUE, then Validity is set to the invalid value, unless it was
already done at the sender end.
• Test
The Test quality attribute uses the values TRUE or FALSE.
The Test quality attribute indicates to the receiving device that the object received through the GOOSE
message is created under test conditions and not operating conditions.
• OperatorBlocked
The OperatorBlocked quality attribute uses the values TRUE or FALSE.
The OperatorBlocked quality attribute indicates whether an object transferred through GOOSE message
originates from a SIPROTEC 5 device, that is in a functional logoff state. If the sending device is switched
off, the object is no longer being received and assumes the invalid state. However, since the Operator-
Blocked quality was identified on the receiving device, the object may be treated different at the
receiving end. At the receiving end, the object may be treated like a dropped signal.
• For binary input signals of device-internal functions using the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix
Related Topics
9.7.1 Overview of Quality
12.1.1.8 Processing Quality in Function Charts (CFC)
9.7.3 Processing Quality of GOOSE Connections
9.7.2 Processing Quality of SPS Type Signals
With the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix, you can influence the quality processing of SPS type signals.
Related Topics
² 9.7.1 Overview of Quality
² 12.1.1.8 Processing Quality in Function Charts (CFC)
² 9.7.3 Processing Quality of GOOSE Connections
With the 22.3.2 Information Routing, you can influence the data value and quality of all data types. The
setting options work for the device receiving the data.
Related Topics
² 9.7.1 Overview of Quality
² 12.1.1.8 Processing Quality in Function Charts (CFC)
² 9.7.2 Processing Quality of SPS Type Signals
10.1 Overview
The IEC 61850 structure indicates the hierarchical arrangement of the IEC 61850 elements in an application.
You can use the 22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor to access the structure and adjust it to meet your require-
ments. This process is also called Flexible Engineering.
An application in SIPROTEC 5 devices is organized into function groups and functions. The functions are
arranged within a function group. Functions can consist of one or more function blocks. This application struc-
ture can be viewed for example in the matrix 22.3.2 Information Routing.
The IEC 61850 structure is created by generically converting the application structure:
• The function group and function form the logical device. From a function group Line1 with the function
87 Line diff.prot., the logical device becomes Ln1_87LineDiffProt in the IEC 61850 structure.
• The function blocks of the function are mapped as logical nodes. In the example above, these are the
logical nodes I_PDIF1 and IF_PDIF2. The prefix and suffix of a logical node are predefined. However, the
prefix and suffix can be changed.
• The settings and supervisory indications, for example, group indications, are contained in logical nodes
GAPC1 and PDIF_PTRC1.
This IEC 61850 structure corresponds to the SIPROTEC 5 view. The SIPROTEC 5 view is the preset view for the
Edition mode of IEC 61850.
Another view is the SIPROTEC 4 similar view. In the SIPROTEC 4 similar view, the IEC 61850 structure is
arranged similar as in the SIPROTEC 4 devices. The logical devices PROT, CTRL, MEAS, and DR are predefined
as fixed values. In the logical devices the function blocks are logical nodes. A generic assignment of function
groups and functions to the IEC 61850 structure is no longer available in this view. Logical nodes and the
superordinate controlling nodes are, however, displayed in the correct sequence (Logical device, Logical node,
Data object and Data attributes).
The IEC 61850 structure editor allows you to switch between the 2 views. You find more information about
this under 10.4 Switching between Different Views.
Options
NOTE
i These settings should be done at the beginning of the configuration, directly after activation of the
IEC 61850 protocol.
The following tasks can be performed with the IEC 61850 structure editor:
• Switch between the SIPROTEC 5 view and the SIPROTEC 4 similar view.
• Adding signals.
• Showing or hiding the logical devices, logical nodes, and signals on the IEC 61850 interface.
Applications
The following describes 3 example applications for working with the IEC 61850 structure editor:
• To avoid a high flexible engineering effort when using a specification with few Logical Devices, you can
switch from the SIPROTEC 5 structure to the SIPROTEC 4 structure using the IEC 61850 structure editor.
• If you want to adapt the structure and designations of the elements and devices regardless of the manu-
facturer, this can be done using the IEC 61850 structure editor. You can, for example, name a device
according to its location or intended use. In the process, and also for all other elements, you can adapt
the name to comply with the terminology used within your company. This type of structural adaptation is
also called 10.2 Functional Naming and Flexible Product Naming.
• If you are familiar with IEC 61850, you can make allowed changes to the functionality in the IEC 61850
structure editor. Instead of adding a function to a single-line configuration, you can add a user-defined
logical node or user-defined signals directly to the IEC 61850 structure.
Advantages
The variability of the IEC 61850 structure provides advantages including the following:
Related Topics
10.3 Opening and Adjusting the IEC 61850 Structure Editor
10.5 Adding a Logical Node and Selecting a Class
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
15.6 Selecting the IEC 61850 Edition
Definitions
• Functional naming
A data model with functional structure based on SCL is manufacturer-independent and standardized. In
IEC 61850, this function-oriented naming is called Functional Naming (function-related addressing). A
system model according to IEC 61850 is formed by the modeling of the primary system structure with the
following elements:
– Logical nodes for the equipment
– Distributed functions
– Type classes of the logical nodes, data objects, and attributes
Product Naming
With flexible product naming, you can change the object tree structure. You have the following possibilities:
• Custom naming
The attribute LDname is used instead of the combination of the attributes IEDname and LDinst as part of
the address in a GOOSE or report communication only in Edition 2 and the standard solution for func-
tional naming.
You can define the IED name, the instance name of the logical device, the prefix, and the suffix.
Related Topics
10.1 Overview
NOTE
i It is not possible to filter the columns according to the user-defined criteria (for example, the
22.6.25 Custom Filter option is not available in the IEC 61850 structure editor.
Related Topics
10.1 Overview
10.4 Switching between Different Views
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
10.7 Deleting Elements
10.8 Moving Elements
15.6 Selecting the IEC 61850 Edition
NOTE
i Siemens recommends to decide for a preferred view, before you configure the offline configuration.
Selecting a View
² Open the list box for the view in the IEC 61850 structure editor toolbar.
² Select one of the following settings SIPROTEC 5 View or SIPROTEC 4 similar view.
The view in the structure list of the IEC 61850 structure editor is updated.
Related Topics
² 10.1 Overview
• Beh (state)
• Health (readiness)
• NamPlt (name)
• Mod (mode)
A newly added logical node has the class USER. The class defines the function of the node. The class PDIS, for
example, represents distance protection. You can change the class assigned to the logical node you have
added in its properties.
Related Topics
² 10.1 Overview
² 10.6 Renaming a Logical Device and a Logical Node
² 9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
² 10.7 Deleting Elements
² 10.8 Moving Elements
• Instance name
The instance name is the name of the logical device within the IEC 61850 structure, for example Applica-
tion or CTRL.
• Communication name
The communication name is the name of the logical device that is transmitted when communicating with
other devices. If you do not specify a communication name, one will be generated automatically. This
communication name is a concatenation of the device name and the name of the logical device.
You can change the following name parts for a logical node:
• Prefix
Different prefixes are used to group logical nodes according to their function. If, for example, you want to
configure switchgear interlocking protection, you can assign the prefix SFS to all of the logical nodes
required for this function. Adding a prefix also enables logical nodes to be located more easily.
• Instance (inst)
You can use several instances of the same logical node. Each instance of a logical node must be assigned
an instance number. If you use the same prefix for several logical nodes in the same class (LN class),
assign different instance numbers to these logical nodes. If you use the same instance number for several
logical nodes in the same class, the logical nodes must be differentiated by their prefixes.
The combination of prefix, class, and instance number must be unambiguous within a SIPROTEC 5 device in
case DIGSI checks it at a certain point of time during the configuration.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 10.1 Overview
• User-defined signal
You cannot delete the following elements:
• Class LLN0 logical nodes contained within the user-defined logical device
• Predefined signal
Deleting Elements
² Mark one or more elements that you want to delete in the structure list of the IEC 61850 structure editor.
²
Click in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar on the button.
- or -
² Press the <Del> button.
- or -
² Right-click on the element that you want to delete in the structure list of the IEC 61850 structure editor.
² Click Delete in the context menu.
NOTE
i The element(s) is / are deleted without further confirmation prompts. You can delete any logical device in
this view as long as it has only an LN0 with no user-defined signals. You can delete user-defined signals and
logical nodes only if they are not involved in the GOOSE communication.
Related Topics
² 10.1 Overview
• Logical node
• Signal
You cannot move the following elements:
• Logical device
• Logical node, if a logical node with the same combination of prefix, class and instance number already
exists in the logical target device and if the logical node contains connected GOOSE inputs
• Signal, if a signal with the same IEC 61850 name already exists in the destination node
• External signals
Moving an Element
² Mark the element that you want to move in the structure list of the IEC 61850 structure editor.
² Hold down the mouse button and drag the marked element to a suitable target.
If a target is not suitable for the marked element, the mouse pointer changes to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button at a permissible destination.
The marked element is moved.
Related Topics
² 10.1 Overview
NOTE
i You cannot edit the labels for terminals, LEDs, and function keys in the properties of the Information
Routing editor. This can only be done in the properties of the respective hardware in the Hardware and
protocols editor.
Information
The following information types are available:
Sources
The following sources are available:
• Binary inputs
• Function keys
Destinations
The following destinations are available:
• Binary outputs
• LEDs
• Fault records
• Logs
– Operational log
– Fault log
– Ground fault log
– User log 1
– User log 2
• Device menu
– Measurement
– Control
• Display
Related Topics
11.3.1 Opening the Information Routing Matrix
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
9.1 Overview of Signals
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
To open the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix, depending on your current working situation, you have the
following options:
• You can open the Information routing matrix using the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
• If the single-line configuration is shown in the working area, you can use it to open the Information
routing matrix.
To use this version, open the single-line configuration in 22.1.2 Single-Line Editor. You find more infor-
mation about this under 7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration.
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
² 11.3.2 Adjusting the Information Routing View
The following standard functions are available to adapt the view of the information routing:
If the signal numbers were shown, this action hides these numbers. If the numbers were hidden, this action
shows these numbers.
If the display columns were shown, this action hides the display columns. If the display columns were hidden,
this action shows the display column.
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
You can filter the scope of the displayed information, sources, and destinations using 2 different predefined
display profiles. The first predefined profile includes the following display profiles:
• All Entries
There is no constraint regarding the display of pieces of information, sources, and destinations.
• Trips
Only signals connected with tripping are displayed. All other information is hidden. This also applies to
complete function groups, if these do not contain at least one signal that is connected to tripping. All
sources and destinations are displayed.
• Device I/O
Only input and output signals of the SIPROTEC 5 device are displayed. All other information is hidden.
This applies also to entire function groups, unless these contain at least one input and output signal.
The following sources are displayed:
– Binary inputs
– GOOSE
The following destinations are displayed:
– Binary outputs
All other sources and destinations are hidden.
• Routed (*)
• Not routed ()
NOTE
i You cannot switch to the reduced column view if a filtered view is selected. You find more information
about this under 11.3.4 Switching between Condensed Column View.
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
² 11.3.2 Adjusting the Information Routing View
The selection between expanded and reduced column view has an effect on the display of the following
column blocks:
• Binary inputs
• Function keys
• Binary outputs
• LEDs
The expanded and reduced column view has the following differences:
NOTE
i You can only switch to a reduced column view if the display profile All entries has been selected. You find
more information about this under 11.3.3 Filtering Information Routing with Predefined Display Profiles.
- or -
² Using the display profile list box, select one of the display profiles Trips, Measured/metered values,
Device I/O, or Configuration of menu levels.
The information routing is displayed in the Expanded column view.
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
² 11.3.2 Adjusting the Information Routing View
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
You can route the signals of the following types to binary inputs:
• X (routed)
The signal is routed to the binary input.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed to the binary input.
• Not routed
The single-point indication is not routed to the binary input.
• Not routed
The user-defined controllable single-point indication is not routed to the binary input.
• Not routed
The respective single-point indication is not routed to the binary input.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
You can route the signals of the following types to function keys:
NOTE
i A function key can already be occupied because it is parameterized for the selection of an operating level in
the SIPROTEC 5 device.
• T (toggle)
When the function key is pressed, the routed single-point indication is generated and stays. When the
function key is pressed once more, the routed single-point indication is canceled.
• P (trigger pulse)
When the function key is pressed, the routed single-point indication is generated and stays. A renewed
pressing of the function key has no effect.
• Not routed
The single-point indication is not routed to the function key.
• T (toggle)
When the function key is pressed, the routed controllable single-point indication is set to On. When the
function key is pressed once more, the routed controllable single-point indication is set to Off.
• On (on)
When the function key is pressed, the routed controllable single-point indication is set to On.
• Off (off)
When the function key is pressed once more, the routed controllable single-point indication is set to Off.
• Not routed
The controllable single-point indication is not routed to the function key.
NOTE
i Depending on the actual controllable single-point indication, less or even none of the options named can
be available for selection.
• T (toggle)
When the function key is pressed, the command is sent as an On command. When the function key is
pressed once more, the command is sent as a trip command.
• On (on)
When the function key is pressed, the command is sent as an On command.
• Off (off)
When the function key is pressed once more, the command is sent as a trip command.
• Not routed
The command is not routed to the function key.
NOTE
i Depending on the function of the command with double-point feedback, less or even none of the options
named can be available for selection.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
You can route the signals of the following types to binary outputs:
Routing a Single-Point Indication (SPS) or a User-defined Marker Command (SPC) to a Binary Output
You can route a single-point indication or a user-defined marker command to several binary outputs. For this,
select one of the following options:
• L (latched)
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is stored and routed to the binary
output. The relay of the binary output latches as soon as the single-point indication or the user-defined
marker command is pending. Even if the respective signal is no longer pending, the relay remains
latched. You must manually reset the relay on the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about
this in the respective device manual.
• U (unlatched)
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is not stored and routed to the binary
output. The relay of the binary output latches as soon as the respective signal is pending. As soon as the
single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is no longer pending, the relay also
unlatches.
• Not routed
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is not routed to the binary output.
Routing a Command with Double-Point Feedback (DPC) or a User-defined Controllable Single-Point Indication (SPC)
to a Binary Output
You can route a command with double-point feedback or a user-defined controllable single-point indication
(SPC) to several binary outputs. For this, select one of the following options:
• On (on)
The command or the controllable single-point indication is routed as an On command to this binary
output.
• Off (off)
The command or the controllable single-point indication is routed as a trip command to this binary
output.
• CC (common contact)
This binary output is specified as a common contact. You can assign several commands or controllable
single-point indications to a common binary output as a common contact and save binary outputs.
Prerequisite is that the signals at the common contact have the same potential. An application example is
a common ground potential.
• Not routed
The command or the controllable single-point indication is not routed to the binary output.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
NOTE
i LEDs associated with the push-button module are displayed according to the position of the IO module in
the Devices and Network editor.
• L (latched)
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is stored and routed to the LED. The LED
lights up as soon as the single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is pending. Even if
the respective signal is no longer pending, the LED continues to be lit. You must manually reset the LED
on the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about this in the respective device manual.
• U (unlatched)
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is routed to the LED and not stored. The
LED lights up as soon as the respective signal is pending. As soon as the single-point indication or the
user-defined marker command is no longer pending, the LED goes dark.
• Not routed
The single-point indication or the user-defined marker command is not routed to the LED.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
You can route the signals of the following types to fault records.
• Signals
Signals routed to this column are recorded in a fault record.
• Trigger
• Signals routed to this column serve as triggers for fault recording. This column is shown, if you have
selected the setting User-defined for the Fault recording parameter. You find this parameter in the fault
recorder settings.
• X (routed)
The signal is routed to fault records and will be recorded.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed to fault records.
• X (routed)
The signal is routed as trigger for fault recording.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed as trigger for fault recording.
• X (routed)
The signal routed using this option will be available in the created Fast-scan record or Slow-scan record.
• T (trigger)
The signal routed using this option will act as the trigger input for record creation. A change in the status
(value) of this signal will start record generation.
• XT (routed+trigger)
The signal routed using this option will act as the trigger input to generate Fast-scan records or Slow-
scan records. It is also available in the records generated by different triggering sources.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed as trigger for fault recording.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
17.5.3.2 Configuring and Setting Parameters for Fault Recording
• Operational Log
• Fault Log
• X (routed)
The signal is routed to the log.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed to the log.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
You can route user-defined signals of the following types to the device menu Measurement of a SIPROTEC 5
device:
• Measured Values
The signal is routed to the device menu Measurement. This option is available only for user-defined
signals of type Measured Values (MV).
• Metered Values
The signal is routed to the device menu Measurement. This option is available only for user-defined
signals of type Status of a Whole Number (INS).
• Not configured
The signal is not routed to the device menu Measurement.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
You can route user-defined signals of the following types to the device menu Control of a SIPROTEC 5 device:
• X (routed)
The signal is routed to the device menu Control.
• Not routed
The signal is not routed to the device menu Control.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.4.9 Editing the Properties of Sources and Destinations
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
NOTE
i You can also edit the properties of hardware components, for example, of binary inputs or LEDs from the
Properties tab of the Devices and networks editor.
[sc_digsi_binary_input, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
You can edit the properties of the user-defined signals of the following types:
Related Topics
² 9.1 Overview of Signals
² 9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
² 11.1 Overview for Information Routing
² 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
You can route signals of type ACD (Directional protection information) to 1 type of destination.
Destination
You can route signals of type ACD to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type ACT (Protection activation information) to 1 type of destination.
Destination
You can route signals of type ACT to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type BSC (Binary controlled step position information) to 1 type of source and 1
type of destination.
Source
You can route signals of type BSC to binary inputs.
Destination
You can route signals of type BSC to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.1 Routing to Binary Inputs
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type DPC (Double-point controllable) to different sources and destinations.
Sources
You can route signals of type DPC to the following sources:
• Binary inputs
• Function keys
Destinations
You can route signals of type DPC to the following destinations:
• Binary outputs
• Logs
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.1 Routing to Binary Inputs
11.4.2 Routing to Function Keys
11.4.3 Routing to Binary Outputs
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
11.4.8 Routing to Device Menu Control
You can route signals of type ENC (Enumerated setting controllable) to 1 type of destination.
Destination
You can route signals of type ENC to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type ENS (Enumerated status) to 1 type of destination.
Destination
You can route signals of type ENS to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type INC (Controllable integer status) to 1 type of destination.
Destination
You can route signals of type INC to logs.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
You can route signals of type INS (Integer status) to different destinations.
Destinations
You can route signals of type INS to the following destinations:
• Logs
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
11.4.7 Routing to Device Menu Measurement
You can route signals of type SPS (single-point indication) to different sources and destinations.
Sources
You can route signals of type SPS to the following sources:
• Binary inputs
• Function keys
Destinations
You can route signals of type SPS to the following destinations:
• Binary outputs
• LEDs
• Fault records
• Logs
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.1 Routing to Binary Inputs
11.4.2 Routing to Function Keys
11.4.3 Routing to Binary Outputs
11.4.4 Routing to LEDs
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
11.4.8 Routing to Device Menu Control
You can route signals of type SPC (Single-point controllable) to different sources and destinations.
Sources
You can route signals of type SPC to the following sources:
• Binary inputs
• Function keys
Destinations
You can route signals of type SPC to the following destinations:
• Binary outputs
• Logs
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.1 Routing to Binary Inputs
11.4.2 Routing to Function Keys
11.4.3 Routing to Binary Outputs
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
11.4.8 Routing to Device Menu Control
You can route signals of type SPC (Marker command) to 1 type of source and different destinations.
Source
You can route signals of type SPC to function keys.
Destinations
You can route signals of type SPC to the following destinations:
• Binary outputs
• LEDs
• Logs
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.3 Routing to Binary Outputs
11.4.4 Routing to LEDs
11.4.6 Routing to Logs
11.4.8 Routing to Device Menu Control
Destinations
You can route signals of type MV to the following destinations:
• Fault records
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
11.4.7 Routing to Device Menu Measurement
You can route signals of type CMV (Measured value) to different destinations.
Destinations
You can route user-defined signals of type CMV to the following destinations:
• Fault records
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
11.4.7 Routing to Device Menu Measurement
Destinations
You can route user-defined signals of type DEL to the following destinations:
• Fault records
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
11.4.7 Routing to Device Menu Measurement
Destinations
You can route user-defined signals of type WYE to the following destinations:
• Fault records
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
11.4.7 Routing to Device Menu Measurement
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HMV to 2 types of destinations.
Destinations
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HMV to fast-scan recorders and continuous
recorders.
Restrictions
For the PQ 150/180 cycle harmonics/interharmonics function block, the MV array conversions under signals
of type HMV can only be routed to fast-scan recorders and not to continuous recorders.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HWYE to 2 types of destinations.
Destinations
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HWYE to fast-scan recorders and continuous
recorders.
Restrictions
For the PQ 150/180 cycle harmonics/interharmonics function block, the MV array conversions under signals
of type HWYE can only be routed to fast-scan recorders and not to continuous recorders.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HDEL to 2 types of destinations.
Destinations
You can route MV array conversions under signals of type HDEL to fast-scan recorders and continuous
recorders.
Restrictions
For the PQ 150/180 cycle harmonics/interharmonics function block, the MV array conversions under signals
of type HDEL can only be routed to fast-scan recorders and not to continuous recorders.
Related Topics
9.3 Signal Types
11.4.5 Routing to Fault Records
• Interlockings
• Fault indications
• Derivation of new dimensions from the measured indicated and metered values
With the 22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor, you can create function charts (CFC). For this, you use a library
with preassembled blocks that you interconnect for the overall function. This eliminates the programming of
blocks and reduces the frequency of errors.
In order to create the connection to the process or also to other CFC functions, you can use either so-called
connectors or sidebars. Through these 2 elements, you can interconnect blocks with signals or settings from
the signal catalog. On the one hand, signals and settings serve as input information for the CFC function. On
the other hand, only signals act as output indications that are created as the result of a CFC function.
When you have completely configured the function charts, DIGSI 5 creates an executable program for the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.1.3 Block
12.1.1.7 Naming Conventions
12.1.1.6 Flow Model
12.1.1.5 Configuration Strategy
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.7 Naming Conventions
12.1.1.5 Configuration Strategy
12.1.1.3 Block
For the configuration of a Continuous Function Chart, you use predefined function blocks. You can use various
block types for this purpose.
Block Type
A block type is a type-coded block that can be used multiple times. A block receives all the required data to
complete its task from the block inputs. The block algorithm processes the input values and displays the
returned results as the output.
Each block type has a type definition, which contains the following:
• Type name
The type name describes the function of the block. For example, ADD_R is used for adding values.
• Algorithm
The algorithm is a sequence of instructions for processing a task, for example, adding multiple values.
Block Instance
A block instance is the use of a block type in the Continuous Function Chart. You can create multiple blocks
from a single block type in consideration of the resource consumption. Each block instance receives a unique
name within a CFC. The block instance inherits the default settings of the block type as a standard, for
example, the initial values of the inputs.
During configuration, you have the following possibilities:
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.7 Naming Conventions
12.1.1.6 Flow Model
Related Topics
12.5.1 Brief Introduction to Function Subcharts and Templates
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
22.1.12 Data Flow
Optimizing Performance
NOTE
i In order to keep the function charts (CFC) clearly represented, Siemens recommends using user-defined
function blocks (UFBs) to structure the tasks if possible. Structuring tasks of the function chart by using
user-defined function blocks has the following benefits:
• You have the advantage of reusing the UFBs easily in other plans.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
• Event-triggered
Use this task level preferably for logic functions that do not need to be executed with the highest priority.
Functions on the Event-triggered task level are typically processed within a maximum of 5 ms in all
devices. For Busbar protection or Line protection, the functions on the Event-triggered task level are
processed within a maximum of 10 ms. But the protection functions or functions on the High priority
Event-triggered task level can disrupt processing.
NOTE
i In the Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level, no event-based triggering of the plan execution is done.
Siemens does not recommend using the Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level for the event-based
blocks (for example, control blocks) as the behavior of the blocks may differ in comparison to the other task
levels.
All function blocks can be assigned to all task levels. CFC function blocks are always available for all the
devices. If enough TICKS are available, you can create all function plans in the same task level. A TICK is a
measure for the performance requirement of the CFC blocks.
The number of available TICKS per task level is calculated depending on the created device configuration. This
calculation is based on the load model and is described in the Device Manual (chapter Resource-Consump-
tion Supervision). Siemens recommends creating all selected functions and user-defined signals first and
starting the configuration of the function charts afterwards. Thus, it is possible to calculate a realistic value for
the remaining system capacity for function charts.
With the load model, exceeding the typical response time is avoided by limiting the number of CFC function
blocks in the corresponding task level via the available number of TICKS.
The following figure shows an example for function-plan capacities calculated with the load model in DIGSI.
The TICKS available per task level are displayed. The green bars show the used TICKS in the task levels. You can
view this information in the 22.5.5 Resource Consumption tab under 22.5.3 Device Information editor.
[sc_digsi_cfcstatistics, 3, en_US]
NOTE
i High priority Event-triggered function charts are executed with a higher priority than the other task
levels. A considerably lower number of TICKS is available for this task level than for the other task levels.
Siemens recommends configuring only high-priority logics in this task level and configuring everything else
in one of the other task levels.
NOTE
i Empty function charts and unused subcharts consume resources and they also contribute to the system
resource consumption. Siemens recommends deleting empty function charts and unused subcharts.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.1.3 Block
The control characters are exclusively relevant for path and hierarchy specifications. Other than in this
context, the control characters are interpreted as permissible components of a name.
• Place the control characters in the front with the alignment key $, for example, "Motor1$.Temperature".
Example
In the TempControl CFC, the block Motor1.Temperature for the temperature regulation of a motor is config-
ured. The naming conventions of the operator see the period as a delimiter character.
In the Control flow, in order to address the output OUT of the block, the following formats are permissible:
• TempControl\"Motor1.Temperature".OUT
• TempControl\Motor1$.Temperature.OUT
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.1.3 Block
General Processing
NOTE
i The general processing of quality for CFC charts is valid only if you set the option CFC chart quality
handling under CFC as automatic in the 22.5.10 Device Settings editor.
Most of the function blocks do not have an explicit quality processing. For these function blocks, the following
general mechanisms apply:
NOTE
i A function chart can assume the test state because of the following reasons:
• The entire SIPROTEC 5 device is in a test state and thus also all function charts and all functions.
• Using the function block CHART_STATE, an individual chart is switched to the test state.
• 12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
• 12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
• 12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS
• 12.2.5.25 SPLIT_SPS
• 12.2.5.22 SPLIT_DPS
• 12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
• 12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
• 12.2.5.11 BUILD_Q
• 12.2.5.12 BUILD_SPS
• 12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
• 12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
• 12.2.5.9 BUILD_ENS
Related Topics
9.7.1 Overview of Quality
12.1.1.8 Processing Quality in Function Charts (CFC)
9.7.3 Processing Quality of GOOSE Connections
9.7.2 Processing Quality of SPS Type Signals
If you instantiate a CFC block from the DIGSI CFC-block library into a function chart (CFC), the correct CFC-
block version will automatically be used related to the device-configuration version. New CFC blocks can only
be used if the device-configuration version is equal to or higher than the CFC-block version. In devices with an
older configuration version, the new CFC block cannot be used. Changed CFC blocks are usable in the new
version only if the device-configuration version is equal to or higher than the CFC-block version, too. In devices
with older configuration version, the old CFC-block version is used.
If you paste a CFC block or a function chart (CFC) which contains CFC blocks into a device configuration, the
CFC-block version is checked. If a CFC-block version is not allowed for the device-configuration version, an
error message is shown and pasting is canceled. If you upgrade the configuration, the CFC-block version is
taken into account and the CFC block with the correct version is used automatically.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.3.2 Scaling the View
² 12.1.3.1 Adjusting the Layout in the CFC Data Flow View
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.1 Adding a CFC
NOTE
i If you use the Cut option from the context menu to move the CFCs, the CFC is deleted from the source
destination before being pasted to the target destination. For a protected function chart, you can use the
Copy/Paste option, but it is not possible to use the Cut option.
NOTE
i Instead of the Copy command, you can also use the Cut command. The function charts (CFC) are then
deleted from the source device.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
Selecting CFCs
² In the project tree, open the Charts folder in the offline configuration from which you want to delete
function charts.
You see the names of all available function charts (CFC).
² In order to delete an individual CFC, mark the name of this CFC.
- or -
² In order to delete a number of CFCs, mark the names of these CFCs. This is done by holding down either
the SHIFT key or the <CTRL> key, depending on the selection method.
Deleting CFCs
² In the project tree, right-click a marked function chart (CFC).
² Click Delete in the context menu.
A confirmation prompt is displayed.
² Click Yes.
This confirms your action.
The marked function charts (CFC) are deleted from the project.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.1 Adding a CFC
NOTE
i To utilize the print space efficiently and to avoid printing any blank pages, you can adjust the layout
settings in the General group before printing. You can find these settings under the Properties tab of the
function chart. For additional information regarding this topic, refer to 12.1.3.1 Adjusting the Layout in the
CFC Data Flow View .
² Click Print.
The Print dialog closes and the selected data is printed.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
NOTE
i If you reduce the sheet size or the sheet count again, all objects from non-available areas are automatically
positioned on the remaining area. If the area is not adequate for all objects, the objects are placed in the
upper left of the CFC. In this case, expand the sheet count and manually place the objects.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.3.2 Scaling the View
• You can adjust the CFC to fit the size of the working area.
NOTE
i If the maximum or minimum display size is reached, the respective button is inactive.
² Select a percentage value or enter a whole number percentage value between 10 and 200 in the entry
field of the list box.
² Confirm your entry by pressing the <Enter> key or clicking outside the list box.
The CFC is displayed in the percentage size selected or entered.
Additionally to the list box in the toolbar, there are a list box and a slider right beside the horizontal scroll bar
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.3.2 Scaling the View
• Static sidebars
• Dynamic sidebars
• No sidebars
You can select the sidebar variant by clicking the toggle button in the function-chart toolbar or in the
properties of the function chart. The width of the sidebars is variable but all sidebars within a function chart
always have the same width. You can change the width directly using the mouse or by setting the value in the
properties of the function chart. Sidebars can be shown in one or within 2 lines. You can change these settings
Static Sidebars
An area is reserved at the right and left in every sheet of the function chart for the sidebars. This area is exclu-
sively for sidebar entries.
[sc_digsi_static, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i Connections between blocks which cross a sheet area are split and shown in the sidebar as cross-sheet
interconnections .
Dynamic Sidebars
A CFC with dynamic sidebars displays sidebar entries only if necessary.
A CFC configured in this way differs from a CFC with fixed sidebars by way of the following properties:
[sc_blocks, 1, en_US]
No Sidebars
The CFC is shown without sidebars. Instead, so-called connectors show the interconnections to the signals or
to the settings. The connectors are placed next to the block interface. Cross-sheet interconnections are
displayed as if they are on one sheet.
NOTE
i Blocks on sheet borders are not completely illustrated when printed. Thus, when configuring without side-
bars, make sure that you did not place blocks on sheet borders. In order to do so, show the sheet borders
when configuring.
[sc_digsi_nosidebar, 1, en_US]
Sidebar Expansion
If you create more sidebar entries than there is space in the sidebar, this is automatically expanded. An arrow
is shown in the sidebar on the lower edge. The following figure shows a sidebar with sidebar expansion.
[sc_expans, 1, en_US]
By clicking the arrow, you change to the sidebar expansion. The sidebar expansion is displayed slightly offset
from the sidebar.
[sc_expan2, 1, en_US]
In order to return to the sidebar, click the arrow on the upper edge.
Related Topics
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
• Arithmetic
• Compare
• Control
• Conversion
• Edge Detect
• Flip-Flops
• Logic
• Non-linear
• Other
• Persistency
• Selection
Related Topics
12.1.4.2 Adding a Block in a CFC from the Block Library
12.2 Block Types
[sc_librar, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i Blocks are displayed under the following conditions without interconnections and in a different color:
• With automatic positioning: There is not enough space in the sheet of a CFC for all the blocks.
• With manual placement: You can position blocks on top of each other or on an interconnection.
Interconnections to incompletely displayed blocks are executed as connectors. If blocks are on top of each
other, the lowest block is displayed completely. All of the blocks above this are partially displayed.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.7.3 Considering Function Points
² 12.1.4.3 Renaming a Block or Adding a Block Comment
² 12.1.4.7 Deleting Elements from the CFC
² 12.1.4.6 Aligning Elements in the Data Flow View in the CFC
[sc_rename, 1, en_US]
The changed block name is updated automatically in the block and all references.
Related Topics
² 12.1.4.1 Block Library
² 21.4.6 Block – General Properties
Copying Elements
² Right-click one of the selected elements and click Copy from the context menu.
The elements are copied to the clipboard.
² Right-click an open area in the CFC and click Paste from the context menu.
- or -
² Mark all elements in the CFC that you wish to copy.
² Press the <CTRL> key, drag the marked elements to the CFC folder or to the destination group in this
folder, and release the mouse button and the <CTRL> key.
Copies of the original elements are added in the CFC. The added elements automatically receive new names in
order to preserve the uniqueness of the names.
Related Topics
² 12.1.4.1 Block Library
12.1.4.5 Adding and Editing a Text Box in a CFC in the Data Flow View
Use the text boxes in order to add additional information to the CFC. With this, for example, you can docu-
ment a signal characteristic.
You have the following possibilities to configure a text box:
- or -
² Right-click in an open area of the CFC. Then click in the context menu on Add text box.
The text box is added in the predefined standard size.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
• Align left
• Center horizontally
• Align right
• Align top
• Center vertically
• Align bottom
Mark at least 3 elements and select one of the following possibilities:
• Distribute horizontally
• Distribute vertically
The reference element which is used for orienting the other elements is automatically determined.
The following criteria apply:
• Aligning
The marked elements are aligned together. The element whose position is closest to the desired align-
ment is used as a reference element. Example: If you wish to align the 3 elements to the right, the
elements are aligned to that element which is furthest to the right.
• Distributing
The marked elements are distributed equally. The position average of all marked elements is used as a
base value.
Aligning Elements
² Mark at least 2 elements in the CFC.
² Right-click a marked element. Click Align in the context menu.
A submenu is displayed.
² Select one of the actions listed from this submenu.
The marked elements are aligned or distributed.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
NOTE
i If you delete an interconnected block, you also delete the interconnections. The interfaces of the originally
interconnected blocks are set to the standard values of the block type.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
Connectors with the same numbers represent the interconnection. With multiple connectors, the numbers are
numbered continually.
[sc_inter2, 1, --_--]
You can interconnect the blocks by drag and drop or by double-clicking the block input or output and clicking
the destination output or input.
A block output and a block input can be connected if their data types are the same or compatible. Compatible
data types are not the same, but they can be converted. The conversion of compatible data types takes place
automatically. Other information about data types and its conversion are found under 12.1.5.7 Converting
Data Types.
You can interconnect a block output with several block inputs. In order to create such multiple interconnec-
tions, connect the block output with the different inputs of the destination blocks. One or more interconnec-
tion nodes arise depending on the positions of the destination blocks. You can interconnect a block input only
once.
Related Topics
² 12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
NOTE
i Signals of the type MV (measured value), CMV (complex measured value), DEL (3-phase measured value in
delta connection), and WYE (3-phase measured value in Y connection) used as input signals in CFC are used
in percentage values only.
[sc_signal, 2, en_US]
² Drag this into the CFC by pressing the mouse and then moving it to the input or output of the respective
block.
If the signal or setting can be interconnected with the selected connection, the connection will be highlighted
in color. If the interconnection is not possible, the mouse pointer will change into a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button.
If the interconnection is permissible, the signal or setting of the block will be interconnected with the input
and its output respectively. An interconnection line connects the sidebar cell with the block interface.
Related Topics
² 12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
[digscree-110310-27.png, 4, --_--]
You can enable or disable the negation in the context menu or in the properties.
[sc_negat1, 1, en_US]
Depending on the check-box state, the block input will be negated or the negation will be disabled.
[sc_negat2, 1, en_US]
Depending on the check-box state, the block input will be negated or the negation will be disabled.
Related Topics
² 12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
Related Topics
12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
the context menu or clicking the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar. The deletion of an interconnection disa-
bles the negation of a block input.
Related Topics
² 12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
• UINT to DINT
• REAL to DINT
Additional conversions are available for measured values. You will find more information about this under
12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
If you wish to connect 2 connections with different data types to each other, there is an automatic test to see
if a type conversion is possible. If that is the case, you can connect both of the connections with each other.
You do not have to add a conversion block. The data types are automatically converted during the compilation
of the CFC.
When connecting, green markings show that a conversion is possible. If a data type cannot be converted into
a different type, you also cannot combine the corresponding connections with each other.
Related Topics
12.1.5.2 Interconnecting Blocks
NOTE
i Nested function charts get the same task level as the CFC they are used in. You cannot set the task level of
nested function charts in the Properties tab.
NOTE
i If you execute the following changes in the properties dialog, confirm this with OK.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.6 Flow Model
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
Depending on the current state, the sequence numbers in the blocks are shown or hidden.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.6 Flow Model
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.6.3 Adjusting the Running Sequence of Blocks Manually
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.6 Flow Model
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.6.2 Optimizing the Running Sequence Automatically
• The function chart (CFC) contains a feedback loop between the blocks. Optimize the chart and compile
again.
• Signal connected to the CFC block is invalid or deleted. Replace it with an appropriate signal.
• Connection of the signal to the CFC block is invalid. The signal is already connected with another source.
Remove this connection or remove connection(s) to the other source for this signal.
• Only one instance of the CHART_STATE block can be used in a function chart (CFC).
• The function-chart name exceeds the allowed character limit of 100 characters. Correct it and compile
again.
• The length of the text in the Comment area under the General group in the Properties tab of the CFC
block exceeds the allowed size (300 characters).
• The length of the text in the Comment area under the General group in the Properties tab of the func-
tion chart exceeds the allowed size (300 characters).
• CFC blocks are configured, but only 32 000 CFC blocks are allowed for a device. Limit the number of CFC
blocks within 32 000.
• Number of ticks configured for the task exceed the allowed limit. Limit the number of the used ticks in
the task within the allowed limit.
• The CFC block is incompatible with the device version. Use another suitable block.
Related Topics
² 12.1.7.4 Compiling the CFC
² 12.1.7.2 Checking Resource Consumption
• Ticks
A tick is the smallest system-time unit and describes a certain time period in milliseconds. Each block in a
CFC requires a certain number of ticks for processing. The number of ticks depends on the block type, the
signals, and the settings connected to the block. The maximum number of ticks available for each of the
4 task levels will change dynamically based on the device configuration.
– High priority Event-triggered
– Event-triggered
– Low priority Event-triggered and Low priority Cyclic-triggered
In order to determine if the CFC functions are found within the permissible borders, you can check the current
resource consumption. You can view the resource consumption in the Resource consumption tab via the
Device information node in the project tree.
[sc_rescon, 2, en_US]
The respective resource consumption has 2 scales. The left scale begins with the value 0. On the right edge of
the scale you see the value for the maximum permissible number. A green bar within the scale displays the
currently used number. Additionally, the currently used number is displayed numerically next to the right-
hand, smaller scale. A red bar in the right-hand scale informs you that the maximum permissible number has
been exceeded.
In order to reduce resource consumption, proceed as follows:
• Check if you have nested function charts in the root of the Chart folder or other useless function charts.
• Check if you can use a different task level where free ticks are available.
• Check if you can replace blocks for creating constant values by setting the constant value directly at the
block input.
NOTE
i If you change CFCs while the Resource consumption tab is open, update the resource-consumption
Related Topics
² 12.1.7.3 Considering Function Points
NOTE
You can check the actual function-point status in the Resource Consumption tab in the Device information.
You find more information about this under 17.6.3 Determining the Function-Points Class Required.
Starting Compilation
² In the project tree, open the folder of the offline configuration in which you want to compile the CFCs.
² Right-click in this folder on Plans.
² Click in the context menu on Compile.
NOTE
NOTE
i The Compile icon is active if a tree node is selected in the Project tree that is capable of compiling.
The compilation process starts. Possible error messages are listed in the Compile tab of the Info window.
NOTE
i If the Optimize chart option is selected for a chart, the optimization of this chart is always performed
during the compilation. The option is selected by default.
[scgloballib, 1, en_US]
12.2.1 Arithmetic
12.2.1.1 ADD_D
The ADD_D block adds 4 whole-number input values (summands).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of the basic data type, refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 4 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block. In the 3.1.4 Inspector Window unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group of
the Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block adds the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4. The result of the addition is available at the Y output.
• If you want to add floating-point numbers, use the ADD_R block instead of ADD_D.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the ADD_XMV block instead
of ADD_D.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.2 ADD_R
12.2.2.1 ADD_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.2 ADD_R
The ADD_R block adds 4 floating-point numbers (summands).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 4 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the block Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block adds the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4. The result of the addition is available at the Y output.
• If you only want to add whole numbers, Siemens recommends the ADD_D block instead of the ADD_R
block.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the ADD_XMV block instead
of ADD_R.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.1 ADD_D
12.2.2.1 ADD_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.3 SUB_D
The SUB_D block subtracts a whole-number input value (subtrahend) from a 2nd whole-number input value
(minuend).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type please refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block subtracts the value at the INSUB input from the value at the IN input. The result of the subtraction is
available at the Y output.
• If you want to subtract floating-point numbers, use the SUB_R block instead of SUB_D.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the SUB_XMV block instead
of SUB_D.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.4 SUB_R
12.2.2.2 SUB_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.4 SUB_R
The SUB_R block subtracts a floating-point number (subtrahend) from a 2nd floating-point number
(minuend).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block subtracts the value at the INSUB input from the value at the IN input. The result of the subtraction is
available at the Y output.
• If you only want to subtract whole numbers, Siemens recommends the SUB_D block instead of the
SUB_R block.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the SUB_XMV block instead
of SUB_R.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.3 SUB_D
12.2.2.2 SUB_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.5 MUL_D
The MUL_D block multiplies 4 whole-number input values (factors).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 4 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the block Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block multiplies the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4. The result of the multiplication is available at the Y
output.
• If you want to multiply floating-point numbers, use the MUL_R block instead of MUL_D.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the MUL_XMV block instead
of MUL_D.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.6 MUL_R
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.6 MUL_R
The MUL_R block multiplies 4 floating-point numbers (factors).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 4 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the block Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block multiplies the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4. The result of the multiplication is available at the Y
output.
• If you only want to multiply whole numbers, Siemens recommends the MUL_D block instead of the
MUL_R block.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the MUL_XMV block instead
of MUL_R.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.5 MUL_D
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.7 DIV_D
The DIV_D block divides a whole-number input value (numerator) by a 2nd whole-number input value
(denominator).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block divides the value at the IN input (numerator) by the value at the INDIV input (denominator). The
result of the division is available at the Y output as whole-number, that means decimal places are rounded to
whole numbers. If you are interested in the remainder of a whole-number division, you can use MOD_D block.
• If you want to divide floating-point numbers, use the DIV_R block instead of DIV_D.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the DIV_XMV block instead
of DIV_D.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.8 DIV_R
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
12.2.1.9 MOD_D
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.8 DIV_R
The DIV_R block divides a floating-point number (numerator) by a 2nd floating-point number (denominator).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block divides the value at the IN input (numerator) by the value at the INDIV input (denominator). The
result of the division is available at the Y output.
• If you only want to divide whole numbers, Siemens recommends the DIV_D block instead of the DIV_R
block.
• If the quality information of the input values is to be taken into account, use the DIV_XMV block instead
of DIV_R.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.7 DIV_D
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.9 MOD_D
The MOD_D block calculates the modulo from 2 whole-number input values. Modulo is a remainder operation
which generates the whole-number remainder from a whole-number division. For example, with 10 modulo 3
the remainder is 1.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block divides the value at the IN input (numerator) by the value at the INMOD input (denominator) and
outputs the remainder of the division. The result of the modulo function is available at the Y output. You can
use the modulo function to check, for example whether a number is even. If x mod 2 = 0, then x is even.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.7 DIV_D
12.2.1.10 ABS_D
The ABS_D block calculates the absolute value of a whole-number input value.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type see 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the absolute value of the value at the IN input. The result of the function is available at
the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.11 ABS_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.11 ABS_R
The ABS_R block calculates the absolute value from a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type see 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the absolute value of the value at the IN input. The result of the function is available at
the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.10 ABS_D
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.12 LOG_R
The LOG_R block calculates the common logarithm of a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the common logarithm of the value at the IN input. The common logarithm is the loga-
rithm with base 10. The result of the logarithm function is available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.13 LN_R
12.2.1.14 EXP_R
12.2.1.15 EXPT_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.13 LN_R
The LN_R block calculates the natural logarithm of a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the natural logarithm of the value at the IN input. The natural logarithm is the logarithm
with base e. The result of the logarithm function is available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.12 LOG_R
12.2.1.14 EXP_R
12.2.1.15 EXPT_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.14 EXP_R
The EXP_R block calculates the natural exponential function of a floating-point number (exponent).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The EXP_R block calculates the natural exponential function of the value at the IN input. The natural exponen-
tial function is the exponential function with base e. The result of the exponential function is available at the
OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.13 LN_R
12.2.1.15 EXPT_R
12.2.1.12 LOG_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.15 EXPT_R
The EXPT_R block calculates the exponential of a floating-point number (exponent) to a 2nd floating-point
number (base).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the exponential function of the exponent IN_EXP to the base INBASE. The result of the
exponential function is available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.13 LN_R
12.2.1.12 LOG_R
12.2.1.14 EXP_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.16 SQRT_R
The SQRT_R block calculates the square root of a floating-point number (radicand).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the square root of the value at the IN input. The result of the square-root extraction is
available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.14 EXP_R
12.2.1.15 EXPT_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
The SIN_R block calculates the sine of a floating-point number (angle).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the sine of the value at the IN input. The result of the sine function is available at the OUT
output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.19 COS_R
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
The ASIN_R block calculates the arcsine of a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the arc sine of the value at the IN input. The arc sine is the inverse function of the
restricted sine function. The result of the arc-sine function is available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
12.2.1.19 COS_R
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.19 COS_R
The COS_R block calculates the cosine of a floating-point number (angle).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the cosine of the value at the IN input. The result of the cosine function is available at the
OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
The ACOS_R block calculates the arccosine of a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type see 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the arc cosine of the value at the IN input. The arccosine is the inverse function of the
restricted cosine function. The result of the arccosine function is available at the OUT output.
The value at the input IN must be in the area from -1.0 to +1.0.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
12.2.1.19 COS_R
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
The TAN_R block calculates the tangent of a floating-point number (angle).
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the tangent of the value at the IN input. The result of the tangent function is available at
the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
12.2.1.19 COS_R
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.1.22 ATAN_R
The ATAN_R block calculates the arctangent of a floating-point number.
For the connectivity of inputs/outputs of basic data type refer to 12.8.1 Basic Data Types.
Detailed Description
The block calculates the arc tangent of the value at the IN input. The arc tangent is the inverse function of the
restricted tangent function. The result of the arc-tangent function is available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.17 SIN_R
12.2.1.19 COS_R
12.2.1.21 TAN_R
12.2.1.18 ASIN_R
12.2.1.20 ACOS_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.2.1 ADD_XMV
The ADD_XMV block adds up to 4 measured values (summands). The quality of the inputs is taken into
account. With additional input, a floating-point number without quality information is added, which can be
used for an offset.
Detailed Description
The block adds the measured values at input IN1 to IN4 and an additional floating-point number at the IN_C
input. The result of the addition is available at the OUT output. The quality information at the output is built
from the quality information of the inputs IN1 to IN4 combined with the logical OR function.
Additionally to the preferred signals of type MV, you can connect also signals of type INS or block outputs of
compatible type (for example, REAL) to input IN1 to IN4.
On the output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type MV or APC or you can connect other
block inputs with compatible type (for example, REAL) for further processing.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains informa-
tion for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measuring signal from which the value
description shall be used. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output
cannot be converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage
value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.2 ADD_R
12.2.2.2 SUB_XMV
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ
12.2.10.2 NL_MV
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.2.2 SUB_XMV
The SUB_XMV block subtracts a measured value (subtrahend) from a 2nd measured value (minuend). The
quality of the inputs is taken into account.
With an additional input, a floating-point number without quality information is added. It can be used for an
offset.
Detailed Description
The block subtracts the measured value at the IN_SUB input from the measured value at the IN1 input and
adds an additional floating-point value at IN_C input. The result of the calculation is available at the OUT
output. The quality information at the output is built from the quality information of the inputs IN and IN_SUB
combined with the logical OR function.
Additionally to the preferred signals of the type MV, you can connect also signals of the type INS or block
outputs of compatible types (for example, REAL) to input IN to IN_SUB.
On the output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type MV or APC or you can connect other
block inputs with compatible types (for example, REAL) for further processing.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains informa-
tion for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measuring signal from which the value
description shall be used. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output
cannot be converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage
value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.4 SUB_R
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ
12.2.10.2 NL_MV
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
The MUL_XMV block multiplies 2 measured values and an additional floating-point factor. The quality infor-
mation of the measured values at the inputs IN1 and IN2 will be taken into account.
Detailed Description
The block multiplies the measured values at input IN1 and IN2 and an additional floating-point value at IN_C
input. The result of the multiplication is available at the OUT output. The quality information at the output is
built from the quality information of the inputs IN1 and IN2 combined with the logical OR function.
Additionally to the preferred signals of type MV, you can connect also signals of type INS or block outputs of
compatible type (for example, REAL) to input IN1 and IN2.
On output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type MV or APC or you can connect other block
inputs with compatible type (for example, REAL) for further processing.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains informa-
tion for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measuring signal from which the value
description shall be used. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output
cannot be converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage
value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.6 MUL_R
12.2.2.1 ADD_XMV
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ
12.2.10.2 NL_MV
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.2.4 DIV_XMV
The DIV_XMV block divides a measurement value (numerator) by a 2nd measurement value (denominator)
and multiplies it with an additional floating-point number without quality information. The quality of the
measurement inputs are taken into account.
Detailed Description
The block divides the measured value at input IN by the measured value at input IN2 and multiplies the result
with an additional floating point value at the DIV_C input. The result of the calculation is available at the OUT
output. The quality information at the output is built from the quality information of the inputs IN and IN_DIV
combined with the logical OR function.
Additionally to the preferred signals of type MV, you can connect also signals of type INS or block outputs of
compatible type (for example, REAL) to input IN and IN_DIV.
On output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type MV or APC or you can connect other block
inputs with compatible type (for example, REAL) for further processing.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains informa-
tion for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measuring signal from which the value
description shall be used. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output
cannot be converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage
value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.1.8 DIV_R
12.2.2.1 ADD_XMV
12.2.2.2 SUB_XMV
12.2.2.3 MUL_XMV
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ
12.2.10.2 NL_MV
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3 Compare
12.2.3.1 LT_D
The LT_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is less than input value 2, the block
sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
less than the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.2 LT_R
The LT_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is less than input value 2, the block sets
the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
less than the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.3 LE_D
The LE_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is less than or equal to input value 2,
the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
less than or equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.4 LE_R
The LE_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is less than or equal to input value 2,
the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
less than or equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.5 GE_D
The GE_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is greater than or equal to input value
2, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
greater than or equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.6 GE_R
The GE_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is greater than or equal to input value
2, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
greater than or equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.7 GT_D
The GT_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is greater than input value 2, the
block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
greater than the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.8 GT_R
The GT_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is greater than input value 2, the block
sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
greater than the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
The EQ_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is equal to input value 2, the block
sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.10 EQ_E
The EQ_E block compares 3 enumerated values of the type ENG, ENC, or ENS. If input value 1 is equal to input
value 2, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
If you connect a signal or a setting of the type ENC, ENS, or ENG at input IN1 or IN2, a list of all possible
setting values is available automatically at the other input. You can select the setting value for the comparison
directly at the input by selecting the value in the list box.
[scEQ_E, 1, en_US]
If the signals or settings have the same setting list, you can also connect an extra signal or setting of the type
ENC, ENS, or ENG at the 2nd input, instead of selecting a value.
[scEQ_E2, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
The EQ_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is equal to input value 2, the block sets
the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.12 NE_D
The NE_D block compares 2 whole-number input values. If input value 1 is not equal to input value 2, the
block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
not equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.13 NE_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.13 NE_R
The NE_R block compares 2 floating-point input values. If input value 1 is not equal to input value 2, the block
sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN1 input with the value at the IN2 input. If the value at the IN1 input is
not equal to the value at the IN2 input, the block sets the OUT output to 1 (TRUE).
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN1 or IN2, take into
account that there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as
percentage values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.1 LT_D
12.2.3.2 LT_R
12.2.3.3 LE_D
12.2.3.4 LE_R
12.2.3.6 GE_R
12.2.3.7 GT_D
12.2.3.8 GT_R
12.2.3.9 EQ_D
12.2.3.11 EQ_R
12.2.3.12 NE_D
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.14 LIML_R
The LIML_R block compares a floating-point number with a programmable limiting value. If the limiting value
is not reached, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN input with a limiting value at the LIMIT input. If the input value is
smaller than the limiting value, the block sets the EXC output to 1 (TRUE). You can use the value at the HYS
input to parameterize a hysteresis so that, if the limiting value is exceeded, the block does not set the output
to 0 (FALSE) immediately. Instead, the block resets the output only if the input value exceeds the percentage
value (100 + value at the HYS input) of the value at the LIMIT input. For example, if the HYS input has a
default setting of 5, the block resets the output if 105 % of the value at the LIMIT input is exceeded.
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN, take into account that
there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as percentage
values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.15 LIMU_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.15 LIMU_R
The LIMU_R block compares a floating-point number with a programmable limiting value. If the limiting value
is exceeded, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value at the IN input with a limiting value at the LIMIT input. If the input value
exceeds the limiting value, the block sets the EXC output to 1 (TRUE). You can use the value at the HYS input
to parameterize a hysteresis so that, if the input value falls below the limiting value, the block does not set the
output to 0 (FALSE) immediately. Instead, the block resets the output only if the input value falls below the
percentage value (100 - value at the HYS input) of the value at the LIMIT input. For example, if the HYS input
has a default setting of 5, the block resets the output if the input value falls below 95 % of the limiting value.
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN, take into account that
there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as percentage
values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.3.14 LIML_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.3.16 DRAGI_R
The DRAGI_R saves the maximum or minimum value present at an input as a floating-point number.
Detailed Description
If the MIN input is 0 (FALSE), the block saves the maximum value at the IN input. If the MIN input is 1 (TRUE),
the block saves the minimum value. The saved value is available at the OUT output. To reset the saved value,
set the RESET input to 1 (TRUE). If the RESET input is 1 (TRUE), the value at the OUT output is set to value at
the input IN.
NOTE
i If you connect a signal (for example, measured values of type MV) at the input IN, take into account that
there is no quality handling in the block and that measured values in CFC are always used as percentage
values only.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.4 Control
12.2.4.1 APC_DEF
You can use the block APC_DEF to prepare a control command for an output by the block APC_EXE.
Detailed Description
The block APC_DEF allows you to specify if a control command selects, operates or selects and operates an
APC control object. To issue control commands, connect the output ID_OUT with the input ID of the APC_EXE
block. For more information, refer to 12.2.4.2 APC_EXE.
At input ID, you can connect a controllable of type APC (Controllable analogue process value). You can release
or block the command output via the value at the EN_I input. The APC_DEF block can forward the ID of the
controllable object connected at input ID to the ID_OUT output only if the input EN_I is set to 1 (TRUE). If the
input EN_I is 1 (TRUE) and a command is triggered, the EN_O output is set to 1 (TRUE) until EN_I is set to 0
(FALSE). You can use these 2 connections to interrupt a command sequence.
If the value at input EN_I is 1 (TRUE) a status change at the input TRIG forwards the ID of the controllable
object connected at input ID to the output ID_OUT. The value at the input EDGE specifies the required status
change.
The values at the inputs SELECT and OPERATE specifies whether the controllable object shall be selected or an
operate command shall be done if a command is triggered. If the value at input SELECT is > 0 and the value at
the input OPERATE is 1 (TRUE), a select-before-operating sequence will be issued if a command is triggered.
Here the control object is selected first.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.2 APC_EXE
With the block APC_EXE, you issue a control command to the APC control object that you have prepared with
the block APC_DEF.
Detailed Description
With the block APC_EXE, issue a control command that you have prepared with block APC_DEF. For this
purpose, connect the input ID of the block APC_EXE with the output ID_OUT of the block APC_DEF. You can
find more information about preparing the switching command under 12.2.4.1 APC_DEF.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.3 BSC_DEF
You are using the block BSC_DEF to prepare a control command for an output by the block BSC_EXE.
Detailed Description
The block BSC_DEF allows you to specify if a control command can perform the following for a BSC control
object:
• Select
• Operate or select
• Operate
To issue control commands, connect the output ID_OUT with the input ID of the BSC_EXE block. For more
information, refer to 12.2.4.4 BSC_EXE.
At input ID, you can connect a controllable of type BSC (controllable binary controlled step position).
You can release or block the command output via the value at the EN_I input. The BSC_DEF block can forward
the ID of the controllable object connected at input ID to the ID_OUT output only if the input EN_I is set to 1
(TRUE). If the input EN_I is 1 (TRUE) and a command is triggered, the EN_O output is set to 1 (TRUE) until EN_I
is set to 0 (FALSE).
If the value at input EN_I is 1 (TRUE), a status change at the input TRIG forwards the ID of the controllable
object connected at input ID to the output ID_OUT. The value at the input EDGE specifies the required status
change.
The values at the inputs SELECT and OPERATE specify whether the controllable object should be selected or
an operate command should be selected if a command is triggered. If the value at input SELECT is > 0 and the
value at the input OPERATE is 1 (TRUE), a select-before-operating sequence is issued if a command is trig-
gered. Here the control object is selected first.
The value at the VAL input specifies whether the controllable object will be switched one step higher or one
step lower.
You can assign a certain originator to the switching command using the value at the ORIGIN input. If for
example you use the value 4, the command is treated like a remote-control command during processing. The
originator is also an additional item of information in the indication log.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.4 BSC_EXE
With the block BSC_EXE, you issue a control command to the tap changer that you have prepared with the
block BSC_DEF.
Detailed Description
With the block BSC_EXE, issue a switching command that you prepared with block BSC_DEF. For this purpose,
connect the input ID of block BSC_EXE with the output ID_OUT of the block BSC_DEF. More information
about preparing the switching command can be found under 12.2.4.3 BSC_DEF.
For function charts, there is the rule that input signals on the left-hand side of the block and output signals on
the right-hand side of the block are connected. According to this rule, if you show the sidebar, the input
signals will be in the left-hand sidebar and the output signals in the right-hand sidebar. A command should
actually be considered the output signal for the process. However, since the command forwarded by block
BSC-DEF presents an input signal for the BSC_EXE block, the command is connected to the input side of the
block. As a result, the block BSC_EXE receives the information as to which command it will issue. Therefore,
for the command output, the block BSC_EXE requires no further connection to the right sidebar. However, the
block receives feedback. These can be processed further in the function chart, or switched as output signals
using the right sidebar.
Follow this procedure to issue a command using the block BSC_EXE:
• Removing Interlocking
Use the inputs REL_DBL, REL_PLBY, and REL_ILOC to remove the interlocking conditions. If you set one
of these inputs to 1, the applicable interlocking condition will be put out of operation.
• Evaluating Feedback
Use the outputs ACTIVE, SEL_OK,OK and ERR to evaluate different feedbacks. You can use these
outputs, for example, for realizing an operating sequence or routing indications or LEDs.
The 2 outputs OK and ERR will keep their condition until the next command execution. The 2 outputs
ACTIVE and SEL_OK are reset after the command execution.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.5 DPC_DEF
With the block DPC_DEF, you prepare a control command for an output by the block DPC_EXE.
Detailed Description
The block DPC_DEF allows you to specify if a control command can perform the following for a DPC control
object:
• Select
• Operate or select
• Operate
To issue control commands, connect the output ID_OUT with the input ID of the DPC_EXE block. For more
information, refer to 12.2.4.6 DPC_EXE.
At the input ID you can connect a controllable of the type DPC (controllable single point).
You can release or block the command output via the value at the EN_I input. The DPC_DEF block can forward
the ID of the controllable object connected at the input ID to the ID_OUT output only if the input EN_I is set to
1 (TRUE). If the input EN_I is 1 (TRUE) and a command is triggered, the EN_O output is set to 1 (TRUE) until
EN_I is set to 0 (FALSE).
If the value at the input EN_I is 1 (TRUE), a status change at the input TRIG forwards the ID of the controllable
object connected at the input ID to the output ID_OUT. The value at the input EDGE specifies the required
status change.
The values at the inputs SELECT and OPERATE specify whether the controllable object should be selected or
an operate command should be selected if a command is triggered. If the value at the input SELECT is > 0 and
the value at the input OPERATE is 1 (TRUE), a select-before-operating sequence is issued if a command is trig-
gered. Here the control object is selected first.
The value at the VAL input specifies whether the controllable object should be switched on or off. You can
assign a certain originator to the switching command using the value at the ORIGIN input. If for example you
use the value 4, the command is treated like a remote-control command during processing. The originator is
also an additional item of information in the indication log.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.6 DPC_EXE
With the block DPC_EXE, you issue a control command to the DPC control object that you have prepared with
the block DPC_DEF.
Detailed Description
With the block DPC_EXE, issue a switching command that you prepared with the block DPC_DEF. For this
purpose, connect the input ID of the block DPC_EXE with the output ID_OUT of the block DPC_DEF. You can
find more information about preparing the switching command under 12.2.4.5 DPC_DEF.
• Evaluating Feedback
Use the outputs ACTIVE, SEL_OK, OK, and ERR to evaluate different feedbacks. You can use these
outputs, for example, for realizing a selection or operation command.
The 2 outputs OK and ERR will keep their condition until the next command execution. The 2 outputs
ACTIVE and SEL_OK are reset after the command execution.
outputs EN_O, you can centrally manage the release of the control sequence. You have to set the input EN_I
of the 1st block DPC_DEF to 0 (FALSE) to block the complete command sequence.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.7 ENC_DEF
With the block ENC_DEF, you prepare a control command for an output by the block ENC_EXE.
After adding the block to the chart, the VAL2, VAL3, and VALSEL inputs are not visible. If you need these
inputs, select the block, go to the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, and unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Inter-
face group of the Properties tab of the block.
Detailed Description
The block ENC_DEF allows you to specify if a control command can perform the following for an ENC control
object:
• Select
• Operate or select
• Operate
To issue control commands, connect the output ID_OUT with the input ID of the ENC_EXE block. For more
information, refer to 12.2.4.8 ENC_EXE.
At the input ID, you can connect a controllable of the type ENC (enumerated controllable).
You can release or block the command output via the value at the EN_I input. The ENC_DEF block can forward
the ID of the controllable object connected at the input ID to the ID_OUT output only if the input EN_I is set to
1 (TRUE). The value of the EN_I input is forwarded to the EN_O output. You can use these 2 connections to
interrupt a command sequence. For more information, refer to the section Realize command sequence in
12.2.4.8 ENC_EXE.
If the value at the input EN_I is 1 (TRUE), a status change at the input TRIG forwards the ID of the controllable
object connected at the input ID to the output ID_OUT. The value at the input EDGE specifies the required
status change.
The values at the inputs SELECT and OPERATE specify whether the controllable object should be selected or
an operate command should be selected if a command is triggered. If the value at the input SELECT is > 0 and
OPERATE is 1 (TRUE), if a command is triggered, then the control object is selected first.
The value which is used for a select with value or an operate command depends on the values at the inputs
VALSEL and VAL1, VAL2, and VAL3.
After connection of an ENC controllable to the input ID, you can select a value directly at the VALx input in the
list box. The list-box content depends on the connected controllable at the input ID.
[sc_enc_def1, 1, en_US]
If you want to change the value which is used for a select with value or an operate command during
runtime, carry out the following steps:
• Set the value at the VALSEL input for the selection of the VALx input which should be used as shown in
the following example:
[sc_enc_def2, 1, en_US]
You can also connect a setting of type ENG, a controllable of type ENC, or a signal of type ENS directly to a
VALx input. You must ensure that the allowed values for both of the connected objects match, otherwise you
cannot connect the 2nd object.
[sc_enc_def3, 1, en_US]
12.2.4.8 ENC_EXE
With the block ENC_EXE, you issue a control command to the ENC control object that you have prepared with
the block ENC_DEF.
Detailed Description
With the block ENC_EXE, issue a control command that you prepared with the block ENC_DEF. For this
purpose, connect the input ID of the block ENC_EXE with the output ID_OUT of the block ENC_DEF. You can
find more information about preparing the control command under 12.2.4.7 ENC_DEF.
• Evaluating Feedback
Use the outputs ACTIVE, SEL_OK, OK, and ERR to evaluate different feedbacks. You can use these
outputs, for example, for realizing a selection or an operation command.
The 2 outputs OK and ERR will keep their condition until the next command execution. The 2 outputs
ACTIVE and SEL_OK are reset after the command execution.
[sc_enc_exe, 1, en_US]
[sc_enc_exe2, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
12.2.4.9 SPC_DEF
With the block SPC_DEF, you prepare a control command for an output by the block SPC_EXE.
Detailed Description
The block SPC_DEF allows you to specify if a control command can perform the following for a SPC control
object:
• Select
• Operate or select
• Operate
To issue control commands, connect the output ID_OUT with the input ID of the SPC_EXE block. For more
information, refer to 12.2.4.10 SPC_EXE.
At the input ID, you can connect a controllable of the type SPC (controllable single point).
You can release or block the command output via the value at the EN_I input. The SPC_DEF block can forward
the ID of the controllable object connected at the input ID to the ID_OUT output only if the input EN_I is set to
1 (TRUE). The value of the EN_I input is forwarded to the EN_O output.
If the value at the input EN_I is 1 (TRUE), a status change at the input TRIG forwards the ID of the controllable
object connected at the input ID to the output ID_OUT. The value at the input EDGE specifies the required
status change.
The values at the inputs SELECT and OPERATE specify whether the controllable object should be selected or
an operate command should be selected if a command is triggered. If the value at the input SELECT is > 0 and
the value at the input OPERATE is 1 (TRUE), a select-before-operating sequence is issued if a command is trig-
gered. Here the control object is selected first.
The value at the VAL input specifies whether the controllable object should be switched on or off. You can
assign a certain originator to the switching command using the value at the ORIGIN input. If for example you
use the value 4, the command is treated like a remote-control command during processing. The originator is
also an additional item of information in the indication log.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.4.10 SPC_EXE
With the block SPC_EXE, you issue a control command to the SPC control object that you have prepared with
the block SPC_DEF.
Detailed Description
With the block SPC_EXE, issue a switching command that you prepared with the block SPC_DEF. For this
purpose, connect the input ID of the block SPC_EXE with the output ID_OUT of the block SPC_DEF. You can
find more information about preparing the switching command under 12.2.4.9 SPC_DEF.
• Evaluating Feedback
Use the outputs ACTIVE, SEL_OK, OK, and ERR to evaluate different feedbacks. You can use these
outputs, for example, for realizing a selection or operation command.
The 2 outputs OK and ERR will keep their condition until the next command execution. The 2 outputs
ACTIVE and SEL_OK are reset after the command execution.
outputs EN_O, you can centrally manage the release of the control sequence. You have to set the input EN_I
of the 1st block SPC_DEF to 0 (FALSE) to block the complete command sequence.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
NOTE
i The functionality of SPC_INFO and DPC_INFO blocks is identical. The descriptions for these blocks are
therefore combined.
Detailed Description
You can use this block to query information about the current command.
The block delivers the information summarized in the previous table, regardless if the command was actually
executed or not. Therefore, this block does not provide any information about the process.
Before the 1st command output, the output VAL is equal to 0. During the command output the output is set
to the value which corresponds to the desired switching state On or Off. After the command output, the
output keeps this value until the next command output.
During the output of a command for switching, the output DOOPR and the outputs PEND_ON or PEND_OFF
are set. The outputs are reset as soon as the command output is completed.
The output DOSEL is set by selecting the switching devices, and is only reset after the command output has
expired.
ADDCAUSE:
• 0: Unknown
• 1: Not-supported
• 2: Blocked-by-switching-hierarchy
• 3: Select-failed
• 4: Invalid-position
• 5: Position-reached
• 6: Parameter-change-in-execution
• 7: Step-limit
• 8: Blocked-by-Mode
• 9: Blocked-by-process
• 10: Blocked-by-interlocking
• 11: Blocked-by-synchrocheck
• 12: Command-already-in-execution
• 13: Blocked-by-health
• 14: 1-of-n-control
• 15: Abortion-by-cancel
• 16: Time-limit-over
• 17: Abortion-by-trip
• 18: Object-not-selected
• 19: Object-already-selected
• 20: No-access-authority
• 21: Ended-with-overshoot
• 22: Abortion-due-to-deviation
• 23: Abortion-by-communication-loss
• 24: Blocked-by-command
• 25: None
• 26: Inconsistent-parameters
• 27: Locked-by-other-client
NOTE
i A block SPC_INFO or DPC_INFO can only process a single command. Therefore, for every command for
which you need information, it must be switched with its own block SPC_INFO or DPC_INFO block.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
NOTE
i The functionality of the block SPC_OUT and DPC_OUT is identical. The descriptions for these blocks are
therefore combined. The blocks SPC_OUT and DPC_OUT are described in the following as xPC_OUT.
Detailed Description
You can use the block xPC_OUT to issue a switching command directly to the switching device without having
to define the command as Selecting or Switching. Therefore, the block is suitable for switching tasks with
less security requirements.
In order to issue a command using block xPC_OUT, please follow this procedure:
• Removing Interlocking
Use the inputs REL_EQ, REL_DBL, REL_PROT, REL_PLBY, and REL_ILOC to remove the interlocking condi-
tions. If you set one of these inputs to 1, the applicable interlocking condition will be put out of opera-
tion.
• Issuing Command
A condition change at the input TRIG issues the command to the switching device. The value at the input
EDGE specifies the required status change. If the EDGE input is set to 1, every condition change forwards
the command. If the input EDGE is set to 0 then only a condition change from 0 to 1 issues the
command.
• Evaluating Feedback
The outputs OK and ERR tell you whether the command execution was successful or unsuccessful. You
can route the outputs for example to indications or LEDs. The 2 outputs OK and ERR will keep their state
until the next command execution.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
• Block APC_INFO for Controllable analogue process value (APC) service request
• Block BSC_INFO for Binary controlled step position information (BSC) service request
NOTE
i The functionality of APC_INFO, BSC_INFO, and INC_INFO blocks is identical. The descriptions for these
blocks are therefore combined.
Detailed Description
You can use this block to query information about the current command. The block delivers the information
summarized in the previous table, regardless if the command was actually executed or not. Therefore, this
block does not provide any information about the process.
Before the 1st command output, the VAL output is equal to 0. During the command output, the output is set
to the value which corresponds to the desired control service request. After the command output, the output
keeps this value until the next control service request.
During the output of a command for switching, the output DOOPR and the output PEND are set. The outputs
are reset as soon as the command output is completed.
The output DOSEL is set by selecting the switching devices and is only reset after the command output has
expired.
ADDCAUSE:
• 0: Unknown
• 1: Not-supported
• 2: Blocked-by-switching-hierarchy
• 3: Select-failed
• 4: Invalid-position
• 5: Position-reached
• 6: Parameter-change-in-execution
• 7: Step-limit
• 8: Blocked-by-Mode
• 9: Blocked-by-process
• 10: Blocked-by-interlocking
• 11: Blocked-by-synchrocheck
• 12: Command-already-in-execution
• 13: Blocked-by-health
• 14: 1-of-n-control
• 15: Abortion-by-cancel
• 16: Time-limit-over
• 17: Abortion-by-trip
• 18: Object-not-selected
• 19: Object-already-selected
• 20: No-access-authority
• 21: Ended-with-overshoot
• 22: Abortion-due-to-deviation
• 23: Abortion-by-communication-loss
• 24: Blocked-by-command
• 25: None
• 26: Inconsistent-parameters
• 27: Locked-by-other-client
The blocks APC_INFO, BSC_INFO, or INC_INFO can process only a single command. Therefore, for every
command for which you need information, it must be switched with its own APC_INFO, BSC_INFO, or
INC_INFO block.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5 Conversion
12.2.5.1 BOOL_CNT
The BOOL_CNT block counts binary inputs with the value 1 (TRUE).
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 20 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the block in the Properties tab.
Detailed Description
BOOL_CNT counts all inputs with the value 1 (TRUE), and sets the output to result in integer.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.2 BOOL_INT
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.2 BOOL_INT
The BOOL_INT block forms a positive integer value from 4 binary values. You can select between 3 different
modes.
Detailed Description
The block forms from 4 binary values at the IN1, IN2, IN3, and IN4 inputs a positive integer value from 0 to 15
at the OUT output. Via the MOD input you can select between 3 different modes of how the output value
shall be formed from the input values. If the MOD input has the value 1, 2, or 3, then the output value is
formed according to the following value tables. If the MOD input has a different value, then the output value
is set to 0 regardless of the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4.
Value Tables
In the following table, you find the output values depending on the input values, if the Mode equals 1. In this
mode, the output value is specified by a single input value. The priority of the input value is decreasing from
input IN1 to input IN4. If, for example, input IN1 has the value 1 (TRUE), the output value also is 1, regardless
of the values of the remaining inputs.
IN1 IN2 IN3 IN4 OUT
1 Not relevant Not relevant Not relevant 1
0 1 Not relevant Not relevant 2
0 0 1 Not relevant 3
0 0 0 1 4
In the following table, you find the output values depending on the input values, if the Mode equals 2. In this
mode, the output value is specified by a single input value. The priority of the input values is increasing from
input IN1 to input IN4. If for example input IN4 has the value 1 (TRUE), the output value is 4, regardless of the
values of the remaining inputs.
IN1 IN2 IN3 IN4 OUT
1 0 0 0 1
Not relevant 1 0 0 2
Not relevant Not relevant 1 0 3
Not relevant Not relevant Not relevant 1 4
In the following table, you find the output values depending on the input values, if the Mode equals 3. For
this mode the output value is created by the binary coding of the input values.
IN1 IN2 IN3 IN4 OUT
0 0 0 0 0
1 0 0 0 1
0 1 0 0 2
1 1 0 0 3
...
0 1 1 1 14
1 1 1 1 15
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.1 BOOL_CNT
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.3 BUILD_ACD
The BUILD_ACD block is used to create an ACD object (directional protection activation information) from the
corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At the output side, you can connect a
user-defined signal of the type ACD (subtype pickup). No other subtypes can be built with this block. The
internal output structure contains phase, direction, and quality information.
If at least 1 of the phase inputs PHSA, PHSB, PHSC, or GND is set, the general flag will be set additionally at
the output side.
The directional information at the inputs FWRD and BWRD is applied to all affected phases. If the forward and
backward inputs are not set or both inputs are set, the direction information is set to unknown at the output
side.
The quality of the output is built from the quality information located at the GOOD and BAD inputs. If the
input BAD is 1 (TRUE), the quality at the output side is set to invalid. If the input BAD is 0 (FALSE) and the
input GOOD is 1 (TRUE), the quality at the output side is set to valid. If both inputs are 0 (FALSE), the quality
at the output side is set to questionable.
NOTE
i If the inputs BAD and GOOD are not connected and default values are used, the quality at the output side
is set to valid.
NOTE
i In order to avoid an inconsistent signal, the general, unknown, and both flags cannot be set directly.
According to IEC 61850-7-3, it is not allowed to assign the direction information to both for a single-phase.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.17 SPLIT_ACD
12.2.5.4 BUILD_ACT
The BUILD_ACT block is used to create an ACT object (protection activation information) from the corre-
sponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At the output side you can connect a
user-defined signal of the type ACT. The internal output structure contains phase and quality information.
If at least 1 of the phase inputs PHSA, PHSB, PHSC, or GND is set, the general flag will be set additionally at
the output side. In order to avoid an inconsistent signal, the general flag cannot be set directly.
The quality of the output is build from the quality information located at the GOOD and BAD inputs. If the
input BAD is 1 (TRUE) the quality at the output side is set to invalid. If the input BAD is 0 (FALSE) and the
input GOOD is 1 (TRUE) the quality at the output side is set to valid. If both inputs are 0 (FALSE) the quality at
the output side is set to questionable.
NOTE
i If the inputs BAD and GOOD are not connected and default values are used, the quality at the output side
is set to valid.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.18 SPLIT_ACT
12.2.5.5 BUILD_BSC
The BUILD_BSC block is used to create a BSC object (Binary Controlled Step Position Information) from the
corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At the output side, you can connect a
user-defined signal of the type BSC. The internal output structure contains position, busy, and quality informa-
tion.
The valid range for the step position at the input POS is limited according to the range defined by the standard
IEC 61850-7-3 Ed. 2.0. The defined range covers the the values from -64 and +63.
If the value at the input POS does not exceed the limits, the output values for position, busy, and quality is set
to the corresponding input values.
If the value at the input exceeds these limits, the output value for position is set to -64, the output value for
busy is set to 0 (FALSE) and the output value for quality is set to invalid.
NOTE
i The BUILD_BSC block does not perform any switching commands. The user-defined signal of the type BSC
connected to the OUT output can be assigned to the corresponding switching object.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.19 SPLIT_BSC
12.2.5.6 BUILD_CMV
The BUILD_CMV block is used to create a CMV object (complex measured value) from the corresponding input
values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a complex measured value CMV at the OUT output from the inputs MAG (magnitude) and
ANG (angle). The output contains the quality information located at the QL input. If the QL input is not
connected and the default value is used, the quality is set to valid.
At the output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type CMV.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains informa-
tion for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measuring signal from which the value
description shall be used. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output
cannot be converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage
value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.7 BUILD_DEL
The BUILD_DEL block is used to create a DEL object (3-phase measured value, delta connection) from the
corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a 3-phase measured value delta connection DEL at the OUT output from the magnitude,
angle, and quality input of each phase.
If a quality input is not connected and the default value is used, the quality of the corresponding phase is set
to Valid. At output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of type DEL.
Measured values are handled in CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains an infor-
mation for the conversion to primary / secondary values including the unit. This information is read from
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measurement signal the value description
shall be used from. If you do not connect the VALDESC input the signal connected at OUT output cannot be
converted. That means primary and secondary values of the signal are same as percentage value.
NOTE
i For the user-defined signals of the type MV, CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC, you can overwrite the multiplier
and the unit (for example, kV) for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal
in the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
properties of a signal, instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you, for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to
V. Nevertheless, for the value conversion from the CFC-internal percentage value to a primary or secondary
value, the VALDESC input has to be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
The BUILD_DPS block is used to create a DPS object (double-point status) from the corresponding input
values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At output side, you can connect a
user-defined signal of type DPS. The internal output structure contains a value and a quality information.
The output value is built from the values at inputs IS_ON and IS_OFF. If both inputs are 1 (TRUE), the output
value is set to disturbed position. If both inputs are 0 (FALSE), the output value is set to disturbed position or
intermediate position depending to the value at input BAD_00, see value table below.
The output quality is set to the value at the input QL. If the input QL is not connected and the default value is
used, the quality at the output side is set to valid.
Value Table
In the following table, you find the values of the double-point status (DPS) created, depending on the values
found at the inputs of the block.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.9 BUILD_ENS
The BUILD_ENS block is used to create an ENS object (enumerated status) from the corresponding input
values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At output side, you can connect a
user-defined signal of type ENS (enumerated status), INS (integer status), or INC (controllable integer status).
The internal output structure contains a value and a quality information.
The output value is built from the values at inputs VL1 to VL6 depending to values at inputs IN1 to IN6.
The inputs IN and VL with same number are combined with each other. At the input IN, you can connect a
signal of type SPS (single-point status). If the input IN has the value 1 (TRUE), the value at output OUT is set to
the value of the corresponding VL input.
Because more than one input IN1 to IN6 can have value 1 (TRUE) at the same time, the inputs are prioritized.
IN1/VL1 have highest priority, IN6/VL6 have lowest priority
Via the STRICT input, you can select if the quality of the input signals should be taken into account for
selecting the assigned value or not. If you set the STRICT input to 1 (TRUE), signals with Invalid or Question-
able quality will be ignored. The output quality is used from the same input the output value is used from. If
the output value cannot be set from an input (for example, all IN inputs are 0 (FALSE)), the output is set to
value 0 and quality 0 (GOOD).
NOTE
i You have to set the VL input values directly at the block inputs by selecting the value and enter the value.
NOTE
i User-defined signals of type ENS are available for health only with enumerated values ok (1), warning (2),
alarm (3).
NOTE
i There is no corresponding SPLIT_ENS block in the library, but for signals of type ENS, you can use the
SPLIT_INS block.
NOTE
i With the BUILD_INS block, an additional BUILD block is available where user-defined signals of type ENS
(enumerated status), INS (integer status), or INC (controllable integer status) can be connected at output
side. Check which block is best for your use case.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.10 BUILD_INS
The BUILD_INS block is used to create an INS (integer status), INC (controllable integer status), or ENS (enum-
erated status) object from the corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At the output side, you can connect
user-defined signals of the type INS (integer status), INC (controllable integer status), and ENS (enumerated
status). The internal output structure contains value and quality information.
The value and the quality of the output is set to the corresponding input values. If the input QL is not
connected and the default value is used, the quality at the output side is set to valid.
NOTE
i With the BUILD_ENS block, an additional BUILD block is available where user-defined signals of the type INS
(integer status), INC (controllable integer status), or ENS (enumerated status) can be connected at the
output side. Check which block is best for your use case.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.9 BUILD_ENS
12.2.5.23 SPLIT_INS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.11 BUILD_Q
The BUILD_Q block is used to get a quality information from the corresponding input values. The possible
output values are Valid, Questionable, and Invalid.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the QL output from the inputs. The internal output structure contains a
quality information only. At the output side, you can connect block inputs QL of other BUILD blocks (for
example, BUILD_SPS).
If the value at the input GOOD is 1 (TRUE) and the value at the input BAD is 0 (FALSE), the output value is set
to 0 (Valid or GOOD).
If the value at the input BAD is 1 (TRUE), the output value is set to 1 (Invalid) regardless of the value at the
input GOOD. If the value at both of the inputs is 0 (FALSE), the output value is set to 2 (Questionable).
NOTE
i This block is not needed if you only want to build a static value for a quality, for example, 0 (GOOD). You
can set static values directly at the quality inputs of a block.
Value Table
In the following table, you can find the quality information created from the values at the inputs of the block.
GOOD BAD QL
0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) Questionable
0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE) Invalid
1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE) Valid
1 (TRUE) 1 (TRUE) Invalid
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.12 BUILD_SPS
The BUILD_SPS block is used to create an SPS object (single-point status) from the corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output of the inputs. At the output side, you can connect a
user-defined signal of the type SPS (single-point status), predefined logical inputs of the type SPS, identifiable
by the prefix > in the signal name or in other compatible block inputs for further processing.
The internal output structure contains a value and a quality information. The value and the quality of the
output are set to the corresponding input values. If the input QL is not connected and the default value is
used, the quality at the output side is set to valid.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.25 SPLIT_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.13 BUILD_WYE
The BUILD_WYE block is used to create a WYE object (3-phase measured value, Y connection) from the corre-
sponding input values.
Detailed Description
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, the inputs for the phases NEUT and NET are invisible. If you
need these inputs, select the block. In the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the
Interface group of the Block Properties tab.
If a quality input is not connected and the default value is used, the quality of the corresponding phase is set
to Valid.
At the output side, you can connect a user-defined signal of the type WYE. Measured values are handled in
the CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains information for the conversion to
primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the VALDESC input, where you can
directly connect the corresponding measurement signal the value description shall be used from. If you do not
connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output cannot be converted. That means
primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as the percentage value.
NOTE
i You can overwrite the multiplier and the unit (for example kV) of user-defined signals of the type MV,
CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal in
the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
Properties tab instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to V.
For the value conversion from the CFC internal percentage value to the primary or secondary value, the
VALDESC input must be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.26 SPLIT_WYE
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
The BUILD_XMV block is used to create an MV object (measured value) or an APC object (controllable analog
process value) from the corresponding input values.
Detailed Description
The block creates a structured value at the OUT output from the inputs. At the output side, you can connect
user-defined signals of the type MV and APC. The internal output structure contains a value, a value descrip-
tion, and a quality information.
The value of the output is set to the corresponding values at the input IN_R, IN_I, and IS_REAL. All values are
copied unchanged into the output structure of the corresponding inputs. With the value at the input IS_REAL,
the selection is done if the floating-point number at the input IN_R or the whole number at the input IN_I is
used for further processing at the output side.
The output contains the quality information located at the QL input. If the QL input is not connected and the
default value is used, the quality is set to valid.
Measured values are handled in the CFC as percentage values only. Therefore the OUT output contains infor-
mation for the conversion to primary/secondary values including the unit. This information is read from the
VALDESC input, where you can directly connect the corresponding measurement signal the value description
shall be used from. If you do not connect the VALDESC input, the signal connected at the OUT output cannot
be converted. Primary and secondary values of the signal are the same as percentage value.
NOTE
i The value description of the VALDESC input is only intended for internal processing of measured values
and is not transmitted, for example, via protection interface.
NOTE
i You can overwrite the multiplier and the unit (for example kV) of user-defined signals of the type MV,
CMV, DEL, WYE, and APC for primary and secondary representation in the Properties tab of the signal in
the Information Routing matrix. If Define Unit is selected, the multiplier and the unit are used from the
Properties tab instead of the multiplier and the unit set in the CFC given by the VALDESC input. This
feature allows you for example, to change the multiplier and the unit of a user-defined signal from kV to V.
For the value conversion from the CFC internal percentage value to the primary or secondary value the
VALDESC input must be connected.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.15 CMP_DPS
The CMP_DPS block compares the value of a double-point status with a value specified by 2 binary input
values. If both values are the same, the block sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block compares the value of the double-point status at the IN input with the value specified by the binary
input signals at the C_ON and C_OFF inputs. If both values are the same, the block puts the Y output to 1
(TRUE).
At the input IN, you can connect signals of the type DPS (double-point status) or DPC (controllable double
point). The combination of both of the values at the inputs C_ON and C_OFF allows 4 values for the compar-
ison with the value at the input IN:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
12.2.5.22 SPLIT_DPS
12.2.5.16 DPS_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.16 DPS_SPS
The DPS_SPS block splits a double-point status into 4 outputs as a single-point status.
Detailed Description
The block splits the DPS (double-point status) available at the input IN into 4 structured output values. Each
output is assigned to a possible value of the double-point status at the input IN. The internal output structure
contains a value and a quality information.
At the input IN, you can connect a signal of the type DPS or DPC (controllable double point).
At the output side, you can connect user-defined signals of the type SPS, predefined logical inputs of the type
SPS, identifiable by the prefix > in the signal name or other compatible block inputs for further processing.
The output values are built from the value at the input IN, see value table.
The output qualities are set to the quality at the input IN.
Value Table
In the following table, you find the outputs, depending on the value at the IN input.
Value at Input IN Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica-
tion for On tion for Off tion for Inter- tion for Disturbed
mediate Position Position
1 (On) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE)
2 (Off) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE)
Value at Input IN Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica- Single-Point Indica-
tion for On tion for Off tion for Inter- tion for Disturbed
mediate Position Position
0 (Intermediate 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE)
position)
3 (Disturbed posi- 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE)
tion)
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
12.2.5.22 SPLIT_DPS
12.2.5.15 CMP_DPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.17 SPLIT_ACD
The SPLIT_ACD block splits a signal of the type ACD (activation information of directional protections)
according to the subtype pickup into the following:
• Activation flags
• Affected phases
• Quality
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type ACD.
The general flag at the output side is set, as soon as 1 of the 3 phases or GND is set.
If the corresponding flags at the input IN are set, then the activation flag outputs GEN, PHSA, PHSB, PHSC,
and GND are set to 1 (TRUE).
If any phase is activated in forward direction, then the output FWRD is set to 1 (TRUE).
If any phase is activated in backward direction, then the output BWRD is set to 1 (TRUE).
If no phase is activated in forward and backward direction (FWRD is 0 (FALSE) and BWRD is 0 (FALSE)), then
the output UNKN is set to 1 (TRUE).
If a phase is activated in forward direction and a phase is activated in backward direction (FWRD is 1 (TRUE)
and BWRD is 1 (TRUE)), then the output BOTH is set to 1 (TRUE).
Directional information is not directly assigned to a particular phase but indicates that there is an activation in
this particular direction.
If forward as well as backward are activated, then both flags are set. If forward or backward are not set, the
unknown flag is being activated. PHS1 indicates that 1 of the phases A, B, or C is affected. PHS2 indicates that
2 out of the 3 phases A, B, C are affected. P2GND indicates that 2 out of 3 phases of A, B, C, and additionally
GND (neutral phase) are affected. PHS3 indicates that all of the 3 phases A, B, and C are affected. VALID indi-
cates the validity of the signals.
The structured value at the output QL contains the quality of the input IN. The quality information can be split
into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further information, refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.3 BUILD_ACD
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.18 SPLIT_ACT
The SPLIT_ACT block splits a signal of the type ACT (protection activation information) into its activation flags,
the affected phases, and the quality.
Detailed Description
The General flag is activated as soon as at least 1 of the 4 phases is activated.
QL is a quality-type signal that can be decomposed further with the usage of a SPLIT_Q block. Connect the
quality output to the input of the SPLIT_Q block. For further descriptions on quality, refer to the
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Qs description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.4 BUILD_ACT
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.19 SPLIT_BSC
The SPLIT_BSC block splits a signal of the type BSC (binary controlled step position information) into the
following:
• Position
• Quality
Detailed Description
The block splits a signal Position (type BSC) at the IN input into status information at the POS output and the
BUSY output.
The value at the VALID output indicates whether the quality of the signal is Valid or not. This value contains
the information if the signal Position is set or not. If the signal Position is not set (value -64), then the value at
the VALID output indicates Invalid regardless of the signal quality. The quality information of the signal is
available at the QL output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.5 BUILD_BSC
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.20 SPLIT_CMV
The SPLIT_CMV block splits a signal of the type CMV (complex measured value) into magnitude and angle, an
internal value description, and the signal quality.
Detailed Description
At the input IN, you can connect a signal of the type CMV (complex measured value).
The SPLIT_CMV block splits the complex measured value available at the input IN into magnitude and angle,
an internal value description, and the signal quality.
The values for the magnitude and the angle of the CMV at the input IN are available at the output MAG and
ANG as floating-point numbers.
The value at the Valid output indicates whether the quality of the complex measured value is Valid or not. The
quality information of the complex measured value at the input IN is available at the QL output as structured
value. The quality available at the output QL can be split into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further infor-
mation refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
The output VALDESC is the value description available at the input IN. The output VALDESC can be connected
with the VALDESC inputs of other blocks, for example, BUILD_CMV for further processing. For further infor-
mation refer to the BUILD_CMV block description.
NOTE
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.6 BUILD_CMV
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.21 SPLIT_DEL
The SPLIT_DEL block splits a signal of the type DEL (3-phase measured value, delta connection) into the
following:
• Magnitude
• Angle
Detailed Description
At the input IN, you can connect a signal of the type DEL (3-phase measured value, delta connection).
The SPLIT_DEL block splits the 3-phase measured value and delta connection available at the input IN into the
following:
• Magnitude
• Angle
• Signal quality
The values for the magnitude and the angle of each phase of the DEL signal at the input IN are available at the
outputs PHS_AB_MAG/PHS_AB_ANG, PHS_BC_MAG/PHS_BC_ANG, and PHS_CA_MAG/PHS_CA_ANG as
floating-point numbers.
The qualities of each phase of the signal of the type DEL at the input IN are available at the outputs
PHS_AB_QL, PHS_BC_QL, and PHS_CA_QL as structured values. The quality available at these outputs can be
split into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further information, refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
The output VALDESC is the value description available at the input IN. The output VALDESC can be connected
with VALDESC inputs of other blocks, for example, BUILD_DEL for further processing. For further information,
refer to the BUILD_DEL block description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.7 BUILD_DEL
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.22 SPLIT_DPS
The SPLIT_DPS block splits a signal of the type DPS (double-point status) into binary values and the quality.
Detailed Description
At the input side you can connect a signal of the type DPS (double-point status).
The SPLIT_DPS block splits the double-point status available at the input IN into binary values and the quality.
The outputs IS_ON, IS_OFF, IS_00, and IS_11 represent the values 0 to 3 of the double-point status available
at the input IN. For further information, refer to Value Table, Page 431.
The output VALID indicates the validity of the double-point status available at the input IN.
The structured value at the output QL contains the quality of the input IN. The quality information can be split
into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further information, refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
Value Table
In the following table, you find the values of the 4 outputs IS_ON, IS_OFF, IS_00, and IS_11, depending on
the value of the double-point status at the IN input.
IN IS_ON IS_OFF IS_00 IS_11
2 (On) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE)
1 (Off) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE)
0 (Intermediate position) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE) 0 (FALSE)
3 (Disturbed position) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 0 (FALSE) 1 (TRUE)
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.15 CMP_DPS
12.2.5.16 DPS_SPS
12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.23 SPLIT_INS
The SPLIT_INS block splits a signal of the type INS (integer status) or INC (controllable integer status) into
value and quality.
Detailed Description
At the input side you can connect a signal of the type INS (integer status) or INC (controllable integer status).
The SPLIT_INS block splits the integer status available at the input IN into value and quality.
The value of the integer status at the input IN is available at the output VAL as whole number.
The output VALID indicates the validity of the integer status available at the input IN.
The structured value at the output QL contains the quality of the input IN. The quality information can be split
into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further information refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.9 BUILD_ENS
12.2.5.10 BUILD_INS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
The SPLIT_Q block splits the quality information into binary values.
Detailed Description
At the structured input QL, you can connect a QL output of another block. You cannot connect a signal
directly to the input. If you are interested in the quality of a signal in detail, split the signal using a corre-
sponding SPLIT block depending on the signal type. You can connect the QL output of the SPLIT block to the
input QL of the SPLIT_Q block.
If the quality at the input IN is Valid, the output GOOD is set to 1 (TRUE). That means initialized, not invalid,
and not questionable.
If the quality at the input IN is invalid (hex: 1), the output BAD is set to 1 (TRUE). If the not initialized flag
(hex: 40) in the quality is set, the output BAD is also set to 1 (TRUE).
If GOOD and BAD outputs both have a value of 0 (FALSE), then the quality information is Questionable
(hex: 2).
The output TEST is set if the quality at the input IN shows the test bit (hex: 10) set. The quality information for
TEST is independent of the Valid, Invalid, or Questionable information.
The output OFF is set if the quality at the input IN shows the OFF bit (hex: 80) set.
The output OBLK is set if the quality at the input IN shows an operator blocked bit (hex: 20) set. If the signal is
blocked or in functional lockout state, then the quality operator blocked bit is set for signals that are used as
input signals in CFC internally.
You can use this block for example, to decide the further processing of signals depending on the quality infor-
mation.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.11 BUILD_Q
12.2.5.17 SPLIT_ACD
12.2.5.18 SPLIT_ACT
12.2.5.19 SPLIT_BSC
12.2.5.20 SPLIT_CMV
12.2.5.21 SPLIT_DEL
12.2.5.22 SPLIT_DPS
12.2.5.23 SPLIT_INS
12.2.5.25 SPLIT_SPS
12.2.5.26 SPLIT_WYE
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.25 SPLIT_SPS
The SPLIT_SPS block splits a signal of the type SPS (single-point status) or SPC (controllable single point) into
value and quality.
Detailed Description
At the input side you can connect a signal of the type SPS (single-point status) or SPC (controllable single
point).
The SPLIT_SPS block splits the SPS signal or the SPC signal available at the input IN into value and quality.
The value of the SPS signal or SPC at the input IN is available at the output VAL as binary value. Value 1 (TRUE)
indicates On and 0 (FALSE) indicates Off.
The output VALID indicates the validity of the SPS signal or SPC available at the input IN.
The structured value at the output QL contains the quality of the input IN. The quality information can be split
into its flags with the SPLIT_Q block. For further information refer to the SPLIT_Q block description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.12 BUILD_SPS
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.26 SPLIT_WYE
With the block SPLIT_WYE, you can split a signal of the type WYE (3-phase measured value Y connection) into
the following:
• Magnitude
• Angle
Detailed Description
At the input IN, you can connect a signal of the type WYE (3-phase measured value, Y connection).
The block splits a 3-phase measured value Y connection at the IN input into the following:
• Angle
NOTE
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.13 BUILD_WYE
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.5.27 SPLIT_XMV
The SPLIT_XMV block splits a signal of the type MV (measured value) or APC (controllable analog process
value) into value and quality.
Detailed Description
At the input IN you can connect a signal of the type MV or APC.
The SPLIT_XMV block splits the MV signal or APC signal available at the input IN into value, internal value
description, and signal quality.
The block can differ between whole number values or floating-point values on the input side.
The structured value at the input IN contains a whole number, a floating-point number, and an extra informa-
tion which number has to be used (IS_REAL). This information is available on the output side of the
SPLIT_XMV block at the corresponding outputs:
• IS_REAL for the information for which the value has to be used
NOTE
i If you connect a signal of the type MV or APC at the input IN, the value is always a floating-point number
because these signals are stored in the device as floating-point numbers only. Therefore you can directly
use the value at the output VAL_R for further processing without any additional logic which checks the
value of the output IS_REAL and you can select the corresponding value output VAL_R or VAL_I.
The value at the Valid output indicates whether the quality of the MV or APC is Valid or not. The quality infor-
mation of MV or APC at the input IN is available at the QL output as structured value. The quality available at
the output QL can be split into its flags with a SPLIT_Q block. For further information refer to the SPLIT_Q
block description.
The output VALDESC is the value description available at the input IN. The output VALDESC can be connected
with VALDESC inputs of other blocks, for example, BUILD_MV for further processing. For further information
refer to the BUILD_MV block description.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.14 BUILD_XMV
12.2.5.24 SPLIT_Q
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.6.1 R_TRIG
The R_TRIG block detects the rising edge of a binary signal at the input and sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
When there is a value change from 0 (FALSE) to 1 (TRUE) at the CLK input, the block sets the output Q to 1
(TRUE). In the next chart run, the block sets the output back to 0 (FALSE), irrespective of the input value.
NOTE
i In the first run of the CFC after startup of the device, value 1 (TRUE) at the CLK input results in 1 (TRUE) at
the output Q.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.6.2 R_TRGM
12.2.6.3 F_TRIG
12.2.6.4 F_TRGM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.6.2 R_TRGM
The R_TRGM block detects the rising edge of a binary signal at the input and sets the output to 1 (TRUE). In
the CFC Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level with cyclic chart run, you can use the R_TRGM block to detect
the status changes from 0 (FALSE) to 1 (TRUE) that take place between 2 cyclic chart runs with short state
changes.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS (single-point status). The quality of the input signals
is not taken into account.
If a value change from 0 (FALSE) to 1 (TRUE) is detected at the CLK input, the output Q is set to 1 (TRUE).
In the CFC Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level with cyclic chart run, a value change in between 2 runs is
detected and stored as input value until the next run.
If the output has been set to 1 (TRUE) in the next chart run, the block sets the output back to 0 (FALSE), irre-
spective of the input value.
NOTE
i In the 1st run of the CFC after startup of the device, value 1 (TRUE) at the CLK input results in value 1
(TRUE) at the output Q.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.6.1 R_TRIG
12.2.6.3 F_TRIG
12.2.6.4 F_TRGM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.6.3 F_TRIG
The F_TRIG block detects the falling edge of a binary signal at the input and sets the output to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
When there is a value change from 1 (TRUE) to 0 (FALSE) at the CLK input, the block sets the output Q to 1
(TRUE). In the next chart run, the block sets the output back to 0 (FALSE), irrespective of the input value.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.6.4 F_TRGM
12.2.6.1 R_TRIG
12.2.6.2 R_TRGM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.6.4 F_TRGM
The F_TRGM block detects the falling edge of a binary signal at the input and sets the output to 1 (TRUE). This
block is useful in the CFC Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level with cyclic chart runs to detect also status
changes from 1 (TRUE) to 0 (FALSE) that take place between 2 cyclic chart runs with short state changes.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS (single-point status). The quality of the input signals
is not taken into account.
The output Q is set to 1 (TRUE) if a value change from 1 (TRUE) to 0 (FALSE) is detected at the CLK input.
In the CFC Low priority Cyclic-triggered task level with cyclic chart run, a value change in between 2 runs is
detected and stored as input value until the next run.
If the output has been set to 1 (TRUE) in the next chart run, the block sets the output back to 0 (FALSE), irre-
spective of the input value.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.6.3 F_TRIG
12.2.6.1 R_TRIG
12.2.6.2 R_TRGM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.7 Flip-Flops
12.2.7.1 FF_D
The FF_D block is a bistable function block.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to the value available at the input D with the rising edge of the clock signal at the CLK
input. That means if the value at the input CLK is 1 (TRUE) and was 0 (FALSE) in the last run, the value at the
output OUT remains unchanged until the block detects the next rising edge at the CLK input.
If in the 1st CFC run after a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device, 1 (TRUE) is available at the input CLK, it is
handled as a rising edge and the value at the output OUT is set to the value available at the input D. Other-
wise, the initial value at the output OUT is 0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
12.2.7.2 FF_SR
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.7.2 FF_SR
The FF_SR block is a bistable function block with a higher priority for the set input.
Detailed Description
If the value available at the input S is 1 (TRUE) regardless of the value at the input R, the output OUT is set to 1
(TRUE). This value remains unchanged until the value at the input R is 1 (TRUE) and the value at the input S is
0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
12.2.7.1 FF_D
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
The FF_RS block is a bistable function block with a higher priority for the reset input.
Detailed Description
If the value available at the input S is 1 (TRUE) and the value at the input R is 0 (FALSE), the output OUT is set
to 1 (TRUE). This value remains unchanged until the value at the input R is 1 (TRUE) regardless of the value at
the input S.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
12.2.7.1 FF_D
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8 Logic
12.2.8.1 OR
The OR block combines binary input values via the logical OR function.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 10 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs X1 to X10 with the logical OR function if the inputs are visible or
not. The value at the output Y is set to 1 (TRUE) if at least 1 input value is 1 (TRUE). Only if the values of all
inputs are 0 (FALSE) the output value is set to 0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.8.3 XOR
12.2.8.4 NOR
12.2.8.2 OR_DYN
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8.2 OR_DYN
The OR_DYN block combines binary input values via the logical OR function. The block creates a DPS object
(double-point status) with GOOD quality from the input values.
The block has 5 binary inputs IN1 to IN5. If you need more than 5 binary inputs, you can interconnect several
blocks of the OR_DYN type in series. In doing so, interconnect the OUT output of one block with the CHAIN
input of the following block.
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs IN1 to IN5 by the logical OR function. The result of the operation
is available at the OUT output as a double-point status (DPS).
If all values at the inputs IN1 to IN5 are 0 (FALSE), the block sets the value of the DPS signal at the output OUT
to 1 (Off).
If at least 1 of the values at the inputs IN1 to IN5 changes from 0 (FALSE) in the last CFC run to 1 (TRUE) in the
current CFC run, the block sets the value of the DPS signal at the output OUT to 3 (Disturbed position), regard-
less of the values available at the other inputs.
If the block detects no change in value from 0 (FALSE) in the last CFC run to 1 (TRUE) in the current CFC run at
the inputs IN1 to IN5 and if at least 1 of these inputs shows the value 1 (TRUE), the block sets the value of the
DPS signal at the output OUT to 2 (On).
A value change at the inputs IN1 to IN5 from 1 (TRUE) in the last CFC run to 0 (FALSE) in the current CFC run
has no effect on the output side until all values at the inputs IN1 to IN5 are 0 (FALSE). In that case, the block
sets the value of the DPS signal at the output OUT to 1 (Off).
The quality of the DPS signal at the output OUT is always set to 0 (GOOD).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.8 BUILD_DPS
12.2.8.3 XOR
12.2.8.4 NOR
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8.3 XOR
The XOR block combines binary input values via the logical XOR function.
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs X1 and X2 via the logical XOR function. The value at the output Y
is set to 1 (TRUE) if exactly 1 input value is 1 (TRUE). If both input values are 0 (FALSE) or both input values are
1 (TRUE), the output value is set to 0 (FALSE).
Value Table
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.8.4 NOR
12.2.8.2 OR_DYN
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8.4 NOR
The NOR block combines binary input values via the logical NOR function.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 10 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs X1 to X10 by the logical NOR function if the inputs are visible or
not. The value at the output Y is set to 1 (TRUE) if all input values are 0 (FALSE). If at least 1 input value is 1
(TRUE), the output value is set to 0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.8.3 XOR
12.2.8.7 NEG
12.2.8.2 OR_DYN
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8.5 AND
The AND block combines binary input values via the logical AND function.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 10 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the Properties tab.
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs X1 to X10 via the logical AND function if the inputs are visible or
not. The value at the output Y is set to 1 (TRUE) if all input values are 1 (TRUE). If at least 1 input value is 0
(FALSE) the output value is set to 0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.8.6 NAND
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.8.6 NAND
The NAND block combines binary input values via the logical NAND function.
Once the block has been inserted into the chart, only 2 of the 10 inputs are visible. If you need more inputs,
select the block and in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group
of the Properties tab.
NOTE
i Inputs that are not used must be assigned to a default value of 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
The block combines the values at the inputs X1 to X10 via the logical NAND function if the inputs are visible or
not. The value at the output Y is set to 1 (TRUE) if at least 1 input value is 0 (FALSE). If all input values are 1
(TRUE), the output value is set to 0 (FALSE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
12.2.8.7 NEG
The NEG block inverts the binary input value with the logical NOT function.
NOTE
i You can negate binary values also directly at the block inputs. For further information refer to
12.1.5.4 Negating a Block Input.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS
12.1.5.4 Negating a Block Input
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
The OR_SPS block combines 4 inputs of the type SPS (single-point status) or SPC (controllable single point)
using the logical OR function. The quality is taken into account.
After adding the block to the chart, the STRICT input is not visible. If you need this input, select the block and
go to the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group of the Properties
tab.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS or SPC.
The OR_SPS block combines the values of the SPS signal or SPC signal available at the inputs IN1 to IN4 using
the logical OR function.
The value of the single-point status at the output OUT is set to 1 (TRUE) if the value of at least 1 input is 1
(TRUE). The value of the single-point status at the output OUT is set to 0 (FALSE) only if the values of all the
inputs are 0 (FALSE).
The quality information at the output is built of the quality information of the inputs IN1 to IN4 combined
with the logical OR function. The output VALID indicates if the quality information of all inputs (IN1 to IN4) is
Valid or not.
You can decide via the STRICT input if the quality at the inputs IN1 to IN4 has to be taken into account for
setting the output value or not.
If you use the default value 0 (FALSE) as a STRICT input value, the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4 are used
regardless of the quality described. If you set the STRICT input to 1 (TRUE), the value of the SPS signal at the
OUT output is set to 1 (TRUE) only, if the quality of all inputs shows a Valid value and if the value of at least
1 input is 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
The AND_SPS block combines 4 inputs of the type SPS (single-point status) or SPC (controllable single point)
using the logical AND function. The quality is taken into account.
After adding the block to the chart the STRICT input is not visible. If you need this input, select the block and
in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window, unmark the Invisible check boxes in the Interface group of the Properties tab.
NOTE
i When the input INx is not used, the value must be preset to 1 (TRUE).
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS or SPC.
The AND_SPS block combines the values of the SPS signal or SPC signal available at the inputs IN1 to IN4
using the logical AND function.
The value of the single-point status at the output OUT is set to 1 (TRUE) if all values at the inputs IN1 to IN4
are 1 (TRUE). Only if at least one value is 0 (FALSE), the value of the single-point status at the output OUT is
set to 0 (FALSE).
The quality information at the output is built of the quality information of the inputs IN1 to IN4 combined
with the logical OR function.
The output VALID indicates if the quality information of all inputs (IN1 to IN4) is Valid or not.
You can decide via the STRICT input if the quality at the inputs IN1 to IN4 has to be taken into account for
setting the output value or not.
If you use the default value 0 (FALSE) as a STRICT input value, the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4 are used
regardless of the quality described. If you set the STRICT input to 1 (TRUE), the value of the SPS signal at the
OUT output is set to 1 (TRUE) only, if the quality of all inputs shows a Valid value and if the values of all inputs
are 1 (TRUE).
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.9.3 NEG_SPS
The NEG_SPS block inverts the value of the SPS signal (single-point status) or SPC signal (controllable single
point) using the logical NOT function. The quality at the output side of the block is set to the input quality.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS or SPC.
The NEG_SPS block reverses the value of the SPS signal or SPC signal available at the input IN using the logical
NOT function.
The value of the single-point status at the output OUT is set to 1 (TRUE) if the value of the input IN is 0
(FALSE). If the value of the input IN is 1 (TRUE), the value of the single-point status at the output OUT is set to
0 (FALSE).
The quality information at the output is set to the quality information of the input IN.
The output VALID indicates if the quality information of the input IN is Valid or not.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.8.7 NEG
12.2.9.2 AND_SPS
12.2.9.1 OR_SPS
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.10 Non-Linear
12.2.10.1 NL_ZP
The block NL_ZP (non linear zero point) sets the measured value at the output side to the measured value on
the input side, except the value is below a parameterizable zero-point value. If the input value is below the
parameterizable zero-point value, the output value is set to 0. Using this block, measuring compensation can
be done for inaccuracies or transformer tolerances.
[dwnlczp1-020212-01.tif, 1, en_US]
Detailed Description
The block maps a measured value at the input IN via the characteristic curve of a measured value with
constant gradient at the output OUT. For this characteristic curve a value is determined via the input XZ,
under which all input values are set to 0. The gradient of the characteristic curve is not influenced by this
moved zero point.
On the output side of the block, for example, a user-defined signal of the type measured value (MV) can be
connected. The user-defined measured value gets automatically the value description from the input signal
which is connected to the IN input of the block. You can overwrite the multiplier, the unit, and the decimal
points for primary and secondary representation in the properties of the user-defined signal. For more infor-
mation, refer to 21.9.13 MV – Details.
To set parameters to a characteristic curve, following these rules:
• If the value of the input XZ is not within the range from 0 % to 30 %, then the output measured value
becomes the quality Questionable.
• If the input value exceeds the range defined by MAX_XP, then the output measured value becomes the
quality Questionable.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.10.2 NL_MV
The NL_MV block calculates a new measured value from a measured value using the characteristic curve. You
can determine the course of this characteristic curve using different input settings.
[dwnlcxmv-020212-01.tif, 1, en_US]
Detailed Description
With the block you can set parameters to a non-linear characteristic curve. The measured value at the input IN
is then mapped via this characteristic curve to a measured value at the output OUT. You can then for example,
linearize the output characteristic curve of a non-linear transformer, and at the same time, adjust the resolu-
tion of different measuring ranges. You can do this in one of the following ways:
• If the values of the inputs Xn or Yn violate the previously mentioned rules, then the output measured
value receives the quality Invalid.
• If the input SYM is 0 and the input value is negative, then the quality becomes Questionable.
• If an input or output value exceeds the ranges specified by MAX_XP and MAX_YP, then the output meas-
ured value receives the quality Questionable.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.10.3 NL_LZ
The block NL_LZ issues an alarm indication for measured values below a live-zero value. This allows you to
identify failures of the measuring transducer or the wiring. For this purpose, the block shifts the parameteriz-
able zero point of a characteristic curve through the x-axis. With a parameterizable break point, you can divide
the characteristic curve into 2 areas with different slopes.
[dwnlclz1-020212-01.tif, 1, en_US]
Detailed Description
The block maps a measured value at the input IN via the characteristic curve of a measured value at the output
OUT. For this characteristic curve a live-zero value is determined via the input LZ, under which all input values
are set to 0. With a break point that you determine via the inputs XK and YX, you can divide the characteristic
curve into 2 areas with different slopes. When moving the live-zero value on the x-axis, only the slope of the
bottom character curve area changes. The slope at the top character curve area remains constant.
If the measured value at the input falls below 90 % of the live-zero value, then the block sets the output ALERT
to 1. The hysteresis prevents resetting the output immediately to 0 if exceeding. The hysteresis automatically
adapts to the live-zero value. For a live-zero value greater than 10 %, the hysteresis is 5 % of the live-zero
value. That means the alarm is reset only if the input value is greater than 95 % of the live-zero value. For a
live-zero value less than 10 %, the alarm is reset to 0 only if the input value is greater than 90 % of the live-
zero value plus 0.5 % offset.
On the output side of the block, for example, a user-defined signal of the type measured value (MV) can be
connected. The user-defined measured value gets automatically the value description from the input signal
which is connected to the input IN of the block. You can overwrite the multiplier, the unit, and the decimal
points for primary and secondary representation in the properties of the user-defined signal. For more infor-
mation, refer to 21.9.13 MV – Details.
To set parameters to a characteristic curve, following these rules:
• If the value of the input LZ is less than 0 % or greater than XK, the quality becomes Questionable.
• If the value of the input XK is less than 0 % or greater than 100 %, the quality becomes Questionable.
• If the value of the input YK is less than 0 % or greater than 200 %, the quality becomes Questionable.
• If an input or output value exceeds the ranges specified by MAX_XP and MAX_YP then the output meas-
ured value receives the quality Questionable.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.11 Other
12.2.11.1 CONNECT
With the block CONNECT, you can route a signal of the type SPS (single-point status) or SPC (controllable
single point) to another signal at the output.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type SPS or SPC.
At the output side, you can connect user-defined signals of the type SPS (single-point status), predefined
logical inputs of the type SPS, identifiable by the prefix > in the signal name or signals of the type SPC
(controllable single point).
The internal input and output structure contains a value and a quality information. The block passes the input
information unchanged to the output.
NOTE
i Connection blocks are not available for all types. If you need the functionality of a connection block for
types which are not supported, use the appropriate SPLIT and BUILD blocks instead.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.12 BUILD_SPS
12.2.11.2 CON_ACD
12.2.11.3 CON_ACT
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.11.2 CON_ACD
The CON_ACD block can be used to route a signal of the type ACD (directional protection activation informa-
tion) to another user-defined signal of the same type at the output.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type ACD (directional protection activation information). At
the output side, you can connect user-defined signals of the same type. The internal input and output struc-
ture contains a phase, a direction, and a quality information. The block passes the input information
unchanged to the output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.3 BUILD_ACD
12.2.5.17 SPLIT_ACD
12.2.11.3 CON_ACT
12.2.11.3 CON_ACT
The CON_ACT block can be used to route a signal of the type ACT (protection activation information) to
another user-defined signal of the same type at the output.
Detailed Description
At the input side, you can connect a signal of the type ACT (protection activation information). At the output
side, you can connect user-defined signals of the same type. The internal input and output structure contains
a phase and a quality information. The block passes the input information unchanged to the output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.5.3 BUILD_ACD
12.2.5.17 SPLIT_ACD
12.2.11.2 CON_ACD
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.11.4 CHART_STATE
The CHART_STATE block enables setting, retrieving, and displaying the execution state of a function-block
diagram. The execution states possible are On, Off, Test, and Error.
Outputs LED STRUCT Single-point status (SPS) that changes its value
depending on the state of the function-block diagram
The quality of this single-point indication is always
valid.
BAD BOOL Indicator for the state of the function-block diagram
or the quality of signals
1: Error state of the function-block diagram or signal
with the quality questionable or invalid
0: No error state and all signals with the quality valid
ERR DINT Detailed information about the state of the function-
block diagram:
0x0000: Chart state is valid. Either, the automatic
quality handling is used and all the signals have the
quality valid, or the manual quality handling is set.
0x0011: Chart state is invalid. The automatic quality
handling is used and there is a signal with the invalid
quality at the block input in the function-block
diagram.
0x0012: Chart state is questionable. The automatic
quality handling is used and there is a signal with the
questionable quality at the block input in the func-
tion-block diagram.
0x0013: Chart state is invalid and questionable.
0x0100: Chart state is off. In most cases, an execu-
tion error changes the state of the function-block
diagram to off.
0x0200: CFC is not working as the signals are not
initialized.
0x0400: CFC is not working due to an execution
error.
0x0800: Chart state is in the test mode.
Detailed Description
You have the following options with this block:
• With the help of the COFF and TEST inputs, you can disable the function-block diagram or put it in the
test state.
• You can use the LED output to indicate the execution state at the SIPROTEC 5 device using an LED.
• The BAD and ERR outputs provide information about the current execution state of a function-block
diagram.
NOTE
i A function-block diagram can be put in the Off or Test state only when the CHART_STATE block has been
processed. This is why Siemens recommends that you place this block as the first block to be executed in
the function-block diagram.
The inputs and outputs of the block are explained in the following.
• COFF Input
A 1 at this input puts the function-block diagram in the off state. In this state, the output values of the
blocks are no longer changed. All outputs retain the values that were current just before the state
changed to off. The quality of the output signals, however, is set to invalid. When both the COFF and
TEST inputs are set to 1 simultaneously, the function-block diagram state is set to off. You can find more
information about this in the Values table section.
• TEST Input
A 1 at this input puts the function chart in the Test state. The function chart continues to be executed. In
this state, however, all output signals are marked with the additional information Test. When both the
COFF and TEST inputs are set to 1 simultaneously, the function-block diagram state is set to off. You can
find more information about this in the Priority scheme section.
• LED Output
As long as the function-block diagram is being executed, the value of this output changes cyclically. If
you route this output to an LED of the SIPROTEC 5 device, you can indicate the execution state of the
function-block diagram visually.
– When everything is okay, the output value changes every 3 seconds. The LED is, thus, switched on
for 3 seconds and then switched off for 3 seconds. As a result, there is a low flashing frequency.
– If the function-block diagram is in the test state, the value changes at different time intervals. The
LED is then switched on for 0.5 seconds and then switched off for 3 seconds.
– If the block detects a major problem, the value changes in equal and short time intervals. The LED is
then switched on and off for 0.5 seconds respectively. A major problem is, for example, a block
input without a defined input value.
– In most cases, an execution error changes the state of the function-block diagram to Off. In this
case, the LED output is set to 0. The LED then remains off.
• BAD Output
This output is set to 1 when the signal qualities are invalid or questionable. If the block detects invalid
signal qualities for short periods of time, it sets the BAD output to 1 for a minimum time range of 0.5
seconds.
The output is set to 1 even in case of an execution error of the function-block diagram. The prerequisite
for this is that the function-block diagram continues to be executed. In most cases, an execution error
changes the state of the function-block diagram to Off. The BAD output then has the value 0 like the
other outputs.
• ERR Output
This output provides detailed information about the state of the function-block diagram. The information
is coded as hexadecimal values. The possible values and the associated meaning are given in the Connec-
tions and Explanations section.
Values Table
The state of a function-block diagram can be controlled by both the CHART_STATE block and via the
IEC 61850 indications. The function-block diagram can, for example, be disabled, although the signal at the
COFF input is equal to 0. The following table illustrates the dependencies between the possible input signals
and IEC 61850 indications and the corresponding result.
TEST - Input TEST - IEC 61850 OFF - Input OFF - IEC 61850 Function-Block
Diagram State
Not relevant Not relevant Not relevant 1 OFF
Not relevant Not relevant 1 0 OFF
Not relevant 1 0 0 TEST
1 0 0 0 TEST
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.11.5 LOOP
The LOOP block creates a feedback loop of a binary output signal to another block with a smaller sequence
number in the same function chart.
Detailed Description
If the value at the OUT output is the same as the value available at the input IN, the LOOP block does nothing.
If the value at the OUT output is not the same as the value available at the input IN, the LOOP block sets the
value at the OUT output to the input value. If the output value of the LOOP block is changed, all blocks in the
function chart are executed but without setting the process output signals. After all blocks have been
executed, the function chart is immediately executed once again without updating the process input signals.
NOTE
i After device startup, the initial value in the 1st CFC run at the OUT output is 0 (FALSE). Value 1 (TRUE) at
the input IN in the 1st run is detected as a value change and results in an extra function-chart run.
In order to prevent an endless loop, the function chart is executed maximum 5 times via the LOOP block.
When this number is exceeded, the LOOP block sets the ERR output to 1 (TRUE) and stops the feedback loop.
In the High priority Event-triggered task level, the function chart is executed maximum 2 times via the LOOP
block.
NOTE
i If you are using LOOP blocks, check if the ERR output is 0 (FALSE).
NOTE
i Take care about the sequence number of the LOOP block, because as a difference to other blocks, a logical
wrong sequence number cannot be detected during function-chart compilation. By optimizing the running
sequence, the sequence number of the blocks are possibly changed so that the LOOP block finally no
longer works correctly. Hence, do not optimize the running sequence of function charts that contain LOOP
blocks.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.1.6.3 Adjusting the Running Sequence of Blocks Manually
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.11.6 SUBST_B
The SUBST_B block replaces a binary value by a predefined binary value. The output is a single-point status
(SPS). A specified condition must be fulfilled for the replacement of the input value.
Detailed Description
The block SUBST_B sets the single-point indication at the output OUT to the binary value from the input IN. If
the condition specified at the input COND is fulfilled, the binary value at the input SVAL is used instead of the
binary value from input IN.
The quality of the single-point status at the output OUT becomes the quality from the function-block diagram.
You can use the CHART_STATE block to check the function-block diagram quality.
If the value is substituted, the quality of the single-point indication at the output OUT becomes Valid and
Substituted.
Conditions
In the following table, you will find the permitted conditions and the applicable values.
Value at the COND Input Condition
0 Never
1 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
10 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
100 Function-block diagram state is Off
11 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
101 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram state is Off
110 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
111 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
12.2.11.7 SUBST_BQ
The SUBST_BQ block replaces the value of a single-point indication (SPS) by a predefined binary value. The
output is a single-point indication (SPS). A specified condition must be fulfilled for the replacement of the
input value.
Detailed Description
The block SUBST_BQ sets the single-point indication (SPS) at the output OUT to the value and the quality from
the single-point indication (SPS) at the input IN. If the condition specified at the input COND is fulfilled, the
binary value at the input SVAL is used instead of the binary value from the single-point indication (SPS) at
input IN.
If the value is substituted, the quality of the single-point indication (SPS) at the output OUT becomes Valid
and Substituted.
Conditions
In the following table, you can find the permitted conditions and the applicable values.
Value at the COND Input Condition
0 Never
1 Quality of the single-point indication at the input IN is Invalid
10 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
100 Function-block diagram state is Off
11 Quality of the single-point indication at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
101 Quality of the single-point indication at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram state is Off
110 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
111 Quality of the single-point indication at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
12.2.11.8 SUBST_D
The SUBST_D block replaces an integer value by a predefined integer value. The output is a measured value. A
specified condition must be fulfilled for the replacement of the input value.
Detailed Description
The block SUBST_D sets the measured value at the output OUT to the value from the input IN. If the condition
specified at the input COND is fulfilled, the value at the input SVAL is used instead of the value from input IN.
The quality of the measured value at the output OUT becomes the quality from the function chart. You can
use the CHART_STATE block to check the function-chart quality.
If the value is substituted, the quality of the output measurement signal becomes Valid and Substituted.
If a user-defined signal is connected at the output OUT, it gets the value description from the input VALDESC,
where for example, a predefined measured signal can be connected to. You can overwrite the multiplier, the
unit, and the decimal points for primary and secondary representation in the properties of the user-defined
signal. For more information, refer to 21.9.13 MV – Details.
Conditions
In the following table, you will find the permitted conditions and the applicable values.
Value at the COND Input Condition
0 Never
1 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
10 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
100 Function-block diagram state is Off
11 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
101 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram state is Off
110 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
111 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
12.2.11.9 SUBST_R
The SUBST_R block replaces a floating-point number by a predefined floating-point number. The output is a
measured value. A specified condition must be fulfilled for the replacement of the input value.
Detailed Description
The block SUBST_R sets the measured value at the output OUT to the value from the input IN. If the condition
specified at the input COND is fulfilled, the value at the input SVAL is used instead of the value from input IN.
The quality of the measured value at the output OUT becomes the quality from the function-block diagram.
You can use the CHART_STATE block to check the function-block diagram quality.
If the value is substituted, the quality of the output measuring signal becomes Valid and Substituted.
If a user-defined signal is connected at the output OUT, it gets the value description from the input VALDESC,
where for example, a predefined measured signal can be connected to. You can overwrite the multiplier, the
unit, and the decimal points for primary and secondary representation in the properties of the user-defined
signal. For more information, refer to 21.9.13 MV – Details.
Conditions
In the following table, you will find the permitted conditions and the applicable values.
Value at the COND Input Condition
0 Never
1 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
10 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
100 Function-block diagram state is Off
11 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
101 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram state is Off
110 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
111 Quality of the function-block diagram is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
12.2.11.10 SUBST_XQ
The SUBST_XQ block replaces a measured value by a predefined floating-point number. The output is a meas-
ured value. A specified condition must be fulfilled for the replacement of the input value.
Detailed Description
The block SUBST_XQ sets the measured value at the output OUT to values from the input IN. If the condition
specified at the input COND is fulfilled, the floating-point number at the input SVAL is used instead of the
value from input IN (IN.VAL_I , IN.VAL_R).
If the value is substituted, the quality of the output measuring signal becomes Valid and Substituted.
If a user-defined signal is connected at the output OUT, it gets the value description from the input IN. You
can overwrite the multiplier, the unit, and the decimal points for primary and secondary representation in the
properties of the user-defined signal. For more information, refer to 21.9.13 MV – Details.
Conditions
In the following table, you will find the permitted conditions and the applicable values.
Value at the COND Input Condition
0 Never
1 Quality of the measured value at the input IN is Invalid
10 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
100 Function-block diagram state is Off
11 Quality of the measured value at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
101 Quality of the measured value at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram state is Off
110 Function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state is Off
111 Quality of the measured value at the input IN is Invalid
or function-block diagram operating condition is Functional logout
or function-block diagram state Off
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.12 Persistency
12.2.12.1 MEMORY_D
The MEMORY_D block saves a whole number in such a way that it remains available even after a restart.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to the value available at the input IN with the rising edge of the signal at the STORE
input. This is the case if the value at the input STORE is 1 (TRUE) and was 0 (FALSE) in the last run. The value
at the output OUT remains unchanged until the block detects the next rising edge at the STORE input.
If the value at the output OUT changes, the block saves the value in a persistent way.
After a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device in the 1st CFC run, the value at the output OUT depends on the value
available at the input STORE, the input IN, and the saved value.
If the value available at the input STORE is 1 (TRUE) in the 1st CFC run, the block handles the value like a rising
edge and the value at the output OUT is set to the value available at the input IN. If the value available at the
input STORE is 0 (FALSE) in the 1st CFC run, the saved value is used as initial value at the output OUT.
After an initial restart of the device, the persistent value is removed and the block uses the initial value avail-
able at the input START instead.
• If the value at the output of the block does not have to be available after a restart, Siemens recommends
using the HOLD_D block instead of MEMORY_D block. This block requires fewer system resources.
• If you have to process floating-point numbers, use the Memory_R block instead of the MEMORY_D
block.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.7 HOLD_D
12.2.12.2 MEMORY_R
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.12.2 MEMORY_R
The MEMORY_R block saves the value of a floating-point number in such a way that it remains available even
after a restart.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to the value available at the input IN with the rising edge of the signal at the STORE
input. It means that if the value at the STORE input is 1 (TRUE) and was 0 (FALSE) in the last run, the value at
the output OUT remains unchanged until the block detects the next rising edge at the STORE input.
If the value at the output OUT changes, the block saves the value in a persistent way.
After a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device in the 1st CFC run, the value at the output OUT depends on the value
available at the input STORE, the input IN, and the saved value.
If the value available at the input STORE is 1 (TRUE) in the 1st CFC run, the block handles the value like a rising
edge and the value at the output OUT is set to the value available at the input IN. If the value available at the
input STORE is 0 (FALSE) in the 1st CFC run, the saved value is used as initial value at the output OUT.
After an initial restart of the device, the persistent value is removed and the block uses the initial value avail-
able at the input START instead.
• If the value at the output of the block does not have to be available after a restart, Siemens recommends
using the HOLD_R block instead of the MEMORY_R block. This block requires fewer system resources.
• If you only have to process whole numbers, Siemens recommends using the MEMORY_D block instead of
the MEMORY_R block. This block provides better accuracy for higher values.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.8 HOLD_R
12.2.12.1 MEMORY_D
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
The FF_D_MEM block is a bistable function block with an additional save function. The block saves a value in
such a way that it remains available even after a restart.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to the value available at the input D with the rising edge of the clock signal at the CLK
input. It means that if the value at the input CLK is 1 (TRUE) and was 0 (FALSE) in the last run, the value at the
output OUT remains unchanged until the block detects the next rising edge at the CLK input.
If the value at the output OUT changes, the block saves the value in a persistent way.
After a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device in the 1st CFC run, the value at the output OUT depends on the value
available at the input CLK, the input D, and the saved value. If the value available at the input CLK is 1 (TRUE)
in the 1st CFC run, the block handles the value like a rising edge and the value at the output OUT is set to the
value available at the input D. If the value available at the input CLK is 0 (FALSE) in the 1st CFC run, the saved
value is used as initial value at the output OUT. After an initial restart of the device, the persistent value is
removed and the block uses the initial value 0 (FALSE) instead.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.7.1 FF_D
12.2.7.2 FF_SR
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
The FF_SR_MEM block is a bistable function block with a higher priority for the set input and an additional
save function. The block saves a value in such a way that it remains available even after a restart.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to 1 (TRUE) if the value available at the input S is 1 (TRUE) regardless of the value at the
input R.
This value remains unchanged until the value at the input R is 1 (TRUE) and the value at the input S is 0
(FALSE).
If the value at the output OUT changes, the block saves the value in a persistent way.
After a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device in the 1st CFC run, the value at the output OUT depends on the value
available at the input S, the input R, and the saved value.
If both of the values available at the inputs S and R are 0 (FALSE) in the 1st CFC run, the saved value is used as
initial value at the output OUT. After an initial restart of the device, the persistent value is removed and the
block uses the initial value 0 (FALSE) instead.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.7.1 FF_D
12.2.7.2 FF_SR
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.12.5 FF_RS_MEM
The FF_RS_MEM block is a bistable function block with a higher priority for the reset input and an additional
save function. The block saves a value in such a way that it remains available even after a restart.
Detailed Description
The output OUT is set to 1 (TRUE) if the value available at the input S is 1 (TRUE) and the value at the input R is
0 (FALSE).
This value remains unchanged until the value at the input R is 1 (TRUE) regardless of the value at the input S.
If the value at output OUT changes, the block saves the value in a persistent way.
After a startup of the SIPROTEC 5 device in the 1st CFC run, the value at the output OUT depends on the value
available at the input R, the input S, and the saved value.
If both of the values available at the inputs R and S are 0 (FALSE) in the 1st CFC run, the saved value is used as
initial value at the output OUT. After an initial restart of the device, the persistent value is removed and the
block uses the initial value 0 (FALSE) instead.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.7.1 FF_D
12.2.7.2 FF_SR
12.2.7.3 FF_RS
12.2.12.3 FF_D_MEM
12.2.12.4 FF_SR_MEM
12.8.1 Basic Data Types
12.2.13 Selection
12.2.13.1 MIN_D
The MIN_D block uses up to 4 whole-number input values to determine the minimum value.
NOTE
i You can also interconnect signals of data types UINT and INT with this block. The block converts these data
types into the DINT data type automatically.
Detailed Description
The block determines the minimum value from those at the inputs IN1 to IN4. This minimum value is then
available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.2 MIN_R
The MIN_R block uses up to 4 floating-point numbers present at the inputs to determine the minimum value.
Detailed Description
The block determines the minimum value from those at the inputs IN1 to IN4. This minimum value is then
available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.3 MAX_D
The MAX_D block uses up to 4 whole-number input values to determine the maximum value.
NOTE
i You can also interconnect signals of data types UINT and INT with this block. The block converts these data
types into the DINT data type automatically.
Detailed Description
The block determines the maximum value from those at the inputs IN1 to IN4. This maximum value is then
available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.4 MAX_R
The MAX_R block uses up to 4 floating-point numbers present at the inputs to determine the maximum value.
Detailed Description
The block determines the maximum value from those at the inputs IN1 to IN4. This maximum value is then
available at the OUT output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.5 MUX_D
Depending on a selection value, the MUX_D block transmits exactly one out of up to 4 whole-number input
values to the output.
NOTE
i You can also interconnect signals of data types UINT and INT with this block. The block converts these data
types into the DINT data type automatically.
Detailed Description
The block displays exactly one of the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4 at the OUT output, depending on the
selection value at input K. If a selection value of 1 is present at the K input, the value at input 1 is transmitted.
If a selection value of 2 is present, the value at input 2 is transmitted, and so on. If a value lower than 1 is
present, the value at input 1 is transmitted. If a value greater than 4 is present, the value at input 4 is trans-
mitted.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.6 MUX_R
Depending on a selection value, the MUX_R block outputs exactly one out of up to 4 floating-point numbers
present at the input.
Detailed Description
The block displays exactly 1 of the values at the inputs IN1 to IN4 at the OUT output, depending on the selec-
tion value at input K. If a selection value of 1 is present at the K input, the value at input 1 is transmitted. If a
selection value of 2 is present, the value at input 2 is transmitted, and so on. If a value lower than 1 is present,
the value at input 1 is transmitted. If a value greater than 4 is present, the value at input 4 is transmitted.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.7 HOLD_D
The HOLD_D block can save a whole number present at the input. The save function can be activated by either
a rising or a falling edge.
NOTE
i You can also interconnect signals of data types UINT and INT with this block. The block converts these data
types into the DINT data type automatically.
Detailed Description
If the INVH input is not set, on a rising edge at the HOLD input, the block saves the value present at that time
at the IN input. If the INVH input is set, on a falling edge at the HOLD input, the block saves the value present
at that time at the IN input. The saved value is available at the OUT output. The output of the block remains at
0 as long as there is no rising or falling signal edge.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.13.8 HOLD_R
The HOLD_R block can save the value of a floating-point number present at the input. The save function can
be activated by either a rising or a falling edge.
Detailed Description
If the INVH input is not set, on a rising edge at the HOLD input, the block saves the value present at that time
at the IN input. If the INVH input is set, on a falling edge at the HOLD input, the block saves the value present
at that time at the IN input. The saved value is available at the OUT output. The output of the block remains at
0 as long as there is no rising or falling signal edge.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.1 TSHORT
The TSHORT block is a timer for short-time intervals in the second range.
Detailed Description
You set the length of the time interval at the Tx1ms input with a resolution of 1 ms.
A state change from 0 to 1 at the START input starts the time interval T. The QT output adopts a value of 1;
the Q output remains at 0. A state change from 0 to 1 at the START input cancels an ongoing time interval
and starts it again. The Q output retains its state.
Once the time interval has elapsed, the QT output is set to 0 and the Q output to 1. Only a value of 1 at the
RESET input can reset the Q output to 0. This also cancels an ongoing time interval and sets the QT output to
0. Both outputs remain at 0 as long as the RESET input has a value of 1.
The following figure illustrates the way in which the block works:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.2 TLONG
The TLONG block is a timer for long-time intervals in the hour range.
Detailed Description
You can set the length of the time interval separately for hours, minutes and milliseconds, using the HOUR,
MIN and MS100 inputs.
A state change from 0 to 1 at the START input starts the time interval T. The QT output adopts a value of 1;
the Q output remains at 0. A state change from 0 to 1 at the START input cancels an ongoing time interval
and starts it again. The Q output retains its state.
Once the time interval has elapsed, the QT output is set to 0 and the Q output to 1. A value of 1 at the RESET
input resets the Q output to 0. This also cancels an ongoing time interval and sets the QT output to 0. Both
outputs remain at 0 as long as the RESET input has a value of 1. The first time the block is started, the Q
output is also set to 0.
The following figure illustrates the way in which the block works:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.3 TOF
The TOF block delays falling edges of a binary signal in the millisecond range.
Detailed Description
The block forwards a state change from 0 to 1 at the IN input to the Q output directly. The block displays a
state change from 1 to 0 at the Q output, delayed by time PT. If the IN input adopts a value of 1 again while
the time delay is still ongoing, the Q output remains at 1.
The block has an additional ET output. You can use this output to check the time delay which has already
elapsed. The value at the ET output increases in small stages during the PT time delay from 0 up to the PT
value. One stage and, consequently, the rate of increase in the value depend on the cycle time. This depend-
ency means that you may only interconnect this output in cyclic task levels.
The following figure illustrates the way in which the block works:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.4 TON
The TON block delays rising edges of a binary signal in the millisecond range.
Detailed Description
A state change from 0 to 1 at the IN input is displayed by the block at the Q output, delayed by time PT. The
block forwards a state change from 1 to 0 to the Q output directly. If the IN input adopts a value of 0 again
while the time delay is still ongoing, the Q output remains at 0.
The block has an additional ET output. You can use this output to check the time delay which has already
elapsed. The value at the ET output increases in small stages during the PT time delay from 0 up to the PT
value. One stage and, consequently, the rate of increase in the value depend on the cycle time. This depend-
ency means that you may only interconnect this output in cyclic task levels.
The following figure illustrates the way in which the block works:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.5 TP
The TP block is a timer for short-time intervals in the second range that cannot be interrupted.
Detailed Description
You set the length of the time interval at the PT input with a resolution of 1 ms.
A state change from 0 to 1 at the IN input starts the time interval PT. The Q output adopts a value of 1. A
further state change at the IN input does not affect the progress of the time interval. Once the time interval
has elapsed, the Q output is set to 0. Only then can you start a new time interval.
The block has an additional output ET. You can use this output to check the time which has already elapsed.
The value at the ET output increases in small stages during the PT time interval from 0 up to the PT value. A
stage and, consequently, the rate of increase in the value depend on the cycle time. This dependency means
that you may only interconnect this output in cyclic task levels.
The following figure illustrates the way in which the block works:
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.6 BLINK
The BLINK block generates a continuous state change from 0 to 1 and from 1 to 0 at the output. Therefore,
the block is suitable for controlling LEDs which are intended to flash, for example.
Detailed Description
The block always starts with the ON phase. As long as the START input has a value of 1, the Q output changes
its state from 0 to 1 and from 1 to 0 in accordance with the set times.
You can set the lengths for the ON and OFF phases separately. In order to do this, use the TH and TL inputs.
NOTE
i The resolution for the lengths of the ON and OFF phases is 100 ms. This means that, depending on the
start time, the first ON phase can follow up to 99 ms after the set TH value.
If a cyclic task level has been set for the block, the minimum possible phase length corresponds to the dura-
tion of 1 cycle.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.7 ALARM
The ALARM block signals that an alarm time defined with different input variables has been reached.
You can define a single or cyclic alarm time with the following input values:
• Year
• Month
• Day
• Hour
• Minute
• Second
You can use the value at the CYCLE input to specify a repetition mode for the alarm. This input also enables
you to set a compatibility mode with SIPROTEC 4. To do this, assign a value of 9 to the input.
In compatibility mode, you can parameterize alarm repetitions as with SIPROTEC 4. The following table shows
the entries for the SIPROTEC 4-compatible repetition mode.
Name Explanation
YEAR 0: Every year
MNTH 0: Every month
DAY 0: Every day
HOUR 24: Every hour
MIN 60: Every minute
NOTE
i If you parameterize several input values, the shortest repetition period always takes precedence.
Detailed Description
The block is only active if a value of 1 is always present at the START input.
The block uses a state change from 0 to 1 at the Q output to signal that the alarm time defined with the input
values has been reached. The Q output remains set for 1 second, after which the Q output adopts a value of 0
again. If you define an invalid alarm time, for example February 31, the ERR output is set instead of Q. The
ERR output remains set until you define a valid alarm time.
NOTE
i The block does not take the switchover from standard time to daylight-saving time, or from daylight-saving
time to standard time into account. If the alarm time falls within this period, the block either outputs no
alarm or a double alarm.
If the input values change dynamically, the block must be reactivated with a state change from 0 to 1 at the
START input. This then causes the block to adopt the modified input values.
Examples
With the following values, the block sets its output Q to 1 at the beginning of the 2011-11-03.
YEAR MNTH DAY HOUR MIN SEC CYCLE START
2011 11 3 0 0 0 0 1
With the following values, the block sets its output Q to 1 every month, beginning on the 2010-04-05.
YEAR MNTH DAY HOUR MIN SEC CYCLE START
2010 4 5 0 0 0 5 1
With the following values, the block runs in SIPROTEC compatible mode. The block sets its output Q to 1 at the
beginning of the 5th hour of each day.
YEAR MNTH DAY HOUR MIN SEC CYCLE START
0 0 0 5 0 0 9 1
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.8 CTD
The CTD (Count Down) block counts down, starting at a defined start value. The current counter value
decreases by 1 with every counting step. You can select from various tripping criteria to start the count.
Detailed Description
The value at the PV input equates to the start value. As soon as the value at the LD input is 1, the block adopts
this start value as the value for the CV output. The downward-counting procedure is controlled using the CD
input. If the value at the LD input is 1, the block stops the count and sets all outputs to 0.
The value at the EDGE input determines the counting criterion. You can select from the following counting
criteria:
• EDGE = 0
The block decreases the metered value each time there is a state change from 0 to 1 (rising edge) at the
CD input.
• EDGE = 1
The block decreases the metered value each time there is a state change at the CD input.
• EDGE = 2
The block decreases the metered value each time a chart is executed. On a cyclic task level, therefore, the
metered value changes with every cycle. As a precondition for this tripping criterion, the value at the CD
input must be static 1.
If the value 0 is reached when counting down, the block sets the Q output to 1. However, the count continues
as long as all criteria are met. The block has a counting range which is defined by the PVmin and PVmax limiting
values which you cannot change. Once the lower limiting value PVmin is reached, the block cannot count
down any further. However, the current counter value at the CV output is retained until the value at the LD
input is 1.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.9 CTU
The CTU (Count Up) block counts up to a defined final value, starting at 0. The current counter value increases
by 1 with every counting step. You can select from various tripping criteria to start the count.
Detailed Description
The value at the PV input equates to the final value. The upward counting procedure is controlled using the
CU input. If the value at the R input is 1, the block stops the count and sets all outputs to 0.
The value at the EDGE input determines the counting criterion. You can select from the following counting
criteria:
• EDGE = 0
The block increases the metered value each time there is a state change from 0 to 1 (rising edge) at the
CU input.
• EDGE = 1
The block increases the metered value each time there is a state change at the CU input.
• EDGE = 2
The block increases the metered value each time a chart is executed. On a cyclic task level, therefore, the
metered value changes with every cycle. As a precondition for this tripping criterion, the value at the CU
input must be static 1.
If the final value is reached when counting up, the block sets the Q output to 1. However, the count continues
as long as all criteria are met. The block has a counting range which is defined by the PVmin and PVmax limiting
values which you cannot change. Once the upper limiting value PVmax is reached, the block cannot count up
any further. However, the current counter value at the CV output is retained until the value at the R input is 1.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
12.2.14.10 CTUD
The CTUD (Count Up and Down) block counts up starting from 0 or down starting from a definable start value.
You can specify the step value per counting step. In addition, you can select from various tripping criteria to
start the count.
Detailed Description
If the block is to count up, the value at the PV input equates to the final value. If the block is to count down,
the value at the PV input equates to the start value. As soon as the value at the LD input is 1, the block adopts
this start value.
The upward counting procedure is controlled using the CU input. The downward counting procedure is
controlled using the CD input.
The value at the EDGE input determines the counting criterion. You can select from the following counting
criteria:
• EDGE = 0
The block increases the metered value each time there is a state change from 0 to 1 (rising edge) at the
CU or CD input.
• EDGE = 1
The block increases the metered value each time there is a state change at the CU or CD input.
• EDGE = 2
The block increases the metered value each time a chart is executed. On a cyclic task level, therefore, the
metered value changes with every cycle. As a precondition for this tripping criterion, the value at the CU
or CD input must be static 1.
If the final value is reached when counting up, the block sets the QU output to 1. If the value 0 is reached
when counting down, the block sets the QD output to 1. However, in both cases the count continues as long
as all criteria are met. The block has a counting range which is defined by the PVmin and PVmax limiting values
and which you cannot change. Once the lower limiting value PVmin is reached, the block cannot count down
any further. Once the upper limiting value PVmax is reached, the block cannot count up any further. However,
the current counter value at the CV output is retained until the value at the R or LD input is 1.
Under the following conditions, the block does not count up or down:
• The value at the R input is 1. In this case, the value at the CV output is 0.
• The value at the R input is 0 and the value at the LD input is 1. In this case, the CV output adopts the
value at the PV input.
• The values at the R and LD inputs are 0 and the values at the CD and CU inputs are 1.
Related Topics
12.1.1.3 Block
• You can view the signals and the settings assigned to the respective blocks.
• You can navigate from the Cross-reference list editor to the block pin where the signal or the setting is
connected in the CFC editor.
[sc_digsi_cfccrossreference, 2, en_US]
[sc_sethighlight, 1, en_US]
•
: Table sorted in alphabetically ascending order.
•
: Table sorted in alphabetically descending order.
If you click the Custom filter option, the 22.6.25 Custom Filter dialog opens.
² Create a user-defined filter as described in 3.2.5 Creating a User-Defined Filter and click OK.
The Create user-defined filter dialog closes. The display of the content is updated in relation to the filter you
have created.
NOTE
i If you close and reopen the cross-reference list, the filters are reset.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.1.5 Configuration Strategy
² 12.1.2.1 Adding a CFC
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
[sc_digsi_terminal, 1, en_US]
You can select the For Test option from the Control flow editor for the respective terminal.
[sc_digsi_controlflow, 1, en_US]
You can select the entire block and select the option For Test under the Interface group in the Properties tab.
[sc_digsi_block, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You can select a maximum number of 20 terminals for test before starting the CFC offline analysis and
more than 20 terminals while CFC offline analysis is in progress. Even if you do not select the For Test
option, you can still probe the terminal to view the runtime values while analyzing, by positioning the
mouse pointer over the respective terminal. For structured type variables, the 1st item of the selected vari-
able value is always displayed as the default runtime value.
You must create a test sequence before starting the CFC offline analysis and assign the desired values for
the configured signals in function charts (CFC).
For additional information to create a test sequence, refer to 13.2.2 Adding a Test Sequence.
²
To start the CFC offline analysis, click the button in the 22.7.6 Toolbar Data Flow.
- or -
² Select Start function chart (CFC) analysis > Offline analysis from the Tools menu.
The Offline analysis of function charts window is displayed for selecting the test sequence.
[sc_digsi_sequence, 1, en_US]
² Select the desired sequence from the Select signal sequence list box.
² Click OK.
The Offline analysis for function charts (CFC) window displays the progress status of the analysis and closes
after completion. Values for input/output terminals are displayed in the working area. The title bar changes to
orange color indicating that the offline analysis is in progress. This display remains until the test-sequence
execution is completed or you stop the analysis. While the CFC offline analysis is in progress, you can still add
or remove the terminals for the offline analysis and view the values available at the terminal.
[sc_digsi_watching, 1, en_US]
After executing all the steps of the test sequence, the CFC offline analysis stops automatically and displays the
trace output file. This action is possible only if the CFC chart is configured for tracing by enabling the For Test
option. The name of trace output file is device-specific. It displays the graphical representation of variables set
for watching.
[sc_digsi_tracefile, 1, en_US]
²
Click to save the trace output file in the CFG format in the desired location.
NOTE
i You can select up to 100 terminals for CFC online analysis. If you exceed the limit, the online analysis is not
starting, an error message is shown instead. By default, the connection between output terminals with
Boolean values is also considered for the CFC Online analysis even if not selected for watching. During
runtime of the CFC Online analysis, you still can add or remove terminals for test. If you exceed the limit of
100 terminals during runtime, some values may be shown as "?".
During runtime of the CFC Online analysis, you still can probe a terminal by positioning the mouse pointer
over the terminal.
- or -
² Select Start function chart (CFC) analysis > Online analysis from the Tools menu.
The Online test of function charts window displays the progress status and after completion, the values for
input/output terminals are displayed in the working area. The title bar changes to orange color indicating that
the editor is in the online mode. The real time values from the device are displayed at the terminals continu-
ously until you stop the analysis.
[sc_digsi_cfc_analysis, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i For structured type interfaces, always the 1st item of the structure is displayed as the runtime value.
You can probe to see the complete structure values or you must select the items of the structure for test
and watch them in the block or terminal Properties or in the Control flow view.
For the CFC Online analysis of measuring values (MV), it can be confusing, because a measuring value is a
real value which is visible in the 2nd structure item (VAL_R). The first item shown as runtime value is the
integer value (VAL_I) which is normally 0.
Also take into account that measuring values (MV, CMV, DEL, WYE) are always used as percentage values in
CFC analysis.
While the CFC Online analysis is in progress, you can still add or remove the terminals for the online anal-
ysis and you can view the values available at the terminal. Other CFC operations like creating a new logic
and the modification of any existing logic are not possible, while CFC Online analysis is in progress.
² Click the Control flow tab to add/remove multiple values for watching at a time and also watch the
values for already added terminals in the tabular view.
[sc_digsi_tabview, 1, en_US]
²
Stop the CFC Online analysis by clicking in the CFC toolbar or select Stop function chart (CFC)
analysis from the Tools menu.
Related Topics
² 12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
The feature is intended to structure the CFC logic in a better way to reduce the complexity of the function
charts (CFC), and increase the modularity and reusability of the function chart. It allows you to configure and
use a function chart inside another function chart. A chart within another chart is known as the subchart. A
subchart used inside another chart appears like a function block. Subcharts must have interfaces configured.
These interfaces are the entry points to the subcharts. A function chart with interfaces (subchart) can be
added to another function chart. The inputs and outputs of a subchart are connected to interfaces, whereas
for a parent chart they are connected to signals. Similar to function charts, subcharts can also be copied,
pasted, and deleted. A configured function subchart can be saved as template in the Project library and the
Global libraries so that it can be used across different projects or by different users. For additional information
how to create a master copy of a function subchart, refer to 3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI
5 Library. If you add a function subchart inside another function chart from the library or by copy and paste,
always a copy of the function subchart is created. Any modification later in this subchart does not affect the
original subchart.
A subchart will be executed if the parent function chart is executed within the parameterized run sequence
and the task level of the parent chart. After execution of a subchart, the outputs from the subchart are avail-
able via the output interfaces. These outputs can be used for further processing in the parent chart.
NOTE
NOTE
NOTE
i The task level for subcharts will be set automatically to the parent chart task level to which it is copied. If
for example, a subchart with the task level Event -triggered is copied to a parent chart with the task level
Low priority Event-triggered, the task level of the subchart is set to Low priority Event-triggered, too.
NOTE
Related Topics
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
22.1.12 Data Flow
There are several ways to add a subchart into a function chart, which itself also can be a subchart.
To add an existing subchart, you can select an existing chart that has no signals and settings or a subchart
from the project tree and drag and drop it into the working area of another chart. A copy of the function chart
or subchart is created as a subchart.
If you already created a CFC master copy in the DIGSI global library, (see 12.5.5 Creating a Master Copy of a
Subchart), you can add subcharts from the library per drag and drop. To add a new subchart, proceed as
follows:
²
Click the Insert a new subchart button in the 22.7.6 Toolbar Data Flow.
- or -
² Right-click in the function chart area and select the option Insert new subchart in the context menu.
- or -
² Select the Insert menu item in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar and select the Insert a new subchart option
and click anywhere in the function chart area.
The new subchart (for example, CFC_1_1) is created and displayed in the working area. It is listed under the
parent chart (for example, CFC_1) in the project tree. You can rename the subchart.
[sc_digsi_nestedchart, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_digsi_subchart, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 12.5.2 Adding a Subchart
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
² In the CFC Data Flow view of the CFC you want to use as subchart, click the button above the toolbar to
show the Interface section.
² Assign the block inputs you want to use as subchart interface inputs into the Input list of the Interface
section by drag and drop.
- or -
² Select the interface and click the Create Interface button.
² Assign the block outputs you want to use as subchart interface outputs into the Output list of the Inter-
face section by drag and drop.
- or -
² Select the interface and click the Create Interface button.
NOTE
i Drag and Drop of block inputs or outputs of structured types is not possible.
The interfaces are created with the default name and the matching data type.
NOTE
i You can assign more than one block input to a subchart interface, but a subchart interface output can only
be assigned to one block output. If you want to remove a subchart interface, right-click the interface in the
Interface section and select Delete in the context menu.
Interface sections:
• Interface Name
The interface can be renamed if the name is selected. The interface names has to be unique for the
subchart. Therefore the name is expanded automatically by adding a number if the added or changed
name is already used. The name must not contain commas.
• Interface Type
The Type of the interface is set automatically, if you assign the interface to the block terminal via Drag
and Drop. You can change the interface Type only if no terminal is assigned.
• Interface Value
In column Value, you can set a default value for the interface. The default value is used if the interface is
not connected in the parent function chart. If the interface is already connected in the parent function
chart, the Value is shown as empty and you cannot set the Value.
• Interface Comment
In the Comment field, you can add a comment to the subchart interface which may be helpful if the
subchart is used as a template. If you select the subchart in the parent chart, you can see the interface
Comment in the Interface tab of the Properties page. The interface Comment is also shown if you
select the terminal of the subchart in the parent chart in the General tab of the Properties page.
NOTE
i You can also add a comment for the subchart itself in the General tab of the Properties page.
[sc_digsi_interface, 1, en_US]
[sc_digsi_automatic_cfc, 1, en_US]
Figure 12-18 Defining the Interface for Subchart using the Create Interface button
NOTE
i You can only assign one interface to a CFC block input terminal, but you can assign multiple interfaces to a
CFC block output terminal.
Related Topics
² 22.1.12 Data Flow
² 12.5.2 Adding a Subchart
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
by clicking the icon. You can also create a new global library by clicking the icon in the
Global libraries toolbar.
² Select the function subchart which you want to add to the library as a template subchart for the device in
the Project Tree.
² Drag and drop the function subchart to the desired user-defined library in the Master copies folder.
- or -
² Copy the CFC from the project tree and paste it in the Master copies folder using the context menu
option.
The Insert master copy dialog displays the progress status and after completion, the master copy of the CFC
chart is created and displayed in the Global libraries palette.
[sc_digsi_create_mastercopy, 3, en_US]
NOTE
i You can select multiple function charts at a time in the device Project Tree and paste them as a single
master copy with the context menu option Paste as a single master copy. You can change the name of
the master copy by selecting Rename in the context menu.
Related Topics
² 3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
NOTE
i The internal logic is transferred from the source subchart to the destination subchart, but the name of the
destination subchart is not changed.
The name of the source subchart is displayed in the Properties tab of the subchart, in the Subchart
section, in the Created using field.
During the analysis of CFC charts via Offline analysis or Online analysis, the value at the CFC block terminals
changes continuously depending on the value of the input signal or status. The Trend View editor allows you
to view the continuous changes at the block terminals in the form of graphical representation and simulate
the various conditions based on a changing input-signal value and status. With this editor, you can select the
CFC terminal block and view the signal or value status at the terminal block during the CFC analysis. You can
monitor multiple static and online values.
You must configure the trend display by assigning the terminals in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor or the
22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor editor. Based on this configuration, you can view the continuous changes in
the configured trends. Trend display allows you to visualize multiple values in a trend chart. Dynamic display
allows you to visualize multiple values in a table. The compilations of selected tags/parameters are stored for
reuse.
• The trend display configured in the editor window consists of the following objects:
– Definition table
– Trend window with operator controls and trend chart
• The values are assigned to digital and analog axes and displayed. A trend display may contain several
digital and analog axes.
• The values of the trend chart can be exported or imported in CSV format.
• You can print the dynamic display from the project tree. In the offline mode, the offline values are
printed, while the online mode prints the online values.
Data Storage
The data of trend and dynamic display as well as for test data are stored in a way so that they are preserved in
Logic Editor even if, for example, a device has been renamed or copied via the SICAM Device Manager.
However, since these data are not stored in the device itself, they are not available anymore when you retrieve
the data from the device.
[sc_digsi_trenddisplay, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_digsi_dynamicdisplay, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
To add an analog axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor editor, proceed as follows:
² Open the Trend display editor configured with a trend display (for example, Trend_1).
The Trend view is displayed in the working area
²
Double-click the button.
The analog axis is created and displayed with the default name Axis_1.
[sc_digsi_analogaxis, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
To add the digital axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor , proceed as follows:
² Open the trend display editor configured with a trend display (for example, Trend_1).
The Trend view is displayed in the working area.
²
Double-click the button.
The digital axis is created and displayed with the default name Digital axis_1.
[sc_digsi_digitalaxis, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_digsi_analog_trend, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You cannot add analog IO terminals to the digital axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor . You can assign
the analog IO terminals directly from the Properties tab of the Inspector window or the Control Flow
editor. You can configure a maximum number of 30 terminals in a single trend display.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
² Drag and drop the digital terminals from the CFC blocks to the digital axis in the trend display editor.
Digital IO terminals are successfully added to the digital axis.
[sc_digsi_digital_trend, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You cannot add digital IO terminals to the analog axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor . You can assign
the digital IO terminals directly from the Properties tab of the Inspector window or the Control Flow
editor. You can configure a maximum number of 30 terminals in a single trend display.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
To assign struct type IO terminals of a CFC block to a trend display, proceed as follows:
² Open the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor containing an analog or digital axis.
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar to view and work with Trend display editor and with the CFC
chart editor simultaneously.
² Add a new CFC chart and instantiate the CFC blocks which have the struct type terminals.
² Connect compatible struct signals or settings to the CFC block IO terminals.
² Open the Properties tab via the Inspector window.
² Drag and drop the subterminals of the struct type IO from the Properties tab of the CFC block to the
analog or digital axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor depending on the type of the signal or setting.
Struct type IO terminals are successfully added to the analog axis or to the digital axis.
[sc_digsi_structtype_trend, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You can add struct type IO terminals to the analog axis in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor only via the
Properties tab of the Inspector window. You can configure a maximum number of 30 terminals in a single
trend display.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
To assign IO terminals from one trend display to another trend display, proceed as follows:
² Open the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor configured with 2 or more trend displays (for example, Trend_1
and Trend_2) with the respective analog axis and digital axis assigned with IO terminals.
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar to work with 2 open Trend display editor windows simultane-
ously.
² Drag and drop any assigned IO terminal from the Trend_1 display to the Trend_2 display.
IO terminals are successfully moved from the source trend display to the target trend display.
[sc_digsi_trenddisplays, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
To assign IO terminals from one trend display to another trend display via the project tree, proceed as follows:
² Open the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor configured with 2 or more trend displays (for example, Trend_1
and Trend_2) with the respective analog axis and digital axis assigned with IO terminals.
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar to work with 2 open Trend display editor windows simultane-
ously.
² Drag and drop the assigned IO terminals from the Trend_1 display in the trend display to the Trend_2
node in the project tree.
IO terminals are successfully copied from the source trend display to the target trend display and displayed in
the Trend display editor.
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_digsi_dynamic_analog_digital, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i You can add struct type IO terminals in the 22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor only via the Properties tab. You
can also assign the IO terminals directly from the Properties tab of the Inspector window or the Control
Flow editor.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
12.6.12 Deleting CFC Block/CFC Chart after Assigning their Terminals to the Trend
Display/Dynamic Display Editor
To confirm deletion of the CFC block or CFC chart after assigning their IO terminal to the trend display or
dynamic display, proceed as follows:
² Open the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor or 22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor assigned with IO terminals of
CFC blocks or charts.
² Right-click the CFC block or chart whose IO terminals are assigned to the trend display or the dynamic
display.
² Click Delete in the context menu.
The CFC block or the chart along with the assigned terminals in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor or
22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor is deleted.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
To watch values in the Trend/Dynamic display while CFC online analysis is in progress, proceed as follows:
² In the project tree of an offline configuration, open a configured function chart (CFC).
² Create the trend display and/or dynamic display.
² Configure the trend display/dynamic display with the respective CFC block IO terminals.
² Load the configuration to the device.
² Start the online analysis of the Function Charts (CFC).
The values for the configured IO terminals are displayed in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor or in the
22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor.
[sc_digsi_trenddisplayonline, 1, en_US]
Figure 12-20 Trend Display with CFC Online Analysis in Progress - Sample
[sc_digsi_dynamicdisplay_online, 1, en_US]
Figure 12-21 Dynamic Display with CFC Online Analysis in Progress - Sample
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
12.6.14 Watching Values in the Trend/Dynamic Display while CFC Offline Analysis is in
Progress
To watch values in the Trend/Dynamic display while CFC offline analysis is in progress, proceed as follows:
² In the project tree of an offline configuration, open a configured function chart (CFC).
² Create the trend display and/or dynamic display.
² Configure the trend display/dynamic display with the respective CFC block IO terminals.
² Configure the test sequences.
² Start the offline analysis of the Function Charts (CFC).
The values for the configured IO terminals are displayed in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor or in the
22.1.15 Dynamic Display Editor.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
NOTE
i You cannot use the same name for different axes. You cannot rename the Tag name.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
12.6.15.3 Changing the Color of the Trend in the Trend View Display
To change the color of the trend in the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor , proceed as follows:
² Open the 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor with the configured trend display.
² Select the desired color in the Trend color column.
² Start the CFC online/offline analysis
The trend graph appears with the selected color in the trend view display.
NOTE
i If you select the check box option under the Emphasis column for any trend, the trend graph gets high-
lighted in bold.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
² Click OK.
The trend view graph will be printed.
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
Related Topics
² 22.1.35 Trend Display Editor
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.3 Renaming a Function Chart (CFC)
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
With this feature, you can set the protection level for function charts and secure each function chart with a
defined password. The following protection levels for function charts are possible:
• Access protection
This protection level allows you to set an access protection for a CFC with a password and to restrict the
display of the content.
• Write protection
This protection level allows you to set a write access protection for a CFC with a password and to restrict
the modification of the content.
Protected function charts can be copied but not deleted. If a protected function chart is copied, the protection
is still valid for the copied chart. If you want to delete a protected function chart, you must remove the protec-
tion first. Deleting a complete device in the project tree of an offline configuration with protected function
charts is possible.
NOTE
i CFC protection is very important. If you you do not remember the password, you cannot access protected
charts or change Write-protected charts anymore.
Related Topics
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
22.1.12 Data Flow
12.7.2 Configuring the Access Protection for the Function Charts (CFC)
[sc_activate_prot, 1, en_US]
The Activate access protection dialog closes and the chart is protected. The respective protection status
message is also displayed in the Protection area under the Properties tab and in the Properties dialog of the
function chart.
[sc_protected, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
² Click OK.
The access-protected CFC is displayed in the working area.
² If you enter a wrong password, the indication Invalid password is displayed.
[sc_wrongpass, 1, en_US]
² If you click Cancel the function chart is opened, but the content is not shown.
[sc_nocontent, 1, en_US]
²
An access-protected function chart is displayed in the project tree with the following symbol: .
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.2.1 Setting the Access Protection for a CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
- or -
² In the Properties dialog opened via the context menu of the function chart (CFC) in the project tree,
select the Protection node under the General tab and click the Protection button in the Access protec-
tion area.
The Change access protection dialog is displayed.
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.2.1 Setting the Access Protection for a CFC
² 12.7.2.2 Opening an Access-Protected CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.2.1 Setting the Access Protection for a CFC
² 12.7.2.2 Opening an Access-Protected CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
12.7.3 Configuring the Write Protection for the Function Charts (CFC)
[sc_act_writeprot, 1, en_US]
The Activate write protection dialog closes and the chart is write-protected. The respective protection-status
message is also displayed in the Write protection area under the Properties tab.
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
NOTE
i To edit the CFC, you do not need to deactivate the write-protection password. You can click the unlock icon
in the Data flow view toolbar of the function chart and enter the correct password in the following
dialog. The function chart is editable now but still keeps the write protection in general. After closing the
function-chart window or by clicking the icon in the toolbar, the function chart is no longer editable.
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.3.1 Setting the Write Protection for a CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_chg_writeprot, 1, en_US]
The Change write protection dialog closes and the write-protection password is modified.
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.3.1 Setting the Write Protection for a CFC
² 12.7.3.2 Opening a Write-Protected CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
[sc_deact_writeprot, 1, en_US]
The Deactivate write protection dialog closes and the write-protection password is removed. The respective
protection-status message is also displayed in the Protection area under the Properties tab and in the Proper-
ties dialog of the function chart.
Related Topics
² 12.7.1 Brief Introduction to Protecting Function Charts (CFC)
² 12.7.3.1 Setting the Write Protection for a CFC
² 12.7.3.2 Opening a Write-Protected CFC
² 12.7.3.3 Modifying the Write-Protection Password of a CFC
² 12.1.1.2 Function Chart
² 12.1.2.2 Opening a CFC
² 12.1.2.5 Deleting CFCs
² 12.1.2.4 Copying a CFC
In CFC, the following connections for block inputs and outputs of basic data types are allowed:
Block Input Type Connectable Block Output Types
BOOL BOOL
DINT DINT, REAL, UINT
UINT DINT, UINT
REAL DINT, REAL
In CFC, the following signal and setting types can be connected to block inputs of basic data types:
Block Input Type Connectable Signal/Setting Types
BOOL SPS, SPG
DINT MV, INS, BCR, ING
UINT INS, ING
ENUM ENC, ENS, ENG
REAL MV, BCR, ASG
In CFC, the following signal types can be connected to block outputs of basic data types:
Block Output Type Connectable Signal Types
BOOL SPS
DINT MV, INS, INC
UINT INS, INC
REAL MV
• Set parameters for analog test signals for the phases of each measuring point
• You can configure 1 analog test signal for each phase of a measuring point.
• You can set 1 starting value for magnitude, phase angle, and frequency for each analog test signal.
• With the ramp function you can achieve the raising or reducing signal profiles.
• You can define a binary input signal for each binary input.
If the SIPROTEC 5 device is in simulation mode, the test sequence can be started. You have the following
options for this purpose:
• A signal at a binary input can start the test sequence. This method is especially suitable for testing the
interaction between multiple SIPROTEC 5 devices.
Information about the use of test sequences can be found under 17.4.5 Testing Protection Functions or
17.4.2 Testing Analog Inputs.
Related Topics
13.2.2 Adding a Test Sequence
13.2.1 Opening the Test Sequence
13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
13.3.5 Configuring Analog Test Signals for Measuring Points
13.3.9 Setting the Value of Binary Input Signals
13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
Test sequences are always assigned to an offline configuration and therefore a certain SIPROTEC 5 device.
Therefore, a test sequence within the project structure will always be stored in the folder of an offline configu-
ration. The test sequence is opened using the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
You can create as many test sequences as you like for each offline configuration. A consecutively numbered
default name is assigned to each test sequence that is added. You can change this name. The new test
sequence contains 1 state. The settings for this state are preset to default values. The test sequence is added
using the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.2.3 Renaming a Test Sequence
² 13.2.5 Copying Test Sequences
² 13.2.4 Deleting Test Sequences
When you add a test sequence, it is automatically given a consecutively numbered default name. You can
change this name. The name of a test sequence must be unique within a SIPROTEC 5 device. You can modify
the name of a test sequence in the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
To delete a test sequence, use the 3.1.2 Project Tree. You can simultaneously delete a single test sequence or
multiple test sequences.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
You can copy test sequences within an offline configuration or between offline configurations. Test sequences
are always copied using the 3.1.2 Project Tree. It is also possible to copy multiple test sequences simultane-
ously.
NOTE
i DIGSI 5 does not check whether the test sequences copied are compatible with the destination configura-
tion. You must ensure this yourself.
- or -
² If you want to copy multiple test sequences simultaneously, first select their names. This is done by
holding either the SHIFT key or the <Ctrl> key down, depending on the selection procedure. Then right-
click one of these names.
² Click Copy in the context menu.
The test sequences will be copied to the clipboard.
² Right-click the Test sequences folder.
² Click Paste in the context menu.
The names of the copied test sequences will be displayed under the Test sequences folder.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.2.3 Renaming a Test Sequence
A test sequence consists of at least 1 and a maximum of 20 states. For each state you can set the various
values for the analog test signals, function-chart (CFC) input signals and binary input signals. For configuring
the states, you have the following possibilities:
Related Topics
13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
13.3.2 Changing the Number
13.3.3 Renaming a State
13.3.4 Setting Duration for a State
A test sequence can consist of up to 20 states. For each state, you can define different values. A state ends
after a set duration. The next state is then automatically executed.
You can add states to or delete states from a test sequence with the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor.
A new state will be added to the test sequence. This state has a consecutively numbered default name. The
name is entered in the list box on the toolbar. The default settings of the state are displayed in the working
area.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
When you add a state, it is automatically given a consecutively numbered default name. You can change this
name with the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor. The name of a state must be unique within a test sequence.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
A state of the test sequence ends after a settable duration. The next state is then automatically executed. After
a new state has been created, a duration of 10 s is preset. You can change this value with the 22.1.22 Test-
Sequences Editor.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
² 13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
In the area Indicate value for secondary analog input signals for this state, you can configure for each
state separately, test signals for each measuring point. Doing this you can configure one measuring point for 1
test signal for each phase. You can do this in one of the following ways:
• You can set start values for the analog test signals.
Related Topics
13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
13.3.6 Setting Starting Values for Analog Test Signals
13.3.7 Using the Ramp Function
13.3.8 Configuring Harmonic
You can set the starting value for each analog test signal with the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor within a
state. If you use the ramp function, the value of the analog test signal will be incremented or decremented
starting from this starting value. If you do not use the ramp function, the analog test signal is assigned the
defined starting value permanently during a state.
The analog test signals are supplied directly to the logical measuring points. You can configure 1 test signal for
each phase of a configured measuring point.
You can define starting values for the following physical quantities:
• Magnitude
• Phase angle
• Frequency
You can set the magnitude and phase angle for each analog test signal individually. However, the frequency
must be identical for all analog test signals that are routed to one measuring point. Therefore, set 1 frequency
value per measuring point. This is automatically applied to all relevant analog test signals.
With only 1 mouse click, you can take over the final values of the previous state as starting values for the
current state. With this functionality, you can create a continuous signal flow from several states. For this
purpose, the following conditions must be met:
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
If the value entered is permissible, it is accepted. If the entered value is outside the permissible range of
values, an error message appears. In this case, correct your entry.
- or -
² Double-click the cell in the row containing the name of the measuring point.
² Click the arrow keys to the right of the cell.
The value shown in the cell will be incremented or decremented in defined states.
Taking over the Final Value of the Previous State as a Starting Value for the Current State
² Select the state to be processed with the list box in the 22.7.10 Toolbar Editor Test-Sequences.
²
Click the button in the toolbar of the Test-sequences editor.
The final values of the previous state are taken over as starting values for the selected state.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.5 Configuring Analog Test Signals for Measuring Points
² 13.3.9 Setting the Value of Binary Input Signals
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
² 13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
The 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor provides a ramp function. With the ramp function, within a state either the
magnitude, the phase angle, or the frequency of an analog test signal is gradually increased or decreased. This
is done by defining the step duration and a delta value. As soon as the step duration has elapsed, the value of
the selected setting (magnitude, phase angle, or frequency) will be incremented or decremented by the
step value. This process is performed repeatedly until the state duration has elapsed.
To increment a value, enter a positive state value. To decrement a value, enter a negative state value. You
cannot both increment and decrement a value at the same time within a state. For example, if you want first
to increment a value and then decrement it again, implement this behavior in 2 consecutive states.
You select one of the settings magnitude, phase angle, or frequency always for the measuring point and
therefore for all conductors of a measuring point. You can set a different state value for each analog test
signal. The step duration, on the other hand, applies to all analog test signals.
Proceed with configuring the step function in the following sequence:
• Select one of the settings Magnitude, Phase angle, or Frequency for the measuring point.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
If the value entered is permissible, it is accepted. If the entered value is outside the permissible range of
values, an error message appears. In this case, correct your entry.
- or -
² Click the arrow keys to the right of the text box.
The value shown in the text box will be incremented or decremented in defined states.
As well as the text box, the resulting step quantity is shown.
NOTE
i If the step duration is 0 ms, you cannot configure the ramp function. In this case, all analog signals remain
at its current value.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.5 Configuring Analog Test Signals for Measuring Points
² 13.3.9 Setting the Value of Binary Input Signals
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
² 13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
You can configure up to 3 harmonics for each analog test signal with the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor. A
harmonic is an integer multiple of a fundamental frequency. The harmonic exhibits a purely sinusoidal
progression over time.
You can influence the following settings for each harmonic:
• Magnitude
• Phase angle
• Factor
The factor denotes whether the harmonic is a 3rd-order harmonic or a 7th-order harmonic, for example. You
can configure numbers in the range 2 through 10.
All settings for the harmonic are summarized in the area Specify values for secondary analog-input signals
for this state. To show this area, click the arrow next to the name of the area. Within this area, the 3 settings
mentioned are summarized to a column range. Since you can set settings for 3 harmonics, 3 column ranges
are provided. After you have created a new state, the individual columns of a column range and therefore the
settings will be hidden. To show the individual columns, click the arrow next to the term Harmonic. The rele-
vant individual columns will then be shown.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.5 Configuring Analog Test Signals for Measuring Points
² 13.3.9 Setting the Value of Binary Input Signals
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
² 13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
You can define the value of each binary input signal within a state separately. To do this the 22.1.22 Test-
Sequences Editor contains a check box for each binary input which you can activate or deactivate.
If you want a binary input signal to have the value 1 first and then the value 0, implement this behavior using
2 consecutive states.
All check boxes for the binary inputs are summarized in the area Specify status of binary-input signals for
this state. To show this area, click the arrow next to the name of the area.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
² 13.3.5 Configuring Analog Test Signals for Measuring Points
² 13.3.1 Configuring States for the Test Sequence
² 13.3.10 Saving Settings of a Test Sequence in a File
You can store the settings of all states of a test sequence with the 22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor regardless of
the usual project data in one of the external files. The settings are saved in the CSV(Comma Separated Values)
format. With this format, data is generated to a file row by row, separated by semicolons. Most of the spread-
sheet programs can open the files in CSV format. Therefore you have the possibility of documenting and
archiving the test sequences.
Saving settings
²
Click the button in the 22.7.10 Toolbar Editor Test-Sequences.
Related Topics
² 13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
USB Interface
With USB interface in the on-site operation panel of the base module, it is possible to connect to every modern
PC. The USB interface is used to exchange local data bi-directionally between the SIPROTEC 5 device and DIGSI
5. For this, connect the notebook on which DIGSI 5 is installed and the SIPROTEC 5 device using a conventional
USB cable.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
Plug-in modules for serial or Ethernet-based communication ensure flexibility in terms of system communica-
tion. The modules are available in various optical and electrical versions. Each module has its own processor
with its own firmware. This means that the communication applications are strictly separated from the
remaining applications such as protection or control. The communication modules are not bound to a definite
protocol or communication application. Instead you can select a protocol to suit your requirements, configure
it and load it to the module with DIGSI 5.
You find more information about configuration of communication protocols in the respective manuals. For the
configuration of DNP, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, and IEC 61850, you will find additional information
in the specific manuals.
Related Topics
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.1.3 Communication Using Protection Interfaces
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
A protection interface enables data exchange between SIPROTEC 5 devices using synchronous, serial point-to-
point connections. You can use such connections for differential protection or transmission of other data, for
instance. You can configure each optical version of the serial communication module as a protection interface.
As each SIPROTEC 5 device can be equipped with each communication module, all device types can be fitted
with a protection interface in SIPROTEC 5. At the same time, you can select whether the interface is to be used
for differential protection or for the transmission of data between SIPROTEC 5 devices. The SIPROTEC 5 devices
7SD8 and 7SL8 can also transmit other data in addition to the differential protection application.
An effective topology consists of 2 to 6 SIPROTEC 5 devices. These exchange indications, measured values,
and other protection data including the necessary time synchronization using the protection interface. The
connection is continuously monitored for data faults and failure, and the delay time of the data is also meas-
ured.
An effective connection can result directly between 2 SIPROTEC 5 devices. Alternatively, you can also imple-
ment ring topologies and chain structures. A ring topology tolerates the outage of one communication
connection. The communication then continues using the remaining sequence.
You can typically use an existing communication network as a transmission medium. However, Siemens
recommends optical connections using fiber optical cables. Therefore, you can bridge distances up to 100 km
and reach transmission rates up to 2 MBit/s.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
Many substation automation protocols, for example, IEC 61850, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus TCP, PROFINET IO,
or DNP 3 TCP are transmitted using Ethernet. DIGSI 5 also uses Ethernet as a mode of communication. With a
degree of dispersion of more than 90 %, Ethernet is the most modern type of connection between computers
and their peripherals in a local network. Ethernet is therefore the current mainstream communication
medium.
Compatibility
Selecting Ethernet as a transmission medium gives you access to a reasonably priced product range and often
to an existing infrastructure as well. Ethernet is also backwards and forwards compatible. Thus a 10-MBit
network can be integrated in a 100-MBit network and the latter in a 1 GBit network.
Flexible Cabling
A further advantage is the simple and standardized cabling in comparison to the use of parallel transmission
routes. A mixture of different conductor technologies is also possible: Electrical or optical, coaxial cables,
twisted-pair cables, or optical fibers. Optical fibers and shielded CAT-5 cables fulfill all the high EMC require-
ments for applications in substation control and protection equipment.
Unique Addressing
Each SIPROTEC 5 device is given its own IP address so that the individual users can communicate with one
another within a subnetwork. Every other user can address the SIPROTEC 5 device using this. The IP address is
unique within a subnetwork. However, SIPROTEC 5 devices can also communicate with one another in
different subnetworks. The subnetworks are connected using routers for this. Both subnetworks and routers
also receive unique addresses.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
With SIPROTEC 5, a communication module is not bound to a particular communication protocol. Instead, you
can select between a number of communication protocols. For Ethernet interfaces, you can also activate
several network protocols in addition to the main communication protocol. The following overview provides
some basic information on the available protocols.
• DNP3
SIPROTEC 5 supports DNP3 for both serial and Ethernet-based data transmission. That means you can also
use DNP3 in an optical Ethernet ring. In the same way as IEC 60870-5-103, DNP3 can also be operated
redundantly, either on a single serial communication module or with 2 separate serial modules. DNP3 is
also suitable for the transmission of UTC (Universal Coordinated Time). The time information communi-
cated using the bus is then converted to local time in the SIPROTEC 5 devices.
• Synchrophasor
The synchrophasor process measures complex voltage and current phasors simultaneously at various
locations and then compares these. The process only provides reliable statements if the measurement is
actually performed simultaneously. The synchrophasor process thus uses the 1-second pulse as a time
reference. GPS provides this pulse with an accuracy of 1 µs. SIPROTEC 5 devices transmit these values
using Ethernet to a data concentrator, which saves and evaluates the synchrophasors of different
SIPROTEC 5 devices.
• IEC 60870-5-103
SIPROTEC 5 fully supports the IEC 60870-5-103 serial protocol. With SIPROTEC 5, you can now also
change protection settings directly using the communication protocol. You do not need DIGSI 5 for this.
Redundant operation with IEC 60870-5-103 is also new. For this, configure the communication protocol
either on both channels of a communication module, or use 2 separate communication modules.
• Modbus TCP
SIPROTEC 5 supports the Modbus TCP protocol. Modbus TCP can run in parallel to IEC 61850 (for
example, GOOSE) on one Ethernet module. 2 independent Modbus TCP masters are allowed and 1
Ethernet module in the device can be configured with the Modbus TCP protocol option.
• PROFINET IO
SIPROTEC 5 supports the PROFINET IO protocol. Only 1 Ethernet module in the device can be configured
with the PROFINET IO protocol option. Apart from the signal types supported in the earlier versions (SPS,
DPS, SPC, DPC, and MV), DIGSI 5 V7.50 supports the following signal types for PROFINET IO:
– BCR
– APC
– BSC
• SUP-Ethernet
This protocol is used to connect the external RTD units or 20-mA units to a SIPROTEC 5 device via
Ethernet. This proprietary protocol based on a Modbus protocol request works only with the special units
provided by Siemens as an accessory equipment.
• IEC 61850-8-1
IEC 61850 covers the process, field, and station level as the station-control protocol and defines compre-
hensively the data exchange between devices within a switchgear. Here the individual participants
communicate between the levels or using GOOSE (Generic Object Oriented Substation Event) on one
level.
The GOOSE service enables rapid data exchange between devices and can therefore replace the cross-
wiring between devices by communication connections. As another IEC 61850 service, SIPROTEC 5
supports the static or dynamic reporting. The greatest benefit of IEC 61850 is the seamless interopera-
bility of devices of different type and origin.
SIPROTEC 5 supports Edition 1, Edition 2, and Edition 2 of IEC 61850. In fact, the internal data model
used in a SIPROTEC 5 device is based on IEC 61850.
• 9-2 Client
The process-bus client allows a subscription of current and voltage signals published by a merging unit
(MU) complying with the IEC 61850-9-2 and IEC 61869-9 standard.
• 9-2 Merg.Unit
The process-bus merging unit allows a publishing of current and voltage signals on a process-bus
network according to IEC 61850-9-2 and IEC 61869-9 standard.
Redundancy
• Line
Line is used for a direct connection to an Ethernet switch. One or 2 ports can be connected. If 2 ports are
used, they must be connected to different switches.
• RSTP
The Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP) serves for reorganization of the network structure in the event
of a system incident. In other words, RSTP reroutes the data to another path after the failure of a network
path.
• PRP
The Parallel Redundancy Protocol (PRP) is used for highly available Ethernet networks. A parallel network
structure is supported and data is sent and received over both networks. Data duplicates are removed by
the device. The number of devices is limited to 512.
• HSR
The High Availability Seamless Redundancy Protocol (HSR) is used for ring networks. There is no reconfi-
guring time due to loss of one connection with HSR. It allows to build high available ring network struc-
tures up to 50 per ring and 512 in total in the network.
Network Protocols
Network protocols perform certain tasks within an Ethernet network. The network protocol SNTP is typically
responsible for the time synchronization.
You can activate one or more of the following network protocols separately for each Ethernet interface:
• DHCP
The Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol (DHCP) is activated if the IP address is set to 0.0.0.0. In this
case, the IP address of the Ethernet interface is given by a DHCP server in the network.
• DCP
The Discovery and Basic Configuration Protocol (DCP) is used for automatic recognition of devices
without a configured IP address. DIGSI 5 can find all SIPROTEC 5 devices in the network using DCP.
• SNTP
The Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) synchronizes the date and time in a network. An SNTP timer
which provides the binding date and binding time is necessary for this. The connected devices access this
timer using the network and set their clocks accordingly. SIPROTEC 5 devices support the redundant time
query using 2 independent timers.
• SNMP
The Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is used for network supervision. SIPROTEC 5 devices
use special variables for network supervision that can be used to monitor the network continuously. This
data is accessible as MIB files. The secure version 3 of SNMP is used.
• IEEE 1588
The IEEE 1588 protocol is used for time synchronization through network communication. IEEE 1588 is
available in all Ethernet communication modules as a time receiver (slave only clock, one-step, two-step).
A runtime measurement (IEEE Standard Profile for use of IEEE 1588TM Precision Time Protocol in power-
system applications) is not supported. The direct Ethernet transport through Multicast Ethernet MAC
address according to Annex F of the standard IEEE 1588 is used (Annex F Transport of PTP over IEEE
802.3 /Ethernet). The reception of frames with the IEEE 802.1Q flag (VLAN tag, only single tagged) is
supported.
Service Protocols
• Homepage
The homepage for communication modules is used for diagnostic purposes. On the homepage, you can
find information on the communication module as well as the network and communication protocols
that run on the communication modules.
The homepage is physically accessible using a Web browser via external Ethernet interfaces, for example,
http://<Module-IP>:Port. The following list provides the port-configuration details:
– Port J: http://IP:8080
– Port E: http://IP:8081
– Port F: http://IP:8082
– Port N: http://IP:8083
– Port P: http://IP:8084
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
The 22.1.6 Network View shows the front views of all SIPROTEC 5 devices in the project. Colored squares mark
the Ethernet interfaces of a SIPROTEC 5 device. These interfaces can be connected to one another by drag and
drop. In this way, you can establish different Ethernet-based communication connections between the
SIPROTEC 5 devices. The Ethernet interfaces connected to one another form a common subnetwork.
The following options are available to open the Network view:
• You can open the Network view with the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
• You can change to the Network view from the 22.1.7 Device View.
The Network view is shown in the working area for both alternatives.
Related Topics
² 14.2.2 Scaling the Network View
You can change the display size of the 22.1.6 Network View and hence adapt it to the relevant working situa-
tion.
The following options are available for scaling the view:
² Select a percentage.
- or -
² Enter an integral percentage value between 25 and 500 in the text box of the list box.
² Click outside the text box.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> key.
These 2 actions confirm your entry.
The Network plan is shown in the selected or entered percentage size.
Each Ethernet interface has an IP address. You can show or hide these IP addresses jointly for all interfaces in
the 22.1.6 Network View.
Showing IP Addresses
²
Click the button in the toolbar of the Network view.
Hiding IP Addresses
²
In the 22.7.4 Toolbar Network View, click the button.
Related Topics
² 14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
You can connect 2 Ethernet interfaces that are not yet connected to a subnetwork by dragging and dropping
in the 22.1.6 Network View. A new subnetwork is automatically created here. This new subnetwork connects
the interfaces to one another.
You can cancel the connection process at any time.
NOTE
i If you wish to exchange information between SIPROTEC 5 devices with the GOOSE Service, connect these
SIPROTEC 5 devices to one another using a subnetwork. Only then is the information concerning the rele-
vant SIPROTEC 5 devices displayed in the editors required for the GOOSE communication.
Canceling Connection
² Double-click a free area inside the Network view.
- or -
² Press the <Esc> key.
The connection process is canceled with these 2 actions.
Related Topics
² 14.2.5 Connecting an Interface to an Existing Subnetwork
You can connect an Ethernet interface to an existing subnetwork in the 22.1.6 Network View.
The following options are available for this:
NOTE
i If you wish to exchange information between SIPROTEC 5 devices with the GOOSE service, connect these
SIPROTEC 5 devices to one another using a subnetwork. Only then, the information concerning the relevant
SIPROTEC 5 devices is displayed in the editors required for the GOOSE communication.
If you position the mouse cursor over a suitable target this will show the networking symbol.
² Click the destination.
The interface and subnetwork are connected to one another. At the same time, the address settings of the
interface are automatically set consistently.
Related Topics
²
² 14.2.4 Connecting Interfaces Using a New Subnetwork
The following options are available in the 22.1.6 Network View to change connections between a subnetwork
and interfaces:
• You can delete a subnetwork. The links to all interfaces connected to this are deleted as a consequence.
Deleting a Subnetwork
² Right-click the name field of the subnetwork or on the line visualizing the subnetwork.
² Click Delete in the context menu.
A confirmation prompt is displayed.
² Click Yes if you wish to delete the subnetwork.
The subnetwork and the links to all interfaces connected to it are deleted.
If the IP protocol is used for communication using the Ethernet, all users must be correctly addressed. The
following addresses are relevant in this context:
• IP address
The IP address of a SIPROTEC 5 device must be unique within a subnetwork. If a SIPROTEC 5 device has
several Ethernet modules, each module must be given its own unique IP address. The integrated Ethernet
interface also requires its own IP address.
• Subnetwork mask
2 stations communicating with one another can use the subnetwork mask to determine whether they are
located in the same subnetwork or in different subnetworks. The IP addresses must have been assigned
consistently as a prerequisite for this.
• Router address
You require a router for the transition from one subnetwork to another. A router is treated as a normal
user and therefore also has a unique IP address. If a particular router is to be used for the communication,
indicate its IP address.
NOTE
i The IP address and router address have the format x.y.y.x (x = 1 to 254, y = 0 to 254). Subnetwork masks
have the format x.y.y.z (x = 1 to 255, y = 0 to 255, z = 0 to 254). At the same time, it must be noted that
not every possible combination is permissible within the value range. Impermissible exceptions are rejected
with a corresponding indication.
You can manually address a user. In this case, enter an IP address and an address for the subnetwork. If you
require a router, you also have to enter its address. The Ethernet addresses group must be visible in the
Inspector window and the IP protocol activated as a prerequisite.
Related Topics
² 14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
• You can open the device settings with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. The device settings are then displayed with
the 22.1.9 Settings Editor in the working area.
• If the 22.1.3 Single-Line tab or the 22.1.6 Network View tab is shown in the working area, you can use it
to open the device settings. The device-setting parameters are then displayed as properties in the
3.1.4 Inspector Window.
In the settings editor, all device-setting parameters are displayed. In the tab Properties only a partial quantity
of the settings are displayed.
Opening the Device Settings with the Single-Line Configuration or Network View
² Mark the single-line configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device, for which you want to select one of the
IP addresses.
- or -
² Mark the network view of the base module of the SIPROTEC 5 device, for which you want to select one of
the IP addresses.
² Open the Inspector window.
² Select the Properties tab.
² Go to the Settings group.
The settings of the device settings are displayed in the Properties tab.
Related Topics
² 14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
NOTE
i You cannot reverse a change of the functionality in the offline configuration. Before you change the func-
tionality, check whether your SIPROTEC 5 device supports the expanded functionality.
You cannot change the functionality from DIGSI 5 connection and IEC 61850 reporting to Only DIGSI 5
connection.
If you click Yes, the functionality is changed. The Integrated Ethernet interface list box is inactive. If you click
No, the functionality remains unchanged.
Related Topics
² 14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
² 14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
With SIPROTEC 5, a communication module is not bound to a particular communication protocol. Instead, you
can select among a number of protocols. Other settings are displayed as soon as you select a protocol. These
settings can be used to configure the communication protocol to suit your requirements.
You first have to mark the interface so that you can select a communication protocol. You can mark Ethernet
interfaces in both the 22.1.6 Network View and the 22.1.7 Device View. You can mark serial interfaces only in
the Device view.
NOTE
i If you cancel the protocol selection, all the settings for this protocol will be lost irrecoverably.
Related Topics
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
Network protocols perform certain tasks within an Ethernet network. You can activate one or more of the
following network protocols separately for each Ethernet interface:
• DCP
• SNMP
• SNTP
• IEEE 1588
If you select the network protocols SNTP or SNMP, further settings will be displayed. These settings can be
used to configure the network protocol to suit your requirements.
NOTE
i All services are deactivated for safety reasons. Activate these manually, if necessary. The Communication
manuals contain further information about configuring the network protocols.
Related Topics
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
• Line mode
• HSR
• PRP
• RSTP
NOTE
Related Topics
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
Related Topics
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
Timely recording of process data requires precise time synchronization of the devices. Every SIPROTEC 5 device
maintains an internal device time with date. Within a system, or even beyond, it is necessary to record the
time of process data accurately and to have exact time synchronization of all devices. You can meet this
requirement using parent, external time sources.
With SIPROTEC 5, you can select 2 time sources independent of each other for each device. In doing so, time
source 1 has priority over time source 2, for example, time source 2 is effective for synchronization of the
device time only if time source 1 fails. If only one time source is configured, the SIPROTEC 5 device will
continue, whose outage desynchronizes the internal time.
The time sources available with SIPROTEC 5 can be divided into the following types of synchronization:
• Internal
The SIPROTEC 5 device functions without any external time synchronization. The integrated data/time
synchronization allows the exact time mapping of events to an internally conducted device time. Internal
time synchronization is monitored cyclically.
A clock module internal to the device and having battery backup is synchronized cyclically with the
current device time so that the right device time is available and used even in case of auxiliary voltage
failure. At the same time, this permits hardware-supported supervision of the device time.
• Communication Protocol
The protocols, for example, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus TCP, PROFINET IO, or DNP 3
take over the time synchronization over the configured communication interfaces.
• Radio Clock
An internal IRIG-B- or DCF 77 receiver provides for time synchronization. These external times can be
connected to Port G of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Network Protocol
SNTP
The time synchronization is done over the Ethernet-based SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol), for
example with IEC 61850 stations. You can address 2 timers independent of each other, which feed their
time signals into the Ethernet network. The SNTP service must be enabled for the configuration of
Ethernet interfaces, so that it is available as an option for the time synchronization.
Inside the SNTP settings, if one IP address is set for the SNTP server, and the other IP address is set to
0.0.0.0, only one server is requested. If both the IP addresses are not set to zero, then the servers will be
requested 2 times. SNTP always gives UTC time. Local time will be calculated by the device.
IEEE 1588
For time synchronization through Ethernet systems, you can use the protocol IEEE 1588. In this case,
besides the clocks, all other power-system components must also support IEEE 1588, for example,
switches as transparent clock (TC) or boundary clock (BC).
There must be a timing master in the system. If there are several timing masters in the system, the actual
master is set according to the IEEE 1588 best-master-clock algorithm (BMC).
The actual timing master transmits the time using Ethernet multicast to the receivers. The SIPROTEC 5
device is such a receiver and subscribes to the multicast address while the IEEE 1588 option is activated.
The transmission can be done with or without VLAN tag.
and the state of the internal time keeping. Important synchronization processes, the status of the time sources
and faults detected are reported. A device time that has become invalid will be marked so that affected func-
tions can go to a safe state.
Related Topics
14.6.2 Time Sources
14.6.3 Processing Time Settings
14.6.4 Displaying Time Information
14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
14.6.6 Configuring Time Synchronization of the Protection Interface
14.6.7 Configuring Time Synchronization Using SNTP
You can select 2 time sources independent of each other for each SIPROTEC 5 device in the time settings.
Depending on the device and communication configuration, you have the following selection options:
• IRIG-B 002(003)
The control function bits of the signal are not occupied. The missing year is
formed from the current device time. In this case, it is possible to set the year via
the online access in DIGSI 5.
• IRIG-B 006(007)
The bits for the calendar year are not equal to 00. The calendar year is set auto-
matically by the time protocol.
• IRIG-B 005(004) with extension according to IEEE C37.118-2005
If in the time signal, other control function bits are occupied in addition to the
calendar year, then the SIPROTEC 5 device takes the additional information into
consideration for leap seconds, daylight saving time, time offset (zone, daylight
saving time), and time accuracy.
DCF77 An external DCF 77 receiver connected to port G takes on the time synchronization.
DCF 77 is only available in central Europe.
PI Inside a protection topology, one of the devices involved can take on time synchroni-
zation as a timing master. The time synchronization is done via the protection connec-
tions and the configured protection interfaces of the SIPROTEC 5 devices. Signal
runtimes of the protection communication are calculated automatically.
This time source is only available for selection under the following prerequisites:
Related Topics
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
14.6.3 Processing Time Settings
14.6.6 Configuring Time Synchronization of the Protection Interface
14.6.7 Configuring Time Synchronization Using SNTP
For each SIPROTEC 5 you can select 2 time sources independent of each other for each device. Depending on
device and communication configuration, you can select the various 14.6.2 Time Sources. In operation, time
source 1 has priority over time source 2, for example, time source 2 is effective for synchronization of the
device time only if time source 1 fails.
You can separately establish for each time source, whether their time zone corresponds to world time (UTC) or
the time zone of the device. To compare signal runtimes you can define a delay time for each time source,
which is added to the times received.
The date format can be adjusted. For the usual local representation of the date format, you have the following
options available:
• You can open the time settings with the 3.1.2 Project Tree. The time settings are then displayed with the
22.1.9 Settings Editor in the working area.
• If the matrix 22.3.2 Information Routing or the matrix 22.3.1 Communication Mapping is shown in the
working area, you can use it to open the time settings. The time-setting parameters are then displayed as
properties in the 3.1.4 Inspector Window.
In the settings editor, all time-setting parameters are displayed. In the tab Properties, only a partial quantity of
the settings is displayed.
NOTE
i Make sure that the settings for the time sources coincide with the actual hardware configuration of your
SIPROTEC 5 device. At any rate, misadjustments cause the status indications of time sources to respond.
NOTE
i SIPROTEC 5 devices automatically consider, in the formation of the internal device time in UTC format, if
time sources transfer the status of daylight saving time switching. In doing so, the daylight-saving time
differential time is considered in the SIPROTEC 5 device. However, in contrast, the settings of Start of
daylight saving time and End of daylight saving time are ignored when converting into the device
internal UTC format.
Related Topics
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.6.4 Displaying Time Information
² 14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
If DIGSI 5 online is connected to a SIPROTEC 5 device, you can read and display information on the time
synchronization from the device. Part of this information is, for example, the configured type of time source
and the status of time synchronization. All information displayed is constantly updated.
NOTE
i All times displayed, also those of the time sources, take into consideration the local time settings (zone and
daylight saving time of the device) in the form of a numerical offset for UTC (World time).
Related Topics
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 14.6.3 Processing Time Settings
If DIGSI 5 online is connected to a SIPROTEC 5 device, you can set the date and time in the device. You find the
controls for setting in the tab 22.5.8 Time Information.
Related Topics
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.6.4 Displaying Time Information
² 14.6.3 Processing Time Settings
All devices of a topology can be time-synchronized with one another. In this way, all events in the devices of
the protection topology are recorded with the same time and are time-synchronized even across different
substations. This simplifies fault analysis and the fault records are taken with the same timestamp in all
devices.
The synchronization is done precisely to the millisecond directly over the protection connections. The synchro-
nization works independently of the protection function and is exclusively for simultaneous time-keeping in
the devices of a protection topology.
The device with the lowest device index, such as device 1 in the protection topology, is the timing master. If
the timing master is logged off and switched off, the device with the next highest device index takes on the
function of the timing master.
The timing master synchronizes the clocks of the other devices of this topology via the protection links. The
time of the timing master is, for example, synchronized over a network protocol such as SNTP or through a
timer connected to Port G. To do that, you must set the corresponding time source as the 1st time source in
the timing master. Optionally, you can also select a 2nd time source, which takes over time-keeping if the 1st
time source fails. In the other devices of protection topology, set the protection interface as the 1st time
source.
NOTE
i You find additional information on time synchronization in the Device manual in chapter System functions
> Protection-data communication.
Related Topics
² 14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.6.2 Time Sources
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
The Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) synchronizes the date and time in a network. An SNTP time server
which provides date and time is necessary for it. The connected devices access this timer using the Ethernet
network and set their clocks accordingly. SIPROTEC 5 devices support the redundant time query using 2 inde-
pendent SNTP time server.
Proceed in the following sequence:
• For the SIPROTEC 5 device, activate and configure the SNTP protocol.
• In the time settings, select SNTP as the time source. You find more information about this under
14.6.7 Configuring Time Synchronization Using SNTP.
Related Topics
² 14.6.2 Time Sources
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
For time synchronization through Ethernet systems, you can use the IEEE 1588 protocol. Runtimes and oper-
ating times in the components are transmitted within the protocol. These correction times can be considered
in the end device and improve the time synchronization of the end devices. IEEE 1588 is deactivated by
default. If time synchronization should be done using IEEE 1588, you must activate the IEEE 1588 check box of
the Ethernet communication module. IEEE 1588 is not available for the integrated Ethernet interface.
Related Topics
² 14.6.2 Time Sources
² 14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
A protection-data communication from SIPROTEC 5 enables data exchange between SIPROTEC 5 devices using
synchronous, serial point-to-point connections. You use such connections typically for the differential protec-
tion or with the teleprotection method for distance protection and ground-fault protection. The protection-
data communication comprises all functionalities required to exchange data via the protection interface. In
this, SIPROTEC 5 manages up to 2 protection interfaces for each device. In SIPROTEC 5 you can configure
protection connections in all devices and then use them for further protection applications. At the same time,
any binary information and measured values can be transferred between devices.
NOTE
i You will find additional information on protection-data communication in the Device manual, in chapter
System functions > Protection-data communication.
• Topology recognition
The Topology recognition component determines the protection topology of a device connection, such
as the way in which the devices are connected to each other. The communication is controlled on this
basis.
• Remote data
If you route a signal or a measured value to the protection interfaces, the Remote data component is
created. The protection interface then attends to sending and receiving this remote data. The available
bandwidth determines the maximum quantity of remote data.
A connection is automatically created between the protection-data communication and the Line function
group. Binary signals, measured values, and other data are automatically exchanged using this connection.
• Topology data and values are exchanged for monitoring and testing the link.
• Protection data, for example, differential protection data or binary data of the signal-transmission
method, is transmitted for distance protection and ground-fault protection.
A time synchronization of the devices is possible directly over the protection connection, whereby a device of
the protection topology assumes the role of the timing master.
Related Topics
14.7.2 Inserting a Communication Module in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
14.7.3 Configuring the Communication Channel as a Protection Interface
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
14.7.5 Mapping Signals for Protection Interface
14.6.6 Configuring Time Synchronization of the Protection Interface
To prepare a SIPROTEC 5 device for protection communication, you must insert at least one suitable communi-
cation module in the offline configuration of the device. To do that, you can use all the serial communication
modules in the optical version. You can recognize these communication modules by their model description
USART and by the name extension FO. Some of these communication modules have 2 communication chan-
nels. On such communication modules you can configure 2 protection interfaces.
To insert a communication module use the 22.1.7 Device View with the tab 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog. Open
the Device view for the offline configuration of the relevant SIPROTEC 5 device. All the available communica-
tion modules are found in the tab Hardware catalog. Communication modules can be placed at the plug-in
module position E and the plug-in module position F of the base module and at the plug-in module position N
and the plug-in module position P of the extension module CB202.
NOTE
i You may be able to plug up to 4 serial communication modules into 1 SIPROTEC 5 device, However, you
can only configure a total of 2 communication channels as protection interface.
NOTE
i You find other options for opening the Device view under 6.3.2 Opening the Device View.
² Select the needed communication module and drag this with the mouse button held down to the needed
plug-in module position on the Device view.
If insertion is not allowed at this position, the mouse pointer changes to a crossed-out circle.
² Release the mouse button at a permissible position.
The communication module is placed on the selected plug-in module position.
NOTE
i You find more possibilities for inserting a communication module or another hardware component under
6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware Catalog.
Related Topics
² 14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication
² 14.7.3 Configuring the Communication Channel as a Protection Interface
You can configure up to 2 communication channels of a SIPROTEC 5 device as protection interface. To do this,
select the protocol Protection interface for the communication channel(s). Both communication channels
can be on a single communication module or on 2 separate communication modules. As soon as you have
configured 2 communication channels as a protection interface, this option is deactivated for the communica-
tion channels of the other modules plugged in.
For each communication channel established as a protection interface, you then have to select a constellation,
for example, 3 device prot. communication. With this selection you establish how many devices are taking
part in the protection communication. If you change the constellation to another communication channel, the
constellation of the other communication channel is also automatically changed. As soon as you have selected
a constellation for a communication channel, the other settings with which you can parameterize the commu-
nication channel to fit your requirements are shown.
NOTE
i If you change the constellation, all settings for the protection communication are reset to default values. In
the process, the communication mapping created for the constellation selected previously is deleted.
To configure a communication channel as a protection interface, use the 22.1.7 Device View with the Proper-
ties window. Open the Device view for the offline configuration of the relevant SIPROTEC 5 device.
NOTE
i You find other options for opening the Device view under 6.3.2 Opening the Device View.
² Open the Protocols group and select a communication protocol from the protocol channel group, such
as Channel 1 Protocols or Channel 2 Protocols.
² Select Protection interface from the Protocols list box.
² Select the suitable constellation for the protection communication from the Mapping list box, so that is
the number of accessing devices. If you have already configured another communication channel, select
the same constellation as for this other communication channel.
Other settings are shown under the Settings group by which you can configure the protection communica-
tion. These settings are summarized into the following groups:
Changing Constellation
² Display, as described in the first section, the group for the needed communication channel.
² Select another constellation from the Mapping list box.
Related Topics
² 14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication
² 14.7.2 Inserting a Communication Module in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
As soon as you have selected a constellation for a communication channel, other settings are shown. With
these parameters, you can configure the protection-data communication for this communication channel.
NOTE
i You find additional information on protection-data communication in the Device manual, in chapter
System functions > Protection-data communication.
NOTE
i You find other options for opening the Device view under 6.3.2 Opening the Device View.
Related Topics
² 14.7.5 Mapping Signals for Protection Interface
² 14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication
Between the devices of a protection topology, a data bar is exchanged which can be written or read by the
devices. This data bar is for exchanging various signals between the devices. To do this, the data bar has indi-
vidual data fields. In this case, a data field corresponds to 1 bit. Depending on its type, each signal accepts a
certain number of data fields and therefore bits.
The data bar is divided into 3 priority levels. The priority level decides on how often it is transmitted.
• Priority level 1
Signals in the priority level 1 are sent with each telegram, that is, at least every 20 ms (at 64 kBit/s).
Priority level 1 is therefore preferably used for the transmission of fast signals, for example, release for
breaker intertripping. A strictly deterministic, fast transmission is required there.
• Priority level 2
Signals of priority level 2 are transmitted with at least every 2nd telegram. For bit rates greater than
256 kBit/s there are no transmission differences between priority 1 and priority 2.
• Priority level 3
Signals in priority level 3 are transmitted at least every 100 ms. This priority level is used for the transmis-
sion of measured and metered values or slow binary events.
Each priority level has a different number of data fields. The number of data fields depends on the value of the
parameter Lowest appearing bit rate. You find this setting in the group 21.6.4 Device Combination Settings.
NOTE
i You will find additional information for mapping the signals in the Device manual, in chapter System func-
tions > Protection-data communication.
NOTE
i You will find further information for routing signals under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
² 14.7.1 Overview of the Protection-Data Communication
Phasor measurement is a measurement method for energy systems. With this method, Phasor Measurement
Units (PMU) measure complex voltage and current phasors, even in large and widely distributed networks,
simultaneously at various locations. The PMUs transfer these values via Ethernet to a Phasor Data Concentrator
(PDC) that stores and evaluates the phasors of different PMUs.
Time Synchronization
Only when the measurement is carried out simultaneously, the phasor measurement method delivers reliable
information. For that reason, the method phasor measurement requires exact time synchronization with GPS.
The high accurate pulse per second (PPS) is required, which is provided by special GPS receivers together with
the IRIG-B telegram. Also, a separate PPS input can be used on time synchronization port G.
To receive the GPS signal, you use a GPS receiver that supports the time quality characteristics defined in the
synchrophasor standard IEEE C37.118. You connect the receiver to the SIPROTEC 5 device via the time-
synchronization interface.
Data Communication
The phasor measurement communication is a Client-Server communication. Here, the PDC works as client and
the PMU, that is, the SIPROTEC 5 device, as server. The PDC switches on the measured data transmission of the
PMU, requests the configuration and receives the measured data.
After the successful connection of a PDC to the PMU and after querying the PMU configuration data, the PDC
starts the transfer of the synchrophasor data by sending an ON command to the PMU.
The PMU transfers the following data to the PDC:
• Frequency
In addition, the PMU transfers the channel names of the routed measuring points. The relevant PMU function
group generates these names itself. You cannot change these names.
The PMU transfers the data to the PDC continuously with the parameter-assignable reporting rate. Switching
off the PDC or an interruption of the communication connection ends the data transmission.
Related Topics
14.8.2 Inserting and Configuring a Communication Module
14.8.3 Setting the Phasor Measurement Units
14.8.4 Connecting Measuring Points to PMU Function Group
To prepare a SIPROTEC 5 device for phasor measurement, you must insert at least one suitable communication
module in the offline configuration of the device. To do that, you can use all the Ethernet communication
modules.
You can recognize these communication modules by their model description.
NOTE
i If you change the communication protocol, all settings for PMU are reset to default values.
NOTE
i You find more possibilities for inserting a communication module or another hardware component under
6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware Catalog.
Related Topics
² 14.8.1 Overview of Phasor Measurement
² 14.8.3 Setting the Phasor Measurement Units
² 14.8.4 Connecting Measuring Points to PMU Function Group
When selecting the protocol IEEEC37.118PMU for a communication module, other parameters are displayed.
With these parameters, you can set the PMU for this communication channel. These parameters are summar-
ized into the 21.6.16 PMUx group.
Related Topics
² 14.8.1 Overview of Phasor Measurement
² 14.8.2 Inserting and Configuring a Communication Module
² 14.8.4 Connecting Measuring Points to PMU Function Group
When you select the IEEEC37.118 protocol for an Ethernet communication module, a function group of the
type PMU is automatically generated. Each configured PMU is represented by its own function group in the
application of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
To transfer the measured values through Ethernet interface, you must connect measuring points to the PMU
function groups belonging to the interface.
You can connect the maximum following measuring points to 1 PMU function group:
• If needed, expand the offline configuration with additional I/O modules, using the 22.1.7 Device View.
You find more information about this under 6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware
Catalog.
• If needed, add additional measuring points to the application, using the 22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing
matrix. You find more information about this under 8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points.
• With the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix, connect the PMU function groups to the measuring
points.
In the 22.3.5 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Group window of the Function-group connec-
tions matrix, every measuring point is represented by a line. Each PMU function group is displayed by a
column. When you route a measuring point to a PMU function group, the measuring point and the PMU
function group are connected to each other. The detailed procedure is described in the following section.
² Repeat this process for all other measuring points to be connected and the PMU function groups.
As soon as the measuring points are correctly routed, the color-highlighting of the cells is hidden.
Related Topics
² 14.8.1 Overview of Phasor Measurement
² 14.8.2 Inserting and Configuring a Communication Module
² 14.8.3 Setting the Phasor Measurement Units
With communication mapping, you establish for serial protocols which signals will be transmitted over the
communication interfaces of a SIPROTEC 5 device. Depending on your model, you can also route signals in the
send or receive direction for each individual communication type. You also have to set mapping settings for
each signal routed, for example, the information number or the function type in the communication protocol
DNP3, IEC 60870-5-103, IEC 60870-5-104, Modbus TCP, and PROFINET IO.
To simplify engineering, you can select a default communication mapping for each communication channel.
Routings for signals and settings for mapping settings are defined in a default communication mapping. You
can accept these routings and settings or adapt them to your specific requirements.
You edit the communication mapping of a SIPROTEC 5 device with the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping
matrix. The Communication mapping matrix is a device-oriented tool. A separate communication-mapping
matrix is available for each offline configuration present in a project.
Related Topics
14.9.2 Selecting a Default Communication Mapping
14.9.3 Opening the Communication Mapping Matrix
14.9.5 Routing Signals for Communication
14.9.6 Setting Mapping Settings
14.9.7 Copying Settings for Mapping Settings
Routings for signals and mapping settings are defined in a default communication mapping. Regardless of the
communication protocol selected, DIGSI 5 provides you with various default communication mappings.
When you select a default communication mapping, the predefined routings and settings are automatically
accepted into the communication mapping of the offline configuration. You can then change these routings
and settings using the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix.
The selection of a default communication mapping is optional. You can route signals and set mapping settings
using the Communication mapping matrix even without the default communication mapping. The number
of default communication mappings from which to select depends on the protocol selected.
To select a default communication mapping, first establish the communication protocol and to select the
default communication mapping, use the properties window in the 22.1.7 Device View for the relevant offline
configuration.
NOTE
i If you select a default communication mapping, this does not overwrite routings and settings already
present in the communication mapping. Instead, the default communication mapping extends the commu-
nication mapping already present with the predefined routings and settings.
NOTE
i You find other options for opening the Device view under 6.3.2 Opening the Device View.
Related Topics
² 14.9.5 Routing Signals for Communication
² 14.9.6 Setting Mapping Settings
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
Edit the communication mapping of a SIPROTEC 5 device using the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix.
You therefore route the signals in the send or receive direction and set the mapping settings.
Communication mappings are oriented to the device. Therefore, the communication mapping inside the
project structure is always assigned to the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
² 14.9.4 Adjusting the View of the Communication Mapping
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
The following standard functions are available to adapt the view of the communication mapping:
• DNP3
• IEC 60870-5-103
• IEC 60870-5-104
• PROFINET IO
• Modbus TCP
button .
If the signal numbers are hidden, your action shows the numbers. If the numbers are shown, your action hides
the numbers.
Related Topics
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
To transmit signals over a configured communication channel of the SIPROTEC 5 device, route these signals to
Receive or Transmit. You can do this in one of the following ways:
NOTE
i If you route a signal, set the mapping settings belonging to this signal. The cells of the relevant mapping
settings are highlighted in color in the Communication mapping matrix.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for routing signals under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
NOTE
i You find further possibilities for removing routings under 11.2 Basic Principles of Routing.
Related Topics
² 14.9.3 Opening the Communication Mapping Matrix
² 14.9.6 Setting Mapping Settings
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
If you route a transmission signal for the communication channel of a SIPROTEC 5 device, set the mapping
settings for this signal. Examples of this are the information number or the function type in the communica-
tion protocol IEC 60870-5-103. The mapping settings to be set are dependent on the communication protocol
selected for the relevant communication channel.
You can set the following protocol-specific mapping settings:
Some mapping settings can only accept defined values, for example, yes or no. For setting such settings, the
relevant cell contains a list box. Other settings are defined by a numerical value. For this settings, the relevant
cell contains a text box.
NOTE
i Additional information for setting the mapping settings is found in the respective Communication protocol
manual.
Related Topics
² 14.9.7 Copying Settings for Mapping Settings
² 14.9.5 Routing Signals for Communication
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
You can copy settings for mapping settings from a communication channel to another communication
channel. Both communication channels can also be configured in different offline configurations.
For copying and pasting, the following conditions apply:
• You can insert copied settings of a certain transmission direction (send or receive) only in the mapping
settings of the same transmission direction.
• You can copy settings from more than one column at the same time. However, the target area must
comprise the same columns as the source area.
• If you copy settings between 2 offline configurations, these offline configurations must belong to the
same SIPROTEC 5 device type.
Related Topics
² 3.2.6 Marking Ranges
² 14.9.6 Setting Mapping Settings
² 14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
14.10 VLAN
14.10.1 Overview
The Virtual Local Area Network (VLAN) is a data-link layer technology and standardized in IEEE 802.1Q. VLAN
allows separation of different communication traffic types (for example, process data, engineering or manage-
ment, voice calls, and video surveillance) sharing the physical links of the Ethernet network.
Regarding VLAN, SIPROTEC 5 supports the following protocols and technologies:
[dw_VLANSolutionExample, 2, en_US]
IP-Interface Settings
In DIGSI 5, you can configure the Ethernet communication module ETH-BD-2FO with IP-interface settings
under the General section of the Properties tab.
[sc_VLANSettings, 1, en_US]
If the Obtain an IP address automatically (from DHCP server) is marked, the IP address and
default gateway IP address, the Subnet mask, are assigned by the DHCP (Dynamic Host Configuration Protocol)
server.
NOTE
i Make sure that each module is only assigned to 1 default gateway IP address.
VLAN settings are deactivated by default. You can activate the VLAN settings by marking the Use VLAN tag
check box.
[sc_VLANSettingsEnabled, 1, en_US]
You can configure the size of the maximum transmission unit (MTU) on each Ethernet communication module
ETH-BD-2FO.
[sc_MTUSizeSettings, 1, en_US]
Each IP interface can be configured independently. The IP interfaces must belong to separate, non-overlapping
IP subnetworks (determined by the IP address and subnet mask). If you have set the parameter VLAN Mode to
Tagged, each IP interface must have a separate VLAN ID.
Either 1 and only 1 IP interface can have the Use VLAN tag parameter unchecked or 1 and only 1 IP inter-
face can have the VLAN Mode parameter set to Priority-tagged.
[sc_IPInterfacesSettings, 1, en_US]
[dw_IPRouteApplication, 1, en_US]
In DIGSI 5, you can configure the static IP route settings under the General section of the Properties tab.
After the default gateway IP address in the IP interface section is assigned by the gateway configuration or
DHCP, you can configure the static IP routes.
You can configure up to 10 static IP routes besides the default route set in the gateway address of the inter-
face.
[sc_IPRouteSettings, 1, en_US]
The IP settings and VLAN settings are configured in the Hardware and protocols Editor in DIGSI 5.
You can configure the Ethernet communication modules ETH-BD-2FO with IP settings and VLAN settings in
DIGSI 5.
IP-Interface Assignment
If you have defined multiple IP interfaces on the communication module ETH-BD-2FO, you can assign the
IP interface to one or several server protocols. It is not necessary to assign the IP interface to client protocols.
The IP interface is selected automatically by the module for client protocols (for example, SNTP, Syslog,
RADIUS, MQTT).
² Select the communication module ETH-BD-2FO in the Device view.
² Select the Properties tab.
² In the lower Editor section, under General, select the Protocols entry.
The following figure shows the assignment using the IEC 61850-8-1 as an example.
[sc_IPInterfaceAssignment, 1, en_US]
² Under the Communication section, check the IEC 61850-8-1 check box.
² Select the desired IP Interface for the IEC 61850-8-1 protocol.
NOTE
i You can configure static IP routes only when the default gateway address has been configured at IP inter-
face 1 or any IP interface has been configured with DHCP.
NOTE
i If destination networks must be reached via multiple next-hop routers (and not only via the single default
gateway), the static IP routes are needed.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
² 5.1.4 Converting a Project
NOTE
i You can add only 1 IEC station per project in DIGSI with a maximum number of 200 devices. You cannot
cut, copy, or paste an IEC station.
Related Topics
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
² 18.1.6 SCD
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
NOTE
i The IEC station name must be unique and the maximum allowed character limit is 128 characters. This
name is used as the default IEC station name if a new System configurator project is created and it is not
synchronized between the IEC 61850 System configurator and DIGSI 5.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 21.1.2 IEC 61850 Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
• Correction and clarity in the event of misunderstandings and interoperability problems that are docu-
mented in the Tissue database.
• Functional extensions in the engineering process, especially when exchanging configuration data
between system configuration tools.
• Stronger test of SCL files during import. This test is implemented using another special SCL scheme.
• Extension of test equipment capabilities (data tracking and monitoring functions), device models, and
character strings.
• Extension of the data model in terms of statistics data, power quality, conditional monitoring, hydro-
power, distributed energy resources, wind power, and communication between substations.
• You have not yet changed the default setting in the IEC station properties.
• You select the IEC 61850 protocol within the current project for the first time for a communication
channel.
Related Topics
² 14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
² 10.1 Overview
² 21.1.2 IEC 61850 Station
NOTE
i The Available devices group displays the list of devices that provide the IEC communication (can be set in
the properties of a communication module) and that have the correct IEC edition (an Edition 1 device can
be added to an edition 1 or 2 station, an edition 2 device can be added to an edition 2 station).
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i The following devices would be displayed under the Available devices group:
• For an IEC station with Edition 1, only devices with Edition 1 are displayed.
• For an IEC station with Edition 2, devices with Edition 1 and Edition 2 are displayed.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i The GOOSE configuration of the device is also deleted if you remove its assignment with the respective
IEC station.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i The GOOSE configuration of all the devices in the respective IEC station is also deleted.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
² 18.1.6 SCD
NOTE
i For additional information regarding IEC 61850 system configuration, select Help topics from the Help
menu or press the <F1> key to open the IEC 61850 System Configurator manual.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i While exporting the changes from DIGSI 5 to the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool, the IP address config-
ured in DIGSI 5 is not taken over into the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool. The IP addresses are taken
into DIGSI 5 only while importing the changes from the IEC 61850 Configurator tool.
NOTE
i You can export an IEC 61850 station configuration from DIGSI 5 to the System Configurator, even if there is
an opened instance of the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool.
NOTE
i When an IEC 61850 change is done in DIGSI5, only the export functionality to the IEC 61850 System
Configurator is possible and the options Export changes to IEC 61850 System Configurator and Export
all devices to IEC 61850 System Configurator are enabled. The options Import changes from IEC 61850
System Configurator and Import all devices from IEC 61850 System Configurator are enabled only after
synchronization with the SCD.
• Export changes to IEC 61850 System Configurator: Selecting this option exports the modified devices
(only with IEC changes) added in the IEC station to the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
• Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator: Selecting this option imports the modified
devices from the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
• Export all devices to IEC 61850 System Configurator: Selecting this option exports all the devices (irre-
spective of the IEC changes) added in the IEC station to the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
• Import all devices from IEC 61850 System Configurator: Selecting this option imports all the devices
from the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station
² 15.11 Associating a System Configurator Project with the DIGSI 5 IEC Station
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i To achieve full project synchronization between SCD and DIGSI engineering, you must import the SCD
changes (of the IEC 61850 System Configurator) before doing IEC 61850-relevant changes. Otherwise,
dataset engineering can be synchronized incorrectly and can be lost.
You can perform the following functions using the System Configurator tool:
• Create an SCL file containing the entire station configuration (SCD file)
For additional information regarding the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool, select Help topics from the
Help menu or press the <F1> key to open the IEC 61850 System Configurator manual.
Transferring the IEC 61850 System Configurator Project Configuration to a DIGSI 5 IEC station
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree that contains IEC stations.
² Double-click the IEC 61850 stations folder in the project tree.
The element Add new station along with the list of IEC stations is displayed.
² Right-click any IEC station (for example, IEC station 1) that is already associated with IEC system configu-
rator project.
² Click Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator in the context menu.
The information regarding success or failure of the complete import is displayed.
NOTE
i The IEC station in DIGSI 5 should be associated with the System Configurator project. In order to provide a
convenient way of exchanging information between DIGSI 5 and the IEC System Configurator, a feedback
message under the Inconsistencies tab in DIGSI 5 indicates whether any change in the configuration in
System Configurator tool has synchronized back into DIGSI 5. This feedback message indicates to reimport
the configuration from the IEC 61850 System Configurator tool to DIGSI 5.
Related Topics
² 15.1 Viewing the IEC Stations Node in DIGSI 5
² 15.3 Opening an IEC Station
² 15.2 Adding an IEC Station
² 15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station
² 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator Project
² 5.1.1 Overview of Projects
² 3.1.2 Project Tree
NOTE
i When opening the converted DIGSI project, a dialog appears to attach the IEC Station to the new System
Configurator project. If you click Ok, the IEC station is attached to the System Configurator project. If you
click Cancel, DIGSI closes the project.
² Associate the previously created System Configurator project with the newly created IEC Station.
² Import the data (SCD file) to the current version of DIGSI 5 using the IEC station context menu option
Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator.
Related Topics
² 5.1.4 Converting a Project
² 15.11 Associating a System Configurator Project with the DIGSI 5 IEC Station
² 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator Project
² 15.13 Transferring the IEC 61850 System Configurator Project Configuration to a DIGSI 5 IEC station
NOTE
i Later binding is possible only if you create GOOSE with the configuration version V07.50 or higher. To
change from the old system to the new system, you must delete the old GOOSE connection and create it
again with the configuration version V7.50 or higher.
NOTE
i If the IEC 61850 protocol with Edition 2 is not enabled in the device, the GOOSE column is not displayed in
the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor.
NOTE
i As long as the GOOSE inputs are not connected to a GOOSE source, you can decrease the number in the
GOOSE column.
You can see the External signal and its GOOSE source signal in the Properties section in the Received via
GOOSE from section.
² Save the project and export the changes to the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
The IEC Station Editor is displayed in the working area.
For additional information, refer to 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Config-
urator Project .
² In the IEC Station editor, click the Network tab from the toolbar.
The network view is displayed.
² Enter the desired IP address for the devices in the Subnets section.
² Click the GOOSE tab from the toolbar.
The GOOSE view is displayed.
² Right-click the IEC station in the GOOSE messages section and select GOOSE application from the
context menu.
A GOOSE application is created in the IEC station.
² Drag and drop the desired node from the Source catalog section to the GOOSE application.
² Drag and drop the desired node from the Destination catalog to the newly created dataset.
NOTE
i Only logical nodes or GOOSE inputs within a destination logical node are displayed in the Destination
catalog.
² In the Station menu, click Save and close the IEC Station editor.
² In DIGSI, double-click the IEC station from the project tree.
² Import the changes to the IEC 61850 system configurator.
For additional information, refer to 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Config-
urator Project .
² Double-click Information routing from the project tree.
The Information routing matrix is displayed in the working area.
² Double-click the desired source-device folder in the External Signals folder.
The assigned signals are displayed.
NOTE
i When a signal is assigned using the IEC Station Editor, it is moved from the Unassigned folder to the corre-
sponding source-device folder.
I11 Fix ICD file (no adaptable export needed) At least one (1) Not applicable - no fix
ICD
I12 Export of ICD file or IID file according to IED At least one (1) Yes
preconfiguration performed by tool
I13 State the data model name space M Yes, IEC 61850-7-4
(61850-7-3 subclause 7.2) within ICD file
(LLN0.NamPlt.ldNs value)
I14 State the data-model version (61850-7-3 M Yes, 2003, 2007
subclause 7.8.3) and any predefined/fixed
configuration values within ICD file
(9.5.4.4)
I15 Version 2003 export O Yes
I16 Version 2007B export GC_1 (2) For example, Yes, if at least Edition 2 is
2007 for this selected for the device
version
I17 Predefined datasets O Yes
I18 Predefined control blocks O Yes
I19 Substation bay template with IED part O Yes
I110 Communication section with default O Yes
address
I111 Export correct valKind value (Table 46) O Read-only, Yes
Configurable
I112 Exports internal addresses as InRef or Input O Yes
section (subclause 9.3.13)
I113 Exports internal addresses in Input section O Yes
with expected serviceType (subclause
9.3.13)
I114 Exports in UTF-8 coding M Other XML Yes, no other coding
codings?
SCD import M
• The respective FG/FN/FBs/Signals are available in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor:
[sc_digsi_comsupervision, 1, en_US]
• The corresponding LDs/LNs/DOs are available in the IEC 61850 structure Editor:
[sc_digsi_comsupervision_iec, 1, en_US]
Export the changes to the IEC 61850 System Configurator for further GOOSE-supervision configuration. For
more information about configuring GOOSE supervision in the IEC 61850 System Configurator, refer to the
respective manual.
Restrictions
• It is possible to move LGOS LNs to other LDs as long as they are currently not used.
• It is not possible to rename or delete the GOOSE Supervision LDs ComSupervision and ComSupervi-
sion_GOOSE independent of whether they have configured LGOS instances or not. They can only be
deleted by disabling the GOOSE Supervision.
• It is not possible to modify LGOS instances or their parents in DIGSI 5 as long as they contain an LGOS
configuration:
– It is not possible to delete LGOS instances (LDs /LNs /DOs/FGs/FNs/FBs).
– It is not possible to define the ldName property for the GOOSE Supervision LDs.
– It is not possible to change the prefix or the instance of an LGOS LN (lnClass cannot be changed
anyway since this LN is not user-defined).
– It is not possible to move an LGOS LN which is in use (is configured).
Related Topics
22.3.2 Information Routing
22.5.10 Device Settings
NOTE
i This chapter gives a short summary on configuring Process-bus systems with SIPROTEC 5. For a more
comprehensive description, refer to the SIPROTEC 5 Process Bus manual.
NOTE
i You can configure the merging unit protocol only if the IEC 61850 protocol with Edition 2 or higher is
enabled in the device.
NOTE
i You can activate the 9-2 Merg.unit protocol in up to 4 ETH-BD-2FO communication modules of the same
device using IO module CB 202.
You can activate the 9-2 Client protocol either in the same or another ETH-BD-2FO communication
module.
The Merging-unit routing editor is added under the device project tree.
NOTE
i By default, the following values are displayed under the respective columns:
² Click the Add New button in the Merging-unit routing Editor to add an additional stream.
NOTE
i The current measuring points and voltage measuring points can be added in the 22.3.8 Measuring-Points
Routing editor in the Current-measuring points and Voltage-measuring points window. For more infor-
mation, refer to Adding a Measuring Point in the Measuring-Point Routing, Page 235.
² Route the required current or voltage measuring point inputs. Based on the routing, the channel number
in the Consumed channels column is updated.
NOTE
i You can add a maximum number of 2 streams under a single ETH-BD-2FO communication module.
² To change the Stream type, select the stream, navigate to the Properties tab in the Inspector window
and select Settings.
NOTE
i The default value for the Stream type is displayed as IEC 61869-9. You can change the Stream type to
IEC 61850-9-2 (LE) or IEC 61869-9 (LE comp.).
You can change the values for SMV ID and Sampling-rate config.
² Create a new station with IEC 61850 Edition 2.0 or higher from the IEC 61850 stations folder. For more
information, refer to 15.2 Adding an IEC Station.
NOTE
i If the IEC 61850 station already exists, you can skip this step and the next step.
² Assign the desired available devices to the IEC 61850 station. For more information, refer to
15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station .
² Save the project and export the changes to the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
The IEC station editor is displayed in the working area.
For more information, refer to 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator
Project .
² Click Network in the IEC 61850 configurator bar.
The Network view is displayed.
² Assign the publisher/subscriber to the respective subnets.
² Click SMV in the IEC 61850 configurator bar.
The SMV view is displayed. SMV datasets and its attributes are automatically assigned in the Source.
² Drag and drop the desired node from the Destination catalog to the source signals under Source.
² Save the project and import the changes from the IEC 61850 System Configurator. For more information,
refer to 15.13 Transferring the IEC 61850 System Configurator Project Configuration to a DIGSI 5 IEC
station .
NOTE
i For an external publisher, drag and drop the desired signals from the Source catalog and the Destination
catalog to the SMV messages area for the assignment of source and destination signals.
NOTE
i You can configure the process-bus client protocol only if the IEC 61850 protocol with Edition 2 or higher is
enabled in the device.
NOTE
i You can activate the 9-2 Client protocol in up to 3 ETH-BD-2FO communication modules of the same
device using IO module CB 202.
You can activate the 9-2 Merg.unit protocol either in the same or another ETH-BD-2FO communication
module.
[sc_digsi_PBclientrouting_measuringpoint, 1, en_US]
The inconsistencies are displayed. Configure the PB-Client to resolve the inconsistencies.
NOTE
i If the IEC 61850 station already exists, you can skip this step and the next step.
² Assign the desired available devices. For more information, refer to 15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device
to an IEC Station
² Save the project and export the changes to the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
The IEC station Editor is displayed in the working area.
For more information, refer to 15.12 Transferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator
Project .
² If the publisher or the subscriber device is a third-party device, right-click the station in the Devices tab
and add a publisher or a subscriber.
² Click Network in the IEC 61850 configurator bar.
The Network view is displayed.
² Assign the publisher/subscriber to the respective subnets.
² Click SMV in the IEC 61850 configurator bar.
The SMV view is displayed. SMV datasets and their attributes are automatically assigned in the Source.
² Click the SMV tab from the toolbar.
The SMV view is displayed. Drag and drop the desired node from the Destination catalog to the source
signals.
NOTE
i For an external publisher, drag and drop the desired signals from the Source catalog and the Destination
catalog to the SMV messages area for the assignment of source and destination signals.
² Import the changes from the IEC 61850 System Configurator. For more information, refer to 15.12 Trans-
ferring the IEC Device Configurations to a System Configurator Project .
² Double-click the Measuring-points routing of the subscriber device in the project tree.
The Measuring-points routing matrix is displayed in the working area.
² Select the required measuring point in the Measuring-points routing matrix.
In the Properties tab, under the Details section, you can verify the external source, COM port, and SvId under
the field Received via Process bus from:.
[sc_digsi_PBclient_mapping_afterimport, 1, en_US]
[sc_digsi_sv_supervision, 1, en_US]
The corresponding LDs/LNs/DOs are available in the IEC 61850 structure editor:
[sc_digsi_com_supervision_iec, 1, en_US]
Restrictions
• It is not possible to rename or delete the SV supervision LDs ComSupervision and ComSupervision_SV
independent of whether they have configured LSVS instances or not. They can only be deleted by disa-
bling the SV supervision.
• It is not possible to modify LSVS instances or their parents in DIGSI 5 as long as they contain an LSVS
configuration:
– It is not possible to delete LSVS instances (LDs/LNs /DOs/FGs/FNs/FBs).
– It is not possible to define the ldName property for the SV supervision LDs.
– It is not possible to change the prefix or the instance of an LSVS LN (lnClass cannot be changed
anyway since this LN is not user-defined).
– It is not possible to move an LSVS LN which is in use (is configured).
For DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device to exchange data, the DIGSI 5 PC and the SIPROTEC 5 device must be
connected with a physical communication line or remotely using a satellite modem connection. A logical
communication connection must also be established between the 2 communication participants.
The following information gives you some basics about the communication between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5.
Additional information can be found in the Communication protocols manual and in the Operating manual.
Physical connection
There are 4 ways to connect the DIGSI 5 PC to a SIPROTEC 5 device:
• Via USB
NOTE
i Loading firmware to device using the remote connection takes more than 180 minutes.
Logical Connection
For a data exchange between the 2 communication participants, a logical communication connection must be
established. This connection can be temporary or permanent.
DIGSI 5 automatically establishes a temporary communication connection for certain processes. DIGSI 5 drops
the connection once the process is completed. DIGSI 5 establishes a temporary communication connection for
the following processes:
• Initializing Device
Before placing a SIPROTEC 5 device in operation, initialize it once using the offline configuration created
for this device. During initialization, this offline configuration is transmitted from the DIGSI 5 PC to the
SIPROTEC 5 device. Only once this is done you can put the SIPROTEC 5 device into operation and establish
a permanent communication connection between the DIGSI 5 PC and the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find
more information about this under 17.1.3 Initializing a SIPROTEC 5 Device.
• Updating Firmware
Load the updated firmware and protocols into the SIPROTEC 5 device before you can use the improved or
new functionality. You find more information about this under 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware
and Protocols.
DIGSI 5 only establishes a permanent communication connection at your explicit command. The communica-
tion connection remains until it is explicitly disconnected, or the physical connection between the DIGSI 5 PC
and the SIPROTEC 5 device is interrupted. You find more information about this under 17.1.4 Permanently
Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device.
An IP-based internal Siemens protocol is used for data transmission between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device.
DIGSI 5 and the SIPROTEC 5 device are authenticated via TLS 1.2 (Transport Layer Security). You do not have to
worry about the required certificate. This certificate is included in the SIPROTEC 5 device or DIGSI 5 upon
delivery. A confirmation prompt is displayed if the renewal of this certificate is required or if there is any issue
with the authentication of the certificate. You can proceed accordingly. The data sent between DIGSI 5 and
the SIPROTEC 5 device is always encrypted. If you would like to use the certificates issued by your own organi-
zation for securing the DIGSI 5 communication with the device, follow the instructions for using the client
DIGSI 5 certificates in the chapter DIGSI 5 Client Authentication of the SIPROTEC 5 security manual. This
feature is available starting with DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5 firmware versions V7.90.
Related Topics
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.1.2 Communication Modules
DIGSI 5 uses HTTP connections for communication. Address conflicts and faulty proxy settings can block the
communication. For USB and the offline analysis of CFC (debugging), the following IP-address bands are used:
• USB:
– Network adaptor name: SIPROTEC 5 devices connected via USB
– Address band: 192.168.2.*
– Subnet mask: 255.255.255.0
Proxy Settings
While connecting to the SIPROTEC 5 device via DIGSI 5, a communication error with the USB, Port J, and Port E
can occur if the proxy server for the LAN on your PC is enabled. You must disable the proxy server or use the
proxy server with exceptions to resolve this issue.
NOTE
i You must ensure that the proxy settings match your network configuration. If the option Use automatic
configuration script for LAN on your PC is enabled or if you are unable to edit the proxy settings, or for any
further assistance, you must contact your network administrator.
Related Topics
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.1.2 Communication Modules
Before placing a SIPROTEC 5 device in operation, initialize it once using the offline configuration created for
this device. During initialization, this offline configuration is transmitted from the DIGSI 5 PC to the SIPROTEC 5
device.
NOTE
i For initialization, connect the SIPROTEC 5 device to the DIGSI 5 PC via a USB connection or Port J. For more
information, refer to the SIPROTEC 5 Operating manual.
To connect the SIPROTEC 5 device to the DIGSI 5 PC, see notes under 17.1.1 Communication Overview
between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5.
With initialization, the offline configuration is assigned to the SIPROTEC 5 device. For this purpose the serial
number of the SIPROTEC 5 device is entered in the offline configuration. You find more information about this
under 17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration.
NOTE
i Certain operating conditions can necessitate reinitialization of the SIPROTEC 5 device, for example, if the
device is permanently in supervision mode. When reinitializing, all configuration and process data in the
device are deleted.
Further information about initializing a SIPROTEC 5 device can be found in the Operating manual.
Starting initialization
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² Using your right mouse button, click in the project the name of the offline configuration that you want to
use for initializing the SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Click Initialize device in the context menu. This menu item is only active if the SIPROTEC 5 device is
connected through a USB connection to the DIGSI 5 PC.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID is opened.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
A confirmation prompt is displayed if DIGSI 5 recognizes a SIPROTEC 5 device connected via USB.
Several indications will inform you about the current status. After the initialization is complete, or if initializa-
tion failed, a 22.6.26 Status Dialog opens. You find more information about the status dialog under 3.4 Using
the Status Dialog.
² Click OK.
The status dialog closes.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.1.5 Online Configuration
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
² 17.1.7 Removing the Assignment between a SIPROTEC 5 Device and an Offline Configuration
For DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device to exchange data, you must establish a permanent communication
connected between the 2 communication participants. You can do this in one of the following ways:
Related Topics
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.1.8 Disconnecting the Connection to the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration
An online device in the list of online accesses contains the online configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device,
which is represented by the online device.
If you transmit the configuration from a SIPROTEC 5 device to the DIGSI 5 PC, initially the settings in the online
configuration are identical to the settings in the device configuration. However, since you can edit the online
configuration, the online configuration can differ from the device configuration. You find more information
about this under 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations.
Depending on how you establish a communication connection to a SIPROTEC 5 device, the online device can
contain the complete online configuration or the reduced online configuration. Additional information about
establishing a connection can be found under 17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device.
• Connect to device
With this entry, you can connect to any specific device using the IP address of the device and then create
the life-list device in DIGSI 5 with no project device involved. If the entered IP address is accessible, a new
life-list device is created under the network-connection adaptor to which the device is connected. If the IP
address is not accessible, a respective error message is displayed in the Info tab. It can be used when the
DCP protocol for device discovery over Layer 2 is not available (for example, remote access over a router).
• Open Browser
With this entry, you can open the browser-based monitoring tool (comprehensive commissioning and
monitoring tool that provides an easy-to-understand display of the most important measured data).
For more information regarding this topic, refer to 17.1.9 Opening a Web Browser using Link from DIGSI
5.
• Device Information
With this entry, open the device information to the online connected SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more
information about this under 6.1.9 Opening Device Information.
• Logs
This folder contains other entries for the various logs:
– Operational log
– Fault log
– Setting-history log
– User-defined log 1
– User-defined log 2
With these entries, open the table 22.4.1 Log for displaying the log contents You find more information
about this under 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table.
• Fault Records
With this entry, open the table 22.4.2 Records for displaying the fault records. You find more information
about this under 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table.
• Indications
With this entry, open the table 22.4.3 Indications for displaying the indications. You find more informa-
tion about this under 17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications .
• Measurements
This folder contains one entry for each function group for which you can read measured and metered
values from the SIPROTEC 5 device. With these entries you open the table 22.4.5 Measurements for
displaying the measured and metered values. You find more information about this under
17.5.1.3 Opening the Measured Value Table and Reading Values.
• Test Suite
This folder contains other entries for the different test functions of the test suite:
– Wiring
– Communication modules
– Analog inputs
– Control
– Circuit breaker
– Protection functions
– Protection interface
– Communication protocols
With these entries, open the respective Test editor. Information about the same is available in the help
topics for the test functions.
• Device information
• Safety
Related Topics
17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
2.1.3 Working Offline and Online
6.1.2 Offline Configuration
You can assign a SIPROTEC 5 device to a certain offline configuration in the project. Assigning a SIPROTEC 5
device to a certain offline configuration is a requirement for the following processes:
• Disconnecting the Communication Connection to the Device via the Offline Configuration
If you want to disconnect a communication connection to a SIPROTEC 5 device via the offline configura-
tion in the project, then the SIPROTEC 5 device must be assigned to this offline configuration. You find
more information about this under 17.1.8 Disconnecting the Connection to the SIPROTEC 5 Device.
NOTE
i You can identify whether a SIPROTEC 5 device is assigned to an offline configuration or not by the corre-
sponding online device in the list of online accesses. Depending on the status, the name of the online
device has the add-on Assigned or Not Assigned.
² In the entry field Serial number enter the serial number of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Click outside the entry field.
- or -
² Press the <Enter> button.
You confirm your entry with these 2 inputs.
The SIPROTEC 5 device is now assigned to the offline configuration.
Related Topics
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.1.7 Removing the Assignment between a SIPROTEC 5 Device and an Offline Configuration
You can remove the assignment between a SIPROTEC 5 device and an offline configuration. For this purpose
the serial number of the SIPROTEC 5 device is deleted in the device information of the offline configuration.
Removing an Assignment
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the project, right-click the name of the offline configuration that is assigned to the SIPROTEC 5 device
to be disconnected.
- or -
² In the list of online accesses, right-click the name of the online device to be disconnected.
² In the context menu click Remove assignment from the assignment.
The assignment between the SIPROTEC 5 device and the offline configuration is removed.
Related Topics
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration
You have the following options for disconnecting the communication connection between a SIPROTEC 5
device and the DIGSI 5 PC:
• Via the context menu, issue the operation for disconnecting the communication connection.
Closing DIGSI 5
² In the Project menu, click Exit.
If you have changed the project since the last save, the confirmation prompt is displayed.
² To save changes in the current project and to close DIGSI 5, click Yes.
- or -
² To close DIGSI 5 without saving the last changes in the project, click No.
- or -
² Click Cancel if you wish to cancel closing.
The entire process is canceled by clicking Cancel. DIGSI 5 remains open and the communication connection is
not disconnected.
If you click Yes or No and you have not changed the online configuration, DIGSI 5 closes and the communica-
tion connection is disconnected.
If you click Yes or No and you have changed the online configuration, you can transmit these changes to the
SIPROTEC 5 device. A confirmation prompt is displayed for this purpose.
² In the online device, in order to transmit the settings in the online configuration, change to the
SIPROTEC 5 device, click Yes, otherwise click No.
If you click Yes, the data are transmitted to the SIPROTEC 5 device. Several indications will inform you about
the current status. If you click No the data are not transmitted.
If the SIPROTEC 5 device is assigned to an offline configuration in the project, then you can update this offline
configuration with the changed online configuration. A confirmation prompt is displayed for this purpose.
² In order to copy the settings changed in the online configuration to the offline configuration, click Yes,
otherwise click No.
If you click Yes, the data are copied to the offline configuration. Several indications will inform you about the
current status. If you click No the data are not copied.
DIGSI 5 is terminated. The communication connection is disconnected.
Related topics
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device
With this feature in DIGSI 5, you can open the browser-based monitoring tool (comprehensive commissioning
and monitoring tool that provides an easy-to-understand display of the most important measured data). You
can operate the device remotely or locally using browser-based monitoring and a Web browser. This browser-
based monitoring is especially optimized for the protection system and provides comprehensive support
during testing and commissioning from the PC. All relevant device information and setting options are
displayed graphically on the screen.
For detailed information about the functionality, refer to chapter Operation Using a Browser-Based User
Interface in the SIPROTEC 5 Operating manual.
NOTE
i SIPROTEC 5 devices generate a self-signed certificate after the IP address has been set. Download this certif-
icate and add it to the Microsoft Certificate Store to establish a secure connection with the device. If no
certificate for the corresponding device and IP address is installed, a Security Warning window displays a
message with the confirmation prompt. If you select Yes, the device certificate is imported to the Microsoft
Certificate Store and a secure connection with the device is established. Once the Web browser is success-
fully connected to the device, the Log on to Device dialog appears.
If you select No, the Web browser opens with a certificate error and the secure connection with the device
is not established.
² Enter the user name, password, and then select the desired language.
NOTE
i The language selection depends on the language set for the user interface of the device.
After a successful login, the menu selection of the Browser-based monitoring tool is displayed. You can
change or view the appropriate settings by selecting the individual entries. If there is no user action in the
browser-based monitoring tool within a defined time lapse, the Web browser disconnects from the device.
NOTE
i Depending on the Web Browser, additional settings could be necessary. Microsoft Internet Explorer, Micro-
soft Edge, and Google Chrome use the Microsoft Certificate Store of the operating system (for example,
Windows 7) for certificate trusting. Mozilla Firefox uses its own certificate store per default for certificate
trusting, but it has also the possibility to use the Microsoft Certificate Store in addition.
Since it is not possible to import self-signed certificates with the latest release of Firefox, Siemens recom-
mends configuring the Web browser for using the Microsoft Certificate Store.
Due to some issues based on the used versions of the operating system and of the Web browser, it may not
be possible to establish a secure connection even if the device certificate is successfully imported to the
Microsoft Certificate Store.
With DIGSI 5 you work in the Offline and Online modes. As a result different configurations are found in the
project, in the SIPROTEC 5 device and in the DIGSI 5 PC memory. These configurations can be transmitted in
various ways.
Configurations
You must distinguish between 3 configurations:
• Offline Configuration
The offline configuration is the configuration saved in a project for a real SIPROTEC 5 device. You can
transmit the offline configuration into the applicable real SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Device Configuration
The device configuration is the configuration saved in a real SIPROTEC 5 device. You can edit the device
configuration directly on the SIPROTEC 5 device. You can also transmit the device configuration of the
SIPROTEC 5 device to the DIGSI 5 PC. There the device configuration is saved temporarily as an online
configuration.
As a requirement for the transmission, DIGSI 5 must be connected online to the SIPROTEC 5 device, and
be visible in the list of online accesses. To better distinguish the real SIPROTEC 5 device, the SIPROTEC 5
device registered in the list of online accesses is designated as an online device.
• Online Configuration
The online configuration is the device configuration saved temporarily for an online device. If you
transmit the configuration from a real SIPROTEC 5 device to the DIGSI 5 PC, then the settings in the
online configuration are initially identical to the settings in the device configuration. However, since you
can edit the online configuration, the online configuration may differ from the device configuration.
Transmission
You have the following ways to transmit the configuration:
• Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC
You can also transmit the device configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 device into the DIGSI 5 PC. DIGSI 5
saves this configuration temporarily as an online configuration. You find more information about this
under 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC.
Related Topics
17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
2.1.3 Working Offline and Online
As soon as you have completed the offline configuration, you can load it into the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device
for a normal project. Here you can directly select an individual offline configuration and load it into the respec-
tive device. You can also load the firmware of the new protocol configured for the communication module
while performing load configuration to the device.
The individual offline configurations along with the firmware of the new protocol that are configured in the
communication module are loaded automatically one after the other into the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can also use the 22.5.18 Configuration Selection to select several offline configurations for different
SIPROTEC 5 devices and start loading at the same time.
If you perform load configuration to the device after modifying only the settings of any project device of an
offline configuration, only these specific changes are loaded to the target device instead of the complete
configuration. A status message indicates the success or failure of loading the settings to the target device and
enables you to proceed further.
If you have selected several offline configurations from the configuration selection, you do not need to
transmit it immediately to the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device. When saving the project your selection is avail-
able after closing and reopening the project. Now you can prepare loading the configurations, while for
example an employee starts loading the configurations in the system.
While performing this action, you are informed about the risk of loading the configuration in that project, but
load configuration is possible again. A confirmation prompt is displayed if the firmware version of the device is
not compatible with the offline configuration. Also the confirmation prompt is displayed if the firmware
version of the configured communication modules on the device is not compatible with the offline communi-
cation configuration. You can proceed accordingly.
Before loading, check if all settings in an offline configuration are consistent. In the project tree, the symbols
to the right of the offline configuration name provide information about the status. The symbol means
that the offline configuration contains inconsistencies.
NOTE
i You are not able to load an inconsistent offline configuration in the SIPROTEC 5 device.
The following alternative requirements must be met for loading an offline configuration in a SIPROTEC 5
device:
• DIGSI 5 PC can reach the SIPROTEC 5 device via the offline-configuration Ethernet connection.
If a selected offline configuration contains IEC 61850 protocol data, you have to expect a longer loading time
when you have a secure transmission. Secure means that during the transmission all protective and control
functions of the SIPROTEC 5 device are active. All protective and control functions of the SIPROTEC 5 device
are deactivated before the loading process. The data can then be loaded faster into the SIPROTEC 5 device.
When the loading process is completed, all protective and control functions are automatically reactivated.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Continue as described in section Start query and transfer.
Several indications inform you about the transmission status. After concluding the transmission or if transmis-
sion was not successful, 22.6.26 Status Dialog opens. You find more information about the status dialog
under 3.4 Using the Status Dialog.
² Click OK.
The status dialog closes.
NOTE
i After loading the offline configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 device, it restarts.
Related Topics
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC
With this option, the security configuration of the device can be loaded into the target device.
The following settings are considered under the security configuration:
NOTE
i The confirmation IDs and connection-password configuration will be a part of the device configuration
(DCF) and is loaded, while loading the configuration to the device. When only the device configuration is
changed in the device, an icon is displayed in the project tree indicating that there are changes only
in the device configuration (DCF). If the configuration has been loaded to the device successfully, the Load
configuration to device is removed. When only the security configuration is changed in the device, a new
icon is displayed in the project tree indicating that there are changes in the security configuration (SCF)
only. If the security configuration has been loaded to the device successfully, the Load security configura-
tion to device is removed. When both the device and security configuration are changed in the device, a
new icon is displayed in the project tree indicating that there are changes in both the device configu-
ration (DCF) and the security configuration (SCF). If the configuration and Load configuration to device
have been loaded to the device successfully, the Load security configuration to device is removed.
Related Topics
² 20.4 Network Access Security
² 20.5.1 Setup the DIGSI 5 CA Store
² 20.5.2 Configuration of the DIGSI 5 Client Authentication Security Feature
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
² 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC
17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the
DIGSI 5 PC
If you transmit the device configuration from one SIPROTEC 5 device into the DIGSI 5 PC, DIGSI 5 will save this
configuration temporarily as an online configuration.
You then have the following option:
• You can save the online configuration as an offline configuration in a project. You find more information
about this under 17.2.6 Copying Online Configuration into the Project.
To be able to transmit the device configuration, DIGSI 5 must be connected online with the SIPROTEC 5 device.
The SIPROTEC 5 device must therefore be visible as an online device in the list of online accesses.
NOTE
i Together with the device configuration, all data found in the SIPROTEC 5 device are transmitted, thus also
the process data. DIGSI 5 supports transmission of device configuration from only 2 online devices at a
time.
Related Topics
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
² 17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device
You can update the offline configuration of the project device from the target device. This action enables the
project device to be updated with the latest configuration data of the target device. When updating, all the
settings of the target device are copied into the existing project offline configuration. The settings in the
offline configuration are overwritten.
Related Topics
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
If you transmit the device configuration from one SIPROTEC 5 device into the DIGSI 5 PC, DIGSI 5 saves this
configuration temporarily as an online configuration. You can only copy this online configuration to a project.
Here DIGSI 5 generates in the project an offline configuration and copies all settings of the online configura-
tion into the new offline configuration. Further, you can also view or modify the IEC 61850 configuration and
export these changes to the IEC 61850 System configurator. For more information about exporting the
changes, refer to 15.11 Associating a System Configurator Project with the DIGSI 5 IEC Station.
You can then for example change the settings in DIGSI 5 and then load them again to a SIPROTEC 5 device. Or
you use this function to archive online configurations in projects.
If you have not yet changed the online configuration, then this corresponds to the device configuration of the
SIPROTEC 5 device connected online. In this case, you can use this function to archive, for example, the device
configurations of several SIPROTEC 5 devices in one project.
If the online configuration is copied as an offline configuration to the project, then the offline configuration is
automatically assigned to the online device and thus the SIPROTEC 5 device connected online.
NOTE
i If the menu item Copy device configuration to project is inactive then no project is open. In this case
open an existing project or create a new project. Then repeat the process. You can copy online device only
to an empty project with no devices in it.
Related Topics
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
² 17.2.2 Loading the Offline Configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
If you transmit the device configuration from one SIPROTEC 5 device into the DIGSI 5 PC, DIGSI 5 saves this
configuration temporarily as an online configuration. A new offline configuration can be created in the project
based on the hardware configuration defined in this online configuration. In contrast to copying an online
configuration to the project, no function settings are taken into account but only the hardware configuration
is adopted. For this hardware, specify additional main features and select an application template. Thereafter
you can process the offline configuration as usual.
This function corresponds to adding a SIPROTEC 5 device to a project with help from the base configuration
from the Hardware catalog. After selecting the base configuration, the dialog 22.6.5 Add New Device opens.
The product code is specified, matching the selected base configuration.
NOTE
i More information about adding an offline configuration can be found under 6.1.4 Adding and Manually
Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device and 6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code.
Related Topics
² 17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
• Process Mode
When the SIPROTEC 5 device has started up without an error, the device is in process mode. Process
mode is the normal operating state of the SIPROTEC 5 device. In process mode, all functions of the
SIPROTEC 5 device are available. You can manually select the process mode.
• Commissioning Mode
In the commissioning mode, the SIPROTEC 5 device sets all functions to inactive. So the wiring can be
tested without influencing the protection functions and other function blocks. Several test procedures
are additionally possible in the commissioning mode, such as, the communication test. You can manually
select the commissioning mode.
• Simulation Mode
In the simulation mode, the SIPROTEC 5 device behaves as in the process mode. In addition, you can
utilize test sequences for the test generator integrated in the SIPROTEC 5 device. You can manually select
the simulation mode.
• Fallback Mode
If the SIPROTEC 5 device detects errors in the hardware or inconsistencies in the application or in the
parameter settings, the device switches into the fallback mode. This can occur during device startup or in
normal operation. The fallback mode is also the state which the SIPROTEC 5 device has until the first initi-
alization.
The fallback mode is a safe device mode to prevent serious damages to the SIPROTEC 5 device. In the
fallback mode, the outputs of the SIPROTEC 5 device are set to their initial state. Access to the hardware
is not possible. In the fallback mode, protection functions or protocol services are not available. You
cannot manually select the fallback mode.
Related Topics
17.3.2 Changing Device Mode
17.3.3 Canceling Fallback Mode
You can change the current device mode for an online connected SIPROTEC 5 device and manually select one
of the following device modes:
• Process mode
• Commissioning mode
• Simulation mode
Changing the device mode is always connected with a restart of the SIPROTEC 5 device. If you change the
device mode from Process mode to Commissioning mode for devices with firmware version V06.00 and
higher version, the target device will switch to Commissioning mode without any restart.
To change the device mode and to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device, you have the following possibilities
depending on your respective work situation:
• You can change the device mode with one of the Test editors or with the Online tab. Depending on the
respective test scenario and the currently set device mode, you can restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in
another device mode.
• You can change the device mode with the Device information tab and then restart the SIPROTEC 5
device.
• You can perform the initial startup of the device by selecting the check-box option Delete buffers during
restart and then by clicking Restart in the Device Information tab. All buffers in the SIPROTEC 5 device
are deleted and the device restarts.
Related topics
² 17.3.1 Overview of Device Modes
² 17.3.5 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Commissioning Mode
² 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode
² 17.3.6 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Simulation Mode
² 17.3.3 Canceling Fallback Mode
When there is a serious device error, the SIPROTEC 5 device automatically switches into the fallback mode. The
following identifiers signalize this device status:
• The remark Fallback Mode appears in the display of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can try canceling the fallback mode and restarting the SIPROTEC 5 device in the process mode. Carry out
the following steps:
• In the Device information tab, select the process mode and restart the SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more
information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode. If the device is
not in the process mode after restarting, carry out the next step.
• Reinitialize the SIPROTEC 5 device via the USB interface. You find more information about this under
17.1.3 Initializing a SIPROTEC 5 Device. If the device is not in the process mode after restarting, carry out
the next step.
Related Topics
17.3.1 Overview of Device Modes
17.3.2 Changing Device Mode
If you have executed the test functions in commissioning or simulation mode and want to continue with the
normal process mode, you have to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
Related Topics
² 17.3.5 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Commissioning Mode
² 17.3.6 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Simulation Mode
For certain test functions, the SIPROTEC 5 device must be in commissioning mode. You need to restart the
SIPROTEC 5 device in commissioning mode.
If you click Yes, and the confirmation ID for Setting/Operation is activated, the 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID
dialog opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
The SIPROTEC 5 device is restarted and is now in commissioning mode.
Related topics
² 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode
² 17.3.6 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Simulation Mode
For certain test functions, the SIPROTEC 5 device must be in Simulation mode. The SIPROTEC 5 device must be
restarted in simulation mode.
Related Topics
² 17.3.5 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Commissioning Mode
² 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
The 22.1.23 Test Editor for Wiring allows you to carry out the following test functions:
• Testing Binary Inputs, Binary Outputs and LEDs of the SIPROTEC 5 Device to be Tested
You can change the current state of a binary input, binary output, or an LED, that is, from On to Off or
from Off to On. If the state change is successful, the new state will be displayed in the Test editor for
wiring.
If you close the Test editor for wiring, the last states of the binary inputs, binary outputs, and LEDs are
restored.
The indications are saved in CSV (Comma-Separated Values) format. With this format, data is generated
to a file row by row, separated by semicolons. Most spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format.
In order to execute the test functions described above, the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested must be in commis-
sioning mode. You can check whether this requirement is met from the following:
• The text Wiring test can be executed can be found in the header of the Test editor for wiring.
• The information Commissioning is periodically hidden and displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device display.
If the Test editor for wiring is closed, the SIPROTEC 5 device remains in commissioning mode. You can then
execute additional test functions - these require the commissioning mode. If you do not want to execute any
more test functions and want to continue with process mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
You can also click Show device mode to navigate to the Device information editor.
The state of the selected element changes. The new state of the element is entered in the Current state
column.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Check the current and voltage values present on a SIPROTEC 5 device measuring points with the 22.1.25 Test
Editor for Analog Inputs. This Test editor shows the current- and voltage-measured values as a percentage
according to magnitude and phase. In this case, 100 % is equivalent to the rated current or rated voltage of a
phase. The left window of the Test editor for analog inputs shows the current and voltage values of 3-phase
measuring points as a phasor diagram. The right window of the Test editor shows the power and voltage
values of all measuring points in a table as a numerical value.
This test function can be used differently depending on the selected source for current and voltage values:
• Simulation Mode
– The header for analog inputs of Test editors is orange.
– The instructions Simulated values are displayed can be found in the Test editor for the header of
analog inputs.
– The information Simulation mode is periodically hidden and displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device
display.
• Commissioning Mode
– The header of Test editors for analog inputs is yellow.
– The instructions Normal operating values are displayed can be found in the Test editor for the
header of analog inputs.
– The information Commissioning is periodically hidden and displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device
display.
• Process Mode
– The header of Test editors for analog inputs is yellow.
– The instructions Normal operating values are displayed can be found in the Test editor for the
header of analog inputs.
If the SIPROTEC 5 device is in simulation mode or commissioning mode and the Test editor for analog inputs is
closed, the SIPROTEC 5 device remains in current device mode. Additional test functions can be executed that
require one of these device modes. If you do not want to execute any more test functions and want to
continue with process mode, you must restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
The following section describes the test method for testing test sequences.
Test Sequence
The test method consists of the following steps:
• Open the project that contains the offline configuration that belongs to the online device. You find more
information about this under 5.1.3 Opening a Project.
• Make sure that the offline configuration that belongs to the online device contains at least one test
sequence. If necessary, generate a new test sequence. You find more information about this under
13.1 Overview of Test Sequences.
• Make sure that the offline configuration that belongs to the online device is assigned. If necessary, assign
the offline configuration to the online device. You find more information about this under
17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration.
• If the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in simulation mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in simulation mode.
You find more information about this under 17.3.6 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Simulation
Mode.
• If you want to continue with the normal process, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode. You find
more information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
The switching performance of circuit breakers can be checked with the 22.1.27 Test Editor for Circuit Breakers
during the primary test. The prerequisite for performing Circuit breaker test successfully is that there should
be no protection function in pick-up state and the initial Circuit breaker position should be closed.
The circuit breaker opens and then automatically closes during the test. Depending on the circuit-breaker type,
the testing method applied can be either 1-pole or 3-pole. The circuit breaker is always switched in a non-
interlocked way, regardless of the testing method selected. Spontaneous indications log the behavior of the
circuit breaker.
You can save the indications independent of the other project data in external files. You can save all indica-
tions or specific and individually marked indications in a file. The indications are saved in CSV (Comma-Sepa-
rated Values) format. With this format, data is generated to a file row by row, separated by semicolons. Most
spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format. This enables you to sort and evaluate indications
according to various criteria.
In order to be able to execute the described test function, the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested must be in
process mode. For instance, if the SIPROTEC 5 device is in commissioning or simulation mode on account of
another test function, you must restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
You can check whether this requirement and the recommendations are met from the following:
• The header of the Test editors for the circuit breaker is yellow.
• The instructions Circuit-breaker test can be executed can be found in the header of the Test editor of
the circuit breaker.
NOTE
i Do not use this test function for normal switching operations. Carry out normal switching operations with
the on-site operation panel of the SIPROTEC 5 device or with a connected substation automation tech-
nology.
Test Sequence
The test sequence consists of the following steps:
• If the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in process mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode. You find
more information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode.
• Start the test process for the circuit breaker and check the responses.
! WARNING
Warning of danger due to unauthorized switching states.
Non-compliance with safety instructions means that death, serious injuries, or significant property
damage can occur.
² Primary tests may be done only by personnel who are skilled electricians and who are familiar with the
startup of protection systems, with the operation of the system and with safety regulations and provi-
sions (switching, grounding, etc.).
²
Click the button in the 22.7.19 Toolbar Test Editor for Circuit Breaker.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Using the 22.1.26 Test Editor for Control Functions, you can test the control functions for switching devices
such as circuit breakers, tap changers, and disconnector switches during a primary test. A requirement for this
is that the function groups of the switching devices to be tested must contain the Control function.
NOTE
i It is recommended to enable the check-box option Oper.bin.outp. under test under the Test support area
in the Device Settings editor before testing the control functions.
In order to check a control function, change the current state of a circuit breaker or a disconnector switch. Do
so via Open to Closed or from Closed to Open. Or change the position of a tap changer with the commands
Higher or Lower. If the changes are successful, the new states will be displayed in the Test editor for control
functions. In addition, spontaneous indications log the response of the switching device.
You can save the indications independent of the other project data in external files. You can save all indica-
tions or specific and individually mark indications in a file. The indications are saved in CSV (Comma-Separated
Values) format. With this format, data is generated to a file row by row, separated by semicolons. Most
spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format. This enables you to sort and evaluate indications
according to various criteria.
In order to be able to execute the described test function, the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested must be in
process mode or in simulation mode. For instance, if the SIPROTEC 5 device is in commissioning or simulation
mode on account of another test function, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
In addition to this requirement, Siemens makes the following recommendations:
• Activate the test mode. All signals transmitted are now identified with a test bit.
• The text indication Test of the control functions can be carried out (Telegrams are sent with the test
bit activated) is given in the header of the Test editor for control functions.
NOTE
i Do not use this test function for normal switching operations. Carry out normal switching operations with
the on-site operation panel of the SIPROTEC 5 device or with a connected substation automation tech-
nology.
Test Sequence
The test sequence consists of the following steps:
• If the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in process mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode. You find
more information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode.
• Triggering state changes of the switching devices and check the responses.
! WARNING
Warning of danger due to unauthorized switching states.
Non-compliance with safety instructions means that death, serious injuries, or significant property
damage can occur.
² Primary tests can be done only by personnel who are skilled electricians and who are familiar with the
startup of protection systems, with the operation of the system and with safety regulations and provi-
sions (switching, grounding, etc.).
² Select a new state for the switching device from this list box.
² Click the Select button in the row of the switching device.
If the confirmation ID for switching is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes. The current and all other state changes are now released by the
entry of the confirmation ID. When you close the project or disconnect the communication connection to the
SIPROTEC 5 device, the release is canceled. The switching device is now selected for the switching procedure.
² Click Operate.
The control function is executed.
The new state of the switching device is entered in the Current state column. Indications appear in the indi-
cation overview window about the progress of the test. Responses are based on the control model config-
ured for the circuit breaker.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Protection-function reactions can be checked for analog or binary input values with the 22.1.28 Test Editor for
Protection Functions. This test function is helpful in optimizing protection function settings and to test-signal
routing.
The following options are available to test a protection function:
• Process Mode
– The header of the Test editors for the Protection function is yellow.
– The instructions Protection function test can be executed (normal operation values are
displayed) can be found in the header of the Test editor of the circuit-breaker for communication
protocols.
• Simulation Mode
– The header of the Test editors for the Protection-function editor is orange.
– The instructions Protection function test can be executed (simulated values are displayed) can
be found in the header of the Test editor of the Protection-function editor.
– The information Simulation mode is periodically hidden and displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device
display.
If the SIPROTEC 5 device is in simulation mode and you close the Test editor for protection functions, the
SIPROTEC 5 device remains in simulation mode. Additional test functions can be executed - these require
simulation mode. If you do not want to execute any more test functions and want to continue with process
mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode.
The following section describes the test sequence for testing protection functions with test sequences.
Test Sequence
The test sequence consists of the following steps:
• Open the project that contains the offline configuration that belongs to the online device. You find more
information about this under 5.1.3 Opening a Project.
• Make sure that the offline configuration that belongs to the online device contains at least one test
sequence. If necessary, generate a new test sequence. You find more information about this under
13.1 Overview of Test Sequences.
• Make sure that the offline configuration that belongs to the online device is assigned. If necessary, assign
the offline configuration to the online device. You find more information about this under
17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration.
• Open the protection functions to be tested in the Test editor for protection functions.
• If the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in simulation mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in simulation mode.
You find more information about this under 17.3.6 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Simulation
Mode.
• If you want to continue with the normal process, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode. You find
more information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode.
Opening the Protection Function to be Tested in the Test Editor for Protection Functions
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the list of online accesses, open the online device that represents the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested.
² Open the Test Suite folder for this online device.
² Open the Protection functions folder in this folder.
² In this folder, open the Protection group containing the protection function to be tested.
² In this folder, double-click the name of the protection function to be tested.
The Test editor for protection functions is displayed in the scope of operation. If the selected protection func-
tion can be displayed graphically, the Test editor diagram or characteristic curve will be displayed in the
Graphic window.
NOTE
i For the 7SS device type, it is possible to view the differential current (Idiff) and the restraint current (I-restr)
on the characteristic curve by selecting the respective check-box options for check zone and bus zone in
the test editor of the protection function.
² If the test sequence should be executed only after a specific binary input is set, select the If following
binary input is set option. Next, select the binary input in question with the list box assigned to the
option.
² Click Start.
When the Immediately start test sequence is selected, the test sequence starts immediately. After selecting
the If the following binary input is set option, click the Start button to release the test sequence. The test
sequence first starts when the selected binary input is set.
The displayed indications are stored as snapshots in the assigned offline configuration in the project.
²
In order to save the snapshot permanently, click the button in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar.
You can now view the saved snapshots in the Indications snapshot editor.
and or the list box . Information about additional progress of this procedure can be
found under 8.2.4.5 Scaling View in the Graphics Window.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
A default value can be set for signals and sent via the system interface with 22.1.29 Test Editor for Communi-
cation Protocols. Signals are identified as standard with a test bit. You cannot deactivate this identification.
However, Siemens does recommend manual default signals be identified with a test bit.
In order to be able to execute the described test function, the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested must be in
Commissioning mode.
You can check whether this requirement is met from the following:
• The header of the Test editors for the communication protocol is yellow. As a prerequisite, the test bit
must not be deactivated. If the test bit is deactivated, the header is orange, even if the SIPROTEC 5 device
is in commissioning mode.
• The instructions Communication-protocols test can be performed (telegrams are sent with test flag
enabled) can be found in the Test editor for the communication protocol.
• The information Commissioning is periodically hidden and displayed in the SIPROTEC 5 device display.
If the Test editor for communication protocols is closed, then the SIPROTEC 5 device will remain in commis-
sioning mode. You can then execute additional test functions - these require the commissioning mode. If you
do not want to execute any more test functions and want to continue with process mode, restart the
SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode by clicking the Activate process mode button.
Test Sequence
The test sequence consists of the following steps:
• If the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in commissioning mode, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in commissioning
mode. You find more information about this under 17.3.5 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Commis-
sioning Mode.
• Optionally, the signal identification can be deactivated with test bits (not recommended).
• Select a value for a signal and send this via the system interface.
• If you want to continue with the normal process, restart the SIPROTEC 5 device in process mode. You find
more information about this under 17.3.4 Restarting the SIPROTEC 5 Device in Process Mode.
The display is reduced to signals that are transmitted with this protocol.
² Open additional levels in the signal list until the desired signal is displayed.
If the signal has a value, this value can then be seen in the Current value column.
² Click the cell in the Simulated value column that the signal belongs to.
A list box opens.
² Select a new value for the signal from this list box.
² Click the button that belongs to the signal in the Set value column.
A confirmation ID is requested for some signal types. If the associated confirmation ID is activated, the
22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID dialog opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes. The current and all other state changes for the respective signal type
are now released by entering the confirmation ID. When you close the project or disconnect the communica-
tion connection to the SIPROTEC 5 device, the release is canceled.
The state of the selected signal is changed. A new signal value is entered in the Current value column.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Every communication module inside the SIPROTEC 5 device and also the integrated Ethernet interface each
have their own communication log. This SIPROTEC 5 device communication log can be read out with the
22.1.24 Test Editor for Communication Modules.
A communication log protocols the current communication-module state. Failures, test and diagnosis opera-
tion or communication capacity, for example, are included in the current state. Every change to the current
state leads to a indication in the communication log.
A communication log saves up to 500 indications simultaneously. If a communication log has already saved
500 indications, then the oldest indication is deleted from the communication log if a new indication arrives.
A communication log cannot be deleted.
You can save the indications read independently of the other project data in external files. You can save all
indications or specific and individually highlighted indications in a file. The indications are saved in CSV
(Comma-Separated Values) format. With this format, data is generated to a file row by row, separated by
semicolons. Most spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format. This enables you to sort and evaluate
indications according to various criteria.
NOTE
i Additional information about individual indications can be found in the respective Communication manual
and in the Operating manual.
button.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5-PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Every SIPROTEC 5 device has a device-diagnosis log and a security log. Both logs can be read from the
SIPROTEC 5 device with the 22.5.7 Logs tab of the 22.5.3 Device Information.
Both logs have the following functions:
• Security Log
The security log protocols access to areas of the SIPROTEC 5 device that require prior authentication and
authorization. The security log also protocols failed and unauthorized access attempts as well as other
security-relevant events. Each of the accesses mentioned lead to an indication in the security log. For a
complete listing of security events and relevant details, refer to the SIPROTEC 5 Security manual.
• Device-Diagnosis Log
The device-diagnosis log saves indications for the following events:
– Required maintenance, for example battery replacement
– Identified hardware defect
– Compatibility problems
The indications are supplemented by practical instructions. For example, Inform the repair service. The
device diagnosis log is especially required if the SIPROTEC 5 device is in supervision mode or is no longer
ready for operation.
The security log saves up to 2048 indications simultaneously and the device-diagnosis log can save up to 500
indications. If a log has already saved 500 indications, then the oldest indication is deleted from the log if a
new indication arrives. You can delete the logs after you complete the operation Get all data from device. It
is also possible to delete logs from the device.
You can save the indications read independently of the other project data in external files. You can save all
indications or specific and individually marked indications in a file. The indications are saved in CSV (Comma-
Separated Values) format. With this format, data is generated to a file row by row, separated by semicolons.
Most spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format. This enables you to sort and evaluate indications
according to various criteria.
NOTE
i You can download the logs from the Logs tab of the Device information editor of the project device, even
if there is a product-code mismatch with the connected device.
Similarly for an online device, even if no connection can be established to the online device due to a
product-code mismatch, you can still download the logs from the Logs tab of the Device information
editor.
You can find additional information about individual indications in the respective Device manual and in the
Operating manual.
Reading a Log
² Mark the log group in the left window that should be read.
The log is read. Indications from the log are displayed in the right-hand window of the Logs tab.
²
To update a indication, in the 22.7.26 Toolbar Device Information , click the button .
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Diagnosis information can be read from the SIPROTEC 5 device with the 22.5.9 Diagnostic Information tab of
the 22.5.3 Device Information. Diagnostics information is available for CPU, for IP configuration or for system
time.
Opening the Device Information and Displaying Diagnostics Information Tab for an Online Device
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the list of online access links, open the online device that represents the SIPROTEC 5 device to be
tested.
² Double-click Device information.
The device information is displayed in the scope of operation.
² Select the Diagnostics information tab.
There is 1 group per SIPROTEC 5 device mainboard in the left window and it is provided for every communica-
tion module inside the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Opening the Device Information and Displaying Diagnostics Information Tab for an Offline Device
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the list of available devices, open the offline device that represents the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested.
² Double-click Device information.
The device information is displayed in the scope of operation.
² Select the Diagnostics information tab.
There is 1 group per SIPROTEC 5 device mainboard in the left window and provided for every communication
module inside the SIPROTEC 5 device.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Topology-measured values for protection-data communication can be checked with the 22.1.30 Test Editor for
Protection Topology. Topology-measured values are Siemens predefined current- and voltage-measured
values. These measured values are recorded every 2 seconds by SIPROTEC 5 devices participating in the
protection-data communication and are then sent to the other respective SIPROTEC 5 devices via protection
interfaces. At the same time, current- and voltage- measured values of different devices are synchronized to
one another.
The Test editor for protection topology has 2 tabs. To check the topology-measured values, select the
22.1.32 Phasors tab. This shows the current- and voltage-measured values as a percentage according to
magnitude and phase, separately for each SIPROTEC 5 device. In this case, 100 % is equivalent to the rated
current or rated voltage of a phase. The left-hand window of the Phasors tab shows the measured values as a
phasor diagram. The right-hand window of the tab shows the measured values in a table as numerical values.
Opening the Test Editor for Protection Topology and Checking Topology-Measured Values
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² In the list of online accesses, open the online device that represents the SIPROTEC 5 device to be tested.
² Open the Test Suite folder for this online device.
² In this folder, double-click Protection topology.
The Test editor for protection topology is displayed in the scope of operation.
² Select the Phasors tab.
Topology measured values are displayed as phasor diagrams and numerical values.
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can carry out various test and diagnostics
functions for this SIPROTEC 5 device.
Different diagnosis data about protection-data communication can be checked with DIGSI 5. These diagnosis
data is especially useful if data faults or other irregularities occur in a communication connection, for example
runtime fluctuations.
Diagnosis data can be checked for the following areas of a protection-data communication:
• Protection Topology
Check diagnosis data for protection topology with the 22.1.30 Test Editor for Protection Topology. This
Test editor shows comprehensive information about protection topology in the 22.1.31 Protection
Topology tab. This tab also contains the following diagnosis data, separately for every SIPROTEC 5 device
participating in the protection communication:
– SIPROTEC 5 device address in the protection topology
– Circuit-breaker position
– Availability of protection communication within the last minute as a percentage
– Availability of protection communication within the last hour as a percentage
– Runtime between a local SIPROTEC 5 device and a neighboring SIPROTEC 5 device
• Protection Interface
Check diagnosis data for the protection interface with the 22.1.24 Test Editor for Communication
Modules. This Test editor shows signal information of all SIPROTEC 5 device protection interfaces, for
example transmission rates or average signal runtimes.
NOTE
i Additional information about parameters and settings can be found in the corresponding Device manual.
Comprehensive topology information is displayed in the upper window of the tab. Device-specific information
is structured in groups in the left window. Each group corresponds to one of the SIPROTEC 5 devices involved
in the protection-data communication.
² Open the SIPROTEC 5 device group whose diagnosis data is to be checked.
Each device group contains the groups, General and Protection interface.
² Mark one of the groups.
Diagnosis data from the selected group is displayed in the right-hand window of the Protection topology tab.
Categories
The measurands recorded and calculated by SIPROTEC 5 devices can be divided into the following categories.
• Statistic Values
The SIPROTEC 5 device can detect statistic values for motors (motor protection devices), circuit breakers
and disconnector switches. These values include the number of times the motor has started, the circuit
breaker has tripped or the number of switching procedures carried out by the disconnector switch.
You can use the Measurements table to perform the following actions:
• Save measured and metered values as snapshots in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device
Snapshots
You can save values which have been read as snapshots in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can then display the values saved as snapshots in the 22.4.6 Measured-Value Snapshot table, without any
need for a communication connection with the SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can use the Measured-value snapshots table to perform the following actions:
Related Topics
17.5.1.2 Setting Parameters for Measured and Metered Value Processing
17.5.1.3 Opening the Measured Value Table and Reading Values
17.5.1.8 Saving Measured and Metered Values in a File
17.5.1.5 Creating Snapshots of Measured and Metered Values
17.5.1.4 Setting and Resetting Values in a SIPROTEC 5 Device
• You can set parameters for processing minimum, maximum, and mean values, as well as energy-metered
values.
Setting Parameters for Minimum, Maximum , and Mean Values as well as for Energy-Metered Values
² In 3.1.2 Project Tree, open the folder of the offline configuration for which you want to set parameters.
² Open the Settings folder.
² Double-click Device settings.
The Settings editor opens in the working area with the 22.5.10 Device Settings.
² Set the individual settings in the Measurements section.
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.3 Opening the Measured Value Table and Reading Values
• Saving measured and metered values as snapshots in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.8 Saving Measured and Metered Values in a File
² 17.5.1.7 Selecting the Display Mode
² 17.5.1.5 Creating Snapshots of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.4 Setting and Resetting Values in a SIPROTEC 5 Device
You can set values from the following categories to a definable value or reset them to 0:
Resetting Values
² Go to the tab which contains the values to be reset.
²
In the toolbar of the table, click on the Measurements table, on the button. This button is
only active if the values displayed can be reset simultaneously. This button is not active, for example, if
the tab has been user defined. Values is selected.
All values on the selected tab are reset.
- or -
² If you want to reset groups of metered values, click the Reset button assigned to the group.
The metered values in the relevant group are reset.
Setting Values
² Go to the tab which contains the values to be set.
² Click on the cell which forms the intersection between the measured value row and the New value
column.
² Click the Set button assigned to the row.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
The new value is displayed in the Current value column.
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
If the prerequisites are met, the measured and metered values for the entire function group are assigned in
the form of a snapshot to the corresponding offline configuration in the project.
²
Click on the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar to permanently save the snapshot .
You can now display the snapshot in the Measured-value snapshots table. This continues to work after
closing and reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.6 Opening the Measured-Values Snapshots Table and Selecting a Snapshot
² 17.5.1.8 Saving Measured and Metered Values in a File
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.5 Creating Snapshots of Measured and Metered Values
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
Selecting Measurands
² Go to the tab containing the measured or metered values which you want to save.
² If you want to save the entire contents of the tab, make sure that no individual measurand is selected.
- or -
² If you want to save all the measurands within certain groups, select the headers of the groups in ques-
tion.
- or -
² If you want to save individual measurands, select the rows of the measurands in question.
Saving Measurands
² Select the groups or individual measurands to be saved, as described in the previous section.
² In 22.7.31 Toolbar Table Measurements or 22.7.34 Toolbar Table Measured-Value Snapshot, click the
button.
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
² 17.5.1.5 Creating Snapshots of Measured and Metered Values
• In the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device concerned, add the function Pulse metered value
in one of the 2 named function groups.
• Set the function Pulse metered value. You find more information about this under 8.2.3.1 Selecting a
Function for Setting Parameters.
• Set the metered value. You find more information about this under 17.5.1.2 Setting Parameters for
Measured and Metered Value Processing.
• Route the indications of the function. You find more information about this under 11.1 Overview for
Information Routing.
Depending on your respective working situation, you can add the function Pulse Metered Value in different
areas:
Opening the Global DIGSI 5 Library and Marking the Function Element
² In the task card, go to the 22.2.3 Libraries tab.
² Open the Global libraries palette.
² Open the Global DIGSI 5 Library folder.
² Open the folder for the device type.
² Open the folder Measurements.
² Open the folder User-defined values.
² Open the folder Puls.met.val.
The element Puls.met.val is displayed.
² Mark this function element.
NOTE
i You find more information about the other possibilities to add the function Pulse Metered Value under
8.1.2.3 Adding a Function.
Related Topics
² 17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
17.5.2 Indications
• Saving spontaneous indications as snapshots in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device
Snapshots
You can save spontaneous indications which have been read out as snapshots, whereby the indications are
archived together in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You can then display the indications
saved as snapshots in the 22.4.4 Indication Snapshot table, without any need for a communication connec-
tion with the SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can use the Indication snapshots table to perform the following actions:
Related Topics
17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications
17.5.2.8 Saving Indications in a File
17.5.2.6 Creating Snapshots of Spontaneous Indications
17.5.2.4 Deleting Spontaneous Indications from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
17.5.2.5 Specifying an Indication as Reference for Relative Time
• Saving spontaneous indications as snapshots in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
² 17.5.2.8 Saving Indications in a File
² 17.5.2.6 Creating Snapshots of Spontaneous Indications
² 17.5.2.4 Deleting Spontaneous Indications from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.5.2.5 Specifying an Indication as Reference for Relative Time
If the auto-scrolling behavior is deactivated, your action activates the auto-scrolling behavior. If the auto-
scrolling behavior is activated, your action deactivates the auto-scrolling behavior.
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
² 17.5.2.8 Saving Indications in a File
² 17.5.2.6 Creating Snapshots of Spontaneous Indications
² 17.5.2.4 Deleting Spontaneous Indications from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.5.2.5 Specifying an Indication as Reference for Relative Time
Deleting Indications
²
Click the button in the 22.7.32 Toolbar Table Indications.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
The indications are deleted in the SIPROTEC 5 device and in the Indications table.
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
² 17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
² 17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications
If the prerequisites are met, the indications displayed are assigned in the form of a snapshot to the corre-
sponding offline configuration in the project.
²
In order to save the snapshot permanently, click the button in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar .
You can now display the snapshot in the Indication snapshots table. This continues to work after closing and
reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
² 17.5.2.6 Creating Snapshots of Spontaneous Indications
Selecting Indications
² If you want to save all indications, make sure that no individual indication is selected.
- or -
² If you want to save individual indications, select the relevant ones.
Saving Indications
² Select the indications to be saved, as described in the previous section.
²
In 22.7.32 Toolbar Table Indications or 22.7.33 Toolbar Table Indication Snapshot, click the button.
Related Topics
² 17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
Fault-Recording Memory
The SIPROTEC 5 device manages its available fault recording memory dynamically, so the maximum recording
capacity is always available. When the fault recording memory is full, the oldest recordings are overwritten
automatically. This means that the most recent recordings are always available. The sampling rate, type, and
number of measured-value traces to be recorded are the crucial values when it comes to restricting the length
and number of possible recordings. You can define a large number of binary signal traces, with no fixed upper
limit.
For special device type (for example, 7KE), the flash memory size up to 16 GB (where 12 GB is ready for use
and 4 GB is reserved) for all types of recorders like Fast scan record, Slow scan record, Continuous scan record,
and Trend record can be defined using respective settings editor displayed under Recording function in the
project tree.
NOTE
i Changing the memory configuration of the 7KE device type will result in deletion of all available records in
the device.
Related Topics
17.5.3.2 Configuring and Setting Parameters for Fault Recording
17.5.3.5 Displaying Saved Fault Records
17.5.3.6 Reading Fault Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device
17.5.3.18 Exporting Fault Records
17.5.3.20 Deleting Fault Records Saved in the Offline Configuration
17.5.3.21 Deleting Fault Records from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
17.5.3.19 Saving Fault Record Information in a File
17.5.3.14 Triggering Test Fault Records
17.5.3.15 Opening Fault Records for Viewing Only
17.5.3.16 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating
• You can set the fault recording parameters, for example, the recording duration or the sampling
frequency. Information about all settings for fault recording can be found in the respective Device
manual.
• You can set parameters to define other signals as fault recording triggers.
NOTE
i For a device type (for example, 7KE), you can route the signals (SPS and MV) for Fast scan, Slow scan, or
Trend records under the Recorder column. You can route only the signals of MV type to be recorded to
Continuous records column.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
• SIGRA
• Records Editor
• COMTRADE Viewer
[sc_digsi_signalorder, 2, en_US]
NOTE
i Default signal order: The order of the signals in the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor matches the order of the
signals routed to the Recorder column in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor.
[sc_digsi_defaultorder, 2, en_US]
• If you route any signal under the Recorder column in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor without
changing the default order in the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor , the newly routed signal or signals are
added and displayed according to the default order.
[sc_digsi_defaultorder, 2, en_US]
• If you copy and paste any function group, function, or function block without changing the default order
in the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor , the signal or signals that were routed under the Recorder column in
the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor are added and displayed according to the default order in the
22.1.36 Signal Order Editor .
• If you route any signal under the Recorder column after changing the default order in the 22.1.36 Signal
Order Editor , the newly routed signal is added and displayed at the end of the respective signal group in
the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor .
• If you copy and paste any function group, function, or function block after changing the default order in
the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor , the signal or signals that were newly routed under the Recorder column
in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor are added and displayed at the end of the respective signal
group in the 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor .
²
Click to reset the order of the signals to the default order.
• SIGRA
• Records Editor
• COMTRADE Viewer
NOTE
² Open the fault record via SIGRA to view the signal order:
² To view the harmonics signals via the SIGRA plug-in, select the Harmonics Signals tab as shown in the
following figure:
² For viewing harmonics signals in SIGRA, select the record and select Open in SIGRA. Then select
Harmonics Heatmap from the menu bar as shown in the following figure:
² In SIGRA, the harmonics signals are displayed as shown in the following figure:
- or -
² Open the fault record via the 22.4.2 Records Editor to view the signal order:
The fault record displays the SAV signals first and then the MV and SPS signals.
- or -
² Open the fault record via the COMTRADE Viewer to view the signal order:
The record displays the signal order similar to the default/defined order in the Signal order Editor.
For viewing harmonics signals in the COMTRADE viewer, select the Harmonics Signals tab as shown in the
following figure:
The alternative names of signals in the records can be displayed in the following ways:
[sc_digsi_altname, 1, en_US]
• When the alternative name is not defined for the conversion signal, but defined for the parent signal:
[sc_digsi_altname_parent, 1, en_US]
• When the alternative name is defined for the conversion signal, but not defined for the parent signal:
[sc_digsi_altname_conversion, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i For more information about comparing parameters of different devices, refer to 8.2.5 Comparing Parame-
ters of Different Devices .
The comparison result between devices regarding the signal-order feature is displayed in the following
scenarios:
• Devices with the signal order and devices (older version) without the signal order.
The following message is displayed in this case:
[sc_digsi_compare1, 1, en_US]
• Devices with the reordered signal order and devices with the default order.
The following message is displayed in this case:
[sc_digsi_compare2, 1, en_US]
• Devices with reordered signal order have the same signals routed to a recorder in the same order.
In this case, no differences are displayed in the 22.5.16 Device Comparison view.
• Devices with reordered signal order have a different set of signals routed to the recorder.
The following message is displayed in this case:
[sc_digsi_compare3, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 22.1.36 Signal Order Editor
² 22.3.2 Information Routing
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you open the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, you can perform the following
actions:
• Exporting saved fault records and those which have just been read
• Saving saved fault records and those which have just been read as a file
• Opening saved fault records and those which have just been read for viewing and evaluation
If you open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can perform the
following actions:
• Opening fault records, which have just been read for viewing and evaluation
NOTE
i The Trend node is displayed if you drag and drop the Trend function from the libraries to the Recorder
group in the project tree.
² Double-click Fast and slow scan records, Continuous records, or Trend records to view the desired
record table.
The respective Records table is displayed in the working area.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.5 Displaying Saved Fault Records
² 17.5.3.20 Deleting Fault Records Saved in the Offline Configuration
² 17.5.3.18 Exporting Fault Records
² 17.5.3.19 Saving Fault Record Information in a File
² 17.5.3.15 Opening Fault Records for Viewing Only
² 17.5.3.16 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating
² 17.5.3.6 Reading Fault Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.5.3.21 Deleting Fault Records from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The fault records, which have been
read are added to the fault records already displayed in the table. You can then save the fault records which
have been read with the other project data.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
fault records without meeting any further requirements. The fault records, which have been read replace the
fault records already displayed in the table, which are removed completely.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the fault records to DIGSI 5. The fault records are displayed in the Records
table.
² If you have opened the Records table in the project, you can save the fault records which have been
The fault records are saved. You can still display the saved fault records in the Records table after closing and
reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
17.5.3.7 Reading Fast and Slow Scan Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device (7KE)
To be able to read fault records from a SIPROTEC 5 device, the 22.4.2 Records table must be open. There are 2
ways of doing this:
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The fault records, which have been
read are added to the fault records already displayed in the table.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
fault records without meeting any further requirements. The fault records which have been read replace the
fault records already displayed in the table, which are removed completely.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the fault records overview to DIGSI 5. The fault records overview is displayed
in the Records table with state as New. Under Properties tab, you can view the properties of the selected
record (for example Sampling rate).
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
continuous records without meeting any further requirements.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the configured Continuous recorder along with the data availability for each
recorder to DIGSI 5. You can select a configured recorder from the list box and the data availability (specified
by the Available from and To fields) for the selected recorder is displayed by default.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• Opening the Records table for the offline configuration in the project
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication
connection must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Opening the Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can
read the trend records without meeting any further requirements.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the configured Trend recorder along with the data availability for each
recorder to DIGSI 5. You can select a configured recorder from the list box and the data availability (specified
by the Available from and To fields) for the selected recorder is displayed by default.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The fault records, which have been
read are added to the fault records already displayed in the table. The fault records which are read can be
downloaded from SIPROTEC 5 device. You can then save the fault records which have been read with the
other project data.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
fault records without meeting any further requirements. The fault records which have been read replace the
fault records already displayed in the table, which are removed completely. The fault records which are read
can be downloaded from SIPROTEC 5 device.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the fault records file for selected fault records to DIGSI 5. The fault records
are displayed in the Records table with state as Downloaded.
² If you have opened the Records table in the project, you can save the fault records which have been
The fault records are saved. You can still display the saved fault records in the Records table after closing and
reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
17.5.3.11 Downloading Fast and Slow Scan Records from the SIPROTEC 5 Device
To be able to download Fast and Slow scan records from a SIPROTEC 5 device, the 22.4.2 Records table must
be open. There are 2 ways of doing this:
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The fault records, which have been
read are added to the fault records already displayed in the table. The fault records which are read can be
downloaded from SIPROTEC 5 device. You can then save the fault records, which have been read with the
other project data.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
fault records without meeting any further requirements. The fault records which have been read replace the
fault records already displayed in the table, which are removed completely. The fault records which are read
can be downloaded from SIPROTEC 5 device.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the fault records file for selected fault records to DIGSI 5. The fault records
are displayed in the Records table with state as Downloaded.
² If you have opened the Records table in the project, you can save the fault records which have been
The fault records are saved. You can still display the saved fault records in the Records table after closing and
reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The continuous records which are
read can be downloaded by selecting the duration from SIPROTEC 5 device. You can then save the continuous
records which have been downloaded with the other project data.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
continuous records without meeting any further requirements. The continuous records which are read can be
downloaded by selecting the duration from SIPROTEC 5 device.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the configured Continuous records along with the data availability for each
recorder to DIGSI 5. You can select a configured recorder from the list box and the data availability (specified
by the Available from and To fields) is displayed. The continuous records can be downloaded by selecting the
duration (specified by the Download from and To fields) and are displayed in the Records table with state as
Downloaded.
² If you have opened the Records table in the project, you can save the continuous records which have
The continuous records are saved. You can still display the saved continuous records in the Records table after
closing and reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Records table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The trend records which are read
can be downloaded by selecting the duration from SIPROTEC 5 device. You can save the trend records which
have been downloaded with the other project data.
If you have opened the Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
trend records without meeting any further requirements. The trend records which are read can be down-
loaded by selecting the duration from SIPROTEC 5 device.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the configured Trend records along with the data availability for each
recorder to DIGSI 5. You can select a configured recorder from the list box and the data availability (specified
by the Available from and To fields) is displayed. The trend records can be downloaded by selecting the dura-
tion (specified by the Download from and To fields) and are displayed in the Records table with the state as
Downloaded.
² If you have opened the Records table in the project, you can save the trend records which have been
The trend records are saved. You can still display the saved trend records in the Records table after closing and
reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
The SIPROTEC 5 device immediately records the routed signals in a test fault record (using the fault record
length, which has just been set). The SIPROTEC 5 device then transmits the test fault record to DIGSI 5. The
test fault record is displayed in the Records table.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.2 Configuring and Setting Parameters for Fault Recording
• COMTRADE 1999
• COMTRADE 2013
[sc_digsi_faultrecorder, 1, en_US]
[sc_digsi_comtrade_tabs, 1, en_US]
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.16 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating
• COMTRADE 1999
• COMTRADE 2013
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.15 Opening Fault Records for Viewing Only
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.16 Opening Fault Records for Viewing and Evaluating
• COMTRADE 1999
• COMTRADE 2013
The export procedure separates the data of each fault record into 2 files (if the selected COMTRADE revision
year is COMTRADE 1999):
• Configuration File
The configuration file, which can be identified by its .cfg file extension, describes the fault record chan-
nels. The configuration file provides information about signal names, sampling rates, channel numbers
and more.
• Data File
The actual measured values, that is, the sampled values of the fault record channels, are saved to the
data file with the .dat file extension.
However, while exporting records, if the selected COMTRADE revision year is COMTRADE 2013, 2 more
files are present:
– HDR File:
The HDR file which can be identified by the .hdr file extension provides information about station
name, device name, device number, firmware version, and so on.
– INF File:
The INF file with .inf extension contains information about the name of the device with triggered
fault detectors, the name of the bay protected by the device, the fault distance of the line, and so
on.
If you export several fault records at the same time, a dialog appears for each fault record. In case of device
type (for example, 7KE) only one dialog appears irrespective of the number of records selected.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
- or -
² If you want to export selected records, select the relevant rows by activating the check box.
²
Click in the 22.7.30 Toolbar Records Table .
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
• Time stamp
• Fault number
• Name
The following information is saved for every record for 7KE device type:
• State
• Record Id
• Time stamp
• Duration
• Record type
• Recorder name
• Trigger name
• Trigger Description
• Size
• Test record
The fault information is saved in the CSV (Comma Separated Values) format. With this format, data is written
to a file row by row, separated by semicolons. Most spreadsheet programs can open files in CSV format. This
format enables you to sort and evaluate the table entries according to various criteria.
NOTE
i On saving, only the information specified earlier is taken into account, not the data part of the fault
records. If you want to save the contents of fault records so that they can be processed further in analysis
programs, for example, export the fault records.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.21 Deleting Fault Records from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
• You can open the Records table for the offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Records table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the 22.4.2 Records table for the offline configuration in the project, a communication
connection must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. If you have opened the
Records table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can delete the fault records without
meeting any further requirements.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
The fault records are deleted from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
NOTE
i For special device types (for example, 7KE) in fast and slow scan records, you can select the desired record/
records to be deleted using the check-box option under the Select column. After deletion, the state of the
record is displayed as Deleted from device .
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes and Delete continuous record(s) from device dialog appears.
² Select the desired recorder from the Select recorder list box.
² Click Delete.
A confirmation prompt is displayed.
² Click Yes to confirm.
This step confirms the deletion.
The continuous records are deleted from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
NOTE
i The complete content of the selected continuous recorder is deleted from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
If the confirmation ID for the setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes and Delete trend record(s) from device dialog appears.
² Select the desired recorder from the Select recorder list box.
² Click Delete.
A confirmation prompt is displayed.
NOTE
i The complete content of the selected trend recorder is deleted from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
² 17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
² 17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
² 17.5.3.20 Deleting Fault Records Saved in the Offline Configuration
17.5.4 Logs
• Operational Log
An operational log protocols operating messages. Operational indications are information, which the
SIPROTEC 5 device generates during operation. Included in this, for example, is information about the
state of the device functions. Even the exceeding of or falling below limiting values are stored as an
operational indication. The operational log saves up to 2000 indications simultaneously. You can delete
the operational log.
For busbar devices (for example, 7SS device type), the current status of the switches (closed, open, inter-
mediate, and disturbed) are displayed in a tabular format, if the switch status is assigned in 22.3.2 Infor-
mation Routing, and fault occurs for the same switch.
• Fault Log
A fault log protocols fault indications. Fault indications are events which arise during a fault. They are
logged in the fault log with real-time stamp and relative-time stamp. Faults are numbered consecutively
in rising order. With fault recording engaged, a corresponding fault record with same number exists for
every fault logged in the fault log. The fault log saves up to 1000 fault indications simultaneously. You
can delete the fault log.
• Sequence of Events
A Sequence of events log protocols the operational messages. The Sequence of events log displays the
information generated by the SIPROTEC 5 device during the operation. For example, exceeding of or
falling below the limiting values are stored as a sequence of events log. The Sequence of events log
saves up to 2000 indications simultaneously. You can delete the Sequence of events log.
• User Log
With 2 user logs, you can individually protocol indications. This is helpful, for example, for special moni-
toring tasks. You can also, for example, configure a separate fault log for a second protective object. A
user log saves up to 200 indications simultaneously. You can delete the user log.
• Settings-History Log
The settings-history log protocols all individual settings changes and the downloaded files of entire
setting records. That way, you can for example, clarify whether settings changes are associated with
protocoled events. With fault analyses, you can also check whether the status of the settings actually
corresponds to the status at the time of the fault. The settings-history log saves up to 200 indications
simultaneously. You cannot delete the settings-history log.
• Communication Log
A communication log protocols the current communication-module state. Failures, test, and diagnosis
operation or communication capacity, for example, are included in the current state. Every change to the
current state leads to an indication in the communication log. Every communication module inside the
SIPROTEC 5 device and also the integrated Ethernet interface each have their own communication log. A
communication log saves up to 500 indications simultaneously. You cannot delete the communication
log.
• Security Log
The security log protocols access to areas of the SIPROTEC 5 device with limited access rights. The
security log also protocols failed and unauthorized access attempts. Each of the accesses mentioned lead
to an indication in the security log. The security log saves up to 500 indications simultaneously. You
cannot delete the security log.
• Device-Diagnosis Log
The device-diagnosis log saves indications for the following events:
– Required maintenance, for example battery replacement
– Identified hardware defect
– Compatibility problems
for operation. The device-diagnosis log saves up to 500 indications simultaneously. You cannot delete the
device-diagnosis log.
Logging
² Open the Information routing matrix for the relevant offline configuration.
² Route the indications to be logged to the columns in the Logs group.
Related Topics
² 11.3.1 Opening the Information Routing Matrix
• You can open a Logs table for an offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Logs table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you open a Logs table for an offline configuration in the project, you can perform the following actions:
• Saving saved indication logs and those which have just been read as a file
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.4 Displaying Indications Logs Saved in the Offline Configuration
² 17.5.4.6 Specifying an Indication as reference for relative time
² 17.5.4.7 Deleting Indications Logs Saved in the Offline Configuration
² 17.5.4.9 Saving Indications Logs and Indications in a File
² 17.5.4.5 Reading Indications Logs from the SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.5.4.8 Deleting Indications Logs from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
• You can open the Logs table for an offline configuration in the project.
• You can open a Log table for a SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses.
If you have opened the Logs table for an offline configuration in the project, a communication connection
must exist between the DIGSI 5 PC and the associated SIPROTEC 5 device. The indications logs which have
been read are added to the indications logs already displayed in the table. You can then save the indications
logs which have been read with the other project data.
If you have opened the Log table for the SIPROTEC 5 device in the list of online accesses, you can read the
indication logs without meeting any further requirements. The indications logs which have been read replace
the indications logs already displayed in the table. The previously displayed indications logs are removed from
the table.
The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the indications logs to DIGSI 5. The logs are displayed in the Logs table.
² If you have opened the Logs table for an offline configuration, you can save the indication logs, which
have been read. To do this, in 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar click the button.
The indications logs are saved together with the other project data. The indications are now part of the
project. When copying or exporting a project, the indications are also copied or exported. You can still display
the saved indications logs in the Logs table after closing and reopening the project.
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
NOTE
i The selected indication logs are deleted without another security prompt appearing.
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
² 17.5.4.8 Deleting Indications Logs from a SIPROTEC 5 Device
NOTE
i You cannot delete the logs from a SIPROTEC 5 device via offline configuration of the project.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes.
The logs are deleted from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
² 17.5.4.7 Deleting Indications Logs Saved in the Offline Configuration
² Click Save.
The selected indication logs or indications are saved to a file.
Related Topics
² 17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
When you order a SIPROTEC 5 device, you select not only the hardware for this device but also certain func-
tional characteristics. These functional characteristics include, for example, the function-points class, that is,
the number of function points available for the device application. If you own a SIPROTEC 5 device, you can, if
required, select, order, and finally load additional functionality into the device.
• Function-Points Class
If the current number of function points is inadequate for the device application, you can purchase addi-
tional function points for the SIPROTEC 5 device. You select a higher function-points class for this
purpose. This update feature is available for all device types.
• Significant Property
For certain device types, for example, for the 7SL87 type, you can decide at the time of placing the order
whether the SIPROTEC 5 device should be usable as a 2-ended protection, a 3-ended protection, or as a
multi-ended protection. You can update this device functionality. You can extend a 2-ended protection to
a 3-ended protection or a multi-ended protection, and a 3-ended protection to a multi-ended protection.
Basic Procedure
You can select, order and pay for the additional device functionality via Internet. Use the SIPROTEC 5 configu-
rator to select the device functionality and the Siemens SAP system to order and pay for the same. You will
then receive a signed license file from Siemens, which describes the extended device functionality. Load this
license file with DIGSI 5 into the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Please proceed as follows in order to update the functionality of a SIPROTEC 5 device:
Related Topics
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
You can order additional device functionality only for a specific SIPROTEC 5 device. The serial number of the
device is used as the criterion for assignment to a specific device. You have the following options to determine
the serial number of a SIPROTEC 5 device:
• If you cannot access the SIPROTEC 5 device physically, you can also read the serial number from the
name plate on the SIPROTEC 5 device.
• If you cannot access the SIPROTEC 5 device physically, you can also read the serial number via a commu-
nication connection from the device. To do this, DIGSI 5 online must be connected with the SIPROTEC 5
device. The SIPROTEC 5 device is also visible as an online device in the list of online-access links.
• If you cannot access the SIPROTEC 5 device either physically or via a communication link, you can get the
serial number from the offline configuration of the device. The SIPROTEC 5 device must already be initial-
ized with the concerned offline configuration or must be assigned to it for this purpose. The serial
number may, however, also have been entered manually in the offline configuration. This is why
Siemens recommends that you obtain the serial number from the offline configuration only under excep-
tional circumstances, since the serial number may have been entered incorrectly.
Related Topics
² 17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality
² 17.6.3 Determining the Function-Points Class Required
² 17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC
The functional scope of an application and the CFC functions used determine the number of function points
required for an offline configuration. Using the DIGSI 5 you can also create an offline configuration that needs
more function points than those that are actually available in the SIPROTEC 5 device. If, however, you want to
load the offline configuration in the SIPROTEC 5 device, it must have at least the number of function points
required. If the number of function points currently available is not adequate, you must obtain the next higher
function-points class that covers the requirement of function points.
Proceed as follows to determine the function-points class required:
The device settings and device information are displayed in the working area below one another.
² Select a function-points class that covers the present usage of function points in the device settings. To
do this, use the Function-points class list box.
A confirmation box is displayed. This draws your attention to the fact that changing the function-points class
changes the long product code.
² Click Yes to confirm.
The display of the function points used is updated in the device information. If a red bar is not displayed, the
function-points class is suitable for the current requirement of function points.
Related Topics
² 17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality
² 17.6.2 Determining the Serial Number of the SIPROTEC 5 Device
Use the SIPROTEC 5 configurator to select additional device functionality. The SIPROTEC 5 configurator is a
Web application that you can execute with the browser on your PC. Your Siemens contact will explain to you
how to find the SIPROTEC 5 configurator.
You select the additional device functionality for exactly one SIPROTEC 5 device. To do this, enter the serial
number of the device during the selection process. Please take care to ensure that you enter the serial number
correctly. If you enter the wrong serial number, you cannot load the additional device functionality into the
SIPROTEC 5 device.
You can find the serial number on the housing of the basic module of a SIPROTEC 5 device. If you cannot
access the concerned SIPROTEC 5 device physically, you can also read the serial number via a communication
link from the SIPROTEC 5 device or take it from the associated offline configuration. For details of how to do
this, refer to 17.6.2 Determining the Serial Number of the SIPROTEC 5 Device.
² If you need a higher function-points class for the SIPROTEC 5 device to be updated, select this from the
Function-points class list box. You do not select additional points individually, but instead, a function-
points class that covers the number of function points required. However, you need to pay only for the
difference between the new and the current function-points class.
² If you would like to use the integrated Ethernet interface additionally for IEC 61850 reporting, select the
setting DIGSI 5 and IEC 61850 from the Integrated Ethernet port list box.
Related Topics
² 17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality
² 17.6.5 Loading the Device Functionality into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
Load the signed license file into the SIPROTEC 5 device in order to be able to use the expanded device func-
tionality in the device.
The operation is canceled if you click No. The new device functionality is not transmitted to the SIPROTEC 5
device.
If you click Yes, the loading operation starts and the new device functionality is transmitted to the SIPROTEC 5
device.
Several indications inform you about the status of the transmission. After completion of the transmission or in
case of failed transmission, a 22.6.26 Status Dialog opens. More information about the status dialog is avail-
able under 3.4 Using the Status Dialog.
² Click OK.
The status dialog closes.
Related Topics
² 17.6.1 Overview of Updating the Device Functionality
² 17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device
² 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI 5 PC
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
SIPROTEC 5 devices and applicable plug-in modules are constantly developed. Improved or new functionalities
are anchored in changed firmware or changed protocols. You can receive information about new firmware
and protocol versions and about differences to prior version statuses either at http://www.siemens.com/
siprotec5 or via your personal Siemens contact. So that you can use the improved or new functionality, load
the updated firmware and protocols into the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Updatable Components
You can bring the following individual components to the most up-to-date status with the updated firmware
or protocols:
• Mainboard
• Plug-in modules
• Operating system
• Boot System
• You can select firmware only for the components of an individual offline configuration and then load it
into the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device.
• You can select protocols for the components of an individual offline configuration only in the communi-
cation module and then load it into the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device.
• You can prepare firmware and protocols for the components of several offline configurations. Firmware
and protocols are then loaded automatically one after the other into the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device.
Additionally you can open the firmware and protocol selection in the standard view:
• Standard View
The standard view allows selecting firmware and protocols for base components. These include the main-
board of the SIPROTEC 5 device and the plug-in module. If you are working with the standard view, your
selection is checked, before loading, for completeness and plausibility.
Basic Procedure
To update firmware and protocols of SIPROTEC 5 devices, please proceed in the following order:
• Downloading the Device Driver from the Siemens Internet Page and Importing into DIGSI 5
Find out from the Siemens Internet page which updated DIGSI 5 device drivers are relevant for you and
download these. Import the device driver into DIGSI 5. Further information can be found under
17.7.2 Downloading Device Driver and Importing into DIGSI 5.
You can obtain the DIGSI 5 device driver at www.siemens.com/siprotec5. Download these and import them
into DIGSI 5.
The Select File dialog closes. The dialog 22.6.12 Import Device Drivers opens. The Device driver versions list
box contains the elements that are available for installation. You find more information about the process
under 2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers.
Related Topics
² 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
With the firmware selection in the standard view and the protocol selection in the communication module,
you can prepare the firmware and protocols and start the loading operation. You can select the protocol only
in the communication module.
The following options are possible for the selection of the protocol and the firmware:
• DIGSI 5 is connected online with the applicable SIPROTEC 5 device. The SIPROTEC 5 device is also visible
as an online device in the list of online-access links. You find more information about this under
17.1.4 Permanently Connecting to a SIPROTEC 5 Device.
• The device configuration of the online device is transmitted to the DIGSI 5 PC. You find more information
about this under 17.2.4 Transmitting the Device Configuration from the SIPROTEC 5 Device into the DIGSI
5 PC.
To adapt the firmware selection view, the following standard functions are available:
Opening the Firmware Selection in the Standard View for One Offline Configuration
² Right-click on the name of the offline configuration in the 3.1.2 Project Tree for which you want to open
into the firmware and protocol selection.
² Click Load firmware to device in the context menu.
In the working area, the Standard view of the firmware selection opens.
Opening the Firmware Selection in the Standard View for Several Offline Configurations
² In the project tree, double-click Load firmware to devices.
In the working area, the Standard view of the firmware and protocol selection opens.
Opening the Firmware Selection in the Standard View for One Online Device
² Open the Online access folder in the project tree.
² Open the online access folder through which the SIPROTEC 5 device is connected with DIGSI 5.
² Right-click on the name of the online device that you want to open into the firmware selection.
² Click Load firmware to device in the context menu.
In the working area, the Standard view of the firmware and protocol selection opens.
Related Topics
² 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
² 17.7.4 Preparing Loading Firmware and Protocols
² 17.7.5 Loading Firmware and Protocols in the SIPROTEC 5 Device(s)
Before loading the firmware and protocols in one or more SIPROTEC 5 devices, prepare the loading. These
include the following actions:
• Selecting Components
Select the components for which you are loading another firmware or protocol version, or for which you
want to query the current versions.
• DIGSI 5 PC can reach the SIPROTEC 5 device via the Ethernet connection configured in the offline configu-
ration. In this case, the SIPROTEC 5 device must be assigned to the offline configuration in the project.
You can prepare loading the firmware and protocols for only one single SIPROTEC 5 device. However, you can
prepare loading for several SIPROTEC 5 devices. In this case, start the loading at the same time for all compo-
nents to be updated. The affected SIPROTEC 5 devices are then processed one after the other during loading.
To prepare loading you will always use the 22.5.17 Firmware Selection. The components capable for updating
are structured hierarchically. As in the project tree, you can navigate through the structure and show or hide
individual levels.
When you have prepared loading, you do not need to immediately start loading. When saving the project your
selection is available after closing and reopening the project. Now you can prepare loading, while for example
an employee starts loading the system.
- or -
²
In order to deselect all components, click the button in the firmware and protocol selection toolbar.
If a check-box option is selected, the corresponding component is selected for loading or the version query. To
be able to start loading or the version query, at least one component must be selected.
A confirmation prompt is displayed if DIGSI 5 recognizes a SIPROTEC 5 device connected via USB.
² If the SIPROTEC 5 device connected via USB is the requested device, click Yes, else click No.
If you click Yes, the current versions are queried via the USB connection from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
If you click No, DIGSI 5 searches via the Ethernet connection configured in the offline configuration for the
allocated SIPROTEC 5 device. You receive an error indication if DIGSI 5 cannot find the device.
² click OK. Check if the correct IP address is entered in the SIPROTEC 5 device offline configuration. Then
repeat the process.
If DIGSI 5 finds the device, the current version is queried via the Ethernet connection from the SIPROTEC 5
device.
The selected version is displayed in the column Current version.
Related Topics
² 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
² 17.7.5 Loading Firmware and Protocols in the SIPROTEC 5 Device(s)
Once you have selected the components to be updated and the versions to be loaded, you can start loading.
However, you do not have to immediately start loading. When saving the project your selection is available
after closing and reopening the project. Now you can prepare loading, while for example an employee starts
loading the system.
The firmware and protocols are always loaded in the supervision mode. In this mode the protection function
of the SIPROTEC 5 device is disabled. Once loading is completed, the SIPROTEC 5 device will restart again in
the Process mode.
If you have opened the Standard view of the firmware selection, your selection is checked before loading for
completeness and plausibility. Thereafter, the firmware and protocols selected in the communication module
are loaded.
The following alternative requirements must be met for loading firmware and protocols to a SIPROTEC 5
device:
• DIGSI 5 PC can reach the SIPROTEC 5 device via the Ethernet connection configured in the offline configu-
ration.
Starting Loading
²
Click the button in the 22.7.24 Toolbar Load Firmware to Devices.
A confirmation prompt is displayed. Click Yes to continue with the firmware update if you have already saved
the device data. Click No to cancel the operation. You can then save the device data and start the firmware
update again.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
² Enter the associated confirmation ID in the Enter confirmation ID text box.
² Click OK.
The Enter confirmation ID dialog closes. The current and all other loading actions are now released by
entering the confirmation ID. When you close the project or disconnect the communication connection to the
SIPROTEC 5 device, the release is canceled.
A confirmation prompt is displayed if DIGSI 5 recognizes a SIPROTEC 5 device connected via USB.
² If the SIPROTEC 5 device connected via USB is the requested device, click Yes, else click No.
If clicking on Yes, the offline configuration is transmitted via the USB connection to the connected SIPROTEC 5
device.
If you click No, DIGSI 5 will search via the Ethernet connection configured in the offline configuration for the
assigned SIPROTEC 5 device. You receive an error message if DIGSI 5 cannot find the device.
² Click OK. Check if the correct IP address is entered in the SIPROTEC 5 device offline configuration. Then
repeat the process.
If DIGSI 5 finds the device, the offline configuration is transmitted via the Ethernet connection to the
connected SIPROTEC 5 device.
Several indications inform you about the status of the transmission. After completion of the transmission or in
case of failed transmission, a 22.6.26 Status Dialog opens. You find more information about the status dialog
under 3.4 Using the Status Dialog.
² Click OK.
Related Topics
² 17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
² 17.1.1 Communication Overview between DIGSI 5 and SIPROTEC 5
Confirmation IDs are used for protection against unintentional operation. If a confirmation ID is activated,
enter it in order to perform the relevant action on the SIPROTEC 5 device.
It is possible to protect the communication connection between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device. You can
define a connection password in the SIPROTEC 5 device in order to prevent unauthenticated device access
using DIGSI 5.
Confirmation IDs and the connection password can only be modified with DIGSI 5 but not with the SIPROTEC 5
device HMI. You can also deactivate confirmation IDs and the connection password. However, Siemens recom-
mends only deactivating them during commissioning. During normal operation, confirmation IDs and the
connection password should always be activated.
Confirmation IDs and the connection password are activated, deactivated, and changed by the 20.2 Opera-
tions Safety and Access Control.
Confirmation IDs
A confirmation ID consists of 6 digits, which you can freely select.
For the following areas, you can assign different confirmation IDs:
• Settings
This confirmation ID allows changing the settings and device mode, loading firmware, setting counter,
and deleting logs.
The confirmation ID for this area has the default value 222222.
• Fct.Key/PB operation
This confirmation ID allows operating via function keys and push-buttons only with the confirmation ID of
Settings. By default, the option Fct.Key/PB operation is unchecked. You can activate or deactivate the
option only when the option Settings is enabled. If you change the confirmation ID for the Settings area,
then the new confirmation ID is automatically applicable for the Fct.Key/PB operation area.
• Switching
This confirmation ID allows switching operations.
The confirmation ID for this area has the default value 333333.
Connection Password
A connection password ensures authenticated remote access to a SIPROTEC 5 device. The password must
meet certain requirements, including those of the NERC CIP standards. A password must therefore be at least
8 characters long. It must include at least 1 upper-case letter, 1 lower-case letter, 1 digit, and 1 special char-
acter. No connection password is configured in a SIPROTEC 5 device when it is delivered.
If a password is activated, it must be entered correctly before DIGSI 5 can access the SIPROTEC 5 device. An
activated connection password applies to all interfaces of the SIPROTEC 5 device. Access by plug & play is also
protected with the password. For more information, refer to the chapter Access Control in SIPROTEC 5 in the
SIPROTEC 5 Security manual.
Incorrect password entry is logged in the SIPROTEC 5 device. After 3 incorrect password entries, an alarm can
be output via a binary output. The accessing DIGSI 5 is also blocked for further accesses for a few minutes.
Related Topics
17.8.2 Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor
17.8.3 Changing the Confirmation ID
17.8.5 Activating and Deactivating the Confirmation ID
17.8.4 Changing the Connection Password
17.8.6 Activating and Deactivating a Connection Password
With the Operations safety and access control Editor, you can set the following levels of Access protection:
• Role-based access control with central user management (consumes function points):
With this option, you can configure the role-based access control settings using the RADIUS server. For
more information about the settings, refer to 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control.
Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor for Offline Configuration
² Open the 3.1.2 Project Tree.
² Open the relevant offline configuration in the project.
² Double-click Operations safety and access control.
The Operations safety and access control Editor is displayed in the working area.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.3 Changing the Confirmation ID
² 17.8.4 Changing the Connection Password
You can change each of the confirmation IDs separately. To perform this function, a Change button is
assigned to each working area in the 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control. This button opens a dialog
with which you can modify the current confirmation ID.
The individual confirmation IDs have the following default values:
• Settings: 222222
• Switching: 333333
² Enter no more and no fewer than 6 digits in the New confirmation ID. The sequence of characters must
be nonambiguous, so must not yet be assigned to another confirmation ID.
An asterisk is shown for each digit that you enter.
² Enter the same sequence of digits in the Confirm new confirmation ID text box to verify your entry.
An asterisk is shown for each digit that you enter. If both sequences of digits correspond, the OK button is
activated.
² Click OK.
The new confirmation ID is stored in the offline configuration of the device and will be transmitted to the
respective SIPROTEC 5 online device during the next load configuration operation.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.5 Activating and Deactivating the Confirmation ID
In the 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control operating mode Connect DIGSI 5 to the SIPROTEC 5 device
is assigned to the Change button. This button opens a dialog in which you can modify the current connection
password.
The following alternative requirements must be met for loading an offline configuration in a SIPROTEC 5
device:
• DIGSI 5 PC can reach the SIPROTEC 5 device via the offline configuration projected Ethernet connection.
NOTE
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.6 Activating and Deactivating a Connection Password
² 17.8.2 Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor
You can activate or deactivate each of the confirmation IDs separately. To do that, each working area has a
check-box option in the Active column in the 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control. You can only deacti-
vate a confirmation ID for the current session. When DIGSI 5 is started again, the status of all confirmation IDs
remain same as in the last session before restarting DIGSI.
NOTE
i If a confirmation ID is deactivated, this is not queried before running the relevant action. This can result in
unintended or unauthorized operating actions and even in material damage and personal injury!
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.3 Changing the Confirmation ID
The connection password is deactivated when a SIPROTEC 5 device is delivered. You can activate or also deac-
tivate the connection password. Use the 20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control for this.
When you deactivate the connection password, the current password is deleted. When you activate the
connection password, you have to create a new connection password.
NOTE
i If the connection password is deactivated, it will is not queried before a connection is established. This
enables unauthorized persons to establish a connection between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Click OK.
The Change connection password dialog closes. The new connection password is transmitted into the
connected SIPROTEC 5 device. A check mark appears in the check box of the Active column. The name of the
button Activate changes to Change. The connection password has now been activated.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.4 Changing the Connection Password
² 17.8.2 Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor
If the connection password has been activated, it is queried before a communication connection is established
between DIGSI 5 and a SIPROTEC 5 device. For this purpose, the 22.6.19 Enter Connection Password dialog
opens in which you must enter the connection password correctly. If an incorrect connection password is
entered, this is logged in the SIPROTEC 5 device. After 3 incorrect password entries, the accessing DIGSI 5 is
blocked for further accesses for a few minutes.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.6 Activating and Deactivating a Connection Password
If a confirmation ID has been activated for a certain action, it is queried before this action is enabled. For this
purpose, the 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID dialog opens in which you must enter the confirmation ID
correctly.
Entering a Confirmation ID
² Enter the correct confirmation ID in the Confirmation ID for ... text box.
² Click OK.
If the confirmation ID has been entered incorrectly, an error message is displayed. If the confirmation ID
entered is correct, the relevant action is enabled.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
² 17.8.5 Activating and Deactivating the Confirmation ID
When the prompt for the connection password is activated in a SIPROTEC 5 device, you cannot establish a
connection to the device without inputting this password. When a confirmation ID is activated for a particular
operator handling, you cannot carry out the respective operator handling without this confirmation ID. In case
the connection password or the confirmation ID is no longer available, you have to reset the connection pass-
word or the confirmation ID.
Proceed in the following sequence:
• With DIGSI 5 deactivate the confirmation IDs in the offline configuration of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You
find more information about this under 17.8.5 Activating and Deactivating the Confirmation ID.
• Initialize the SIPROTEC 5 device with the associated offline configuration. You find more information
about this under 17.1.3 Initializing a SIPROTEC 5 Device.
• If required, assign new confirmation IDs and a new connection password and activate them in the
SIPROTEC 5 device. You find more information about this under 17.8.3 Changing the Confirmation ID.
NOTE
i Always press the function key and digit simultaneously. Note that the time-out between key operations is 1
s.
Resetting the Connection Password for Devices Without Display or Devices in Fallback Mode
² Isolate the SIPROTEC 5 device from the auxiliary voltage.
² Remove the battery from the SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Wait for about 2 min.
² Insert the battery into the SIPROTEC 5 device.
² Reconnect the SIPROTEC 5 device to the power supply.
The connection password is reset.
Related Topics
² 17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
If a SIPROTEC 5 device is connected online with the DIGSI 5 PC, you can reset all LEDs and binary outputs of
the SIPROTEC 5 device. LEDs and binary outputs are always reset simultaneously.
All LEDs and binary outputs of the connected SIPROTEC 5 device are reset.
18.1 Formats
The following table provides an overview of all data formats, which are supported by DIGSI 5.
Data Format Meaning Export Source Import Target
TEA-X Data exchange format containing infor- Device Project Device Project
mation of single or multiple devices
(XML-based)
DEX5 Device archive with complete informa- Device — — Project
tion about an individual SIPROTEC 5
device
DSP5 Display pages for an individual Device — Device —
SIPROTEC 5 device
RIO Protection settings for an individual Device — — —
SIPROTEC 5 device for use in test equip-
ment
ELCAD Topology information from CAD — — — Project
diagrams
SEQ5 Test sequences for an individual Device — Device —
SIPROTEC 5 device
ST DIGSI 4 function charts — — Device —
ICD IED Capability Description Device — Device —
IID Instantiated IED Description Device — — —
SCD Substation Configuration Description — — — IEC Station
SSD System-Specification Description — — — Project
MICS Model Implementation Conformance Device — — —
Statement
DIGT103 IEC 60870-5-103 protocol settings for Device — — —
SICAM PAS
DIGT104 IEC 60870-5-104 protocol settings for Device — — —
SICAM PAS
DIGMOD Modbus TCP protocol settings for SICAM Device — — —
PAS
DIGDNP DNP3 protocol settings for SICAM PAS Device — — —
SIM Simulation data format for single/ Device Project — —
multiple devices
UAT User-defined application template Device — Device Project
Group
folder
18.1.2 TEA-X
Description
You can archive the data from individual SIPROTEC 5 devices or whole project in TEA-X format. This format is
also suitable for data exchange between different applications, such as DIGSI 5 and TEA-X Plug-in for Microsoft
Excel. The TEA-X format is based on XML.
File Content
A TEA-X file can contain information from the following categories:
• Communication mappings
• Display pages
• Single-line configuration
• Single-line configuration
You can import the desired data categories.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.2 Configuring the TEA-X Export
18.3.2 Configuring the TEA-X Import
18.1.3 DEX5
Meaning
The abbreviation DEX5 stands for Device 5 Export Format.
Description
You can archive the data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DEX5 format.
File Content
A DEX5 file contains all device-specific data.
Transfer Direction
• You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DEX5 format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.3.4 Configuring the DEX5 Import
18.1.4 SCL
Meaning
The abbreviation SCL stands for Substation Configuration Description Language.
Description
A description language standardized in IEC 61850, SCL is based on XML. This description language allows all
information relevant to an IEC 61850 substation to be documented consistently. This format is therefore suit-
able for exchanging IEC 61850-specific data between different applications, even if these come from different
manufacturers. The described import checks are basically done for all SCL formats, not only for SCD imports.
File Content
A file which uses SCL as its language can contain information from the following categories:
• Configuration, function, and communication capabilities of the individual substation users (devices)
• Communication connections
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.5 ICD
Meaning
The abbreviation ICD stands for IED Capability Description.
Description
Files in the ICD format describe the capabilities of the device within IEC 61850 independently of its concrete
application in a project. To do this, the configuration, function, and communication capabilities of the device
are formulated. The ICD format uses SCL as the description language for this purpose. Files in ICD format can
be used to exchange data with external system configurators.
File Content
An ICD file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
• You can export data of a single SIPROTEC 5 device or another individual device (for example timer) in ICD
format.
• You can import data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device, or into another individual device or a project in
ICD format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.5 Configuring the ICD Export
18.1.6 SCD
Meaning
The abbreviation SCD stands for Substation Configuration Description.
Description
Files in SCD format describe the version of an IEC 61850 substation. The ICD format uses SCL as the descrip-
tion language for this purpose.
You can exchange data between a system configurator and manufacturer-specific device configurators with
SCD files. To do this, the workflow is as follows: In the system configurator, the ICD files are imported into a
device present in the substation. Then the network and communications of the substation are configured with
the system configurator. Then the substation is exported as an SCD file and returned to the manufacturer-
specific tools.
File Content
An SCD file contains information from the following categories:
• Substation-internal communication
Transfer Direction
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.3.3 Configuring the SCD Import
18.1.7 CID
Meaning
The abbreviation CID stands for Configured IED Description.
Description
A file in CID format describes how an ICD file represents the project-independent capabilities of a device within
IEC 61850. A CID file reflects the parameter set of a device, expressed in SCL. In addition, the CID file contains
all information which the device needs to know about substation-internal communication. If, for instance, the
device receives a GOOSE message from another device, information about the transmitting device is
contained in the CID.
File Content
A CID file contains information from the following categories:
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.8 IID
Meaning
The abbreviation IID stands for Instantiated IED Description.
Description
Files in IID format are ICD files adapted for the concrete application in the project. This format is mainly suit-
able for exchanging data between DIGSI 5 and an external system configurator or also a substation automa-
tion system such as SICAM PAS. The ICD format uses SCL as the description language for this purpose.
From the current version, you can exclude the Alternative Descriptions (or alternative texts) from the IID
export file. You can export the IEC 61850 descriptions in English language only if you select the check-box
option Export IEC 61850 descriptions in English under the IEC 61850 settings group in the project proper-
ties. In all other cases, they will not be exported, thus reducing the file size by approximately 10 %.
File Content
An IID file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
• You can export data of a single SIPROTEC 5 device or another individual device (for example timer) in IID
format.
• You can import data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device, or into another individual device or a project in
IID format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.9 SED
Meaning
The abbreviation SED stands for System Exchange Description.
Description
Files in SED format can be used to exchange interface information between DIGSI 5 projects and thus between
substations. To do this, the project extracts the data for the other projects from the file during import and
writes its own data in the same file during export. The contents of an SED file are formulated in SCL.
File Content
An SED file always contains information about the interface settings. The file can also contain information
from other data categories.
Transfer Direction
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.10 SSD
Meaning
The abbreviation SSD stands for System Specification Description.
Description
Files in SSD format contain the complete specification of a station automation system, including a single-line
configuration of the station. The assignment of logical nodes from IEC 61850 to primary equipment can also
be described in SSD files. This allows device requirements to be defined in the SSD file so that the devices can
be used in the substation. The contents of an SED file are formulated in SCL.
File Content
An SSD file contains information from the following categories:
• Substation
Transfer Direction
You can import data into a project in SSD format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.11 RIO
Meaning
The abbreviation RIO stands for Relay Information by OMICRON.
Description
Files in RIO format can be used to exchange data between test systems from the OMICRON company and any
other project-protection planning system. With DIGSI 5, you can export different settings from protection
functions in RIO format, which the OMICRON test equipment can then continue to process. The relevant
settings are described in the Test equipment manual.
You can test the following items of equipment and devices with the OMICRON test equipment:
• Supervision relays
• Paralleling devices
• Measuring transducers
Files in RIO format can also be opened, displayed, and evaluated with SIGRA.
File Content
A RIO file contains information about protection settings.
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in RIO format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.4 Configuring the RIO Export
18.1.12 DIGT103
Meaning
The abbreviation DIGT103 stands for DIGSI 5 protocol settings for IEC 60870-5-103.
Description
If the IEC 60870-5-103 protocol is configured for a system interface, you can export the protocol settings in
DIGT103 format. The DIGT103 format is specially designed to transmit interface data from DIGSI 5 into the
SICAM PAS substation automation system.
File Content
A DIGT103 file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGT103 format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.13 DIGT104
Meaning
The abbreviation DIGT104 stands for DIGSI 5 protocol settings for IEC 60870-5-104.
Description
If the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol is configured for a system interface, you can export the protocol settings in
DIGT104 format. The DIGT104 format is specially designed to transmit interface data from DIGSI 5 into the
SICAM PAS substation automation system.
File Content
A DIGT104 file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGT104 format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.14 DIGMOD
Meaning
The abbreviation DIGMOD stands for DIGSI 5 protocol settings for Modbus TCP.
Description
If the Modbus TCP protocol is configured for a system interface, you can export the protocol settings in
DIGMOD format. The DIGMOD format is specially designed to transmit interface data from DIGSI 5 into the
SICAM PAS substation automation system.
File Content
A DIGMOD file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGMOD format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.15 DIGDNP
Meaning
The abbreviation DIGDNP stands for DIGSI 5 protocol settings for DNP3.
Description
If the DNP3 protocol is configured for a system interface, you can export the protocol settings in DIGDNP
format. The DIGDNP format is specially designed to transmit interface data from DIGSI 5 into the SICAM PAS
substation automation system.
File Content
A DIGDNP file contains information from the following categories:
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DIGDNP format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.16 DSP5
Meaning
The abbreviation DSP5 stands for DIGSI 5 Display Pages.
Description
You can archive individual or all display pages of a SIPROTEC 5 device in DSP5 format. You can also use this
format to exchange display pages between SIPROTEC 5 devices. The DSP5 format is based on XML.
File Content
A DSP5 file contains information about all display pages of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Transfer Direction
• You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DSP5 format.
• You can import data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in DSP5 format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.3 Configuring the DSP5 Export
18.3.6 Configuring the DSP5 Import
18.1.17 ELCAD
Meaning
The abbreviation ELCAD stands for Electrical CAD.
Description
You can import the topology information contained in an ELCAD file into a project and use it as the basis for a
single-line configuration. The other information contained in the ELCAD file is not included in this process.
File Content
An ELCAD file can contain information from the following categories:
• Protection functions
• System interface
• Hardware configuration
Transfer Direction
You can import data into a project in ELCAD format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.18 ST
Meaning
The abbreviation ST stands for Structured Text file.
Description
You can import function charts (CFC) from DIGSI 4 in ST format. First, however, export your function charts
from DIGSI 4.83 or higher.
File Content
An ST file contains information about one or more DIGSI 4 function charts.
Transfer Direction
You can import data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in ST format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.19 MICS
Meaning
The abbreviation MICS stands for Model Implementation Conformance Statement.
Description
You can export the entire IEC 61850 data structure of a SIPROTEC 5 device. The export creates a document in
XML, which you can use for conformance tests, for example.
File Content
A MICS file contains the complete IEC 61850 data structure from a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Transfer Direction
You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in MICS format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.1.20 SEQ5
Meaning
The abbreviation SEQ5 stands for DIGSI 5 Test Sequences.
Description
You can archive individual or all test sequences of a SIPROTEC 5 device in SEQ5 format. You can also use this
format to exchange test sequences between SIPROTEC 5 devices. The SEQ5 format is based on XML.
File Content
A SEQ5 file contains information about all test sequences of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Transfer Direction
• You can export data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in SEQ5 format.
• You can import data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in SEQ5 format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.8 Configuring the SEQ5 Export
18.3.7 Configuring the SEQ5 Import
18.1.21 SIM
Meaning
The abbreviation SIM stands for Simulation data format for single/multiple devices.
Description
You can export the simulation-related files of a SIPROTEC 5 device in the SIM format. This new functionality in
DIGSI 5 provides the ability to export the simulation data and simulate all the devices in the DIGSI 5 project for
test and commissioning needs. The simulation is achieved by importing the simulation file into a signal
processing and automation system which will then simulate the device/devices with the process data as in a
real-time system. This feature also ensures the testing of a device for various real-time system conditions.
File Content
A SIM file contains information about the simulation data of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Transfer Direction
• You can export the data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in the SIM format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.9 Configuring the SIM Export
18.1.22 UAT
Meaning
The abbreviation UAT stands for User-defined application template.
Description
This functionality in DIGSI 5 provides the ability to create a custom template from any device that is config-
ured. You can select one of the active user-defined application templates and use it in the same way as the
standard templates for creating a new device. The new device has the same configuration as the original
device the template was created from, as far as the hardware configuration of the new device allows it. The
User-defined application template can then be used to create new devices (similar or different hardware
configuration) with the same configuration for the respective device type. You can use the UAT in any device
type which is contained in the same DIGSI Device Driver (DDD) as the source of the UAT (for example, source
7SA84 and target 7SL87).
File Content
The UAT file contains all device-specific data (for example, CFC charts, Display pages, protocol mappings,
IEC 61850 configuration, and Test sequences).
Transfer Direction
You can export the data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device in the UAT format.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.10 Configuring the UAT Export
Before exporting data, you must decide if you wish to export the data from an individual SIPROTEC 5 device or
data from the entire project. You can select from various data formats depending on the decision you have
made. For instance, the SCD format can be used only to export entire projects, while the DEX5 format can be
used only for individual SIPROTEC 5 devices.
First select the data format with a dialog. Some data formats can be configured with additional export options.
You also specify the name and file path for the export file with the export dialog. The file extension is preset
for each data format.
Configuring Export
² If you have selected one of the TEA-X, DEX5, DSP5, RIO, ICD, IID, MICS, or UAT formats, the Export
contents prompt will be displayed. Click this prompt.
Additional options or settings will be displayed. These depend on the selected export format.
² You can configure the export with these options and settings. You can learn more about this in the
following topic descriptions in this Help document.
Related Topics
² 18.2.2 Configuring the TEA-X Export
² 18.2.3 Configuring the DSP5 Export
² 18.2.4 Configuring the RIO Export
² 18.2.5 Configuring the ICD Export
² 18.2.6 Configuring the IID Export
² 18.2.7 Configuring the MICS Export
If you select the TEA-X format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can view and select the list of device/devices in
the Devices to export area under the Export contents field to be exported.
You can specify the scope of the export using these export options:
• You can specify which SIPROTEC 5 devices should be included in the export. To do this, use the Devices
to export list box. If you wish to export an individual SIPROTEC 5 device, this list box contains the device
name which you marked in the project tree. If you wish to export an entire project, this list box contains
the names of all the SIPROTEC 5 devices within the project. All SIPROTEC 5 devices are selected as the
default. You can deselect and reselect SIPROTEC 5 devices.
NOTE
i If a check-box option is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for export. At least one
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the export. Only a consistent project or a device can be
exported.
NOTE
i All the GOOSE and report configurations are not exported with the TEA-X file.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.2 TEA-X
If you select the DSP5 format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export options in the
Export contents field. You can specify which display pages should be included for the export using these
export options. To do this, use the Display pages to export list box. The names of all display pages of the
selected SIPROTEC 5 device are displayed in this list box. All display pages are selected as the default. You can
deselect and reselect display pages.
² To select or deselect all display pages, click the Select all check box in the Display pages to export list
box.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding display page is selected for export. At least one display page
must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.16 DSP5
If you select the RIO format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export settings in the Export
contents field.
You can set the following settings:
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.11 RIO
If you select the ICD format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export options in the Export
contents field.
You can specify the type and scope of the export using these export options:
• You can specify which SIPROTEC 5 devices should be included in the export. The Devices to export list
box displays the names of the SIPROTEC 5 devices for which at least one data record is selected for ICD
export. You can set this marking during configuration of the GOOSE communication or of the reporting.
All SIPROTEC 5 devices are selected by default. You can deselect and reselect SIPROTEC 5 devices.
• If you import the exported ICD file together with the additionally exported DEX5 file into a project,
DIGSI 5 can create the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device again from a combination of both
files. However, if you only import the SCD file, DIGSI 5 integrates the data as an external device into the
project.
NOTE
i If a check-box option is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for export. At least one
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.5 ICD
If you select the IID format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export options in the Export
contents field.
You can specify the type and scope of the export using these export options:
• You can specify which SIPROTEC 5 devices should be included in the export. The Devices to export list
box displays the names of the SIPROTEC 5 devices for which at least one data record is selected for IID
export. You can set this marking during configuration of the GOOSE communication or of the reporting.
All SIPROTEC 5 devices are selected by default. You can deselect and reselect SIPROTEC 5 devices.
• From the current version, you can exclude the Alternative Descriptions (or alternative texts) from the IID
export file. You can export the IEC 61850 descriptions in English language only if you select the check
box option Export IEC 61850 descriptions in English under the IEC 61850 settings group in the project
properties. In all other cases, they will not be exported, thus reducing the file size by approximately 10 %.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for export. At least one
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.8 IID
If you select the MICS format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export options in the
Export contents field.
You can specify the type and scope of the export using these export options:
• You can specify which SIPROTEC 5 devices should be included in the export. The Devices to export list
box displays the names of the SIPROTEC 5 devices for which at least one data record is selected for MICS
export. You can set this marking during configuration of the GOOSE communication or of the reporting.
All SIPROTEC 5 devices are selected by default. You can deselect and reselect SIPROTEC 5 devices.
• You can determine if an international character set or a restricted character set is to be used for the
IEC 61850 device description. If you select the international character set, the description texts are
exported in the set edit language. If you select the restricted character set, the description texts are
always exported in English. When selecting a setting, take into consideration if the recipient of the export
file, an automation system, for example, is able to interpret an international character set or only a
restricted character set. The international character set is selected by default.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for export. At least one
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.19 MICS
If you select the SEQ5 format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can show additional export options in the
Export contents field. You can specify which test sequences should be included for the export using these
export options. To do this, use the Test sequences to export list box. The names of all test sequences of the
selected SIPROTEC 5 device are displayed in this list box. All test sequences are selected as the default. You can
deselect and reselect test sequences.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding test sequence is selected for export. At least one test sequence
must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.20 SEQ5
If you select the SIM format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can view and select the device/devices in the
Devices to export area under the Export contents field to be exported.
You can specify type and scope of the export using the following export options:
• This new functionality in DIGSI 5 provides the ability to export the simulation data and simulate all the
devices in the DIGSI 5 project for test and commissioning needs. The simulation is achieved by importing
the simulation file into a signal processing and automation system which will then simulate the device/
devices with the process data as in a real-time system. This feature also ensures the testing of a device for
various real-time system conditions.
NOTE
i For exporting the simulation data, the device must be consistent along with the successful compilation of
Function charts (CFC). Non-modular devices (for example, 7**82 device type) and devices configured with
process-bus modules cannot be exported.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for export. At least one modular
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the export.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.21 SIM
If you select the UAT format in the 22.6.9 Export dialog, you can export the User-defined application template
for the selected configured device.
You can specify type and scope of the export using the following export options:
• This functionality in DIGSI 5 provides the ability to create a custom template from any device that is
configured. You can select one of the active user-defined application templates and use it in the same
way as the standard templates for creating a new device. The new device has the same configuration as
the original device the template was created from, as far as the hardware configuration of the new
device allows it. The User-defined application template can then be used to create new devices (similar
or different hardware configuration) with the same configuration for the respective device type. The
target device must be part of the same DDD as the source for the UAT.
• The template can be stored anywhere in the file system. It contains the complete device configuration
(for example, CFC charts, Display pages, protocols with protocol mappings, (unbound) IEC 61850 config-
uration, and test sequences).
[sc_digsi_UAT_export, 1, en_US]
² Click Export.
The validation of the device configuration is performed. If the configuration is invalid, an error message is
displayed. You must resolve the validation errors to proceed further. With a valid device configuration, the
device data is successfully exported.
Related Topics
² 18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
² 18.1.22 UAT
Before importing data, you must decide if you wish to import the data into an individual SIPROTEC 5 device or
into the project. You can select from various data formats depending on the decision you have made. For
instance, the ELCAD format can be used to import entire projects, while the DSP5 format can be used only for
a single SIPROTEC 5 device.
First select the import file with a file dialog.
An import dialog then provides you with the following information about the selected file:
• Date
This field shows the date and the time when the data was exported.
• Comment
This field shows any comment, which was added during the export.
• Contains
This field gives an overview of the data contained in the file. It shows individual data categories, for
example, Primary topology or Routings.
• Target
This field shows the target of the import, that is, the name of the project or of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
For some data formats, the import dialog offers you additional import options which you can configure. You
can also select a different import file with the import dialog.
² You can configure the import with these options and settings. You can learn more about this in the
following topic descriptions in this Help document.
When importing the data in DIGSI 5 in the TEA-X format, you can customize the import operation via addi-
tional import options in the respective Import dialogs.
TEA-X import involves 2 stages:
[sc_digsi_import, 2, en_US]
[sc_digsi_import2, 2, en_US]
NOTE
i Importing data across different device types is not recommended. Device configuration must be verified
after import as some settings might be changed to default values during the import operation. At least one
SIPROTEC 5 device must be selected to start the import. You can import a maximum number of 100 devices
at a time.
The following table provides a detailed explanation about the TEA-X import for a mapped device (update
device) and an unmapped device (create new device) based on the selection of different subset categories.
² Click Import.
The import operation starts based on your selection and displays the relevant status.
NOTE
i All GOOSE inputs imported via the TEA-X file are unassigned.
If a TEA-X file is imported to the same device it was exported from, the existing assigned GOOSE inputs
remain assigned.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 22.6.30 Import
² 22.6.31 Import TEA-X
² 18.1.2 TEA-X
When you import data in SCD format, you can show additional import options in the Import contents field of
the dialog 22.6.10 Import.
You can import SCD files using the icon in the toolbar of the 22.1.34 IEC Station or using the IEC station
context menu option Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator in the project tree. For a
successful import of the IEC 61850 file, the status of the following parameters is checked and displayed in the
Importing dialog:
• Checking consistency
NOTE
i Using the IEC station context menu option Import, you can import any SCD file which is not created by the
IEC 61850 System Configurator tool. If you import an SCD file manually with this option for any IEC station
that is already associated with an IEC 61850 System Configurator project, the association and the existing
configuration will be lost.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding SIPROTEC 5 device is selected for import. At least one SIPROTEC
5 device must be selected to start the import.
- or -
² Click from the 22.1.34 IEC Station Editor.
- or -
²
Select in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar.
[sc_digsi_scdimport, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i • The device name created for the imported device is based on the Description configured for the
device in the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
• On importing the changes via the options Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator or
Import all devices from IEC 61850 Configurator, the IP address of Time source 1 and Time source 2
displayed under SNTP settings is automatically assigned with the IP address of the primary and secon-
dary clock master configured in the IEC 61850 System Configurator for the devices enabled with IEC
61850 and SNTP protocols on the communication module and/or Port J.
• The IED is created in the newly created project group based on the substation configuration (Voltage
level and the LPHD LNode configuration under the Bay) in the IEC 61850 System Configurator.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 18.1.6 SCD
When you import data in DEX5 format, you can show an additional import option in the Import contents field
of the dialog 22.6.10 Import. You can use this import option to specify if the data of the primary topology
should be imported. In this case, the existing topology will be overwritten. A precondition for this is that the
import file must contain primary topology data.
You can import the data from a DEX5 file only into a project. In doing so, the device data is used to open a
new SIPROTEC 5 device in the project.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 18.1.3 DEX5
If you import data in the ST format (DIGSI 4 function charts), you can show the additional Function charts
(CFC) to import list box in the Import contents field of the 22.6.10 Import dialog. You can select the function
charts which should be included in the import using this list box. This list box contains the names of all func-
tion charts whose data is located in the imported file. All function charts are selected as the default. You can
deselect and reselect function charts.
NOTE
i You can only import function charts which were exported with DIGSI 4 version 4.83 or higher.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding function chart is selected for import. At least one function chart
must be selected to start the import.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 18.1.18 ST
When you import data in DSP5 format, you can show the additional Display pages to import list box in the
Import contents field of the dialog 22.6.10 Import. With this list box, you select the display pages which
should be included in the import. This list box contains the names of all display pages whose data is located in
the imported file. All display pages are selected as the default. You can deselect and reselect display pages.
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding display page is selected for import. At least one display page
must be selected to start the import.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 18.1.16 DSP5
When you import data in SEQ5 format, you can show the additional Test sequences to import list box in the
Import contents field of the dialog 22.6.10 Import. With this list box, you select the test sequences which
should be included in the import. This list box contains the names of all test sequences whose data is located
in the imported file. All test sequences are selected as the default. You can deselect and reselect test
sequences .
NOTE
i If a check box is marked, the corresponding test sequence is selected for import. At least one test sequence
must be selected to start the import.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 18.1.20 SEQ5
With this feature in DIGSI 5, it is possible to use a previously created user-defined application template (UAT)
and import specific data from the function groups configured in the original device to matching function
groups of one or several target devices.
The following parameters are considered for the mapped function groups:
• The subordinate structure (for example, subordinate FNs, FBs, and signals) is created or deleted by
selecting the respective options, so that after import, the subordinate structure of the target matches
with the source).
Note: Signals are created with their default values. Any changes done to the signal in the source are not
taken over to the target.
• Custom texts, in case the respective object does not already have a custom text in the target (wherein
the original target text is kept).
You can configure the UAT import in the 22.6.11 Apply Settings from User-Defined Application Template
dialog by selecting the following options:
• Select the matching function groups that should be mapped as a source and the target.
Restriction: They must be of the same type.
• Delete the subordinate objects that are present in the target, but are not available in the source.
[sc_digsi_uat, 1, en_US]
NOTE
i The source and the target function groups must be of identical types. If they are, they can be mapped, even
if they are from devices of different device types or different DDDs. The DDD version, however, must be the
same for the source and target device.
With the user-defined application template, the data of the source function group can be applied to several
target function groups of several devices at once. The 22.6.11 Apply Settings from User-Defined Applica-
tion Template dialog can be opened for a single target device, for a group folder, or for the project folder.
In the latter case, all the devices under it are displayed as possible target devices.
NOTE
i The nodes of the target devices in the project tree can be expanded and collapsed to show/hide their subor-
dinate FG. The non-matching target devices are not displayed in the grid. If no matching devices were
found, the import dialog is not opened. Instead, an error message is displayed. FGs that are not supported
for this feature are not displayed in the grid.
Related Topics
² 18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
² 22.6.11 Apply Settings from User-Defined Application Template
² 18.1.22 UAT
With the documentation function of DIGSI 5, you can create and manage system documentation in printed
form. You can prepare project data as a standardized circuit manual and design it in a uniform layout. You can
print out the entire project data, a compact overview, or data from individual categories.
When designing and printing the document, you have the following possibilities:
• You can use one of the delivered templates for the cover sheet and the print layout. This includes
templates for technical product documentation according to the ISO standard.
• You can create your own templates based on the delivered templates. You can adjust these, for example,
to your company layout and integrate your company logo.
• You can select a template for printing and examine the expected print result in the print preview.
Related Topics
19.1.2 Opening the Document Information Editor
19.1.7.1 Opening a Template
19.2.2 Determining the Scope of Printing
19.3.2 Opening the Print Preview
19.2.1 Starting the Printing
With 22.1.18 Document Information Editor, you can edit the layout of the project documentation.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.5 Using Document Information
With Frames Editor, you can edit the layout of the project documentation.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.5 Using Document Information
With Cover Pages Editor, you can edit the layout of the project documentation.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.5 Using Document Information
For every project, you can enter document information, for example, the general information, the user details,
and creation date/time. You can select the desired cover page and frame. This information applies for the
complete project and is independent of certain templates. However, you can accept individual document
information in templates with the help of auto texts. The information referenced in this manner is then added
to the template when it is printed.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
NOTE
i If the maximum or minimum display size is reached, the respective button will become inactive.
² Release the mouse button as soon as the template has reached the desired size.
The template will be displayed in the selected size in the working area.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.6.5 Using the Ruler
² 19.1.6.3 Setting the Unit of Measurement
² 19.1.6.4 Using the Grid
² 19.1.6.2 Using the Hand Mode
The button in the toolbar is marked and the mouse pointer changes into a hand symbol.
The button in the toolbar is marked and the mouse pointer changes into the standard arrow symbol.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.6.1 Scaling the Document
• Millimeter
• Centimeter
• Inch
If a value relates to a unit of measurement, for example the width of an object, the value is automatically
updated if you set a different unit of measurement.
The selection of a unit of measurement affects the following properties:
• The size of the objects (entry box, form, and image field)
• The position of the objects (entry box, form, and image field)
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.6.1 Scaling the Document
² 19.1.6.5 Using the Ruler
² 19.1.6.4 Using the Grid
² 19.1.6.2 Using the Hand Mode
• You can enable or disable a function that automatically aligns the objects on the grid during scaling or
moving.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.6.1 Scaling the Document
² 19.1.6.5 Using the Ruler
² 19.1.6.3 Setting the Unit of Measurement
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.6.1 Scaling the Document
² 19.1.6.3 Setting the Unit of Measurement
² 19.1.6.4 Using the Grid
² 19.1.6.2 Using the Hand Mode
• Document information
This category includes layout templates for the document information.
• Cover Pages
This category includes the layout templates for the cover pages delivered with DIGSI 5.
• Frames
This category includes layout templates for the frames.
First select a category and then a template from this category.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.7.2 Adding a Template
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.7.1 Opening a Template
• Text field
The text field stands as a placeholder for a text element from a document information. In the properties
of the text field, you set which text from a document information should be automatically inserted during
printing.
• Page number
The correct page number is automatically applied when printing.
• Free text
You can enter freely selectable text in the properties of the text field. The text is static and is not influ-
enced by the document information selected at the time of printing.
• Image
Select the graphic file in the properties of the placeholder in the Inspector window. Images in the formats
BMP, JPEG, PNG, EMF or GIF are possible.
• Formatting text
NOTE
i You can check and change the unit of measurement in the template properties.
NOTE
i You can check and change the unit of measurement in the template properties.
Formatting Text
² In the Properties tab, select the group 21.8.3 Text - View.
² You can optionally change the appearance of the text. You can set the font, font style, the text size and
select different markups.
² You can optionally change the distance of the text to the borders of the text box. In order to do this,
enter values in the Bottom, Top, Left, Center and Right text boxes that match the currently set unit of
measurement.
² You can optionally change the horizontal and vertical orientation of the text in the text box. In order to
do this, use the Horizontal and Vertical list boxes.
NOTE
i The selected settings are always valid for the entire text.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image
² 19.1.8.4 Marking an Object
² 19.1.8.5 Changing the Sequence of Objects
² 19.1.8.6 Deleting, Copying, or Pasting Objects
In order to configure the image field and the image, you have the following possibilities:
NOTE
i Depending on the selected size mode, an image within the image field will be trimmed or scaled propor-
tionately.
NOTE
i You can check and change the unit of measurement in the template properties. Depending on the selected
size mode, an image within the image field will be trimmed or scaled proportionately.
NOTE
i You can check and change the unit of measurement in the template properties.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
² 19.1.8.4 Marking an Object
² 19.1.8.5 Changing the Sequence of Objects
² 19.1.8.6 Deleting, Copying, or Pasting Objects
Removing a Marking
² Click in a non-marked area on the template.
- or -
² Mark a different object.
NOTE
i You can mark additional objects or remove an existing marking. To do so, hold down the <CTRL> key while
you left-click the corresponding objects.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
² 19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image
² 19.1.8.5 Changing the Sequence of Objects
² 19.1.8.6 Deleting, Copying, or Pasting Objects
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
² 19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image
² 19.1.8.4 Marking an Object
² 19.1.8.6 Deleting, Copying, or Pasting Objects
Deleting Objects
² Mark an individual object or a group of objects.
² Right-click a marked object and then click Delete in the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the 22.7.1 DIGSI 5 Toolbar.
Copying Objects
² Mark an individual object or a group of objects.
² Right-click a marked object and then click Copy in the context menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar.
Inserting Objects
² Right-click on the desired insertion position in the template.
² Click Paste in the text menu.
- or -
²
Click the button in the DIGSI 5 toolbar.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
² 19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image
² 19.1.8.4 Marking an Object
² 19.1.8.5 Changing the Sequence of Objects
Before starting the printing process, decide on one of the 3 basic possibilities:
• You want to print an individual data category, for example, the function settings or the single-line config-
uration. In this case, mark the assigned entry in the project tree. Some data categories must be displayed
in the working area. You can find more information in the respective topic descriptions.
• You want to print a number of data categories or all data from a SIPROTEC 5 device. In this case, mark in
the 3.1.2 Project Tree the name of the concerned SIPROTEC 5 device.
• You want to print a number of data categories or all data from the current project. In this case you mark
the project name in the project tree.
NOTE
i You can still cancel printing when it is in progress, by clicking the button in the object bar.
Starting the Printing Process for the Data from a SIPROTEC 5 Device or from the Project
² Open the project tree.
² Mark the project name or a device name in the project.
² Click Print in the Project menu.
The 22.6.24 Print dialog opens.
² Use this dialog to select a printer, a document layout, and the properties. You find more information
about this under 19.2.3 Selecting Print Options.
² Click Print.
The Print dialog closes, the printing progress is displayed in the object bar and the selected data is printed.
NOTE
i You can still cancel printing when it is in progress, by clicking the button in the object bar.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
If you want to print a number of data categories or all data from a SIPROTEC 5 device or from the project, you
can determine the scope of printing. For this, you can use the dialog 22.6.24 Print. This dialog is displayed
when you mark the project name or a device name in the 3.1.2 Project Tree and then click Print in the Project
menu.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 19.2.3 Selecting Print Options
² 22.5.15 Print Options
Before the printout is started, select a printer, a document template and a cover page. For this, you can use
the dialog 22.6.24 Print.
This dialog is displayed after one of the following actions:
• You have marked an individual data category in the project tree or opened the data in the working area
and then clicked Print in the Project menu.
• You have predefined the scope of printing and then clicked Print button from the DIGSI 5 toolbar.
• You have predefined the print options in the 22.5.15 Print Options and then clicked Print button from
the DIGSI 5 toolbar.
²
Click .
NOTE
i The scope of print options available in the Print dialog vary depending on the elements to be printed.
Related Topics
² 19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
² 22.5.15 Print Options
19.2.4 Printing Labels for LEDs, Push-Buttons, and Function Keys from DIGSI
This feature allows you to print the labels for LEDs, push-buttons, and function keys displayed under the prop-
erties of the 22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor in DIGSI instead of using an extra word template. The respec-
tive device name is also printed.
You can add an operational panel with LEDs and push-buttons (Expans. mod., push-but.(max. 8)/red LEDs)
and print labeling strips for this module. Labeling strips have correct size. The labeling strip of each LED
contains 2 lines. If the text of the user label is too long for one line, it is printed on both lines. If the user label
of the LED is too long, the text is cut off.
You can edit the user labels of the LEDs in the Properties tab of the Devices and networks editor.
NOTE
i By default, the check box option Adjust printer margins is disabled with the default printer margin
settings. Activate the check box option to modify and enter the desired margin value for the Top and Left
margins.
² Click OK.
The Print dialog of Windows appears.
² Click Print.
The Print dialog closes and the labels for LEDs, push-buttons, and function keys configured in DIGSI are
printed. The device name is printed at the top of the page (on every page).
The device name is printed for both print options:
• With border
• Without border
Related Topics
² 22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor
Before printing, you can check the expected print result with 22.6.23 Print Preview.
The print preview offers the following possibilities:
• You can start the document print directly from the print preview.
Related Topics
19.3.2 Opening the Print Preview
19.3.5 Scaling a View
19.3.6 Navigating in the Print Preview
19.2.1 Starting the Printing
Before opening 22.6.23 Print Preview, you must decide on one of the 3 basic possibilities:
• Use the print preview to check an individual data category, for example, the function settings or the
single-line configuration. In this case, you mark the assigned entry in the project tree. In the case of a few
data categories it is necessary to have the data displayed in the working area. More information about
this can be found in the respective topic descriptions in this Help.
• You want to check a number of data categories or all data from a SIPROTEC 5 device with the print
preview. In this case you mark the name of the SIPROTEC 5 device concerned in the project tree.
• You want to check a number of data categories or all data from the current project with the print
preview. In this case you mark the project name in the project tree.
Checking the Data from a SIPROTEC 5 Device or the Project with the Print Preview
² Mark the project name or a device name in the project tree.
² Click Print Preview in the Project menu.
The 22.6.23 Print Preview dialog opens.
² Determine the preview scope with this dialog. You find more information about this under 19.3.3 Deter-
mining the Preview Scope.
² Use this dialog to select the document layout and the properties. You find more information about this
under 19.3.4 Selecting Preview Options.
² Click Preview.
The Print preview dialog closes. The print preview is displayed in the working area.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
² 19.3.5 Scaling a View
² 19.3.6 Navigating in the Print Preview
If you want to print a number of data categories or all data from a SIPROTEC 5 device or from the project, you
can determine the preview scope. For this, you can use the dialog 22.6.23 Print Preview. This is displayed
when you marking the project name or a device name in the 3.1.2 Project Tree and then click Print Preview in
the Project menu.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
Before the print preview is started, select the document layout and the properties. For this, you can use the
dialog 22.6.23 Print Preview.
This dialog is displayed after one of the following actions:
• You have marked an individual data category in the project tree and then clicked Print preview in the
Project menu.
• You have marked the data in the working area and then clicked Preview in the Project menu.
• You have predefined the preview scope with the dialog 22.6.23 Print Preview and then clicked Preview.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
You can scale the view of the 22.6.23 Print Preview and thus change the display size of the document.
You have the following possibilities:
NOTE
NOTE
i When the maximum or minimum display size is reached, the respective button becomes inactive.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
In order to get from one page of the document to the next, you have the following possibilities:
• You can move the pages vertically with the scroll bar.
• You can move the pages vertically with the hand tool.
NOTE
i Please observe the difference between the previous/next page and the previous/next view. For pages, the
terms Previous and Next relate to the 2 bordering pages that are located before and after the currently
visible page. With views, the terms relate to the previous display process. If you navigate through a docu-
ment, the sequence of the displayed pages is documented in a list. With the Previous view and Next view
actions, you can navigate within this list and display the corresponding pages.
- or -
²
In order to display the 1st page of the document, click the button in the Print preview toolbar.
- or -
²
In order to display the next page of the document, click the button in the Print preview toolbar.
- or -
²
In order to display the last page of the document, click the button in the Print preview toolbar.
Corresponding with your respective action, the appropriate page is displayed in the print preview.
- or -
²
In order to display the next view, click the button in the Print preview toolbar.
Corresponding with your respective action, the appropriate page is displayed in the print preview.
The button in the toolbar is marked and the mouse pointer changes into a hand symbol.
² Click on the document in the display area and hold the mouse button.
² Move the document in a vertical direction.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
If you are satisfied with the expected print result, you can start the printout directly from 22.5.2 Print Preview.
Before the document is printed, select a printer.
Related Topics
² 19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
² 19.2.3 Selecting Print Options
• Opening DIGSI 5
• Closing DIGSI 5
[sc_EventViewer, 1, en_US]
The General tab displays the event properties to provide more information about the event logged. The ID
displayed in the figure is the process ID of the DIGSI instance for which the event is logged.
[sc_EventViewer_Properties, 1, en_US]
• Role-based access control with central user management (consumes function points):
With this option, you can configure the role-based access control settings using the Radius server.
For more information about user roles in DIGSI 5, refer to 2.1.5 Role-Based Views in DIGSI 5.
Element Explanation
Action The button in this column opens a dialog in which you can modify the current connec-
tion password. This button is active only after you have used the button
in the 22.7.14 Toolbar Editor Operations Safety and Access Control to retrieve the
current status of the connection password from the SIPROTEC 5 device. As a prerequi-
site for this, DIGSI 5 online must be connected with the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Description The field in this column contains a description of the connection password.
Role-based access control with central user management (consumes function points)
Password secur.
Max. login attempts With this option, you can set the limit on the number of unsuccessful login attempts
that a user can make.
Time lapse With this option, you can define the time period to allow the user to make the speci-
fied number of unsuccessful attempts to access the device.
Blocked duration With this option, you can define the time period wherein the user access is blocked
after making maximum permitted number of unsuccessful attempts to access the
device.
Role-based acc
User cache size With this option, you can define the number of users to be cached by the device so
that the cached users requests do not go to the RADIUS server.
Radius prot.
Server A
IP address Indicates the IP address of the Radius server.
Server UDP port Indicates the port number of the Radius server machine.
Module port Indicates the port of the device through which the SIPROTEC 5 device communicates
with the Radius server.
Pre-shared key With this option, you can enter the pre-shared key value.
This option acts as a security mechanism to authenticate and protect the communica-
tion between the RADIUS server and the device. When the configuration is loaded, the
device verifies if the pre-shared key is the same as that mentioned in the Radius
server.
Server B
Enable Sec. Server With this option, you can enable the secondary server.
IP address Indicates the IP address of the Radius server.
Server UDP port Indicates the port number of the Radius server machine.
Module port Indicates the port of the device through which the SIPROTEC 5 device communicates
with the Radius server.
Pre-shared key With this option, you can enter the pre-shared key value.
This option acts as a security mechanism to authenticate and protect the communica-
tion between the RADIUS server and the device. When the configuration is loaded, the
device verifies if the pre-shared key is the same as that mentioned in the Radius
server.
Emergency Account Settings
With this option, you can check the status of the emergency account in the device.
Clicking the refresh button, a confirmation prompt is displayed to confirm the
security-administrator credentials. After successful user authentication, the following
options are displayed:
Element Explanation
Configure With this option, you can change the emergency password. On clicking the Configure
button, a confirmation prompt is displayed to confirm the Security-administrator
credentials.
After successful user authentication, a window to change the emergency password
with the following options is displayed:
• HMI password:
This password is used to login to the emergency account via SIPROTEC 5 device.
• Remote password:
This password is used to login to the emergency account via DIGSI 5.
Reset With this option, you can change the emergency password. On clicking the Reset
button, a user-authentication prompt is displayed to confirm the Security-adminis-
trator credentials.
After successful user authentication, the set emergency password is removed.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Security Editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Security Editor.
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.2 Opening the Operations Safety and Access Control Editor
2.1.5 Role-Based Views in DIGSI 52.1.6 Deleting Saved Login Credentials
General
Security log cap. warn With this text box, you can define the percentage value of the security log
buffer at which a capacity exhaustion warning is logged in the device. The
percentage value can be set between 5 % to 100 % at a step size of 5 %. You
can set the value to 0 % if you do not want to log the warning in the device.
syslog server A
Enable logging With this check box, you can enable or disable the logging of security events to
the log servers. On selecting the check box option, the settings in the Configu-
ration to server A group are enabled for configuring.
IP address With this text box, you can enter the IP address of the log server A.
Server UDP port With this text box, you can enter the port number of the log server through
which SIPROTEC 5 communicates with the server A.
Module port With this list box, you can select the desired Ethernet port available in the
device. It is the port of the SIPROTEC 5 device that logs the events to the server
A.
syslog server B
Enable logging With this check box, you can enable or disable the logging of security events to
the log servers. On selecting the check box option, the settings in the Configu-
ration to server B group are enabled for configuring.
IP address With this text box, you can enter the IP address of the log server B.
Server UDP port With this text box, you can enter the port number of the log server through
which SIPROTEC 5 communicates with the server B.
Module port With this list box, you can select the desired Ethernet port available in the
device. It is the port of the SIPROTEC 5 device that logs the events to the server
B.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Security Editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Security Editor.
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
• No access:
No DIGSI communication is possible via this interface.
• Read-only access:
You only have read access to the device via this interface.
NOTE
i Under DIGSI access, if a Port is set to read-only access, then the port cannot be used in the device settings
for DIGSI 5. To ensure that the user is not locked out of the write access inadvertently by applying too
many restrictions, at least one Ethernet port must be set with the read and write access.
Web access
Before operating the device via a Web browser, you first have to check the security settings. For more informa-
tion about Web browser, refer to the chapter 17.1.9 Opening a Web Browser using Link from DIGSI 5. With the
security settings, you can restrict the access rights for the Web access (Port J and Ethernet communication
module).
You can set the security settings in DIGSI 5 in the Project tree under Safety and security → Network access
security → Web access.
You can set the following access rights:
• No access:
This interface does not allow access to the device.
• Read-only access:
This interface only allows read access to the device.
NOTE
i Under Web access, a read-only port can be used in the Online access view only.
Client Authentication
NOTE
i For more information in detail about the DIGSI 5 client authentication and to setup the DIGSI 5 CA Store,
refer to the Security manual.
You can configure the DIGSI client authentication for a device via the Trusted CA list box. From the list box
Trusted CA, select the CA that you use to issue your DIGSI 5 client certificates. This list box shows the CAs that
are currently imported in the DIGSI 5 CA store. The default value of this list box is SIPROTEC 5 trusted certifi-
cate authority. If you have selected this value, the default behavior for the connection from DIGSI 5 to the
SIPROTEC 5 device with Siemens issued DIGSI 5 client certificates is activated.
• Available CAs are imported in the DIGSI 5 CA store (see chapter 20.5.1 Setup the DIGSI 5 CA Store).
NOTE
i If the RBAC is enabled, only users in the role of a SECADM or an Administrator can configure the
IEEE 802.1X certificate authentication feature. If the device must be reset to factory settings, Siemens
recommends activating the emergency account.
Configuration in DIGSI 5
To configure the IEEE 802.1X feature for a device, select the target device in the project tree, navigate to
Safety and security and select Network access security. From the list box of a module slot, select the CA
that you use to verify the IEEE 802.1X server certificate. The default value of this list box is Disabled. Load the
settings to the device for them to take effect. In order for the IEEE 802.1X protocol to take effect, you must
sign and upload the certificate manually. For more information on how to upload the IEEE 802.1X certificate
to a device and to verify the status of the IEEE 802.1X feature in a device, refer to the Security manual.
Related Topics
20.5.1 Setup the DIGSI 5 CA Store
20.5.2 Configuration of the DIGSI 5 Client Authentication Security Feature
17.2.3 Loading Security Configuration to Device
In order to use your own client certificates, you must first make DIGSI 5 aware of the corresponding issuing CA
certificate. That means the CA with which you issue the client certificates you will install (along with the
respective private keys) on all Windows user accounts that are authorized to use DIGSI 5.
To perform this step, you must add your issuing CA to the DIGSI 5 CA store. The DIGSI 5 CA store manages a
list of all CAs that can be configured for any service that requires a secure authentication based on your PKI.
You can access the DIGSI 5 CA store via the menu Tools > Manage certificate authorities (CA):
[sc_Manage_CA, 1, en_US]
There are 2 possibilities to add an existing certificate authority (CA) to the DIGSI 5 CA store:
NOTE
i Currently there is a limitation of 8 CAs that can be managed within the DIGSI 5 CA store. Exceeding the
limit truncates the list. Before adding more CAs, remove unused CA manually.
NOTE
i If the CA is already referenced within one or multiple devices in the open project, a warning appears if you
try to remove it..
NOTE
i If you have opened a project with a CA that is currently not part of this CA store, a configured CA will auto-
matically be added to the DIGSI CA store. The same applies to online connections to an existing device.
You must configure your devices to only accept DIGSI 5 connection requests with your client certificates.
To configure the DIGSI client authentication for a device, proceed as follows:
² In the project tree, select the respective device, navigate to Safety and security and select Network
access security:
[sc_Network_access_security, 1, en_US]
[sc_client_authentication, 1, en_US]
² From the list box Trusted CA, select the CA that you use to issue your DIGSI 5 client certificates.
The list box shows the CAs that are currently imported in the DIGSI 5 CA store (see chapter 20.5.1 Setup
the DIGSI 5 CA Store). The default value of this list box is SIPROTEC 5 trusted certificate authority. If
you have selected this value, the default behavior for the connection from DIGSI 5 to the SIPROTEC 5
device with Siemens issued DIGSI 5 client certificates is activated.
Load these settings to the device for them to take effect.
NOTE
i To verify the configured CA via the user interface, navigate to Settings → Security → Client Auth → Trust-
edCA.
² To establish a communication with the device, a client certificate issued by the selected CA must be
installed on the DIGSI PC.
If there are several client certificates to select from, you are asked to select one. If there is no client certif-
icate installed on the DIGSI 5 PC, a respective error message is shown.
21.1 Project
21.1.1 Project
Related Topics
5.1.2 Creating a Project
2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
• You select the IEC 61850 protocol within the current project for the first
time for a communication channel.
IEC 61850 station descrip- This text box displays the SCD file location details.
tion file
Create new IEC 61850 The button enables you to create a new system configurator project. If you click
station description this button, the Create new IEC 61850 station description (SCD)... dialog opens
(SCD)... with the Save button option to select the desired SCD file path.
With this button, you can assign only an existing system-configurator project with
different SCD editions (for example, Edition 1, Edition 2, or Edition 2.1). If you
click this button, the Assign IEC 61850 station description (SCD) dialog opens
with the Open button option. For additional information about Edition 2.1, refer
to the IEC 61850 System Configurator manual.
OK This button is used to accept the selection and close the dialog.
Cancel This button is used to reject the settings and close the dialog.
Related Topics
5.1.2 Creating a Project
15.6 Selecting the IEC 61850 Edition
Related Topics
5.1.2 Creating a Project
2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
• You select the IEC 61850 protocol within the current project for the first
time for a communication channel.
Type This field contains the type of SIPROTEC 5 device, for example 7SA. You cannot
change the type.
Serial number Using the serial number, a unique connection between a real SIPROTEC 5 device
and an offline configuration in DIGSI 5 is defined. As soon as you assign a
SIPROTEC 5 device to an offline configuration or initialize a SIPROTEC 5 device
with an offline configuration, the serial number of the SIPROTEC 5 device is
entered in this text box. Alternatively, you can manually enter the serial number
of the SIPROTEC 5 device into the text box. You can find the serial number on the
enclosure of the SIPROTEC 5 device base module.
Configuration version This field contains the version number of the current device configuration, for
example V01.00.00. You cannot change the version number.
Product code This field contains the long product code of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You cannot
change the product code directly.
Short product code This field displays the short product code of the SIPROTEC 5 device which has a
valid short product code. For a device without a valid short product code, this
field is empty in DIGSI 5. If you load configuration to the device with a valid short
product code, the Short product code value is displayed successfully under
Device information of the device display allowing you to verify the ordered
device. If you load configuration to the device in the absence of a valid short
product code, then the symbol --- is displayed for Short product code under
Device information in the device display.
CPU type This option is displayed only for modular devices. With this list box, you can
modify the CPU type of the device.
From DIGSI 5, version V7.80 on, it is not possible to change the CPU type of the
device. If you have added the device using DDDs with version V7.80 or a higher
version, you cannot change the CPU type of the configured project device from
CP300 to CP200 or vice versa.
The following CPU-type options can be set for the modular device:
• CP200
• CP300
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
6.1.6 Setting the On-Site Operation Panel Language
14.3 Selecting Device IP Address for Communication
17.1.6 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an Offline Configuration
17.1.3 Initializing a SIPROTEC 5 Device
21.2.2 Settings
Device Settings
Edit mode This list box is used to select one of the display modes Primary, Secondary, or
Percent. Depending on your selection, all setting values will be shown as primary
values, secondary values, or percentage values. Enter the values in the selected
format.
Number of settings With this list box, you define the number of settings groups used. The default value is
groups 1. A SIPROTEC 5 device can manage a maximum of 8 settings groups.
Active settings group With this list box, you define one of the settings groups as the active settings group.
There are 3 ways of selecting a settings group:
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
8.2.3.3 Selecting between Secondary Values, Primary Values, or Percentage Values
8.2.1.2 Changing the Number of Settings Groups
8.2.1.3 Activating a Settings Group
8.2.1.4 Copying a Settings Group
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
This group contains properties of the on-site operation panel of a base module. The properties that are
actually available depend on the on-site operation panel used.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
This group contains properties of the on-site operation panel of an expansion module. The properties that are
actually available depend on the on-site operation panel used.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Element Explanation
LED color The LED can light up in the colors red or green. This list box is only available for LEDs
of the on-site control unit of a basic module.
User label If necessary, enter in the text box a label for the LED. The label is shown, for example,
in a tool tip in the 22.3.2 Information Routing matrix when the mouse pointer is
placed on the column of the LED.
Module This field contains the information about the type of module in which the LED is
installed, for example, the base module or expansion module. You cannot change this
information.
Hardware type This text box contains the name of the on-site operation panel in which the LED is
installed. You cannot change the name.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Module This field contains the information about the type of module in which the binary
output is installed, therefore the base module or expansion module. You cannot
change this information.
Hardware type This field contains the name of the input/output module in which the binary output is
installed. You cannot change the name.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.12 Editing Hardware Component Property Values
Related Topics
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
6.5.2.3 Renaming a Display Page
6.5.2.4 Changing a Sequence of Display Pages
6.5.2.5 Defining a Display Page as Standard Page
Element Explanation
Signal type This field contains the type of a connected signal, for example, Double-point indica-
tion. You cannot change the signal type. If you assign a different signal to the
element, the signal type will be updated.
Signal path This field contains the path of a connected signal, for example,
SIP5_7SA85_Type_1\Application Base2010\Circuit-breaker 1\Circuit-breaker. You
cannot change the signal path.
You can see by the path from which device the signal originates and where you will
find the signal in the signal catalog.
Connected device If the element is connected to a signal, this field contains the name of the target
device for the signal. You cannot change this name.
Default object If this check box is marked, the element is selected when the display page is first
shown in the display of the SIPROTEC 5 device. The marking of another element
which was marked as a standard selected element is removed automatically by this
action. The check box is only active for elements which can be selected in the display
of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Standard This field contains the name of the currently set standard, that is, either IEC or ANSI.
You cannot change this name.
The selection of standard influences how elements will be displayed when inserted.
However, changing the standard does not affect elements already inserted into a
display page.
Related Topics
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
6.5.4.1 Renaming a Graphical Element in a Display Page
6.5.3.5 Connecting Graphical Elements in a Display Page with a Signal
3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
Signal path This field contains the path of a connected signal. You cannot change the signal path.
If you assign a different signal to the dynamic field, the signal path will be updated.
Connected device If the element is connected to a signal, this field contains the name of the target
device for the signal. You cannot change this name.
Related Topics
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
6.5.3.4 Inserting a Signal in a Display Page
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
This group contains information about the timestamp of a function chart (CFC).
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
21.4.3 Sidebars/Layout
This group contains the properties of sidebars and the layout of a function chart (CFC).
Sidebars
Static sidebars If you select this option, a permanent area will be
reserved in the function-block diagram on the right
and left. This area is exclusively for sidebar entries, for
example for interconnections throughout the func-
tion-block diagram.
Dynamic sidebars If you select this option, the sidebar entries will only
be shown in the function-block diagram when neces-
sary.
A function-block diagram configured in this way
differs from a function-block diagram with fixed side-
bars by way of the following properties:
Element Explanation
No sidebars If you select this option, the function-block diagram
will be displayed without margin bars. Instead, so-
called connectors show the interconnections to other
function-block diagrams or to operands. The connec-
tors are placed next to the interconnected block
connection. Cross-sheet interconnections are
displayed as if they are on one sheet.
Double-row sidebar entries With this check box, you select between 1-line and 2-
line sidebar entries. This is how you make more space
in the sidebar in the horizontal or vertical direction.
Sidebar size With this list box, you set the width of the sidebars.
This is done by clicking the arrow buttons of the list
box. Alternately, you can enter a value in the entry
field of the list box.
Layout
Vertical With this list box, you increase or reduce the number
of sheets of the function-block diagram in the vertical
direction. This is done by clicking the arrow buttons
of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a value in
the entry field of the list box.
Horizontal With this list box, you increase or reduce the number
of sheets of the function-block diagram in the hori-
zontal direction. This is done by clicking the arrow
buttons of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a
value in the entry field of the list box.
Sheet size With this list box, you select a sheet size. You can
select between the formats A3, A4, and A5.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.3.3 Overview of Sidebars
12.1.3.1 Adjusting the Layout in the CFC Data Flow View
This group contains the general properties of a text box in a function chart (CFC).
Layer
Text box in the back- If you select this check box, the text box will be moved into the background. You can
ground then position interconnections and blocks through the text box.
Background
Background color With this list box, you select a filling color for the text field.
Element Explanation
Border
Border width This entry field contains the current line width in pixels. The default value after inser-
tion of the text box is 0. To modify the width of the line, enter a value in the entry
field.
Border color With this list box, you can select a color for the border line.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.4.5 Adding and Editing a Text Box in a CFC in the Data Flow View
21.4.5 Text
This group contains the text properties of a text box in a function chart (CFC).
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.4.5 Adding and Editing a Text Box in a CFC in the Data Flow View
This group contains the general properties of a block in a function chart (CFC).
Block-Instance Data
Name This text box contains a consecutively numbered default name for the block instance.
Enter another name for the block instance if necessary.
Comment You have the option of entering a comment in this text box.
Element Explanation
Block-Type Data
Type This field contains the type of the block, for example, AND. You cannot change this
block type.
Comment This field contains a comment about the block that has been preset in the factory. You
cannot change this comment.
Author This field contains the user name by which you are logged on to the operating system
when the insertion was made. You cannot change this name.
Version This field contains a version number of the block that has been preset in the factory.
You cannot change this version number.
Changed on This field contains the date on which parameter values of the block were changed.
You cannot change this date directly. It changes as soon as the settings change.
Created on This field contains the date on which the block was inserted into the function-block
diagram. You cannot change this date.
Changed by This field contains the user name by which you are logged on to the operating system
when the change was made. You cannot change this name.
Instruction This field contains an instruction defined in the factory. You cannot change this
instruction.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.3 Block
12.1.4.1 Block Library
21.4.7 Parameters
This group contains the terminals properties of a component in a function chart (CFC).
Element Explanation
Invisible This column contains 1 check box for each block connection. If you select this check
box, the connection will be hidden on the block. To show the block connection again,
remove the selection.
The check box will be synchronized with the check box in the properties of the block
connection. The conditions of the 2 check boxes are therefore always identical.
For test This column contains 1 check box for each block connection. If you select this check
box, the connection will be taken into account during CFC tracing.
The check box will be synchronized with the check box in the properties of the block
connection. The conditions of the 2 check boxes are therefore always identical.
Comment This column contains 1 text box for each connection. You have the option of entering
a comment in this text box.
The comment will be synchronized with the comment in the properties of the block
connection. The contents of the 2 text boxes are therefore always identical.
Comment (type) This field contains a comment preset in the factory. You cannot change this comment.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.3 Block
This group contains the general properties of invisible interconnections in a function chart (CFC).
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.3 Block
21.4.9 Resources
This group contains information on the resources of a component in a function chart (CFC).
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.3 Block
12.1.7.1 Checking Consistency
This group contains the general properties of a block connection in a function chart (CFC).
Instance Data
Name This field contains the name of the block connection. You cannot change this name.
Value This entry field contains the current value of the block connection. You can change
this value. Click the entry field and enter a new value. A plausibility and syntax verifi-
cation checks the value. If the value is permissible, it is accepted. Otherwise, you will
receive a warning.
The value will be synchronized with the value in the properties of the block connec-
tion. The values in the 2 entry fields are therefore always identical.
To the right of the entry field, there is a check box. If the value entered is valid, the
selection of the check box will automatically be removed. If you select the check box
again, the value of the block connection will be reset to the default value. The Value
field in the Type data area shows the default value of the block connection.
Unit With this list box, you can select a unit for the block connection. The unit will be
synchronized with the unit in the properties of the block connection. The selected
units are therefore always identical.
To the right of the list box, there is a check box. As soon as you select a unit, the
selection of the check box will automatically be removed. If you select the check box
again, the unit of the block connection will be reset to the default unit. The Unit field
in the Type data area shows the default value of the block connection.
Invisible If you select this check box, the block connection will be hidden on the block. To
show the block connection again, remove the selection.
The check box will be synchronized with the check box in the connection properties
of the block. The conditions of the 2 check boxes are therefore always identical. The
Invisible check box in the Type data area shows the default value of the block
connection.
Element Explanation
For test If you select this check box, the block connection will be taken into account in the
CFC tracing.
The check box will be synchronized with the check box in the connection properties
of the block. The conditions of the 2 check boxes are therefore always identical. The
For test check box in the Type data area shows the default value of the block
connection.
Comment You have the option of entering a comment in this text box.
The comment will be synchronized with the comment in the connection properties
of the block. The contents of the 2 text boxes are therefore always identical.
Type Data
Type This field contains the data type of the block connection. The following data types
are possible: BOOL, BMEM, DINT, WORD, INT, REAL, and UINT.
Value This field contains the default value of the block connection.
If you insert a block into a function-block diagram, the block connection will be
preset to the default value for the connection type. If the default value of the
connection type changes, it will propagate the new value to the block connection in
the function-block diagram.
If you set parameters for the block connections, propagation of the standard value to
the connection type will be interrupted. You can reactivate the propagation. This
requires that you select the check box next to the Value field. The standard value of
the connection instance then replaces the parameterized value again.
Unit This field contains the default unit of the block connection.
If you insert a block into a function-block diagram, the block connection will be
preset to the default unit for the connection type. If the default unit of the connec-
tion type changes, it will propagate the new unit to the block connection in the func-
tion-block diagram.
If you set parameters for the block connections, propagation of the standard unit to
the connection type will be interrupted. You can reactivate the propagation. This
requires that you select the check box next to the Unit field. The standard value of
the connection instance then replaces the parameterized value again.
Invisible The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the visibility of the block
connection.
For test The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the test of the block
connection.
Comment This field contains a comment about the block connection that has been preset in
the factory.
Configurable The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the parameterizability of
the block connection.
Interconnectable The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the interconnectability of
the block connection.
Section This field contains the information as to whether the block connection is an input or
an output.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.3 Block
21.4.11 Interconnection
This group contains the general properties of an interconnection in a function chart (CFC).
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.5.1 Displaying Interconnections
12.1.5.4 Negating a Block Input
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.5.3 Interconnecting a Block with a Signal or a Setting
This group contains the general properties of a plug-in module or the integrated Ethernet interface.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware Catalog
This group contains the protocol for one channel of a serial communication module.
Element Explanation
Channel 1 Protocols
Communication Protocols
Protocols With this list box, you select a communication protocol. Depending on the selected
module, you can select the following communication protocols:
• Protection Interface
• IEC 60870-5-103
• DNP3
• SUP
If you mark a module in the 22.2.4 Hardware Catalog tab, in the Information
window you can read for which communication protocol this module is suitable.
When you have selected a protocol, other settings will be displayed that you can use
to configure the communication protocol to suit your requirements. The settings are
summarized into the following groups:
• For the protocol IEC 60870-5-103 in the group 21.6.12 IEC 60870-5-103
Settings.
• For the protocol DNP3 in the group 21.6.9 DNP3 Settings.
• For the protocol SUP in the group 21.6.11 SUP Settings.
For the protection interface protocol, other settings will only be shown if you have
selected a constellation for the protection communication with the Select constella-
tion list box.
Mapping This list box is used to select a communication mapping. To adapt the communication
mapping to your requirements, you can modify it using the 22.3.1 Communication
Mapping matrix. If the list box does not offer a communication mapping, you will
have to generate one yourself.
This list box is only active if the IEC 60870-5-103 or DNP3 protocol has been selected.
The list box is not active if the Protection interface protocol has been selected.
Settings If you have selected a protocol, you can configure the protocol based on your require-
ments under the Settings group.
Protection Interface
Mapping With this list box, you can select how many SIPROTEC 5 devices will participate in the
communication. At least 2 devices must, and up to 6 can participate. This list box is
only visible if the Protection interface protocol has been selected.
If you have selected a constellation, other settings will be displayed, with which you
can configure the protection interface to suit your requirements. The settings are
summarized into the following groups:
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.1.3 Communication Using Protection Interfaces
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
• IEC 61850-8-1
SCADA
• DNP3 Ethernet
• IEC 60870-5-104
Industrial
• Modbus TCP
• PROFINET IO
Others
• IEEEC37.118PMU
• SUP Ethernet
Based on the selection, the respective settings are displayed. They can be used to
configure the communication protocol according to your requirements. The settings
are summarized into the following groups:
• For the DNP3 protocol in the group 21.6.10 DNP3 Ethernet Settings
• For the IEEEEC37.118PMU protocol in the group 21.6.16 PMUx
• For the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol in the group 21.6.13 IEC 60870-5-104
Settings
• For the Modbus TCP protocol in the group 21.6.14 Modbus TCP
Note:
For the ETH-BD-2FO module, you can select the following communication protocols:
IEC 61850:
• IEC 61850-8-1
• 9-2 Client
• 9-2 Merg.unit
SCADA
• IEC 60870-5-104
• PROFINET IO
Others
Redundancy
RSTP With this list box, you activate or deactivate the RSTP network protocol. After you
have marked the check box, other settings are displayed, which you can use to
configure the network protocol according to your requirements. The settings are
summarized in the 21.6.3 RSTP Settings group.
The Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol (RSTP) enables the construction of Ethernet
networks with a ring topology. If 1 device or 1 connection fails in the ring, the
protocol ensures that the 2 parts of the broken ring continue to be available for undis-
turbed data exchange.
Network
DCP With this check box, you activate or deactivate the DCP network protocol.
The Discovery and Configuration Protocol (DCP) is used for automatic recognition of
devices without a configured IP address. Using DCP, DIGSI 5 can find all existing
SIPROTEC 5 devices in the local network.
SNMP With this check box, you activate or deactivate the SNMP network protocol. After you
have selected the check box, other settings will be displayed, which you can use to
configure the network protocol according to your requirements. The settings are
summarized into the 21.6.1 SNMP Settings group.
The Simple Network Management Protocol (SNMP) is used for network monitoring.
SIPROTEC 5 devices employ special variables for network supervision that can be used
to monitor the network continuously. These data are accessible as MIB files.
SNTP With this check box, you activate or deactivate the SNTP network protocol. After you
have selected the check box, other settings will be displayed which you can use to
configure the network protocol according to your requirements. The settings are
summarized into the 21.6.2 SNTP Settings group.
The Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) synchronizes the date and time in a
network. This requires a timer that provides the valid date and valid time. The
connected devices access this timer over the network and set their clocks accordingly.
IEEE 1588 With this check box, you can activate or deactivate the IEEE 1588 network protocol.
The IEEE 1588 protocol is used for time synchronization through network communica-
tion. IEEE 1588 is available in all Ethernet communication modules as a time receiver
(slave only clock, one-step, two-step). Runtimes and operating times in the compo-
nents are transmitted within the protocol. These correction times can be considered
in the end device to improve the time synchronization of the end devices.
Service
Homepage With this check box, you can activate or deactivate the Homepage service protocol.
The homepage for communication modules is used for diagnostic purposes. On the
homepage, you can find information on the communication module as well as the
network and communication protocols that run on the communication modules.
The homepage is physically accessible using a Web browser via external Ethernet
interfaces, for example, http://<Module-IP>:Port. The following list provides the port
configuration details:
• Port J: http://IP:8080
• Port E: http://IP:8081
• Port F: http://IP:8082
• Port N: http://IP:8083
• Port P: http://IP:8084
Mapping This list box is used to select a communication mapping. To adapt the communication
mapping to your requirements, you can modify it using the 22.3.1 Communication
Mapping matrix. If the list box does not offer a communication mapping, you will
have to generate one yourself.
The list box will only be active if you have selected a communication protocol.
Settings If you have selected a protocol, you can configure the protocol based on your require-
ments under the Settings group.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
This group contains the Ethernet addresses of an Ethernet communication module or the integrated Ethernet
interface.
IP Protocol
IP protocol is used With this check box, you activate or deactivate the IP protocol for the interface. After
you have selected the check box, further settings will be displayed, with which you
can configure the IP protocol to suit your requirements.
Use the following IP If you select this option, you can set the IP address of the interface yourself or have it
address set by DIGSI 5. You can then also set the subnetwork mask and the router address
yourself. Alternately, you can select the Obtain an IP address automatically (from a
DHCP server) option.
IP address This text box contains the IP address for the interface. The text box is only active if you
have selected the Use the following IP address option.
The entry field is always preset to a default IP address after you have added the
communication module. If you connect the interface with a subnet, the IP address will
be checked for uniqueness within the subnetwork. If the IP address is already
assigned, the IP address will be modified automatically.
You can also modify the IP address manually in the entry field. If the interface is
connected with a subnetwork, the IP address you entered will be checked for unique-
ness within the subnetwork. If the IP address is already assigned, this will be indicated
to you. In this case, you must change the IP address.
The IP addresses have the format x.y.y.x (x = 1 to 254, y = 0 to 254). At the same
time, it must be noted that not every possible combination is permissible within the
range of value. Impermissible combinations will be indicated to you.
Subnet mask This text box contains the subnetwork mask. The text box is only active if you have
selected the Use the following IP address option.
2 stations communicating with one another can use the subnetwork mask to deter-
mine whether they are located in the same subnetwork or in different subnetworks.
This requires that the IP addresses have been assigned consistently.
This entry field is always preset to a default subnetwork mask after you have added
the communication module. You can modify the subnetwork mask manually. If the
subnetwork mask is already assigned, this will be indicated to you. In this case, you
must change the subnetwork mask.
Subnetwork masks have the format x.y.y.z (x = 1 to 255, y = 0 to 255, z = 0 to 254).
At the same time, it must be noted that not every possible combination is permissible
within the range of value. Impermissible combinations will be indicated to you.
Use IP router If you require a router for communication with other networks, select this check box.
This activates the Router Address text box. The check box is only active if you have
selected the Use the following IP address option.
Router address This entry field contains the IP address of the router, which is to be used for communi-
cation. The router connects different subnetworks.
In the entry field, enter the IP address of the station that will function as the router.
The entry field will only be active if you have selected the Use IP router check box.
The IP addresses have the format x.y.y.x (x = 1 to 254, y = 0 to 254). At the same
time, it must be noted that not every possible combination is permissible within the
range of value. Impermissible combinations will be indicated to you.
Obtain an IP address If you select this option, the communication module will obtain the IP address from a
automatically (from DHCP server. For additional information, refer to Obtaining an Ethernet Address from
DHCP server) the DHCP Server, Page 553. As an alternative, you can select the Use the following IP
address option.
Related Topics
14.1.2 Communication Modules
14.2.5 Connecting an Interface to an Existing Subnetwork
14.2.7 Setting Ethernet Addresses
This group contains the properties of the integrated Ethernet interface protocols.
Network Protocols
DCP With this check box, you activate or deactivate the DCP network protocol.
The Discovery and Configuration Protocol (DCP) is used for automatic recognition of
devices without a configured IP address. Using DCP, DIGSI 5 can find all existing
SIPROTEC 5 devices in the network.
If you have deactivated the DIGSI access via communication module and via the inte-
grated Ethernet interface in the security settings (see 20.4 Network Access Security),
then no DIGSI connection is possible via DCP.
SNTP With this check box, you activate or deactivate the SNTP network protocol. After you
have selected the check box, other settings will be displayed, which you can use to
configure the network protocol according to your requirements. The settings are
summarized into the 21.6.2 SNTP Settings group.
The Simple Network Time Protocol (SNTP) synchronizes the date and time in a
network. This requires a timer that provides the valid date and valid time. The
connected devices access this timer over the network and set their clocks accordingly.
IEEE 1588 With this check box, you can activate or deactivate the IEEE 1588 network protocol.
The IEEE 1588 protocol is used for time synchronization through network communi-
cation. IEEE 1588 is available in all Ethernet communication modules as a time
receiver (slave only clock, one-step, two-step). Runtimes and operating times in the
components are transmitted within the protocol. These correction times can be
considered in the end device to improve the time synchronization of the end devices.
Communication Protocols
IEC 61850-8-1 With this check box, you activate or deactivate the IEC 61850-8-1 communication
protocol for the integrated Ethernet interface. This check box is only visible if you
have selected the setting DIGSI 5 connection and IEC 61850 reports in the
22.6.5 Add New Device dialog.
MBSUPEther With this check box, you activate the MBSUPEther network protocol. If you activate
this check box, the function named RTD-box Mb.TCPx is added by default under
Analog units in the project tree, where x stands for the instance number. You can
view the relevant function settings by opening the function in the working area. The
Slave Unit Protocol via Main Board Ethernet (SUPEther) is used for communication
between the RTD-box (Temperature-relays which measure the temperature of up to
12 sensors and provide the data at an Ethernet interface for external evaluation) and
the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
14.1.1 Integrated Interfaces and Slots
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
Related Topics
This group contains the properties for SNMP (Simple Network Management Protocol).
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
This group contains the properties for SNTP (Simple Network Time Protocol).
NOTE
i On importing the changes via the options Import changes from IEC 61850 System Configurator or
Import all devices from IEC 61850 Configurator, the IP address of Time source 1 and Time source 2
displayed under the SNTP settings is automatically assigned with the IP address of the primary and secon-
dary clock master configured in the IEC 61850 System Configurator for the devices enabled with IEC 61850
and SNTP protocols on the communication module and Port J.
Related Topics
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
This group contains the properties for RSTP (Rapid Spanning Tree Protocol).
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
This group contains the device combination properties of the protection interface.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
Element Explanation
Connection via With this list box, you select the transmission rate of the protection interface. The
transmission rate is entered in kBit/s. You can select a defined value, for example,
2048 kBit/s, or you can select a transmission technology, such as fiber-optic cable.
This indirectly determines the transmission rate.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
• The data telegrams sent and received with an error are counted within a period.
• The result is put into relation with the maximum number of data telegrams and
extrapolated for one hour.
If the calculated value exceeds the set limit, the Max. error rate per hour indication
will be generated.
To change the value for the maximum permissible error rate, click the arrow buttons
of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Max. error rate per With this list box, you select a limit value for the maximum permissible per-minute
min error rate for data transmission. The maximum permissible error rate is entered as a
percentage.
The error rate is calculated in 2 stages:
• The data telegrams sent and received with an error are counted within a period.
• The result is put into relation with the maximum number of data telegrams and
extrapolated for one minute.
If the calculated value exceeds the set limit, the Max. error rate per min indication
will be generated.
To change the value for the maximum permissible error rate, click the arrow buttons
of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Disturbance alarm With this list box, you can select the delay for a failure indication in milliseconds. After
after this delay has elapsed, erroneous and missing data telegrams will be reported as
disturbed. For this purpose, the Control interface failure indication will be gener-
ated.
To change the value for the delay, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Transm. fail. alarm With this list box, you can select the delay for a failure indication. After this delay has
after elapsed, a failure of communication will be reported. For this purpose, the Protection
Interface Failure indication will be generated. The delay is stated in seconds.
To change the value for the delay, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Delay time threshold With this list box, you can select a value for the signal-propagation time threshold.
The signal-propagation time threshold is stated in milliseconds.
The signal-propagation time threshold is the maximum permissible propagation time
of a data telegram from transmission to reception. The propagation time of a data
telegram has a direct influence on the tripping time of a differential protection unit. If
the propagation time exceeds the set signal-propagation time threshold, the Propa-
gation Time Exceeded indication will be generated.
To change the value for the signal-propagation time threshold, click the arrow
buttons of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list
box.
PPS synchronization With this list box, you select a setting for the pulse-per-second synchronization. In this
way, you define whether an external synchronization pulse will synchronize the
protection interface communication. For example, a GPS receiver can provide this
synchronization pulse.
If no synchronization pulse is available, select the PPS sync. off setting. If a synchroni-
zation pulse is used, select either telegr. and PPS or telegr. or PPS.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
This group contains the fallback times for priority levels as properties of the protection interface.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
14.7.5 Mapping Signals for Protection Interface
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.7.4 Configuring the Protection-Data Communication
Parity With this list box, you can select a value for the parity. The parity check is used to
detect errors in transmitted bit sequences. For this purpose, a 0 or a 1 is added to the
bit sequence to make the number of bits with the value 1 always even or always odd.
You can select between an even and an odd number. If you do not wish to use a
parity check, select None.
Light idle state (on/ With this list box, you select the state of the light in a fiber-optic connection that
off) corresponds to the idle state (zero-voltage state) of the electrical signal.
Time zone With this list box you select one of the time zones Local or UTC and thus the type of
time synchronization. A DNP3 Master (serial) or DNP3 Client (Ethernet) can
synchronize the SIPROTEC 5 device using the local time or the coordinated world
time. If you select UTC, the SIPROTEC 5 device will convert the coordinated world time
into a local time.
Superv.time com. With this list box you set the connection supervision time. If the DNP3 Master or the
failure DNP3 Client within this connection supervision time, cannot access the SIPROTEC 5
device, the SPIROTEC 5 device will generate an error message because of communica-
tion failure.
To change the connection supervision time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Link retries With this list box, you select the number of transmission attempts. If the communi-
cating partner does not transmit a confirmation within the time interval Link
acknowledgment timeout, a confirmation is not sent and a transmission is
attempted again.
To change the number of attempts, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a number in the text box of the list box.
Link confirm. This list box is used to select datasets in response to which the communicating
required partner will transmit confirmation. You can select from among the following options:
• In the Link confirm. required list box, you must have selected one of the
options multiframe fragment or all frames.
• The maximum number of transmission attempts must not have been reached
yet.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Appl. confirm. This list box is used to define the event for which the application layer will transmit an
required acknowledgment. You can select one of 2 options:
• Event-Data Message
The application layer transmits an acknowledgment if the messages contain
change data.
• Non-Final Fragments
The application layer transmits an acknowledgment if telegrams of divided data-
sets are not the end of the dataset.
Appl. confirm. time- This list box is used to select the time interval within which the communication
out partner waits for confirmation of the previous acknowledgment. The time interval
starts after transmission of the last byte.
If you use the Appl. confirm. required option together with the Link confirm.
required option, adjust the length of the time interval. Set the time interval in such a
way that all transmissions can be completed. The following formula will help you
select a suitable value:
Appl. confirm. required > Link confirm. required * (Link retries +1)
Time sync. required This list box is used to set a delay after which the internal Time synchronization
required indication will be set. This indication signals to the master that it must
resynchronize the time with the slave.
The delay is stated in ms. The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the value set here to the
master with each feedback. If you set the value 0, the internal Time synchronization
required indication will never be set. The master will therefore not perform time
synchronization.
To change the value for the time delay, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Time betw. sel. With this list box, set the time interval within which a command has to be selected
switch and executed. The time interval is stated in milliseconds.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Enable unsolicited With this list box, you select a setting for unrequested transmission. You can select
trans one of 2 options:
• Off
Unrequested transmission is not permitted. The master cannot activate this.
• On
Unrequested transmission is permitted. The master must permit this after the
first unrequested response.
The 4 parameters described below are only relevant if you select the on option.
Unsolicited events With these list boxes, you set a number of events separately for each class. If the
class 1/2/3 number of events exceeds the set value within a class, an unrequested response will
be transmitted.
This parameter is a condition for the transmission of unrequested responses. You only
have to set this parameter if you have selected the on option for the unrequested
transmission.
Unsolicited time class These list boxes are used to set a time value in ms separately for each class. If the
1/2/3 elapsed time after an event matches this value or exceeds this value, a response will
be transmitted unrequested.
This parameter is a condition for the transmission of unrequested responses. You only
have to set this parameter if you have selected the on option for the unrequested
transmission.
To change the time value, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately, you can
enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Unsolicited retry With this list box, you select the number of transmission attempts for unrequested
responses. Transmission is attempted again if no unrequested response is transmitted
within the time to unrequested transmission.
To change the number of attempts, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately,
you can enter a number in the entry field of the list box.
Unsolic. confirm. This list box is used to set the time interval in milliseconds during which the
time-out SIPROTEC 5 device is to wait for acknowledgment of the unrequested response. The
time interval starts after transmission of the last byte.
After the time interval has elapsed, the SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the unrequested
response again. If the SIPROTEC 5 device has received a read query in the meantime,
the read query will be answered. The unrequested response is then not transmitted.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
This group contains the properties for the DNP3 protocol for Ethernet.
Link confirm. With this list box, you select datasets in response to which the communicating partner
required will transmit confirmation. You can select from among the following options:
• In the Link confirm. required list box, you must have selected one of the
options Multiframe fragment or All frames.
• The maximum number of transmission attempts must not have been reached
yet.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Appl. This list box is used to define the event for which the application layer will transmit an
confirm.required acknowledgment. You can select one of 2 options:
• Event-Data Message
The application layer transmits an acknowledgment if the messages contain
change data.
• Not end-of-message
The application layer transmits an acknowledgment if telegrams of divided data-
sets are not the end of the dataset.
Appl. confirm. time- With this list box, you select the time interval within which the communication
out partner waits for confirmation of the previous acknowledgment. The time interval
starts after transmission of the last byte.
If you use the Appl. confirm. required option together with the Link confirm.
required option, adjust the length of the time interval. Set the time interval in such a
way that all transmissions can be completed. The following formula will help you
select a suitable value:
Appl. confirm. required > Link confirm. required * (Link retries +1)
Time sync. required With this list box, you set a delay after which the internal Time synchronization
required indication will be set. This indication signals to the master that it must
resynchronize the time with the slave.
The delay is stated in ms. The SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the value set here to the
master with each feedback. If you set the value 0, the internal Time synchronization
required indication will never be set. The master will therefore not perform time
synchronization.
To change the value for the delay, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Time betw. sel. This list box is used to set the time interval within which a command has to be
switch. selected and executed. The time interval is stated in milliseconds.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Enable unsolicited With this list box, you select a setting for unrequested transmission. You can select
trans. one of 2 options:
• Off
Unrequested transmission is not permitted. The master cannot activate this.
• On
Unrequested transmission is permitted. The master must permit this after the
first unrequested response.
The 4 parameters described below are only relevant if you select the On option.
Unsolicited events With these list boxes, you set a number of events separately for each class. If the
class 1/2/3 number of events exceeds the set value within a class, an unrequested response will
be transmitted.
This parameter is a condition for the transmission of unrequested responses. You only
have to set this parameter if you have selected the On option for the unrequested
transmission.
Unsolicited time class With these list boxes, you set a time value in ms separately for each class. If the
1/2/3 elapsed time after an event matches this value or exceeds this value, a response will
be transmitted unrequested.
This parameter is a condition for the transmission of unrequested responses. You only
have to set this parameter if you have selected the On option for the unrequested
transmission.
To change the time value, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternatively, you
can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Unsolicited retry With this list box, you select the number of transmission attempts for unrequested
responses. Transmission is attempted again if no unrequested response is transmitted
within the time to unrequested transmission.
To change the number of attempts, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a number in the text box of the list box.
Unsolic. confirm. This list box is used to set the time interval in milliseconds during which the
time-out SIPROTEC 5 device is to wait for acknowledgment of the unrequested response. The
time interval starts after transmission of the last byte.
After the time interval has elapsed, the SIPROTEC 5 device transmits the unrequested
response again. If the SIPROTEC 5 device has received a read query in the meantime,
the read query will be answered. The unrequested response is then not transmitted.
To change the value for the time interval, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
This group contains the properties for the SUP protocol. If you activate the SUP network protocol from the list
box for Selected protocol under Communication protocols, the function named RTD-box Mb.ser.x is added by
default under Analog units in the Project tree, where x stands for the instance number. You can view the rele-
vant function settings by opening the function in the working area. The Slave Unit Protocol (SUP) is used for
communication between the RTD-box (Temperature-relays which measure the temperature of up to 12
sensors and provide the data at an interface RS485 for external evaluation) and the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Element Explanation
Baud rate With this list box, you select the transmission rate between the SIPROTEC 5 device and
the substation automation. This is the transmission rate at which connection is first
attempted. If this connection attempt is not successful, a further attempt will be made
at a lower baud rate. This process is repeated until a connection has been successfully
established or the start value of the baud rate has been reached again.
The transmission rate is stated in baud. You can only select defined transmission
rates, for example, 4800 baud or 38 400 baud.
Data bit With this list box, you select the number of data bits. Data bits are the useful data
(characters) in data transmission.
For the SUP protocol, you must set 8 data bits.
To change the number of data bits, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately,
you can enter a number in the entry field of the list box.
Stop bit With this list box, you select the number of stop bits. Stop bits enable the receiver to
synchronize with each transmitted character in asynchronous serial data transmission.
The communication module supports 1 stop bit and 2 stop bits.
To change the number of stop bits, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately,
you can enter a number in the entry field of the list box.
Parity With this list box, you can select a value for the parity. The parity check is used to
detect errors in transmitted bit sequences. For this purpose, a 0 or a 1 is added to the
bit sequence to make the number of bits with the value 1 always even or always odd.
You can select between an even and an odd number. If you do not wish to use a
parity check, select None.
Light idle state (on/ With this list box, you select the state of the light in a fiber-optic connection that
off) corresponds to the idle state (zero-voltage state) of the electrical signal.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
Element Explanation
Stop bit With this list box, you select the number of stop bits. Stop bits enable the receiver to
synchronize with each transmitted character in asynchronous serial data transmission.
The communication module supports 1 stop bit and 2 stop bits. You must set 1 stop
bit for the IEC 60870-5-103 protocol.
To change the number of stop bits, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately,
you can enter a number in the entry field of the list box.
Parity With this list box, you can select a value for the parity. The parity check is used to
detect errors in transmitted bit sequences. For this purpose, a 0 or a 1 is added to the
bit sequence to make the number of bits with the value 1 always even or always odd.
You can select between an even and an odd number. If you do not wish to use a
parity check, select none.
Light idle state (on/ With this list box, you select the state of the light in a fiber-optic connection that
off) corresponds to the idle state (zero-voltage state) of the electrical signal.
Protect function (on/ With this list box, you define whether or not the protection function can be deacti-
off) vated using the protocol. If you want to prevent the protection function from being
deactivated, select the off setting.
Measure. standardiza- With this list box, you can select a value for the measured value scaling. If measured
tion value scaling is used, measured values refer to 1.2 times or 2.4 times the rated value.
This improves the resolution of measured values, which are always below 1.2 times
the rated value.
Superv.time With this list box, you can set the delay for an error message. If no communication is
com.failure performed with a master within this time, a communication failure will be reported.
For this purpose, the Communication channel failure message will be generated.
The delay is stated in ms.
To change the value for the time delay, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Double command This list box specifies if a command feedback should be compatible with protocol IEC
feedb. 60870-5-103 or compatible with SIPROTEC 4.
Redundancy With this list box, you define whether or not the SIPROTEC 5 device will communicate
over a redundant connection.
The 6 parameters described below are only visible if you select the on option.
Redundant slot With this list box, you select the slot of the module on which the 2nd (redundant)
protocol is parameterized. In the case of a serial double module, you can also
configure the protocol redundantly on the same slot on the free channel.
Redundant channel With this list box, you select the slot of the module channel on which the second
(redundant) protocol is parameterized.
To change the value for the module channel, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Number of masters With this list box, you set the number of masters. The communication module
supports connection with 1 or 2 masters.
To change the number, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately, you can
enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Primary channel With this list box, select the channel that is to be used first for communication.
To change the value for the primary channel, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Element Explanation
Fct.type f.channel With this list box, you select a function type for switchover from the primary to the
change redundant channel. Only commands with the selected function type can switchover
the channel. After switchover, the master will transmit an indication. This indication
has the same function type.
To change the function type, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately, you
can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Inf.no. channel With this list box, you select an information number for switchover from the primary
change to the redundant channel. Only commands with the selected information number can
switchover the channel. After switchover, the master will transmit an indication. This
indication has the same function type.
To change the function type, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately, you
can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
Element Explanation
Cycle time Indicates the time for sending cyclic data. Relevant if Cyclic type is Spontan. and
cyclic or All.
To change the value of the cycle time, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Main master IP Ipv4 address 0.0.0.0 means that the slave can listen and contact every IP address.
Main channel t0 Indicates the connection-establishment time-out.
To change the value of the main channel t0, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Main channel t1 Indicates the ASDU reply time-out.
To change the value of the main channel t1, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Main channel t2 Indicates the wait next information transmission frame (I frame) time-out.
t2<t1
To change the value of the main channel t2, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Main channel t3 Indicates the idle time-out.
To change the value of the main channel t3, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Backup master IP Ipv4 address 0.0.0.0 means that the slave can listen and contact every IP address.
Backup channel t0 Connection-establishment time-out
Backup channel t1 Indicates the ASDU reply time-out.
To change the value of the backup channel t1, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Backup channel t2 Indicates the wait next information transmission frame (I frame) time-out.
t2<t1
To change the value of the backup channel t2, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Backup channel t3 Indicates the idle time-out.
To change the value of the backup channel t3, click the arrow buttons of the list box.
Alternatively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Double transmisson Sends indications with or without the time stamp. If double transmission is switched
On, the indication is sent twice to the master (once with the time stamp and once
without the time stamp).
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
Connection superv. With this list box you can set the connection supervision time.
time If the connection time is expired, the SIPROTEC 5 device closes the TCP connection.
Slave address This list box is used to select the device address of the SIPROTEC 5 device. To change
the device address, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter an
address in the entry field of the list box.
If the address is 255, the device does not check the request address from the master.
Master IP address 1 Ipv4 address 0.0.0.0 means that the slave can listen and contact every IP address.
Master IP address 2 Ipv4 address 0.0.0.0 means that the slave can listen to and can contact with every IP
address.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
21.6.15 PROFINET IO
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
21.6.16 PMUx
This group contains the properties for the synchrophasor protocol IEEEC37.118PMU.
Gen. settings
PMU ID With this list box, you select a unique identifier for the configured PMU. If several
PMUs deliver measured values to one and the same PDC, each PMU must have a
unique PMU-ID.
To change the PMU identifier, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alternately, you
can enter a value in the range 1 to 65534 in the entry field of the list box.
Station name In this text box, enter a name for the PMU station (SIPROTEC 5 device). The name
does not have to be unique according to the standard. However, in order to be able to
differentiate the PMU stations, Siemens recommends using unique names.
Transport With this list box, you select the PMU transmission protocol. You can select TCP or
UDP. Siemens recommends TCP as transmission protocol.
• Example 1:
– Valid wildcard mask entry
Wildcard mask PDC IP address: 0.0.0.63
Binary equivalent: 00000000.00000000.00000000.00111111
– Invalid wildcard mask entry
Wildcard mask PDC IP address: 0.0.0.43
Binary equivalent: 00000000.00000000.00000000.00101011
Based on the above example, the valid numbers can be considered as 1, 3, 7, 15,
31, 63, 127, and 255.
• Example 2:
– If the IP address PDC1 is 192.172.16.1 and the corresponding value of the
wildcard mask PDC1 is 0.0.0.127, then the device accepts requests from IP
addresses of the range 192.172.16.1 to 192.172.16.127.
• Example 3:
– If the IP address PDC1 is 192.172.16.100 and the corresponding value of
the wildcard mask PDC1 is 0.0.0.3, then the device accepts requests from IP
addresses of the range 192.172.16.100 until 192.172.16.103.
Func. settings
Mode With this list box, you activate or deactivate the PMU. To activate the PMU, select On.
To deactivate the PMU, select Off. If you select the setting Test, you activate the PMU
in test mode. In test mode, the transferred measured values are identified with a test
bit.
Class With this list box, you select the class P or the class M. The class M has a higher exact-
ness than the class P.
Global PMU ID With this parameter, you enter a global ID for the PMU, which can contain up to 16
characters.
PMU Latitude With this parameter, you set the latitude to a value between -90.000000° and
+90.000000°.
PMU Longitude With this parameter, you set the current longitude to a value between -180.000000°
and +180.000000°.
PMU Elevation With this parameter, you set the current height above sea level to a value between
-50000.00 m and +50000.00 m.
Reporting rate With this list box, you select the number of telegrams that are formed every second
and transferred to the PDC. You can select in defined steps between 1 frame/s and
100 frames/s.
Positive sequence With this list box, you set whether the positive sequence is transferred instead of 3
individual synchrophasors for 3-phase measuring points. The setting selected here is
valid for all PMUs with 3-phase measuring points connected to 1 PDC.
With this list box, you set whether the positive sequence is transferred instead of 3
individual synchrophasors or in addition to 3 individual synchrophasors for 3-phase
measuring points.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.1 Selecting and Configuring a Communication Protocol
14.8.1 Overview of Phasor Measurement
This group contains the properties for the IEEE 1588 protocol.
Compared to the modules ETH-BA-2EL and ETH-BB-2FO, the IEEE 1588 protocol instantiated on the module
ETH-BD-2FO is more accurate in time synchronization.
Related Topics
14.1.5 Protocols and Standards
14.5.2 Selecting and Configuring Network Protocols
Related Topics
10.5 Adding a Logical Node and Selecting a Class
10.1 Overview
With this feature, you can add the standard data objects for the selected logical nodes as defined by the
IEC 61850 standard. This group contains the properties of the standard data objects.
External This column displays the check-box options to configure the data objects as external signal for
signal the selected logical node (LN).
The check-box options (read-only and editable) under the External signal column for the
respective logical nodes indicate different possibilities:
Read-only check-box options:
Indicates that the data object is added as an external signal for the respective logical
node. You cannot modify the check-box state.
Indicates that the data objects cannot be configured as external signals for the selected
logical node.
Editable check-box options:
Indicates that the data object can be selected and configured as an external signal for
the respective logical node.
Note: The signal is added to the logical node only if you select the corresponding
check-box option displayed under Available in project.
Data Objects This column displays the standard data objects for the respective logical node.
CDC This column displays the data-object type (standardized data class).
Presence This column displays the presence of the data objects for the respective logical node:
• O – Optional
• M – Mandatory
• Multi – Multiple instantiation is possible
Description This column displays the description of the data objects.
Related Topics
22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor
10.5 Adding a Logical Node and Selecting a Class
10.1 Overview
Related Topics
10.5 Adding a Logical Node and Selecting a Class
10.1 Overview
Related Topics
10.1 Overview
21.8 Documentation
Document
Name This field contains the name of the currently selected template. You cannot change
this name.
Orientation The field tells you the orientation of the template, that is, portrait or landscape. You
cannot change the orientation.
Paper size This field shows the standardized name for the paper format of the template, for
example, Letter or A4. You cannot change this name.
Width This field contains the current template width as a numerical value. You see the
corresponding unit in the Rulers and grid group. If you select a different unit from
the Unit list box there, the value for the width will be updated.
Height This field contains the current template height as a numerical value. You see the
corresponding unit of measurement in the Rulers and grid group. If you select a
different unit of measurement from the Unit list box there, the value for the height
will also be updated.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.6.3 Setting the Unit of Measurement
19.1.6.4 Using the Grid
Element Explanation
Text Box
Text Enter the text in this text box that will appear in the text box.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
19.1.5 Using Document Information
Style
Font With this list box, you select a font for the text in the text box. The selected font
applies to the entire text.
Font size With this list box, you select a character size for the text in the text box. The selected
character size applies to the entire text.
Font style
Bold If you select this check box, the entire text in the text box will be shown in bold type.
Italic If you select this check box, the entire text in the text box will be shown in italics.
Underline If you select this check box, the entire text in the text box will be shown underlined.
Orientation With this list box, you select the orientation to Horizontal or Vertical for the text in
the text box.
Element Explanation
Alignment
Horizontal With this list box, you select the horizontal alignment of the text in the text box. The
selected alignment applies to the entire text.
You see the unit for the values in the Rulers and grid group. If you select a different
unit from the Unit list box there, the values for the margins will also be updated.
Vertical With these list boxes, you select the vertical alignment of the text in the text box.
The selected alignment applies to the entire text.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
Image
Image This field contains the name of the image that is located in the image field. When
you insert a new image, the name will be updated automatically.
Browse... With this button, you open a file selection dialog. In this dialog, you select the figure
within which the image field is displayed. You can select files in the following
formats: BMP, JPEG, TIFF, GIF, and ICO. The file can be up to 50 KB in size.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.8.3 Inserting and Editing the Image
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type ACD. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Control model With this list box, you select a control model. You can select between a status query
and various combinations of the functions SBO and Feedback Monitoring. The func-
tion SBO (Select Before Operate) reserves the tap changer before switching. In that
way, the tap changer is inhibited for further incoming commands. The feedback
monitoring informs the initiator of the command about the completion of the
command.
• Status only
Only the tap position is recorded. The tap changer is not switched.
• Direct with normal security
The tap changer is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is not activated.
• SBO with normal security
The tap changer is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is not
activated.
• Direct with enhanced security
The tap changer is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is activated.
• SBO with enhanced security
The tap changer is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is acti-
vated.
SBO time-out With this list box, you set a value for the SBO time-out in seconds. Within the set
period, the circuit breaker must be switched. If not, the reservation is withdrawn.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options SBO with normal
security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the SBO time-out, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Feedback monitoring With this list box, you set the time range for the feedback monitoring in seconds.
time Within the set period, a feedback to the command must take place. If not, the
command is considered as failed. If the feedback arrives after the feedback moni-
toring time has expired, the feedback is saved as a spontaneous indication.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the feedback monitoring time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Unit
Define Unit By marking this check box, the unit, the multiplier and the number of decimal places
for this signal can be defined. The selected values have priority against other values.
For example, other values can be originated by CFC charts.
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for the controllable. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For
this multiplier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box.
No. of decimal places With this list box, you set the number of places behind the decimal point of the value.
To change the number of decimal places, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type ACT. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type BCR. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Element Explanation
Name This text box contains the current name of the signal. Enter another name for the
signal if necessary. If you modify the name in the text box, the name also changes in
all the windows that contain this signal.
Original name This field contains the original name of the signal, for example, Counter. The original
name always indicates the type of the signal. You cannot change the original name.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, for example CntRs1. The IEC
61850 name represents the signal according to the specifications of the IEC 61850
standard. You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Pulse multiplier With this list box, you select the weighting for a pulse. If a pulse is to correspond to
10 kWh, for example, you select the value 10. You set the unit (Wh) and the multiplier
for the unit (k = 1000) in the area Unit.
To change the pulse multiplier, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you
can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Restore delta value By marking this check box, the delta value is transmitted. The delta value is the differ-
ence between the current value and the value of the last transmit operation. If this
check box is not marked, the current value is transmitted.
Unit
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for a pulse. If a pulse is to correspond to 10 kWh,
for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box. The unit and the multiplier are
displayed in addition to the list box Pulse multiplier.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If a pulse is to correspond to
10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For this multi-
plier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box. The unit and the multiplier are displayed
in addition to the list box Pulse multiplier.
Seal-in time With this list box, you set the seal-in time for the feedback in seconds. The seal-in time
is the time range in which the feedback is pending.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the seal-in time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
Element Explanation
Name This text box contains the current name of the signal. Enter another name for the
signal if necessary. If you modify the name in the text box, the name also changes in
all the windows that contain this signal.
Original name This field contains the original name of the signal, that is Position. You cannot
change the original name.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, that is TapChg. The IEC 61850
name represents the signal according to the specifications of the IEC 61850 standard.
You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Maximum output With this list box, you set the output time of a higher or lower command in seconds.
time To change the maximum output time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Control model With this list box, you select a control model. You can select between a status query
and various combinations of the functions SBO and Feedback Monitoring. The func-
tion SBO (Select Before Operate) reserves the tap changer before switching. In that
way, the tap changer is inhibited for further incoming commands. The feedback
monitoring informs the initiator of the command about the completion of the
command.
• Status only
Only the tap position is recorded. The tap changer is not switched.
• Direct with normal security
The tap changer is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is not activated.
• SBO with normal security
The tap changer is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is not
activated.
• Direct with enhanced security
The tap changer is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is activated.
• SBO with enhanced security
The tap changer is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is acti-
vated.
SBO time-out With this list box, you set a value for the SBO time-out in seconds. Within the set
period, the tap changer must be switched. If not, the reservation is withdrawn.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options SBO with normal
security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the SBO time-out, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Step size With this list box, you select the step size for a tap changer. The step size is the
number of steps by which 1 command switches the tap changer higher or lower in
succession.
The standard value for the step size is 1. You use values greater than 1 for tap
changers with adjustable intermediate steps. If, for example, 4 intermediate steps
result in one complete step for a tap changer, you select the value 4 for the step size.
A command then switches the tap changer 4 intermediate steps higher or lower.
To change the step size, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Feedback monitoring With this list box, you set the time range for the feedback monitoring in seconds.
time Within the set period, a feedback to the command must take place. If not, the
command is considered to have failed. If the feedback arrives after the feedback
monitoring time has expired, the feedback is saved as a spontaneous indication.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the feedback monitoring time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Minimum value The Minimum value is calculated automatically and displayed based on the values
entered for the parameters Tap-display offset, Number of tap positions, and Tap-
coding type. You can modify the value for this parameter according to the defined
calculated range. By default, this parameter value is reset to a new value if you modify
the value for the parameters Tap-display offset, Number of tap positions, and Tap-
coding type respectively. You can also modify the minimum value via the
IEC Browser and the TEA-X file.
Maximum value The Maximum value is calculated automatically and displayed based on the values
entered for the parameters Tap-display offset, Number of tap positions, and Tap-
coding type. You can modify the value for this parameter according to the defined
calculated range. By default, this parameter value is reset to a new value if you modify
the value for the parameters Tap-display offset, Number of tap positions, and Tap-
coding type respectively. You can also modify the maximum value via the
IEC Browser and the TEA-X file.
Tap display offset With this list box, you select a display offset for the current transformer tap position.
With the display offset, you can shift the displayed value of the transformer tap posi-
tion in positive or negative direction in comparison to the actual value of the trans-
former tap position. The value set for the tap display offset is added to the current
value of the transformer tap position. If the current transformer tap position is to be
displayed, select the value 0 for the tap display offset.
To change the tap display offset, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you
can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Number of bits for With this list box, you select the number of bits required for coding the transformer
tap code tap positions. The required number depends on the selected coding. For example, you
require 3 bits for 8 binary-coded transformer tap positions. An existing routing can
influence the selectable number of bits.
To change the number of bits for tap code, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Number of tap posi- With this list box, you set the number of possible transformer tap positions.
tions To change the number of tap positions, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Tap-coding type With this list box, you select a coding for the input signals routed to the transformer
tap function. The selected coding determines how the pending signals at the binary
inputs are interpreted. You can select 1 of the following codings:
• Binary
The routed signals are interpreted as binary coding. The binary-coding for the
transformer tap position 10 is 1010 and requires 4 binary inputs.
• 1-of-n
The routed signals are interpreted as 1-of-n coding. N bits are representing each
transformer tap position, whereby n equals the number of possible transformer
tap positions. Only 1 bit is set to 1; all other bits are set to 0. The 1-of-n-coding
for the transformer tap position 10 is 1000000000 and requires 10 binary inputs.
• BCD
The routed signals are interpreted as BCD coding. Each digit of the transformer
tap position is binary-coded separately. The BCD-coding for the transformer tap
position 10 (digits 1 and 0) is 10000 and requires 5 binary inputs.
• Table
If you select the Table setting, the Code table area is displayed. In this area, you
can define an individual binary assignment.
• BCD signed
The routed signals are interpreted as BCD signed coding. Each digit of the trans-
former tap position is binary-coded separately. The most significant bit indicates
the sign of the tap position. For example, the BCD signed coding for the trans-
former tap position +5 is 0101, -5 is 1101, and both of them require 4 binary
inputs.
• Gray
The routed signals are interpreted as gray coding. For example, the gray coding
for the transformer tap position 10 is 1111 and requires 4 binary inputs.
Moving contact If you mark this check box, a tap position is only then recognized and accepted as
(highest binary input) valid when the position transit contact signals that the tap has been reached.
As soon as you check the check box, the next-higher binary input is automatically
routed in addition to the already routed binary inputs. This binary input must be
connected to the position transit contact. When you remove the checkmark of the
check box, the routing is also removed.
Code table
With the table and the options in this area, you can define an individual binary assignment for the input
signals of the routed binary inputs. This area is only visible if you have selected the Table setting in the Tap-
coding type list box.
Code table The table contains 1 line for each transformer tap position defined with the Number
of tap positions list box. In the Encoding column, you can define a value for each
transformer tap position. By default, the values in the encoding column are reset to 0,
which indicates inconsistency. You must configure the values in this column to any
value other than 0. For this, double-click in the cell. Enter a number value appropriate
for the currently selected number system (see Representation of encoding). The
number of bits set with the Number of bits for tap code list box determines the
maximum allowable number value.
Representation of With these options, you select a number system for the entry of values in the
encoding Encoding column. You can select one of the following number systems:
• Binary (2 characters)
• Octal (8 characters)
• Decimal (10 characters)
• Hexadecimal (16 characters)
The values you enter in the Encoding column must be appropriate for the selected
number system. If you select another number system, already entered values are
converted to this number system.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of type CMV. Not every signal of this type has all the properties
shown in the following table.
General
Deadband for magni- With this list box, you set the deadband for the magnitude of the measured value in
tude percent.
The deadband determines the transmission frequency of measured values. If you
select the value 0 for the deadband, each measured value is transmitted to the super-
ordinate station. A deadband other than 0 causes all changes of measured values
compared to the measured value transmitted last to be added. If the sum of the
changes reaches the percent value set, a new measured value is transmitted at the
next possible point in time. This measure prevents loading the communication path
too much.
To change the deadband, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Deadband for angle With this list box, you set the deadband for the angle of the measured value in
percent.
The deadband determines the transmission frequency of measured values. If you
select the value 0 for the deadband, each measured value is transmitted to the super-
ordinate station. A deadband other than 0 causes all changes of measured values
compared to the measured value transmitted last to be added. If the sum of the
changes reaches the percent value set, a new measured value is transmitted at the
next possible point in time. This measure prevents loading the communication path
too much.
To change the deadband, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Unit
Define Unit By marking this check box, the unit, the multiplier and the number of decimal places
for this signal can be defined. The selected values have priority against other values.
For example, other values can be originated by CFC charts.
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for the controllable. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For
this multiplier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box.
No. of decimal places With this list box, you set the number of places behind the decimal point of the value.
To change the number of decimal places, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type DEL. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Original name This field contains the original name of the signal, for example, Vpp. The original
name always indicates the type of the signal. You cannot change the original name.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, for example PPV. The IEC 61850
name represents the signal according to the specifications of the IEC 61850 standard.
You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
Unit
Define Unit By marking this check box, the unit, the multiplier and the number of decimal places
for this signal can be defined. The selected values have priority against other values.
For example, other values can be originated by CFC charts.
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for the controllable. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For
this multiplier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box.
No. of decimal places With this list box, you set the number of places behind the decimal point of the value.
To change the number of decimal places, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type DPC. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Control model With this list box, you select a control model. You can select between a status query
and various combinations of the functions SBO and Feedback Monitoring. The func-
tion SBO (Select Before Operate) reserves the switching device before switching. In
that way, the switching device is inhibited for further incoming commands. The feed-
back monitoring informs the initiator of the command about the completion of the
command.
• Status only
Only the circuit-breaker switch position is recorded. The circuit breaker is not
switched.
• Direct with normal security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is not activated.
• SBO with normal security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is not
activated.
• Direct with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is activated.
• SBO with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is acti-
vated.
SBO time-out With this list box, you set a value for the SBO time-out in seconds. Within the set
period, the circuit breaker must be switched. If not, the reservation is withdrawn.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options SBO with normal
security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the SBO time-out, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Feedback monitoring With this list box, you set the time range for the feedback monitoring in seconds.
time Within the set period, a feedback to the command must take place. If not, the
command is considered to have failed. If the feedback arrives after the feedback
monitoring time has expired, the feedback is saved as a spontaneous indication.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the feedback monitoring time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Seal-in time With this list box, you set the seal-in time for the feedback in seconds. The seal-in time
is the time range in which the feedback is pending.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the seal-in time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Chatter Blocking
Chatter blocking With this check box, you activate or deactivate the chatter blocking for this signal.
Equipment connected to binary inputs can generate signals based on faults that
constantly change their states. Chatter blocking detects and blocks such signals.
Chatter blocking prevents indications from being generated that cannot be used.
Software Filter
Software filtering With this list box, you set the software filtering time in milliseconds. For the
time SIPROTEC 5 device to interpret the signal as an indication, the signal must be pending
at least during the entire software filtering time.
To change the software filtering time, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Retrigger filter If you select this check box, the SIPROTEC 5 device will restart the filtering time after
the signal has dropped out and is pending again.
Indication timestamp With this check box, you influence the time at which the SIPROTEC 5 device generates
before filtering an indication. If the check box is not selected, the indication is generated at the
instant at which the filtering time expires. If the check box is selected, the indication
is generated at the instant of the first indication change.
Suppress inter- If you select this check box, the SIPROTEC 5 device suppresses the indication in case of
mediate position an intermediate position.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type ENC. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type ENS. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type INC. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Control model With this list box, you select a control model. You can select between a status query
and various combinations of the functions SBO and Feedback Monitoring. The func-
tion SBO (Select Before Operate) reserves the switching device before switching. In
that way, the switching device is inhibited for further incoming commands. The feed-
back monitoring informs the initiator of the command about the completion of the
command.
• Status only
Only the circuit-breaker switch position is recorded. The circuit breaker is not
switched.
• Direct with normal security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is not activated.
• SBO with normal security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is not
activated.
• Direct with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is activated.
• SBO with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is acti-
vated.
SBO time-out With this list box, you set a value for the SBO time-out in seconds. Within the set
period, the circuit breaker must be switched. If not, the reservation is withdrawn.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options SBO with normal
security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the SBO time-out, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Feedback monitoring With this list box, you set the time range for the feedback monitoring in seconds.
time Within the set period, a feedback to the command must take place. If not, the
command is considered to have failed. If the feedback arrives after the feedback
monitoring time has expired, the feedback is saved as a spontaneous indication.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the feedback monitoring time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Seal-in time With this list box, you set the seal-in time for the feedback in seconds. The seal-in time
is the time range in which the feedback is pending.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the seal-in time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Chatter Blocking
Chatter blocking With this check box, you activate or deactivate the chatter blocking for this signal.
Equipment connected to binary inputs can generate signals based on faults that
constantly change their states. Chatter blocking detects and blocks such signals.
Chatter blocking prevents indications from being generated that cannot be used.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type INS. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
21.9.13 MV – Details
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type MV. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Element Explanation
Name This text box contains the current name of the signal. Enter another name for the
signal if necessary. If you modify the name in the text box, the name also changes in
all the windows that contain this signal.
Original name This field contains the original name of the signal, for example, R err/m. The original
name always indicates the type of the signal. You cannot change the original name.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, for example RxErrRateM. The
IEC 61850 name represents the signal according to the specifications of the
IEC 61850 standard. You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals
only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
General
Deadband for magni- With this list box, you set the deadband for the magnitude of the measured value in
tude percent.
The deadband determines the transmission frequency of measured values. If you
select the value 0 for the deadband, each measured value is transmitted to the super-
ordinate station. A deadband other than 0 causes all changes of measured values
compared to the measured value transmitted last to be added. If the sum of the
changes reaches the percent value set, a new measured value is transmitted at the
next possible point in time. This measure prevents loading the communication path
too much.
To change the deadband, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Unit
Define Unit By marking this check box, the unit, the multiplier and the number of decimal places
for this signal can be defined. The selected values have priority against other values.
For example, other values can be originated by CFC charts.
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for a pulse. If a pulse is to correspond to 10 kWh,
for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box. The unit and the multiplier are
displayed in addition to the list box Pulse multiplier.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If a pulse is to correspond to
10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For this multi-
plier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box. The unit and the multiplier are displayed
in addition to the list box Pulse multiplier.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type SPC (Controllable Single Point). Not every signal of
this type has all the properties shown in the following table.
General
Control model With this list box, you select a control model. You can select between a status query
and various combinations of the functions SBO and Feedback Monitoring. The func-
tion SBO (Select Before Operate) reserves the switching device before switching. In
that way, the switching device is inhibited for further incoming commands. The feed-
back monitoring informs the initiator of the command about the completion of the
command.
• Status only
Only the circuit-breaker switch position is recorded. The circuit breaker is not
switched.
• Direct with normal security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is not activated.
• SBO with normal security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is not
activated.
• Direct with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is switched directly. The feedback monitoring is activated.
• SBO with enhanced security
The circuit breaker is reserved before switching. The feedback monitoring is acti-
vated.
SBO time-out With this list box, you set a value for the SBO time-out in seconds. Within the set
period, the circuit breaker must be switched. If not, the reservation is withdrawn.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options SBO with normal
security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the SBO time-out, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Feedback monitoring With this list box, you set the time range for the feedback monitoring in seconds.
time Within the set period, a feedback to the command must take place. If not, the
command is considered to have failed. If the feedback arrives after the feedback
monitoring time has expired, the feedback is saved as a spontaneous indication.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the feedback monitoring time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Seal-in time With this list box, you set the seal-in time for the feedback in seconds. The seal-in time
is the time range in which the feedback is pending.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Direct with
enhanced security or SBO with enhanced security in the Control model list box.
To change the seal-in time, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can
enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Chatter Blocking
Chatter blocking With this check box, you activate or deactivate the chatter blocking for this signal.
Equipment connected to binary inputs can generate signals based on faults that
constantly change their states. Chatter blocking detects and blocks such signals.
Chatter blocking prevents indications from being generated that cannot be used.
Software Filter
Software filtering With this list box, you set the software filtering time in milliseconds. For the
time SIPROTEC 5 device to interpret the signal as an indication, the signal must be pending
at least during the entire software filtering time.
To change the software filtering time, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Retrigger filter If you select this check box, the SIPROTEC 5 device will restart the filtering time after
the signal has dropped out and is pending again.
Indication timestamp With this check box, you influence the time at which the SIPROTEC 5 device generates
before filtering an indication. If the check box is not selected, the indication is generated at the
instant at which the filtering time expires. If the check box is selected, the indication
is generated at the instant of the first indication change.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type SPC (Marker Command). Not every signal of this
type has all the properties shown in the following table.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, for example FnctLO. The IEC
61850 name represents the signal according to the specifications of the IEC 61850
standard. You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
Initialization
With the operating elements of this area, you define the value with which a marker command is to be initial-
ized after a first start or a restart of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Initialization With this list box, you define when the marker command is initialized. You can select
one of the following options:
• None
The marker command is not initialized in an initial startup or in a restart.
• Initial startup
The marker command is initialized in an initial startup.
• Restart
The marker command is initialized in a restart.
• Initial startup & restart
The marker command is initialized in an initial startup and in a restart.
Initial start With this list box, you define how the marker command is initialized in an initial
startup. You can select one of the following options:
• Invalid
The marker command gets the quality invalid.
• Value
The marker command gets the value that you define with the list box Value for
initial start.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Initial startup or
Initial startup & restart in the Initialization list box.
Value for initial start With this list box, you select On or Off as the new value for the marker command
after an initial startup.
This list box is only active if you have selected the option Value in the Initial start list
box.
Restart With this list box, you define how the marker command is initialized in a restart. You
can select one of the following options:
• Invalid
The marker command gets the quality invalid.
• Value
The marker command gets the value that you define with the list box Value
restart.
• Stored value
The marker command gets the value stored before the restart.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Restart or Initial
startup & restart in the Initialization list box.
Value for restart With this list box, you select On or Off as the new value for the marker command
after a restart.
This list box is only active if you have selected the option Value in the Restart list box.
Software Filter
Software filtering With this list box, you set the software filtering time in milliseconds. For the
time SIPROTEC 5 device to interpret the signal as an indication, the signal must be pending
at least during the entire software filtering time.
To change the software filtering time, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Retrigger filter If you select this check box, the SIPROTEC 5 device will restart the filtering time after
the signal has dropped out and is pending again.
Indication timestamp With this check box, you influence the time at which the SIPROTEC 5 device generates
before filtering an indication. If the check box is not selected, the indication is generated at the
instant at which the filtering time expires. If the check box is selected, the indication
is generated at the instant of the first indication change.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type SPS. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Initialization
With the operating elements of this area, you define the value with which a marker command is to be initial-
ized after a first start or a restart of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
Initialization With this list box, you define when the marker command is initialized. You can select
one of the following options:
• None
The marker command is not initialized in an initial startup or in a restart.
• Initial startup
The marker command is initialized in an initial startup.
• Restart
The marker command is initialized in a restart.
• Initial startup & restart
The marker command is initialized in an initial startup and in a restart.
Initial start With this list box, you define how the marker command is initialized in an initial
startup. You can select one of the following options:
• Invalid
The marker command gets the quality invalid.
• Value
The marker command gets the value that you define with the list box Value for
initial start.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Initial startup or
Initial startup & restart in the Initialization list box.
Value for initial start With this list box, you select On or Off as the new value for the marker command
after an initial startup.
This list box is only active if you have selected the option Value in the Initial start list
box.
Restart With this list box, you define how the marker command is initialized in a restart. You
can select one of the following options:
• Invalid
The marker command gets the quality invalid.
• Value
The marker command gets the value that you define with the list box Value
restart.
• Stored value
The marker command gets the value stored before the restart.
This list box is only active if you have selected one of the options Restart or Initial
startup & restart in the Initialization list box.
Value for restart With this list box, you select On or Off as the new value for the marker command
after a restart.
This list box is only active if you have selected the option Value in the Restart list box.
Chatter Blocking
Chatter blocking With this check box, you activate or deactivate the chatter blocking for this signal.
Equipment connected to binary inputs can generate signals based on faults that
constantly change their states. Chatter blocking detects and blocks such signals.
Chatter blocking prevents indications from being generated that cannot be used.
Software Filter
Software filtering With this list box, you set the software filtering time in milliseconds. For the
time SIPROTEC 5 device to interpret the signal as an indication, the signal must be pending
at least during the entire software filtering time.
To change the software filtering time, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
nately, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Retrigger filter If you select this check box, the SIPROTEC 5 device will restart the filtering time after
the signal has dropped out and is pending again.
Indication timestamp With this check box, you influence the time at which the SIPROTEC 5 device generates
before filtering an indication. If the check box is not selected, the indication is generated at the
instant at which the filtering time expires. If the check box is selected, the indication
is generated at the instant of the first indication change.
• block function
The current function is blocked.
• Keep valid value
The current value is maintained, even if it is not plausible.
• Set value to 0
The current value is replaced by 0.
• Set value to 1
The current value is replaced by 1.
Processing of invalid With this list box, you determine how invalid data is treated. You can select one of the
data following options:
• block function
The current function is blocked.
• Keep valid value
The current value is maintained, even if it is invalid.
• Set value to 0
The current value is replaced by 0.
• Set value to 1
The current value is replaced by 1.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type SEQ. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Element Explanation
Name This text box contains the current name of the signal. Enter another name for the
signal if necessary. If you modify the name in the text box, the name also changes in
all the windows that contain this signal.
Original name This field contains the original name of the signal, for example, Vseq. The original
name always indicates the type of the signal. You cannot change the original name.
IEC 61850 name This field contains the IEC 61850 name of the signal, for example SeqV. The IEC
61850 name represents the signal according to the specifications of the IEC 61850
standard. You can change the IEC 61850 name for user-defined signals only.
IEC 61850 path This field contains the hierarchical IEC 61850 path of the signal. The path is equiva-
lent to the path in the IEC 61850 tree. This path consists of the following elements:
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
This group contains the properties of a signal of the type WYE. Not every signal of this type has all the proper-
ties shown in the following table.
Unit
Define Unit By marking this check box, the unit, the multiplier and the number of decimal places
for this signal can be defined. The selected values have priority against other values.
For example, other values can be originated by CFC charts.
Unit With this list box, you select the unit for the controllable. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you select the unit Wh from this list box.
Multiplier With this list box, you select the multiplier for the unit. If the controllable is to corre-
spond to 10 kWh, for example, you require the multiplier 1000 for the unit Wh. For
this multiplier, select the entry 1E3 from the list box.
No. of decimal places With this list box, you set the number of places behind the decimal point of the value.
To change the number of decimal places, click the arrow buttons of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Related Topics
9.1 Overview of Signals
9.3 Signal Types
21.10 Miscellaneous
This group contains the names and the original names of a function.
Related Topics
8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
The properties of quality processing have changed with the introduction of GOOSE Later Binding. You can find
information about the former quality processing in chapter Previous Quality Processing/Affected by the User
for Received GOOSE Values, Page 891.
In the Information Routing Editor, you can influence the data value and quality of all data types. The
following figure shows the possible influence using the example of a DPC data type. All setting options are
effective for the device receiving the data.
• Select either the desired signal in the External Signals group or the signal of a function activated via the
GOOSE column.
• Open the Properties window and select the Processing Quality Attributes sheet.
[sc_LB_GOOSE_2, 2, en_US]
Figure 21-1 Influence Option When Linking a DPC Type Data Object
Depending on the selected data type of the object, various selection options are offered to you for the Safe
state item in the Common settings section. At this point, you select the manually updated values that allow
a safe operating state as soon as the data access via the communication path is disturbed.
• Open the Properties window and select the Advanced quality attributes sheet.
[sc_LB_GOOSE_1, 2, en_US]
With the following advanced quality attributes, you can filter the transmitted GOOSE indications and check
and set their quality. The values that have been adapted, if necessary, are forwarded to the receiver.
For the tests, you can select from the following setting options depending on the data type.
These settings of the Advanced quality attributes apply to the advanced quality attributes listed below. The
selection can vary depending on the data type.
[sc_LB_GOOSE_3, 2, en_US]
You can also forward the quality attributes unchanged. To do this, you must mark the Keep flag check box.
Communication Outage
There is communication disturbance (time allowed to live) between the transmitter and the receiver indicated
by the transmitter. The indication is set in accordance with the settings (Table 21-1).
Invalidity
The transmitting device sends this indication with the quality information Validity = invalid. The receiver
recognizes this for this indication and reacts according to the settings (Table 21-1).
Questionable
The transmitting device sends this indication with the quality information Validity = questionable. The
receiver recognizes this for this indication and reacts according to the settings (Table 21-1).
Test Mismatch
The transmitting device or the function in the transmitting device that issues this indication is in test mode. As
a result, the indication is transmitted with the quality information test. The receiving function block recog-
nizes this for this indication and reacts, depending on its own test-mode state (specified in IEC 61850-7-4
Annex A), according to the settings (Table 21-1).
NOTE
i Follow the sequence of tests. First, the Functional logoff by operator blocked is tested. Then comes
Communication outage and so on. If a case is recognized as active, the test chain is canceled with the
configured setting for the active case.
In the case of Invalidity, the tests are first performed for Functional logoff by operator blocked (not appli-
cable) and then for Communication outage (not applicable) and canceled with the configured action for
Invalidity.
If an indication is routed into the log, manual updating of a value is also logged based on the conditions listed
above and on the reason for the manual update. Manually updating a value based on the conditions listed
above causes a change in the Health Warning function block, inherited up to Device health (specified
in IEC 61850-7-4).
Keep Flag
The quality attributes and values indicated by the transmitter are accepted without change. Quality processing
must be performed by the user via a logic diagram. The outputs of the logic diagram following the user-
specific quality processing can be connected to the function-block inputs as before.
For controllable types, the following substitute values apply in addition to the settable state values or meas-
ured values:
ctlNum = 0
stSeld = False
origin.orIdent = Substituted by quality processing
origin.orCat = AUTOMATIC_BAY
• Open the Properties window and select the Processing Quality Attributes sheet.
Figure 21-4 Influence Option When Linking a DPC Type Data Object
The setting options work for the device receiving the data.
Quality Attribute: Validity
The validity values reserved and questionable are replaced at the receiving end by the invalid value.
• Check box is not set. The validity attribute and data value are forwarded
without change.
• Check box is set and receipt of Validity = good
Check box is set and receipt of Validity = invalid is • The validity attribute is set to good and
set (also applies to values reserved and ques- processed further using this value.
tionable). • The data value is set to the defined substitute
value and processed further using this substitute
value.
22.1 Editors
Related Topics
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
The Single-line editor is used to edit the single-line configuration and the topology tree.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab to search for information within the Single-line editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab can typically be used to add equipment such as circuit breakers or busbars to the single-line
configuration.
Related Topics
7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
7.5.1 Overview of Topology
22.1.3 Single-Line
You can use the Single-Line tab to edit the single-line configuration.
Related Topics
7.1 Overview of the Single-Line Configuration
7.2.1 Opening a Single-Line Configuration
22.1.2 Single-Line Editor
You can use the Topology information tab to edit the topology of the station.
Path This column shows, for each topology element within a bay, whether or not the
element is connected to one or more function groups. The connection to a function
group is shown in the form <device name>\<function group name>. If the topology
element is not connected to any function group, the cell contains the text <Not
connected>.
Comment In this column, you can enter a comment on each topology element.
Related Topics
7.5.1 Overview of Topology
7.5.2 Displaying Topology
22.1.2 Single-Line Editor
The Device and networks editor is used for editing the hardware configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device and
integrating the SIPROTEC 5 device into the network structure of the station.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab can be used to search for information within the Device and Networks view.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Device and networks
editor.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
14.1.4 Communication Using Ethernet
You can use the Network view tab to edit the Ethernet network structure of the SIPROTEC 5 devices in the
project, and thus, the Ethernet network structure of the station.
Related Topics
14.2.1 Opening Network View
22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor
You can use the Device view tab to edit the hardware configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Related Topics
6.3.1 Overview of the Hardware Structure
6.3.2 Opening the Device View
22.1.5 Device and Networks Editor
With the Project texts editor you process and translate all the project texts.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Project-text editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, this is not needed for working with the Project-text editor.
Related Topics
5.2.5 Opening the Project-Texts Editor
With the Settings editor you process the settings of parameters, for example of protection functions or the
time synchronization.
Header
The header contains operating elements which you can use to select one settings group each for editing and
comparison.
Values for change This list box is used to select the settings group whose values you wish to edit. This
list box is only present if more than 1 settings group is available.
Values for compar- This list box is used to select the settings group whose values are to be displayed for
ison comparison. This list box is only present if more than 1 settings group is available.
Function block
The operating and display elements of this area provide the option of changing the parameter values and
number of function blocks.
The individual information elements for a parameter are displayed in columns in the following order:
• Number
• Name
• Value
• Info symbol
• Unit
Number The numbers of the individual parameters are displayed in this column. These
numbers serve for identification of the parameters and their description in the rele-
vant device documentation.
Press the
button in the toolbar of the Settings editor to show or hide the numbers for all
settings together.
If this icon is displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that upon
changing this setting value and loading the configuration to the device, the device
will be rebooted and then the changes are updated in the target device.
If this icon is displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that this setting
value is the same in all the settings groups.
If this icon is disabled and displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that
you can set the respective parameter as a favorite setting to view it in the Favorite
settings editor.
If this icon is enabled and displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that
it is already set as a favorite setting and also displayed in the Favorite settings editor.
Name The names of the settings are displayed in this column.
Value The current values of the settings are displayed in this column. Depending on the
setting, entry fields or list boxes are available to edit a value. If you move the mouse
pointer over the value, the value range of the setting is shown as a tool tip.
Unit This column displays a unit, depending on the relevant value. The relevant cell of the
column remains empty for values without a unit, for example On or Off.
Info symbols Info symbols appear in this column. If you move the mouse pointer over an info
symbol, further information on the settings are shown as a tool tip.
Add new stage This button is used to add a new function block to the function. If the function block
can be created only based on a single function block type, the function block is added
directly after clicking on the button. If more than one function block type is available,
however, the 22.6.14 List of Permissible Function-Block Types dialog opens. Select
the type of function block to be used with this dialog.
Delete stage This button is used to delete the function block to which the button is assigned. This
button is only active if the function block is user-defined. Function blocks set at the
factory cannot be deleted.
Graphics window
Certain functions, for example, for distance protection or tripping, can be visualized graphically. The relevant
diagrams and characteristic curve are displayed in the graphics window. You can hide or show the graphics
window, for example, with the
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed.
Related Topics
8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
8.2.4.2 Showing and Hiding Graphics Window
8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
With the Favorite settings editor, you can process the settings of parameters which are set as favorites in the
Settings editor (for example, protection functions or the time synchronization).
NOTE
i This editor is displayed only if any parameter is marked as a favorite setting in the Settings editor.
Click the icon in the toolbar of the Settings editor to show or hide the numbers
for all settings together.
If this icon is displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that upon
changing this setting value and loading the configuration to the device, the device
will be rebooted and then the changes are updated in the target device.
If this icon is displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that this setting
value is the same in all the settings groups.
If this icon is displayed against any individual parameter, it signifies that it is already
set as a favorite setting in the Settings editor.
If you unmark the icon by clicking it, the respective parameter no longer appears as a
favorite setting in this editor.
Name The names of the settings are displayed in this column.
Value The current values of the settings are displayed in this column. Depending on the
setting, entry fields or list boxes are available to edit a value. If you move the mouse
pointer over the value, the range of value of the setting is shown as a tooltip.
Unit This column displays a unit, depending on the relevant value. The relevant cell of the
column remains empty for values without a unit, for example On or Off.
Info symbols Info symbols appear in this column. If you move the mouse pointer over an info
symbol, further information on the settings is shown as a tooltip.
Graphics window
Certain functions, for example, for distance protection or tripping, can be visualized graphically. The relevant
diagrams and characteristic curve are displayed in the graphics window. You can hide or show the graphics
window, for example, with the icon in the toolbar of the Settings editor.
Toolbar The 22.7.13 Toolbar Graphics Window allows fast access to actions and settings.
Display area The operational action of the function is visualized graphically in this display area. You
can access various visualization and editing options via a context menu.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed.
Related Topics
8.2.3.1 Selecting a Function for Setting Parameters
8.2.4.2 Showing and Hiding Graphics Window
8.2.4.3 Resizing the Width of the Graphics Window
You can use the Function-chart Editor to configure additional functions for the SIPROTEC 5 device. Use prede-
fined blocks for this.
Element Explanation
Data flow The 22.1.12 Data Flow tab is used to configure the CFC function as a graphic function
chart.
You can do this in one of the following ways:
• Adding modules from the global DIGSI 5 library to the function chart
• Connecting signals as input or outputs
• Interconnecting modules by drag and drop
• Documenting the function chart with text boxes
• Optimizing the function chart for execution in the SIPROTEC 5 device
Control flow Use the 22.1.13 Control Flow tab to change the execution order, if necessary.
You can do this in one of the following ways:
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Function-chart editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab can be used to add function blocks to the function chart.
• 22.2.5 Signals
This tab can be used to add signals to the function chart.
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.5 Configuration Strategy
You can use the Data flow tab to configure the CFC function as a graphic function chart.
Interface
Name This column displays the following sections:
• Input
This section displays the input pins and allows you to add the input terminals of
the CFC block to configure the interface.
• Output
This section displays the output pins and allows you to add the output terminals
of the CFC block to configure the interface..
• InOut
This section displays the IO pins and allows you to add the IO terminals of the
CFC block to configure the interface.
Element Explanation
Type This field contains the data type of the block connection. The following data types are
possible:
• Bool
• Word
• DWord
• UInt
• DInt
• Real
• Struct
Value This field contains the default value of the block connection.
Configurable The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the parameterization of
the block connection.
Interconnectable The state of this check box indicates the default setting for the interconnectability of
the block connection.
Comment This field contains a comment about the block connection that has been preset in the
factory.
Toolbar The 22.7.6 Toolbar Data Flow allows fast access to actions and settings.
Working area This working area is used to generate the function chart for the CFC function. Place
the blocks from the library in the working area for this purpose. Next, set parameters
for the blocks and then interconnect them. Use the signals and settings from the
signal catalog to establish the connection to the process or to internal functions.
Related Topics
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
You can use the Control flow tab to configure the CFC function and change the running sequence, if neces-
sary.
• A value
• An interconnection to another module
• An interconnection to a signal
You can also enter a value manually in this column.
Related Topics
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
The Display editor is used to generate the display pages for displaying in a SIPROTEC 5 device.
• 22.2.5 Signals
This tab can be used to add signals to the display page.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab to search for information within the Display editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
You can use this tab to add equipment items such as circuit breakers or busbars to the display page.
Related Topics
6.5.1 Overview of Display Pages
6.5.2.1 Opening a Display Page
22.1.16 Symbol Editor
Element Explanation
Online value This column displays the online value if the For Test option is set and if the address is
available.
For test This column enables you to select the For Test option for the respective parameter.
Comment This column displays the comment in the function block-terminal to which the signal
is connected.
Related Topics
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
You can use the Symbol editor to create symbols for user-defined elements, which you can then use on the
display page.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab to search for information within the Symbol editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
You can use this tab to insert elements such as, for example, circuit breakers as the basis for your own
elements in the Symbol editor.
Related Topics
6.5.5.1 Opening the Symbol Editor
22.1.14 Display Editor
You can use the Fault-display configuration editor to configure one fault display for each circuit breaker
configured in the application.
• Pickup indication
If you select this indication, the name of the stage that was tripped first will be
displayed in the event of a fault. The displayed indication can also contain addi-
tional information for phases, grounding and direction.
• PU time
If you select this measured value, the entire pickup duration of the fault is
displayed.
• Operate indication
If you select this indication, the name of the position level that was triggered first
will be displayed in the event of a fault. The displayed indication can also contain
additional information for phases.
• Trip indication
If you select this indication, the name of the control device or switching device
which was tripped will be displayed in the event of a fault. The displayed indica-
tion can also contain additional information for phases.
• Trip time
If you select this measured value, the tripping time is related to the start of the
fault event (tripping start)
• Fault distance
If you select this measured value, the measured distance to the fault location is
displayed.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Fault-display configura-
tion editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Fault-display configura-
tion editor.
Related Topics
6.5.7.3 Configuring Fault Displays
The Document information editor is used to create and edit masters for documentation of the device and
project data.
Element Explanation
Text
Location (LID) This text box enables you to specify the location where the project was created or
edited.
1st view This text box enables you to specify the notes about the view or appearance of the
document to be printed using the document information.
1st description This text box enables you to specify the 1st description of the project.
2nd description This text box enables you to specify the 2nd description of the project.
Version This text box enables you to specify the version of the current project.
User Defined The text box for user-defined field enables you to enter freely selectable text that can
be added to a printout.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Document editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Document editor.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.2 Opening the Document Information Editor
The Frames editor is used to create frames for documentation of the device and project data.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Frames editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Frames editor.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.2 Opening the Document Information Editor
The Cover pages editor is used to create frames for documentation of the device and project data.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Cover pages editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Cover pages editor.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.2 Opening the Document Information Editor
You can use the IEC 61850 structure editor to access the IEC 61850 structure of an offline configuration and
adapt the structure to suit your requirements.
Active on This column displays the current visibility of settings and SIPROTEC extensions in the IEC
interface 61850 interface. The interface refers to the IEC 61850 port of the SIPROTEC 5 device. LNs and
LDs which are not checked in this column are not transferred to the IEC 61850 System config-
urator (IID file) or to the SIPROTEC 5 device and therefore cannot be accessed over IEC 61850
(for example, using the IEC Browser).
The check-box options (read-only and editable) under the Active on interface column for the
respective objects in the Name column indicates different possibilities:
Read-only check-box options:
Indicates that the data object cannot be hidden from the IEC 61850 interface. You
cannot modify the check-box state.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab to search for information within the IEC 61850 structure editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
You can use this tab to add logical nodes and user-defined signals in the IEC 61850 structure editor.
Related Topics
21.7.1 Logical Node
21.7.2 Standard Data Objects
10.1 Overview
10.3 Opening and Adjusting the IEC 61850 Structure Editor22.7.11 Toolbar of the IEC 61850 Structure Editor
You can use the Test-sequences editor to generate test sequences for the internal test generator of a
SIPROTEC 5 device.
State name This text box contains a consecutively numbered standard name for the state. Enter
another name for the state, if required.
Execute this state for A state of the test sequence ends after a previously defined duration. This list box is
used to select a value for the duration in seconds. Alternatively, you enter a value in
the text box of the list box.
Duration of each step If you want to use the ramp function, use this list box to select a value for the state
duration in seconds. Alternatively, you enter a value in the text box of the list box.
After creating a state, the value is equal to 0.1. A value greater than 0 is required so
that you can set the further parameters for the ramp function.
With the ramp function, you can incrementally increase or reduce either the magni-
tude, the phase angle, or the frequency of an analog signal within a state. This is done
by defining the step duration and a delta value. As soon as the state duration has
expired, the value of the selected parameter (frequency or magnitude) will be
increased or reduced by the delta value. This process is performed repeatedly until the
duration of each step has expired.
Specify values for In this area, you can set the values of the analog signals for the state currently
secondary analog- selected. More information is provided by the following table, Specify values for
input signals for this secondary analog input signals for this state.
state
Specify status of In this area, you can define the status of each individual binary signal for the state
binary-input signals currently selected. If a binary signal is to adopt the status High, mark the associated
for this state (Only check box. If a binary signal is to adopt the status Low, remove the marking from the
first 25 binary inputs check box.
are supported)
Specify values for In the Signals column, this area displays the names of all signals that are used as
signals used as inputs input signals in the function charts of the current offline configuration. There is a list
in function charts box for each signal in the Value column. These list boxes allow you select a value for
(CFC). each signal that should be used for the signal when the test sequence executes.
Specify values for secondary analog-input signals for this state
Double-click on the cell with the value in order to change a value that can be set. The cell changes to a list
box. To change the value, click on the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you can enter a value in the
text box of the list box.
Analog inputs
This column block contains the names of the measuring points and the individual lines.
Name This column contains the names of all measuring points. You cannot change the
names.
Phase This column contains the names of the individual phases. You cannot change the
names.
Start value
You can define starting values for each analog signal in this column block. If you use the ramp function, the
value of the analog signal will be incremented or decremented starting from this starting value. If you do not
use the ramp function, the analog signal is assigned the defined starting value permanently during a state.
Magnitude This column contains the magnitudes of the individual analog signals.
Unit This column contains the units for the magnitudes of the analog signals. You cannot
change the units.
Phase angle This column contains the values of the phase angles for the individual analog signals.
Frequency This column contains the frequency values for the individual analog signals. The
frequency must be identical for all analog signals routed to a measuring point. Hence,
set a common frequency value per measuring point. This is automatically applied to
all associated analog signals.
Ramping
With the ramp function, you can incrementally increase or reduce either the magnitude, the phase angle or
the frequency of an analog signal within a state. This column block is used to set these parameters for each
analog signal.
Parameter This column contains a list box for each analog signal. This list box is used to select
the settings that need to be changed with the ramp function. The magnitude, the
phase angle, or the frequency are available for selection. The list box does not
become active until a step duration greater than 0 is set. The list box is opened by
clicking in the cell.
Delta This column contains for each analog signal the delta value, which the ramp function
is to use in order to change the setting selected. The value can be edited only if a
setting is selected for the ramp function.
Approx. end value This column contains the tentative final value for each analog signal, with the value
being obtained from the remaining values specified. The final value is calculated auto-
matically.
Unit This column contains the units of the parameters selected. You cannot change the
units.
Harmonic
You can set parameters up to 3 harmonics for each analog signal. You can define the magnitude, phase
angle, and factor for each harmonic. The 3 settings are combined together with the unit to one column
range. Since you can set parameters for 3 harmonics, 3 column ranges are provided.
Magnitude This column contains the magnitudes of the individual harmonics.
Unit This column contains the units for the magnitudes of the individual harmonics. You
cannot change the units.
Phase angle This column contains the values of the phase angles for the individual harmonics.
Factor This column contains the factors of the individual harmonics, for example 3 for the
3rd harmonic. You can enter numbers in the range 2 through 40 for the factors.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab to search for information within the Test-sequences editor.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test-sequences editor.
Related Topics
13.1 Overview of Test Sequences
13.2.1 Opening the Test Sequence
You can select from the following test functions with the Test editor for wiring:
• Testing device components such as binary outputs and LEDs of a SIPROTEC 5 device
Header
This area contains superordinate notes, instructions and operating elements. This area is orange if all the
requirements for carrying out the test function have not yet been met. If the area is yellow, all requirements
have been met and you can perform the test function.
Restart the device You can use this button to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device. The SIPROTEC 5 device is
finally in commissioning mode. This mode is the requirement for carrying out the test
functions. If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog
22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
This button is visible only if the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in commissioning mode.
Show device mode This button is used to open the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area. You
can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for wiring.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for wiring.
Related Topics
17.4.1 Testing Wiring
You can select from the following test and diagnostics functions with the Test editor for communication
modules:
Selection
Information about communication modules is structured hierarchically in groups on the left side of the
window of this Test editor. Each group corresponds to a communication module as well as the integrated
Ethernet interface of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You can open or close the groups using the arrows to the left of
the groups. Each group contains, depending on the respective communication module, other groups, for
example, for the communication protocol.
Communication Protocol
If you mark the group of a communication protocol in the left window of the Test editor, the right window of
the Test editor contains the contents of this communication protocol.
The contents are structured in a tabular manner. One line in the table contains one indication together with
other information. The information is arranged in columns.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the indica-
tion, for example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352. Indications are always summarized in an
indication log. The indication log, too, has a time stamp. If you click on the arrow next
to this time stamp on the left, the individual indications of the indication log are
displayed.
Message number This column contains a sequentially ascending numbering for all indications in the
indication log. The most recent entry has the highest number.
Indication This column contains the indication texts, for example, Starting the log successful.
Further Information
If you mark one of the other groups in the left window of the Test editor, the right window of the Test editor
contains information pertaining to this group. An example of this is the signal information for the Protection
interface group.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for commu-
nication modules.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for commu-
nication modules.
Related Topics
17.4.7 Reading the Communication Log
17.4.11 Checking Diagnosis Data for Protection-Data Communication
You can use the Test editor for analog inputs to check the current and voltage values present at the measuring
points of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
Header
This area contains superordinate notes.
Show device mode This button is used to open the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area. You
can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
Phasor Diagrams
The left window of the Test editor displays the current and voltage values as phasor diagrams for each
SIPROTEC 5 device separately.
Measured Values
The right-hand window of the Test editor displays the current and voltage values as number values for each
SIPROTEC 5 device separately.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains the name and the values for one phase.
The names and values are arranged in columns.
Signals This column contains one group for each SIPROTEC 5 device. You can open or close
these groups using the arrows to the left of the groups. If you open one of the groups,
the names of the phase, terminal, value and quality are displayed in the respective
columns.
Terminal This column contains the terminal values.
Value This column contains the phase values separately for the magnitude and phase. The
values are percentage values. In this case, 100 % is equivalent to the rated current or
rated voltage of a phase.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes of the analog inputs.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for analog
inputs.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for analog
inputs.
• 22.2.6 Online
You can use this tab to select and start the test sequences.
Related Topics
17.4.2 Testing Analog Inputs
You can use the Test editor for control functions to check the control functions for switching devices such as
circuit breakers or disconnector switches.
NOTE
i Follow the warning instructions given under 17.4.4 Testing Control Functions!
Header
This area contains superordinate notes, instructions and operating elements. This area is orange if all the
requirements or recommendations for carrying out the test function have not yet been met. If the area is
yellow, all requirements have been met and you can perform the test function.
Switch device to test You can use this button to start the SIPROTEC 5 device. Afterwards, the SIPROTEC 5
mode (and send tele- device is in process mode. This mode is the requirement for carrying out the test func-
grams with test flags) tions. If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter
Confirmation ID opens.
This button is visible only if the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in process mode.
Operate switching This button is used to activate test mode. All signals transmitted are now identified
devices directly with a test bit. This button is visible only if test mode is deactivated.
Stop operating This button is used to deactivate test mode. All signals are now transmitted without
switching devices an identifier. This button is visible only if test mode is activated.
directly
Ignore interlocking This button is used to deactivate interlocking conditions. This button is visible only if
conditions interlocking conditions are activated.
Consider interlocking This button is used to activate interlocking conditions. This button is visible only if
conditions interlocking conditions are deactivated.
Show device mode This button is used to open the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area. You
can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
Control Functions
In this window, you can test the individual switching devices. You can get information about the current
state of the switching devices, set a new state and activate this state.
The window has a table-like structure. One row in the table contains the name of a switching device together
with operating elements and other information. The operating elements and information are arranged in
columns.
Switching functions This column contains the names of all switching devices, whose particular function
group contains the Control function.
Current value This column contains the current states of the switching devices, for example, Open.
New value This column contains a list box for each switching device. You can select a new state
for the switching device with this list box.
Control operations This column range contains 3 buttons for each switching device. You can use the
Select button to select a switching device for change of state. You can use the Cancel
button to cancel this selection. You can use the Operate button to switch a switching
device that has been selected.
Interlocking condition This column contains information about the state of the interlocking conditions, for
example, Fulfilled.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes of the control functions. The quality attrib-
utes possible are Valid, Questionable and Invalid.
Indication Overview
Spontaneous indication log the switching procedures in this window.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains one indication from several individual
pieces of information. The information is arranged in columns.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the indica-
tion, for example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352.
Indication This column contains the indication texts, for example, Circuit-breaker 1:Control:
Command with feedback.
Value This column contains the current states of the switching devices attained after
switching operations, for example, Closed.
Additional informa- This column contains additional information about the switching procedures, for
tion example, about the cause or the initiator.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes of the indications. The quality attributes
possible are Valid, Questionable and Invalid.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for control
functions.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for control
functions.
Related Topics
17.4.4 Testing Control Functions
The switching performance of the circuit breakers can be checked with the Test editor for circuit breakers.
NOTE
i Follow the warning instructions given under 17.4.3 Testing Circuit breakers!
Element Explanation
Toolbar The 22.7.19 Toolbar Test Editor for Circuit Breaker allows fast access to actions and
settings.
Header
This area contains superordinate notes, instructions and operating elements. This area is orange if all the
requirements for carrying out the test function have not yet been met. If the area is yellow, all requirements
have been met and you can perform the test function.
Start You can use this button to start the SIPROTEC 5 device. Afterwards, the SIPROTEC 5
device is in process mode. This mode is the requirement for carrying out the test func-
tion. If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter
Confirmation ID opens.
This button is visible only if the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in process mode.
Show device mode This button is used to open the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area. You
can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
Test Functions
You can start the testing method for the circuit breakers in this window.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains the name of a testing method together
with the information about the current state and the button to start the test. The information and button are
arranged in columns.
Test function This column contains one group per circuit breaker, whose function group contains
the Circuit-breaker test function.
You can open or close the groups using the arrows to the left of the groups. If you
open one of the groups, the names of the testing methods is displayed in this column
and the information and buttons are displayed in the other columns.
Test state This column contains the test states of the testing methods, for example, Started or
Successful.
Start This column contains a testing method for each button. If you click on a button, the
respective testing method gets started.
Indication Overview
Spontaneous indications log the switching procedures in this window.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains one indication from several individual
pieces of information. The information is arranged in columns.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the indica-
tion, for example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352.
Indication This column contains the indication texts, for example, Circuit-breaker 1:Control:
Command with feedback.
Value This column contains the current states of the switching devices attained after
switching operations, for example, Closed.
Additional informa- This column contains additional information about the switching procedures, for
tion example, about the cause or the initiator.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes of the indications. The quality attributes
possible are Valid, Questionable and Invalid.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for circuit
breakers.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for circuit
breakers.
Related Topics
17.4.3 Testing Circuit breakers
Protection function reactions to analog or binary input values can be checked with the Test editor for protec-
tion functions.
Header
This area contains superordinate notes, instructions and operating elements. This area is yellow if the
SIPROTEC 5 device is in the process mode. This area is orange if the SIPROTEC 5 device is in simulation mode.
You can carry out the test function in both device modes.
Active simulation You can use this button to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device. If the SIPROTEC 5 device is in
mode process mode before restarting, it goes to simulation mode after restarting and vice
versa.
If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter
Confirmation ID opens.
Show device mode This button is used to open the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area. You
can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
Graphics Window
Certain protection functions, for example, for distance protection or triggering, can be visualized graphically.
These graphics include zone diagrams and trigger characteristic curves. If a protection function can be
displayed graphically, you can use this window to check how it is working, based on the changes in the
graphic.
Indication Overview
Spontaneous indication log the response of the protection function in this window.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains one indication from several individual
pieces of information. The information is arranged in columns.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the indica-
tion, for example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352.
Relative time This column contains the relative time of the indication. The relative time refers to the
time difference with respect to the 1st indication. This indication has the relative time
0. An example of the relative time is 00:15:35.231.
Indication This column contains the indication texts, for example, Circuit-breaker 1:Control:
Command with feedback.
Value This column contains the respective value of an indication, for example, Test.
Additional informa- This column contains additional information, for example, about the cause or the
tion initiator.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes of the indications. The quality attributes
possible are Valid, Questionable and Invalid.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for protec-
tion functions.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for protec-
tion functions.
• 22.2.6 Online
You can use this tab to select and start the test sequences.
Related Topics
17.4.5 Testing Protection Functions
You can use the Test editor for communication protocols to set values for signals and then transmit the signals
via the system interface.
Header
This area contains superordinate notes, instructions and operating elements. This area is orange if all the
requirements or recommendations for carrying out the test function have not yet been met. If the area is
yellow, all requirements and recommendations have been met and you can perform the test function.
Activate commis- You can use this button to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device. The SIPROTEC 5 device is
sioning mode finally in commissioning mode. This mode is the requirement for carrying out the test
function. If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog
22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
This button is visible only if the SIPROTEC 5 device is not in commissioning mode.
Show device mode You can use this button to display the 22.5.3 Device Information in the working area.
You can check and change the device mode in the 22.5.4 Device Information tab.
Test Window
Select a value for the signal in this window and send this via the system interface.
The window has a table-like structure. One row in the table contains the name of a signal together with other
information and operating elements. The information and operating elements are arranged in columns.
Signals This column contains the names of the signals. All signals are structured in a hierarch-
ical manner according to function groups and functions. The structure is an image of
the signal list. Click on the arrows to the left of the element names to show or hide
individual elements of the structure.
Type This column contains the type for each signal, for example, PLC.
Routed to interface If a signal in the 22.3.1 Communication Mapping matrix is routed to a communication
interface, this column contains a description of the destination, for example,
F:USART-AE-2FO:Channel 2:IEC 60870-5-103.
Current value This column contains the current values of the signals, for example, Off or Ready.
Simulated value This column contains a list box for each signal whose value can be changed. You can
select a new value for the signal with this list box.
Set/reset value You can use this button to send the signal with the value set via the system interface.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed working with the Test editor for communica-
tion protocols.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed working with the Test editor for communica-
tion protocols.
Related Topics
17.4.6 Testing Communication Protocols
You can select from the following test and diagnostics functions with the Test editor for protection topology:
• 22.2.1 Tasks
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for protec-
tion topology.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, these are not needed for working with the Test editor for protec-
tion topology.
Related Topics
17.4.10 Checking Topology-Measured Values for Protection-Data Communication
17.4.11 Checking Diagnosis Data for Protection-Data Communication
You can use the Protection topology tab to check the diagnostics data to the protection-data communication.
Related Topics
17.4.11 Checking Diagnosis Data for Protection-Data Communication
22.1.32 Phasors
Topology-measured values for protection-data communication can be checked with the Phasors tab.
Phasor Diagrams
The left window of the Test editor shows the current and voltage values of the 3-phase measuring points as a
phasor diagram.
Measured Values
The right window of the Test editor shows the current and voltage values of all measuring points as numer-
ical values.
The window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains the name and the values of one meas-
uring-point input as well as other information. The names, values and other information are arranged in
columns.
Signals This column contains 1 group for each measuring point. You can open or close these
groups using the arrows to the left of the groups. If you open one of the groups, the
names of the measuring point inputs are displayed in this column and the other infor-
mation is displayed in the other columns.
Value This column contains the values present at the measuring point inputs, separately for
the magnitude and phase. The values are percentage values. In this case, 100 % is
equivalent to the rated current or rated voltage of a phase.
Related Topics
17.4.10 Checking Topology-Measured Values for Protection-Data Communication
Related Topics
2.2.8 Managing Device Drivers
The button allows you to import changes from the IEC System Configurator.
Available devices
IEC 61850 name This column displays the list of IEC 61850 names corresponding to the available
devices.
Device name This column displays the device name assigned to the IEC station.
This button allows you to move all the devices from the Available devices group to
the Assigned devices group.
This button allows you to move a single device from the Available devices group to
the Assigned devices group.
This button allows you to move a single device from the Assigned devices group to
the Available devices group.
This button allows you to move all the devices from the Assigned devices group to
the Available devices group.
Assigned devices
Status This column displays the status of the device corresponding to the IEC 61850 configu-
ration.
IEC 61850 name This column displays the list of IEC 61850 names corresponding to the assigned
devices.
Device name This column displays the list of device names assigned to the IEC station.
Related Topics
15.2 Adding an IEC Station
15.8 Assigning a SIPROTEC 5 Device to an IEC Station
15.11 Associating a System Configurator Project with the DIGSI 5 IEC Station
15.7 Viewing Devices in an IEC Station
This list box enables you to set the time range of the x-axis (input in minutes).
• Static
You can select this option for a static time range display. The time interval is not
refreshed. You can set any range. This mode can be used to visualize all logged
values in detail. Siemens recommends using this display mode for static values.
• Strip
You can select this option for a dynamic display. The time axis always displays
the current time at the far right. You can change the duration of the time
interval.
• Scope (jumping time range display)
The time axis displays a fixed time interval. Once the trend values reach the right
edge, the display changes so that the current time is shown at the left edge.
• Sweep
You can select this option for a sweep mode display. This mode is similar to the
Scope mode. However, the values of the last sweep continue to be displayed
until they are overwritten by the current values.
Element Explanation
Trend manager The trend manager visualizes the trend to axis assignments. You can hide trends by
(Select trend: selec- disabling the corresponding check box. Hidden trends are no longer recorded in the
tion field) trend chart, but still displayed in the legend in dimmed mode. Select trends to be
edited in the trend manager. In addition to a color code, the trends in the trend chart
are also provided with a marker to enable their quick identification in the legend and
trend manager.
Import/export (icons) The trends can be exported or imported in CSV format. The export icon is enabled
once you have selected a trend in the trend manager. Imported trends are visualized
on separate x and y axes. You can improve the comparison of an imported trend with
a trend from active logging by linking the x-axis of the imported trend with the
existing axis.
Customizing the user This menu can be used to show and hide display elements such as the legends, rulers,
interface (View or markers.
menu)
Linking x axes (Link When a trend is imported, the new x-axis (axis B) can be linked to the existing x-axis
axes selection field) (axis A). In the linked mode, axis B moves simultaneously with axis A, but can be
adjusted without interfering with axis A. This mode allows you to compare history
trends with the current trend.
Printing (Print icon) The print dialog can be used to print the currently displayed trends of the trend chart.
The printout can include a comment.
• Write protection disabled state (open padlock icon): You can edit the value in the
corresponding column of the definition table, or directly in this field. Changes to
the cell in the definition table are transferred to the field of the y axis. However,
changes to the field of the y axis are not transferred to the corresponding cell in
the definition table.
• Write protection enabled state (closed padlock icon): The value cannot be edited
in the corresponding column of the definition table or in the y axis field.
You can restore the configured minimum/maximum with double-click on the y axis.
Write protection for Using this icon, you can enable write protection for the input field next to the icon
the input field (closed padlock icon), or disable it (open padlock icon).
• Write protection disabled state (open padlock icon): You can edit the value in the
corresponding column of the definition table, or directly in this field. Changes to
the cell in the definition table are transferred to the field of the y-axis. However,
changes to the field of the y-axis are not transferred to the corresponding cell in
the definition table.
• Write protection enabled state (closed padlock icon): The value cannot be edited
in the corresponding column of the definition table or in the y-axis field.
Y axis (here: analog The y-axis is labeled with the axis name and the configured physical unit.
axis)
Minimum value This field displays the minimum value of an analog axis. The access for editing
depends on the state of the write protection.
Time (right edge of This field displays the time for the right edge of the x-axis. The write access depends
the visualized trend on:
range)
• The state of the associated write protection
• The selected display mode
You can use the selection function to open a calendar and select a different day.
Time range of the x- The time range of the x-axis is set in the definition table.
axis
Element Explanation
Time (left edge of the This field displays the time for the left edge of the x-axis. The write access depends on
visualized trend the following:
range)
• The state of the associated write protection
• The selected display mode
You can use the selection function to open a calendar and select a different day.
Digital trend names The names of the digital trends are displayed outside of the trend chart. The position
depends on the configured position of the digital axis.
Y axis (here: digital The y-axis is labeled with the axis names.
axis)
Legend (analog The legend displays the markers and names of the visualized analog trends. The corre-
trends) sponding values are displayed to the right of the trend name:
• If there is no ruler, the last values added to the trend are displayed.
• If at least one ruler is displayed, the associated values are displayed to the right
of the trend name at the active ruler.
Analog trends Analog trends are visualized in the upper area of the trend window. The names of the
analog trends (F) are displayed in the legend of the trend chart.
A tooltip is displayed for each visualized trend whenever you position the mouse
pointer on the trend line. The tooltip first displays the trend name. Click this name to
display the configured data source.
Markers Markers help you to distinguish between several trends. You can enable the display of
markers in the View menu.
Interpolated trend A value without underscore on the ruler indicates that this is an interpolated value. A
value defined online value is not available for this trend point.
Defined trend value An underscored value on the ruler indicates that this is a defined online value.
Digital trends Digital trends are visualized in the lower area of the trend window. The names of the
digital trends are displayed outside of the trend chart. The position depends on the
configured position of the digital axis. A tooltip is displayed for each visualized trend
whenever you position the mouse pointer on the trend line. The tooltip first displays
the trend name. Click this name to display the configured data source.
Ruler A ruler displays the value of each trend at the ruler/trend intersections. Every ruler
displays the associated time stamp with date and time. A trend chart may have
several rulers.
The active ruler is indicated by a yellow marker at its top end. The values at the active
rulers are displayed in the legend (A) to the right of the trend name.
• Adding rulers:
You can drag and drop a new ruler from its docking position on the left edge of
the trend chart to a specific position in the trend chart.
• Copying rulers:
Press <CTRL> and click the ruler to paste a copy thereof.
• Deleting rulers:
Drag the ruler to the left edge of the trend chart.
Press <Alt> and click the ruler to be deleted.
Element Explanation
Ratio display/scroll This function depends on the selected display mode and only affects analog trends:
bar (y-axis)
• Scroll bar function along with the ratio display in the Static display mode.
• Ratio display in all other display modes.
Ratio display
The scroll bar displays the approximate ratio between the configured and currently
displayed range of values of the y-axis in the trend chart.
Scroll bar
The scroll bar can be used to shift the visible range of a trend in the trend chart if the
displayed time range of the y-axis was modified in vertical direction, for example, by
means of the zoom icons.
Ratio display/scroll This function depends on the selected display mode and only affects analog trends:
bar (x-axis)
• Scroll bar function along with the ratio display in the Static display mode.
• Ratio display in all other display modes.
Ratio display
The scroll bar displays the approximate ratio between the configured and currently
displayed range of values of the x-axis in the trend chart.
Scroll bar
The scroll bar can be used to shift the visible range of a trend in the trend chart if the
displayed time range of the x-axis was modified in horizontal direction, for example,
by means of the zoom icons.
Related Topics
12.5.1 Brief Introduction to Function Subcharts and Templates
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor
• Fast-scan
• Slow-scan
• Continuous
• Trend
NOTE
• For all device types other than the 7KE device, the list box is
disabled and it displays the default recorder.
This button allows you to move the selected signal or signals up
by 1 row. Selection of single and multiple signals is possible.
Element Explanation
This button allows you to move selected signal or signals down
by 1 row. Selection of single and multiple signals is possible.
This button allows you to reset the order of the signals to the
default order.
Elements of the Signal order Editor
MV signals This tab displays the MV signals routed to the Recorder column
in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor. The following columns
are available in the MV signals tab:
• Signal:
This column contains the names of the MV signals. All
signals are structured in a hierarchical manner according to
the function groups, functions, function blocks, and signal
names separated by a colon.
• Alternative name:
This column displays the alternative name of the routed
signal.
SPS signals This tab displays the SPS signals routed to the Recorder column
in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor. The following columns
are available in the SPS signals tab:
• Signal:
This column contains the names of the SPS signals. All
signals are structured in a hierarchical manner according to
the function groups, functions, function blocks, and signal
names separated by colon.
• Alternative name:
This column displays the alternative name of the routed
signal.
Related Topics
17.5.3.3 Configuring the Signal Order for Fault Recording
22.3.2 Information Routing
22.2.1 Tasks
The Tasks tab contains operating elements for the Find and Replace function. This function offers a range of
additional options. The extra options that can be selected are dependent on the current tool opened in the
working area, for example, editor or matrix.
Element Explanation
Find This button is used to start the search. The first match is marked in the
editor.
Replace with Enter a substitute term with which you wish to replace the match in the
text box of this list box. Alternatively, you can select one of the substi-
tute terms last entered from the list box.
Replace This button is used to replace the marked match by the specified substi-
tute term. The next match is then automatically marked in the editor.
Replace all This button is used to replace all matches at once.
22.2.2 Toolbox
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.8.2 Adding and Editing a Text Box
22.1.19 Frames Editor
22.1.20 Cover Pages Editor
22.2.3 Libraries
The Libraries tab contains the global DIGSI 5 library and the project library. To create a single-line diagram or a
display page, for example, use elements from the global DIGSI 5 library.
The Libraries tab is divided into 3 palettes:
• Project library
• Global libraries
• Information
Project Library
The project library is intended for future expansion.
Global Libraries
Toolbar The 22.7.41 Toolbar Palette Global Libraries is used for fast access to actions and settings in
the Global DIGSI 5 library palette to work with the user-defined global DIGSI 5 library.
List box This list box is used to filter the display of the global DIGSI 5 library. To be able to see all
elements, select the All settings. If you select the Context-based filtering setting, only those
elements that you require for work with the active editor are displayed.
Library struc- Folders named Global DIGSI 5 library and Documentation templates with subfolders are
ture displayed in the Global libraries palette. You can view the device types grouped under the
respective device family. The device family is based on the type of protection device drivers
imported in DIGSI 5. The content of this library is structured hierarchically. As in the project
tree, you can navigate through the structure and show or hide individual levels.
Information
Display area This display area provides additional information on an element marked in the library. Such
information is typically the type of element or a brief description regarding the use of the
element.
Related Topics
3.3.2 Opening the Libraries Tab
3.3.5 Using Elements of the Global DIGSI 5 Library
3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
The Hardware catalog tab contains individual components of SIPROTEC 5 devices, for example communica-
tion modules, as well as preconfigured devices. The Hardware catalog tab is typically used, for example, to
adapt offline configured hardware to its requirements.
The Hardware catalog tab is divided into 2 palettes:
• Catalog
• Information
Element Explanation
Information
Display area This display area provides additional information about a marked component in a hardware
catalog:
• Graphical representation
• Order no.
• Version
• Description
Related Topics
6.3.8 Searching for a Hardware Component in the Hardware Catalog
6.3.7 Adding a Hardware Component from the Hardware Catalog
6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
22.2.5 Signals
The Signals tab contains the signals and the settings of all offline configurations in the project. The Signals
tab is typically used to link elements on a display page to signals.
The Signals tab is divided into 2 sections:
• Signal catalog
• Information
• Type
• IEC 61850 name
• IEC 61850 path
• Description
Supported Signals
• List of Supported Signal Types for the Function Chart, Page 343
• List of Supported Setting Types for the Function Chart, Page 343
Related Topics
9.6.1 Overview of the Signal Catalog
6.5.3.5 Connecting Graphical Elements in a Display Page with a Signal
12.1.5.3 Interconnecting a Block with a Signal or a Setting
22.2.6 Online
The Online tab contains the Test environment palette. Test sequences can be used online with the DIGSI 5 PC
connected SIPROTEC 5 device with elements of this palette.
Element Explanation
Start This button is used to start the test sequence. When the Immediately start test sequence is
selected, then the test sequence will start immediately. After selecting the If the following
binary input is set option, click the Start button to release the test sequence. The test
sequence is first started when the selected binary input is set. The button is active only if the
online device is in simulation mode and the test sequence has not started yet.
Stop This button is used to prematurely stop the test sequence. The button is active only if the
online device is in simulation mode and the test sequence has started.
Related Topics
17.4.2 Testing Analog Inputs
17.4.5 Testing Protection Functions
22.3 Matrices
You can use the Communication mapping to define the signals for serial protocols that are transmitted via
the communication interface of a SIPROTEC 5 device. Depending on your model, you can also route signals in
the transmit or receive direction for each individual communication channels. You also have to set mapping
settings for each signal routed. The Communication mapping matrix has a table-like structure. One row in
the table is assigned to each signal. The transmit and receive direction as well as the mapping settings are
arranged in columns.
NOTE
i Certain settings described in the following table can take up only defined values, for example, Yes or No.
To configure such settings, the respective cell of the Communication mapping matrix contains a list box.
Other settings are defined by a numerical value. For this settings, the relevant cell contains an entry field.
Element Explanation
IEC 60870-5-103
These columns are available only for the IEC 60870-5-103 protocol. The columns are not available if this
protocol is not configured.
Function type Enter the number of a function type for a signal that has been routed in this column.
The function type identifies the functionality of a device. Certain numbers are not
used. You can use these numbers as you like, without affecting the IEC 60870-5-103
compatibility.
Information number Enter an information number for a signal that has been routed in this column. The
information number describes the signal category (Indication, metered value or
command).
Data unit Enter the number of a data unit (DU) for a signal that has been routed in this column.
Depending on the signal type, you can select from different data units.
General interrogation Specify in this column for an indication that has been routed, whether it is subject to
general interrogation or not. You can select between Yes or No. If you select Yes, the
indication is additionally transmitted only within the scope of a general interrogation.
Position Specify in this column the position in the measured value telegram for a measured
value that has been routed. In a 3-frame DU, you can route up to 4 measured values.
In a 9-frame DU, you can route up to 16 measured values. In total, you can route one
3-frame DU and two 9-frame DU.
Fault channel In this column, you can route a measured value that has been routed to the analog
channel of a fault record. Enter the number of the fault-record channel for this
purpose.
IEC 60870-5-104
These columns are available only for the IEC 60870-5-104 protocol. The columns are not available if this
protocol is not configured.
IOA With this column, you can specify the Information object address (IOA).
IOA 1 With this column, you can specify the 1st byte of the Information object address (IOA)
with low byte.
IOA 2 With this column, you can specify the 2nd byte of the Information object address
(IOA).
IOA 3 With this column, you can specify the 3rd byte of the Information object address (IOA)
with high byte.
TI This column indicates the Type identification.
GI group Specify in this column for an indication that has been routed, whether it is subject to
General Interrogation group (GI group) or not.
Threshold Enter a measured-value threshold in percent for a measured value that has been
routed in this column.
ScaledFactor This column indicates the scaled factor for the measured values.
NormalizedMaxValue This column indicates the maximum percentage value for the measured values.
Modbus TCP
These columns are available only for the Modbus TCP protocol. The columns are not available if this protocol
is not configured.
Register type In this column, you can specify the Register type. It describes the function code to
retrieve the data of the signal.
Register address Enter a register address for a signal that has been routed in this column. The register
address has a certain range for different signal categories.
Event of Protection You can specify in this column whether an indication that has been routed is subject
to an Event of Protection or not.
Element Explanation
PROFINET IO
These columns are available only for the PROFINET IO protocol. The columns are not available if this protocol
is not configured.
Value In this column, you can specify the address for a signal that has been routed. The
address has a certain range for different signal categories.
DNP3
These columns are available only for the DNP3 protocol. The columns are not available if this protocol is not
configured.
Index Enter an index number ranging from 1 to 1,000 for a signal that has been routed in
this column.
Class Assign one of 3 classes to a signal that has been routed in this column. The class 1 is
reserved for critical events. You can assign the class 2 or 3 to the less critical events.
Threshold Enter a measured-value threshold in percent for a measured value that has been
routed in this column.
The measured-value threshold determines the transmission frequency of measured
values. If you select the value zero for the measured-value threshold, each measured
value is transmitted to the superordinate station.
A value of 1 is used to avoid a communication overload. A measured-value threshold
other than zero causes all changes of new measured values compared to the meas-
ured value transmitted last to be added. If the sum of the changes reaches the
percent value set, a new measured value is transmitted at the next possible point in
time. This measure prevents loading the communication path too much.
Protection-Data Communication Protocol
These columns are available only for the protection-data communication protocol. The columns are not avail-
able if this protocol is not configured.
Priority level Select one of 3 priority levels for a signal that has been routed in this column. The
priority level decides on how often it is transmitted.
Bit position Set a bit position in the data bar for each signal that has been routed in this column.
Note that some signal types need more than one bit. Also take care to ensure that a
bit position is not already assigned to a signal of another device.
Fallback value Select a fallback value for a received signal in this column. The fallback value decides
what passes with the value of a signal if the connection is interrupted. Depending on
the signal type, various fallback values can be selected. For example, the signal value
can be set to a secure status or the last value received is retained.
IEC 60870-5-103 and DNP3
These columns are available only for the IEC 60870-5-103 and DNP3 protocols. The columns are not avail-
able if none of these protocols is configured.
Object group Enter the number of an object group for a parameter that has been routed in this
column.
Scaling factor Enter a value for the measured scaling for a measured value that has been routed in
this column.
Busbar-Protection Protocol
This column is only available for the busbar-protection bay units with busbar-protection protocol.
Transmit This column shows the fixed default settings for the routings for current measured
values and switch positions that are necessary for the busbar protection.
NOTE
i Other information regarding the configuration of the mapping settings are given in the Device manual, in
the manual for the respective protocol and in the protocol specifications.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Communication mapping to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
You can use this tab to add function groups, functions and signals in the Communication mapping
matrix, and thus, in the application.
Related Topics
14.9.1 Overview of Communication Mapping
14.9.3 Opening the Communication Mapping Matrix
You can use the Information routing matrix to route information to sources and destinations.
The Information routing matrix has a table-like structure. One row in the table is assigned to each informa-
tion. The sources and destinations are arranged in columns.
Element Explanation
Function keys This column range contains 1 column each for each of the 8 function keys of a base
module. This column range is visible only if the base module has function keys.
GOOSE This column is used to route signals in order to receive input signals via the IEC 61850
GOOSE protocol. M indicates the number of inputs available for binding the GOOSE
external sources via the IEC 61850 system configurator. N indicates the number of
unconnected inputs. The tooltip displays the maximum number of inputs supported
by the signal. The inputs can be OR connected.
CFC This column indicates whether a signal is used in a function chart (CFC). In DIGSI 5, to
be able to use a signal in a function chart (CFC), you no longer need to route it to CFC.
That is why this column only has a display feature. You cannot route any information
to this column.
If this column is not visible, click in the toolbar of the Information routing matrix on
the
• Operational log
• Fault log
• Ground fault log
• User-defined log 1
• User-defined log 2
Device menu This column range contains one column each for the Measurement and Control
device menus. This column range is visible only if the base module is provided with a
display unit.
Element Explanation
CFC This column indicates whether a signal is used in a function chart (CFC). In DIGSI 5, to
be able to use a signal in a function chart (CFC), you no longer need to route it to CFC.
That is why this column only has a display feature. You cannot route any information
to this column.
If this column is not visible, click in the toolbar of the Information routing matrix on
the
button. The column is displayed only if the base module is provided with a
display unit.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Information routing to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
You can use this tab to add function groups, functions and signals in the Information routing matrix,
and thus, in the application.
• 22.2.5 Signals
You can use this tab to add signals from another offline configuration to the Information routing matrix,
and use them to generate a GOOSE connection.
Related Topics
11.1 Overview for Information Routing
11.2 Basic Principles of Routing
11.3.1 Opening the Information Routing Matrix
You can use the Trigger routing matrix to route triggers to fast scan and slow scan records available under
Recorder column.
Element Explanation
Trigger This column contains the names of all Triggers instantiated in the device. Click on the
arrows to the left of the element names to show or hide individual elements of the
structure.
Recorder Each recorder, for example, the Fast scan record, and Slow scan record is represented
by column respectively. Each column bears the name of the associated recorder type.
You can use the context menu to route a trigger to recorders. The common cell of the
respective line and column contains the value X.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Trigger routing matrix to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Trigger routing matrix.
Related Topics
17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
You can use the Function-group connections matrix to edit the connections between the function groups as
well as between function groups and measuring points.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Function-group connections matrix to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Function-group
connections matrix.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
8.1.4.2 Opening a Function-Group Connection Matrix and Adjusting a View
You can use the Connect measuring points to function group window to connect measuring points with
one or more function group inputs. You can find the Connect measuring points to function group window
in the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix.
The Connect measuring points to function group window has a table-like structure. One line in the table
contains one measuring point. The function group inputs are arranged in columns.
• Voltage 3-phase
• Line current 3-phase
• Ground-current parallel line
• Transf. neutral-point current
You can use the context menu to connect measuring points and function-group
inputs. If a measuring point is connected with a function-group input, the common
cell of the respective line and column contains an X. You find details on this under
8.1.4.4 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Groups.
Circuit-breaker func- Each circuit-breaker function group is represented by one column range respectively.
tion group 1 to n A column range bears the name of the associated circuit-breaker function group.
Depending on the types of measuring points used, one circuit-breaker function group
has up to 3 inputs. This is why one column range contains up to 3 columns:
• Voltage
• Line current 3-phase
• Sync. voltage
You can use the context menu to connect measuring points and function-group
inputs. If a measuring point is connected with a function-group input, the common
cell of the respective line and column contains an X. You find details on this under
8.1.4.4 Connecting Measuring Points to Function Groups.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
You can use the Connect function group to circuit-breaker groups window to connect protection groups
with one or more circuit-breaker function groups. You can find the Connect function group to circuit-
breaker groups window in the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix.
The Connect function group to circuit-breaker groups window has a table-like structure. One line in the
table contains one protection group. The circuit-breaker function groups are arranged in columns.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
You can use the Connect protection-function group to protection-function group window to change the
predefined connections between protection groups. You can find the Connect protection-function group to
protection-function group window in the 22.3.4 Function-Group Connections matrix.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
You can use the Measuring-points routing matrix to route the inputs of current and voltage-measuring
points to the physical inputs of a SIPROTEC 5 device.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Measuring-points routing matrix to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Measuring-points
routing matrix.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
8.1.5.2 Opening the Measuring-Point Routing and Adjusting the View
You can use the Current-measuring points window to route the inputs of current-measuring points to the
current inputs of a SIPROTEC 5 device. In addition, you can use the Current-measuring points window to add
other current-measuring points in the application. You can find the Current-measuring points window in the
22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing matrix.
The Current-measuring points window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains one current-
measuring point. The current inputs of the SIPROTEC 5 device are arranged in columns.
Element Explanation
Connection type This column contains a list box for each current-measuring point. You can use this list
box to select the connection type of a current-measuring point.
Adjust a current-measuring point to a three-wire or four-wire system as well as to a
star or delta connection with the connection types. The connection type also deter-
mines the number of the measuring point inputs. A 1-phase measuring point always
has only one single input. A 3-phase measuring point however has 3 or 4 inputs
depending on the connection type.
Base module/Expan- One column range each is available for the base module and for each expansion
sion module module. Each of these column ranges contains 1 extra column range for each current
terminal block on the respective module. Each current terminal block has 4 inputs
consisting of 1 terminal pair respectively. This is why one column range contains 4
columns: One column corresponds to the terminal pair of a current input.
You can use the context menu to route the inputs to the current-measuring points.
While doing so, you can always see the names of the measuring-point inputs avail-
able. Details about routing of the measuring-point inputs can be found under
8.1.5.3 Routing Measuring Points to Physical Inputs.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
You can use the Voltage-measuring points window to route the inputs of voltage-measuring points to the
voltage inputs of a SIPROTEC 5 device. In addition, you can use the Voltage-measuring points window to add
other voltage-measuring points in the application. You can find the Voltage-measuring points window in the
22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing matrix.
The Voltage-measuring points window has a table-like structure. One line in the table contains one voltage-
measuring point. The voltage inputs of the SIPROTEC 5 device are arranged in columns.
Element Explanation
Connection type This column contains a list box for each voltage-measuring point. You can use this list
box to select the connection type of a voltage-measuring point.
Adjust a voltage-measuring point to a three-wire or four-wire system as well as to a
star or delta connection with the connection types. The connection type also deter-
mines the number of the measuring point inputs. A 1-phase measuring point always
has only one single input. A 3-phase measuring point however has 3 or 4 inputs
depending on the connection type.
Base module/Expan- One column range each is available for the base module and for each expansion
sion module module. Each of these column ranges contains 1 extra column range for each voltage
terminal block on the respective module. Each voltage terminal block has 4 inputs
consisting of 1 terminal pair respectively. This is why one column range contains 4
columns: One column corresponds to the terminal pair of a voltage input.
You can use the context menu to route the inputs to the current-measuring points.
While doing so, you can always see the names of the measuring-point inputs avail-
able. Details about routing of the measuring-point inputs can be found under
8.1.5.3 Routing Measuring Points to Physical Inputs.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
8.1.5.1 Overview of Measuring Points
You can use the Circuit-breaker interaction matrix to route functions or function blocks of a protection group
selected to one or more circuit-breaker function groups.
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Circuit-breaker interaction matrix to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Circuit-breaker interac-
tion matrix.
Related Topics
8.1.1 Overview of Applications
You can use the Merging-unit routing editor to route the inputs of current and voltage measuring points to
the physical inputs of a SIPROTEC 5 device used as merging unit (different from the device to be configured).
• 22.2.1 Tasks
You can use this tab within the Merging-unit routing matrix to search for information.
• 22.2.3 Libraries
This tab is always displayed. However, you do not need this for working with the Merging-unit routing
matrix.
22.4 Tables
22.4.1 Log
The Logs table displays the indications that have been read from the log. Each indication is displayed together
with additional information.
Related Topics
17.5.4.3 Opening the Logs Table
17.5.4.5 Reading Indications Logs from the SIPROTEC 5 Device
22.4.2 Records
The Records table shows all fault records read from the SIPROTEC 5 device. Each fault record is displayed
together with additional information.
Element Explanation
State This column contains state of the records. For example, New, and Downloaded.
Toolbar The 22.7.30 Toolbar Records Table allows fast access to actions and settings.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the fault, for
example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352.
Fault number This column contains the fault number of the fault record. A number of fault records
can be taken for one and the same fault. The consecutive fault number identifies a
sequence of associated fault records.
Name This column contains the name of the fault record, for example FRA00002.
Applicable for 7KE Device Types
State This column contains state of the records. For example, New, Downloaded, Deleted
from device.
Record ID This column contains the fault number of the records. The consecutive fault number
identifies a sequence of associated fault records.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at the time of the occurrence of the fault, for
example, 15.02.2011 22:33:06.352.
Duration This column contains the information related to the duration of the recording time.
Record type This column contains the information related to the type of the recorders.
Recorder name This column contains the information related to the name of the recorders.
Trigger name This column contains the information related to the triggering of the fault.
Trigger description This column contains the detailed information related to the triggering of the fault.
Size This column contains the information related to the size of the record, for example,
19000 KB.
Test record This column contains the information related to the test fault records.
Related Topics
17.5.3.1 Overview of Fault Recording
17.5.3.4 Opening the Records Table
22.4.3 Indications
The Indications table shows the spontaneous indications read from the SIPROTEC 5 device. Each indication is
displayed together with additional information.
Element Explanation
Quality This column contains the quality attribute of the indication. The quality attributes
possible are Valid, Questionable and Invalid.
Additional informa- This column contains additional information about the indication, for example
tion Command cancellation.
Related Topics
17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
17.5.2.2 Opening Indications Table and Reading Spontaneous Indications
The Indication snapshot displays indications that have been saved in the project as indication snapshots. The
indications are displayed together with additional information.
Related Topics
17.5.2.1 Overview of Indications
17.5.2.7 Opening Indication-Snapshots Table and Selecting and Showing Snapshots
22.4.5 Measurements
The Measurements table shows measured and calculated values read from the SIPROTEC 5 device. Each value
is displayed together with additional information.
Depending on the respective working situation, the Measurements table contains tabs for the following cate-
gories:
• Energy-metered values
• Statistic values
• Measured values
Element Explanation
Set value This column contains an entry field for every metered and statistic value. You can
enter a value in this entry field. You can use the Set button to set the metered and
statistic value to the value entered.
Set/reset value This column contains buttons to set and reset metered and statistic values. You can
use the Reset button to reset all metered and statistic values in a group, for example,
those in the Energy group. You can use the Set button to set individual metered or
statistic values to the value that you have entered in the Set value column.
Measurements This column contains the name of the measurand for which a value has been calcu-
lated.
Value This column contains the minimum, maximum, or the average value.
Quality This column contains the quality attributes.
Number This column contains a number that identifies the minimum, maximum, or average
value uniquely and clearly.
Related Topics
17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
17.5.1.3 Opening the Measured Value Table and Reading Values
The Measured-value snapshot displays measured and calculated values that have been saved in the project
as measured-value snapshots. Each value is displayed together with additional information.
Depending on the respective working situation the Measured-value snapshot table contains tabs for the
following categories:
• Energy-metered values
• Statistic values
• Measured values
Element Explanation
Quality This column contains the quality of the measured value. The quality attributes
possible are Valid, Questionable, and Invalid.
Number This column contains a number that identifies the measured value uniquely and
clearly.
Metered and Statistic Values
Measurand This column contains the name of the measurand for which a value has been
recorded, for example Op.ct or Wp+.
Value This column contains the metered or the statistic value.
Number This column contains a number that identifies the metered or statistic value uniquely
and clearly.
Minimum, Maximum, and Average values
Measurand This column contains the name of the measurand for which a value has been calcu-
lated.
Value This column contains the minimum, maximum, or the average value.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time at which the value has been calculated.
Number This column contains a number that identifies the minimum, maximum, or average
value uniquely and clearly.
Related Topics
17.5.1.1 Overview of Measured and Metered Values
17.5.1.6 Opening the Measured-Values Snapshots Table and Selecting a Snapshot
The project-language selection is used to select the language used in the project. You also define one
language each as an editing language and as a reference language.
Related Topics
5.2.2 Opening the Project-Language Selection View
The Print preview can be used to check the expected printing result before a printout.
• You can display a certain page directly with a text box in the symbol bar.
• You can display the previous or next page with buttons in the toolbar.
• You can display the previous or next view with buttons in the toolbar.
• You can move the pages vertically with the scroll bar.
• You can move the pages vertically with the hand tool.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.3.1 Overview of the Print Preview
The Device information section consists of several tabs with information and settings for the SIPROTEC 5
device. The scope of information and settings depend whether the device information is displayed for an
offline configuration or an online device.
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
6.1.9 Opening Device Information
This tab contains general information on the SIPROTEC 5 device. If DIGSI 5 is connected online with a
SIPROTEC 5 device, the tab will then contain additional information and setting options for this online device.
IEC 61850 name This text box contains the name of the SIPROTEC 5 unit in the IEC 61850 struc-
ture. You can modify the name. The name must correspond to the IEC 61850
terminology:
• You select the IEC 61850 protocol within the current project for the first
time for a communication channel.
Type This field contains the type of SIPROTEC 5 device, for example 7SA. You cannot
change the type.
Serial number Using the serial number, a unique connection between a real SIPROTEC 5 device
and an offline configuration in DIGSI 5 is defined. As soon as you assign a
SIPROTEC 5 device to an offline configuration or initialize a SIPROTEC 5 device
with an offline configuration, the serial number of the SIPROTEC 5 device is
entered in this text box. Alternatively, you can manually input the serial number
of the SIPROTEC 5 device into the text box. You can find the serial number on the
enclosure of the SIPROTEC 5 device base module.
Configuration version This field contains the version number of the current device configuration, for
example V01.00.00. You cannot change the version number.
Product code This field contains the long product code of the SIPROTEC 5 device. You cannot
change the product code directly.
Short product code This field displays the short product code of the SIPROTEC 5 device which has a
valid short product code. For a device without a valid short product code, this
field is empty in DIGSI 5. If you load configuration to the device with a valid short
product code, the Short product code value is displayed successfully under
Device information of the device display allowing you to verify the ordered
device. If you load configuration to the device in the absence of a valid short
product code, then the symbol --- is displayed for Short product code under
Device information in the device display.
CPU type This option is displayed only for modular devices. With this list box, you can
modify the CPU type of the device.
From DIGSI 5, version V7.80 on, it is not possible to change the CPU type of the
device. If you have added the device using DDDs with version V7.80 or a higher
version, you cannot change the CPU type of the configured project device from
CP300 to CP200 or vice versa.
The following CPU-type options can be set for the modular device:
• CP200
• CP300
Protection Application
This section only exists if the device information is displayed for an online device.
PhyHealth This field contains the value of the PhyHealth data attribute.
PwrUp This field contains the value of the PwrUp data attribute.
Mod This field contains the value of the Mod data attribute.
Device Mode
This section only exists if the device information is displayed for an online device.
Current device mode This field contains the name of the device mode set currently.
The following device modes can be set for the device:
• Process
• Commissioning
• Simulation
• Monitoring and supervision
If the field contains the entry Unknown, it means that either the connection to
the SIPROTEC 5 device is interrupted or that the SIPROTEC 5 device is just being
restarted.
Change device mode You can select a new device mode with this list box. You can use the Restart
button to activate this device mode in the SIPROTEC 5 device.
The following device modes are available:
• Process
• Commissioning
• Simulation
For devices with firmware version V06.00 and higher, if you change the device
mode from Process mode to Commissioning mode, the target device will switch
to Commissioning mode without any restart.
Delete buffers during If you mark this check box and click Restart, all buffers in the SIPROTEC 5 device
restart are deleted and the device restarts. This functionality is similar to the initial
startup of the device wherein all the buffers are deleted.
Restart You can use this button to restart the SIPROTEC 5 device. If the confirmation ID
for setting/operation is activated, the dialog 22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID
opens.
If you have selected a new device mode using the Change device mode list box,
it gets activated during restart.
If you have marked the check-box option Delete buffers during restart, all the
buffers in the SIPROTEC 5 device get deleted during the restart.
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
6.1.9 Opening Device Information
This tab is used for monitoring the resource consumption. The resource consumption considers the CPU and
memory of a SIPROTEC 5 device as well as the function-point status and the function charts (CFC).
Element Explanation
Processor load This area informs you whether the functionality selected for the SIPROTEC 5 device
leads to an overload in the device. Such an overload can affect the protection capa-
bility of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
The following factors, amongst others, affect the CPU load:
• Protection functions
• Function charts
• Communication connections
• Communication indications
The resource consumption is shown separately for different areas. If one of the areas
displayed is marked with a red symbol, reduce the scope of this area, for example,
functions or function charts.
The processor load is displayed in the device information for an offline and online
configuration.
Function points This area informs you about the maximum number of function points available and
the number currently used.
Function-chart (CFC) This area informs you about the function chart (CFC) resources.
statistics The following information displays the number of maximum permitted and currently
used CPU ticks for the following individual process levels:
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
12.1.7.2 Checking Resource Consumption
17.6.5 Loading the Device Functionality into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
8.1.3.4 Checking the Function-points Consumption
22.5.6 IO Consumption
This tab is used for monitoring the IO consumption. This functionality displays information about the availa-
bility of the number of binary Inputs, binary outputs and analog inputs in the device and their consumption.
Further, it allows you to plan for rest of the IOs available, and if required, to add new IOs.
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
22.5.7 Logs
This tab contains Device-diagnosis log and Security log read from the online device.
You can find explanations for the elements of the Security log under the Logs tab in the following table.
Element Explanation
Logs This column contains the indication categories that can be displayed and read. When
you select an indication category, the applicable indications in the Time Stamp,
Message Number, and Message columns are displayed.
Time stamp This column contains the date and time when the event occurred.
Message number This column contains a unique message number.
Severity This column displays the severity of each security log via the following options:
• Alert
• Warning
Indication This column contains the indication in plain text, for example battery error: Please
replace the device battery.
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
17.4.8 Reading Device-Diagnosis and Security Log
This tab displays the details of time sources configured for the device. If you want to change settings, for
example, the type of timer, you have to use the 22.5.11 Time Settings settings. You must do the changes in
offline mode and then transfer this configuration to the device.
However, you can set the date and time in the online device.
Clock errors This field contains an indication on a possible failure with the time synchronization.
The 2 state values of this indication are Yes and No.
Clock not synchron- This field contains an indication regarding the state of the time synchronization. The 2
ized state values of this indication are Yes and No.
Type of timer This field contains the type of selected timer, for example IRIG-B or SNTP.
Device Time
Time list box This list box is used to show a calendar by which you can select a date. This list box is
only active as soon as you click the Process time button.
Process time This button is used to activate the time-list box. Click on the time list box to display
the calendar for setting the time and date.
Set time This button is used to transmit the date and the time into the SIPROTEC 5 device
connected online. If the confirmation ID for setting/operation is activated, the dialog
22.6.18 Enter Confirmation ID opens.
Calendar
Month list box With this list box you select a month.
Year list box With this list box you select a year
Day selection area From this selection area you select a day.
No date With this button you specify that the device time is managed without a date.
Today With this button you will accept the current date for the device time.
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
14.6.2 Time Sources
14.6.4 Displaying Time Information
14.6.5 Setting Date and Time in the SIPROTEC 5 Device
You can use this tab to read diagnostics information from an offline and online device. The diagnostic infor-
mation is summarized in separate groups for the mainboard of the online device and every module plugged
into the device.
Related Topics
22.5.3 Device Information
17.4.9 Reading Diagnostics Information
The Device settings is a compilation of various, device-specific settings and actions. The device settings are
shown in the function settings in the 22.1.9 Settings Editor. The scope of the settings and actions depends on
whether the device settings being displayed are for an offline configuration or an online device.
Binary-input channel This list box is used to change the threshold values of all binary inputs. If you
threshold change the threshold value by selecting an option from the list box, the binary
input channel threshold value is updated in the properties of the 22.1.5 Device
and Networks Editor under the I/O module binary input group.
Used time stamp in GOOSE You can use this list box to configure the Used time stamp in GOOSE subscrip-
subscriptions tions attribute on the device level. This setting is available for the fault recorder
7KE85 with firmware version V6.00 and higher, as well as for all other device
types with firmware version V7.50 and higher. The GOOSE time stamp attribute
can be set to the following states:
• On message reception
If you select this option, the device receiving the GOOSE message uses its
own time stamp when receiving the signal (for example, in logs and fault
records).
• Provided by GOOSE publisher
If you select this option and if the signal contains the time stamp in the
GOOSE telegram, the device receiving the GOOSE message uses the time
stamp of the transmit sending signal.
Notes:
– Ensure that the publisher and subscriber device are time synchronized
when using the option Provided by GOOSE publisher. Failure to
comply with this note can result in missing or incorrect recording of
fault records.
– Regardless of the selected option of the GOOSE time stamp the trigger
time stamp of a fault record always represents the trigger time of the
subscriber/receiving device.
– The sending time stamp is available only for signals with CDC types
(ACD, BAC, BCR, INC, ISC BSC, SPS, SPC, INS, DPS, and DPC). For the
signals types that are not supported, the device always uses the
receiving time stamp regardless of the selected option.
Visibility of settings in You can use this list box to configure the visibility of settings in the IEC 61850
IEC 61850 structure interface by selecting the following options:
Visibility of SIPROTEC You can use this list box to configure the visibility of SIPROTEC extensions in the
extensions in IEC 61850 IEC 61850 structure by selecting the following options:
structure
• Hide all SIPROTEC extensions:
If you select this option, Siemens-internal data objects and logical nodes
information will not be included in the IID export file which is used for data
exchange with the IEC 61850 System Configurator. By default, this option
is enabled for all projects except the converted projects. This option saves
the file space and time. Also, the hidden objects and logical nodes are indi-
cated with an empty check box under the Active on interface column
in the 22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor. You can hide all SIPROTEC exten-
sions via the icon in the 22.7.11 Toolbar of the IEC 61850 Structure
Editor and also via the context-menu option Hide all SIPROTEC extensions
under selected object for individual objects and logical nodes. On
selecting the option Hide all SIPROTEC extensions, the list box option for
Visibility of settings in IEC 61850 structure changes from Show all
settings to Show all settings (customized). This change is not reversed,
even if you select the option Show all SIPROTEC extensions as the
settings and SIPROTEC extensions are hidden or displayed based on the last
selection.
Note:
There are some restrictions as not all elements can be hidden. For example,
elements that are used in GOOSE or referenced by IEC 61850 Datasets or
their parents, mandatory elements, LLN0s are read-only and cannot be
hidden or renamed. The icon displayed against the parent object node
indicates that some of the child object nodes are excluded and included for
export.
• Show all SIPROTEC extensions:
If you select this option, Siemens-internal data objects and logical nodes
information will be included in the IID export file which is used for data
exchange with the IEC 61850 System Configurator. On selecting the Show
all SIPROTEC extensions option, the list box option for Visibility of
settings in IEC 61850 structure changes from Hide all settings to Hide
all settings (customized). This change is not reversed, even if you select
the option Hide all SIPROTEC extensions as the settings and SIPROTEC
extensions are hidden or displayed based on the last selection. Also, the
now visible objects are indicated with a checked check box . You can
Reserv.time for com.prot With the parameter Reserv.time for com.prot., you define the maximum reser-
vation time for the parameterization of the device via the communication
protocol. That means, the maximum time that can elapse between the begin-
ning of the parameterizing operation (selection of the settings group to be
edited) and the end (confirmation) is the time Reserv.time for com.prot..
Otherwise, the parameterization operation is canceled with a time-out and
changes are rejected. This setting value is valid only for the device.
Access point used in With this option, you can specify the access point that is required for communi-
Edition 1 cation when the IEC 61850 protocol is enabled in more than 1 module in the
Edition 1 device.
Use alternative signal If you select this option, the alternative names defined for the signals under the
names Alternative name column in the 22.3.2 Information Routing are used in the
logs and records instead of the hierarchical names.
Enable GOOSE Supervision By default, this option is not enabled. You can enable this option only for
devices with IEC 61850 Edition 2 or a higher Edition. The GOOSE supervision
cannot be enabled for devices created with the configuration version older than
DIGSI 5, version V7.80. For more information about this check-box option, refer
to 15.17 GOOSE Supervision.
Station name With this list-box options, you can define the station name to be displayed in the
generated fault records:
• Substation name: This option is selected by default and the text box is
disabled and displays the project name. The project name is displayed as
the substation name in the generated fault records.
• User-defined: On selecting this option, the text box is enabled. You can
enter the desired name. The entered name is displayed as the substation
name in the generated fault records.
Enable display pages By default, this option is not enabled. If you enable this check-box option, the
Display pages folder is displayed in the project tree and you can proceed
further to configure the display pages in the device without display panel.
Activate Device Functionality
This area is visible only in the device settings for an offline configuration.
Voltage variant You can change the voltage variant of the SIPROTEC 5 device using this list box.
Integrated Ethernet inter- This list box is used to set the functional scope of the integrated Ethernet inter-
face (port J) face. If the new SIPROTEC 5 device is to communicate using this interface only
with DIGSI 5, select Only DIGSI 5 connection. If the new SIPROTEC 5 device is
also to send IEC 61850 indications using this interface, select DIGSI 5 connec-
tion and IEC 61850 reporting. To enable GOOSE communication on Port J for
any modular or non-modular devices (for example 7**82 device type), select
DIGSI 5 connection and IEC 61850 inclusive GOOSE. If you downgrade the
Integrated Ethernet interface (port J) value by changing the selection from
DIGSI 5 connection and IEC 61850 reporting or DIGSI 5 connection and IEC
61850 inclusive GOOSE to Only DIGSI 5 connection, the data associated with
the previous selection is lost. A confirmation prompt is displayed to confirm
downgrade of the Integrated Ethernet interface (port J) value.
Significant feature You can change the significant feature of the SIPROTEC 5 device using this list
box. For example: The number of ends to be protected is a significant feature
for line protection devices. If the current device does not have any significant
features, the list box will not be active. If you downgrade the significant feature
value, the data associated with previous selection is lost irrecoverably and the
data related to the new selection is created. A confirmation prompt is displayed
to confirm the downgrade of the significant feature value.
Function point class You can change the function-point class of the SIPROTEC 5 device using this list
box.
Measurements
You find more information about the settings in this section in the corresponding Device manual.
Energy restore interval You can select a time value in minutes for the energy restore interval with this
list box. The energy restore interval is the time period that expires until a
metered value is made available once again at the communication interfaces of
a SIPROTEC 5 device.
By setting a value greater than zero for the energy restore interval, you disable
the value selected for the Energy restore time from the list box.
To change the energy restore interval, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alter-
natively, you can enter a value in the text box of the list box.
Energy restore time You can select a value for the energy restore time with this list box. The energy
restore time is the point in time at which a metered value is made available once
again at the communication interfaces of a SIPROTEC 5 device. The energy
restore time is a time value based in hours, for example, on the dot each hour
or every half hour.
By selecting a specific value for the energy restore time, you reset the Energy
restore interval value set with the list box.
Energy restore Select the value that needs to be transmitted with this list box.
You can select between the following options:
• Latest Value
The current energy value is transferred.
• Delta Value
The difference in value between the current energy value and the energy
value of the last transmit operation is transmitted.
Energy restore time by By marking this check box, the cyclic restoring after the set time of the param-
A.time eter Energy restore interval is synchronized with the system time as well.
Example: Energy restore interval = 30 min; current system time: 12:10 o'clock.
First restore: 12:30 o'clock; next restore: 13:00 o'clock etc.
If this parameter is activated, the following setting values are possible for the
parameter Energy restore interval:
• 1 min
• 2 min
• 3 min
• 4 min
• 5 min
• 6 min
• 10 min
• 12 min
• 15 min
• 20 min
• 30 min
• 60 min
Control
You find more information about the settings in this section in the corresponding Device manual.
Enable sw. auth. station By marking this check box, you activate the switching authority of the station.
Multiple sw. auth. levels By marking this check box, the remote switching authority in the SIPROTEC 5
device permits switching commands from multiple command sources.
Specific sw. authorities By marking this check box, an individual specific switching authority for this
switching device is configured and additional parameters are displayed. This
function is based on extending the switching-authority check by verifying the
identifier of the command source (field Originator/orIdent of the switching
command).
Spontan.indic.
Fault-display With this list box, you can set the value for the Fault-display parameter. You
can select the options with pickup or with trip. These parameters affect the
functionality of LED routing NT.
For additional information, refer to 11.4.4 Routing to LEDs.
CFC
CFC chart quality handling With the CFC chart quality handling parameter, you can control whether you
want to influence the quality of the CFC charts in a manual or automatic
(default setting) manner.
If you select the option automatic, the quality processing of the CFC charts is
influenced from the quality of the input signals and the device mode. For addi-
tional information, refer to the corresponding Device manual.
If you select the option manual, the CFC chart quality is always valid, regardless
of the quality of the individual signals. The attribute Test is set for CFC chart
quality only if the device is in test mode.
Test support
Test support With the Test support, indications issued via communication interfaces are
labeled with an additional test bit, if this is supported by the protocol. With this
test bit, you can determine that an indication is generated as a test and that all
or individual functions of the device are in the test mode. In this way, the reac-
tions that are necessary in normal operation due to an indication can be
suppressed in other devices that receive these indications. You can also permit,
for example, a trip command to close an energized binary output for test
purposes. Siemens recommends deactivating the Test support again after the
test phase.
You can select between the following options under the Test support group:
• Activate device test mode: With the Activate device test mode param-
eter, you can activate the test mode that adds a test bit to the issued indi-
cations.
• Oper. bin.outputs under test: With the Oper. bin.outputs under test
parameter, you can allow the closing of a binary output for test purposes.
Localization
Unit system With this list box, you change the unit system individually for the SIPROTEC 5
device. You can select between the SI units and US units.
Related Topics
8.2.3.3 Selecting between Secondary Values, Primary Values, or Percentage Values
8.2.1.2 Changing the Number of Settings Groups
8.2.1.3 Activating a Settings Group
8.2.1.4 Copying a Settings Group
8.3.2 Parameterizing and Activating Chatter Blocking
The Time settings include settings for time synchronization and the time format. The various settings are
displayed like the function parameters in the 22.1.9 Settings Editor. You can change the time settings only for
the offline configuration of a SIPROTEC 5 device. You can only check the time settings when you display them
for an online device.
General
Date format This list box is used to select a time format. You can influence the visualization of the
time indication in this way.
You can select one of the following time formats:
• YYYY:MM:DD
• YYYY:DD:MM
• DD:MM:YYYY
Here D stands for the day, M for the month, and Y for the year.
Timer
Time source 1/2 These list boxes are used to select 14.6.2 Time Sources for the time synchronization.
You can select up to 2 different time sources. The entries in the list boxes depend on
which interfaces and communication protocols you have configured for the SIPROTEC
5 device.
For applications with PMU and differential protection, IRIG-B must be used the time
source.
The following rules apply when selecting a 2nd time source:
• If you opt for the 1st time source for a device-internal time synchronization
(None setting), you cannot select an additional 2nd time source.
• You cannot connect 2 different time sources to one and the same port.
• You cannot define one and the same time source as the 1st and 2nd time source
at the same time.
Sync. latency of time These list boxes are used to correct the latency of the associated external time source.
src 1/2 You can set the correction value with an accuracy of 1 µs.
To change the correction value, click the arrow keys of the list box. Alternatively, you
can enter a value in the entry field of the list box.
Time zone time This list box is used to select the time zones for the time sources. You can select
source 1/2 between local time (local) and universal time coordinated (UTC).
Fault indication after This list box is used to set a supervision time in seconds. This supervision time defines
the maximum permissible time interval between 2 synchronization time points. If 2
synchronization time points do not follow in succession within the set time period,
the SIPROTEC 5 device will issue a failure indication.
Switch daylight sav. If you mark this check box, you activate further setting options for the daylight saving
time time. You can then define your own daylight-saving time period. For this, define the
beginning and end of the time period in the way shown in the following 2 examples.
Start of daylight saving time: <Second> <Tuesday> in <April> at <2:15> hours
End of daylight saving time: <Last> <Thursday> in <October> at <1:45> hours
The Offset daylight sav. time list box is used to set the offset of the daylight saving
time defined by you to Greenwich Mean Time. To change the correction value, click
on the arrow keys of the list box. In this case, the increment is 15 minutes. Alterna-
tively, you can enter a value in the entry field of the list box. In this case, the permis-
sible increment is 1 minute.
The check box is only active if you have selected the Manually set daylight saving
time option.
Pulse per second This list box is used to set the sync latency PPS time of port G. By default, the value is
(Port G) set to 0.00 µs.
The time offset is based on Greenwich Mean Time (GMT).
Range of values: 0.00 µs to 40 000.00 µs with a step size of 0.01 µs
Note: This field is enabled for devices with port G.
Related Topics
14.6.1 Overview of Time Synchronization
14.6.2 Time Sources
14.6.3 Processing Time Settings
22.5.12 Settings
The Settings area consists of multiple groups with settings options for DIGSI 5.
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
6.1.9 Opening Device Information
19.2.2 Determining the Scope of Printing
22.5.13 General
You can configure DIGSI 5 with the settings in this group. The settings are applicable to all projects.
Element Explanation
General Settings
User interface language With this list box you select a language for the user interface of DIGSI 5. The
designations of all user-interface elements and information are then displayed in
the language selected.
The user interface of DIGSI 5 is immediately updated after changing the
language. It is not necessary to restart DIGSI 5.
Mnemonic This list box is not required for working with DIGSI 5.
In general, this setting has an impact on the string representation of addresses of
the scopes S71200, S7300400, and S7200. There are 2 different mnemonics
named German and International. They differ in the set of characters used to
represent the address range:
German International
E I
A Q
M
T
Z C
DB
PE PI
PA PQ
For example, input addresses for both representations %EW42 and %IW42 are
equivalent, which indicates that they point to exactly the same bits in the address
space of plc. When parsing an entered address string, both mnemonics are
accepted. The address string shown at the user interface (provided by the prop-
erty adaptor LogicalAddress of the Tag Service) always conforms to the
current mnemonic setting. The string attribute
ITagAddress.LogicalAddress also contains the address string according to
the mnemonic setting that was effective when the address has been set.
Show list of recently used The names of the projects last used can be displayed in the Project menu. With
projects this list box you set how many of the projects last used are displayed in the
project list of the 22.6.3 Open Project dialog.
Load most recent project If you mark this check box, the window settings last used are restored when
during startup starting DIGSI 5.
Tooltips
Show truncated texts If you mark this check box, the truncated texts are displayed.
completely
Show tooltips (context- If you mark this check box, the tooltips are displayed.
sensitive help is available)
Open cascade automati- If you mark this check box, tooltips open automatically and show further informa-
cally in tooltips tion after a few seconds. If the check box is not marked, click the tooltip to
receive additional information.
Reset to default
All application settings Click the Reset to default button for this option to reset the application settings
to the default value.
Editor layouts Click the Reset to default button for this option to reset the layout of the editors
to the default state.
Show all message Click the Reset to default button for this option to reset the display of all
windows message windows to the default state.
Storage settings
Recently used storage If you select this option, projects and libraries are always be saved in the memory
location location that was used the last time. Memory locations entered in the text boxes
are ignored.
Specify default setting for If you select this option, you can enter memory locations for projects and libraries
storage location in the 2 text boxes.
Storage location for proj- Enter a valid memory location for projects in this entry field. This entry field is
ects active only if you have selected the Specify default setting for storage location
option.
Storage location for libra- Enter a valid memory location for libraries in this entry field. This entry field is
ries active only if you have selected the Specify default setting for storage location
option.
Browse This button is used to open the Search folder dialog. This dialog can be used to
find an existing memory location or create a new folder.
Data exchange
Storage location for data Enter a valid memory location for storing imported data in this entry field.
import
Storage location for data Enter a valid memory location for storing exported data in this entry field.
export
Storage location for Enter a valid memory location for storing the support packages in this entry field.
support packages
Storage location for log Enter a valid memory location for storing the log files in this entry field.
files
Browse This button is used to open the Search folder dialog. This dialog can be used to
find an existing memory location or create a new folder.
Related Topics
2.2.2 Selecting the User Interface Language
2.2.3 Defining Start Settings
2.2.4 Defining Storage Locations
2.2.5 Defining Storage Locations for Data Exchange
You can use this group to specify your user name and the default settings used for symbols and units. The
settings are applicable to all projects.
Standard for symbols You can select a default display with this list box. All graphical elements, for example
for the single-line configuration or the display pages, can be displayed in compliance
with either the ANSI or IEC standard.
If you change the standard, graphical elements added in the single-line configuration
will also be updated. However, graphical elements on display pages are not updated.
The standard selected during creation applies here.
Standard unit system You can select a default for the unit system with this list box. You can select between
the SI units and US units as the default. A SIPROTEC 5 device newly added to the
project takes over the selected unit system.
Connection type In this list box, you can select the connection type between DIGSI 5 and the SIPROTEC
5 device. The following options can be selected:
• Direct/LAN
• Remote
When you open DIGSI 5 for the first time, the option Direct/LAN is displayed as
default Connection type. You can change the connection type. When you reopen
DIGSI, the connection type that was set before closing DIGSI is displayed as the
current connection type.
Related Topics
3.3.4 Displaying Elements According to ANSI or IEC
Related Topics
19.2.2 Determining the Scope of Printing
19.2.3 Selecting Print Options
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
The Device comparison view displays the differences between the settings of the compared devices.
Related Topics
8.2.5 Comparing Parameters of Different Devices
With the firmware selection you will select new firmware versions for individual components. You can load
these into one or more SIPROTEC 5 devices.
Related Topics
17.7.1 Overview for Updating Firmware and Protocols
17.7.3 Opening Firmware and Communication-Module Selection and Adjusting the View
With the configuration selection you will select the offline configurations in a project that will be loaded into
the assigned SIPROTEC 5 devices. Thereafter, start loading the offline configurations.
Related Topics
17.2.1 Overview for Transmitting Configurations
17.2.2 Loading the Offline Configuration into the SIPROTEC 5 Device
With this Editor, you can upgrade the device-configuration version of multiple devices in the project at once.
Related Topics
22.7.25 Toolbar Editor Upgrade Project Devices
2.2.8 Managing Device Drivers
22.5.20 Info
The Info tab displays messages with which you can monitor states, sequences and results of actions. The
messages are divided thematically into 5 further tabs.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
22.5.21 General
The General tab displays status messages, warnings, and error messages on currently executed actions. You
can manually copy and delete the messages in this tab.
Each message is displayed with additional information that is divided into several columns.
You find more information about the icons under 4.4 Icons in the Info Tab.
Message This column contains the message text. A message text identified with an arrow pools
several subordinate messages. By clicking the arrow, you show or hide the subordi-
nate messages.
Date This column contains the date at the time of the action.
Time This column contains the time-of-day at the time of the action.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
4.6 Copying and Deleting Messages
22.5.20 Info tab
22.5.22 Compile
If you manually start the compiling of function charts (CFC) of a SIPROTEC 5 device, all function charts are
checked for consistency during the compiling. The Compile tab displays status messages, warnings, and error
messages pertaining to the compilation.
You can manually copy and delete the messages in this tab. A newly started compilation automatically deletes
all existing messages.
All messages belonging to an offline configuration are pooled in one group. The group is identified with the
name of the offline configuration and an arrow. By clicking the arrow, you show or hide the messages. Each
message is displayed with additional information that is divided into several columns.
You find more information about the icons under 4.4 Icons in the Info Tab.
Path This column contains the name of an offline configuration.
Description This column contains the message text.
Errors This column contains the number of errors.
Warnings This column contains the number of warnings.
Time This column contains the time-of-day at the time of the action.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
4.6 Copying and Deleting Messages
22.5.20 Info
22.5.23 Inconsistencies
The Inconsistencies tab displays messages pertaining to inconsistencies in an offline configuration. All
messages belonging to an offline configuration are pooled in one group. The group is identified with the icon
, the name of the offline configuration, and an arrow. By clicking the arrow, you show or hide the
messages.
You cannot directly delete messages pertaining to inconsistencies. When you eliminate an inconsistency, the
associated message is also deleted.
Each message is displayed with additional information that is divided into several columns.
Related Topics
4.1 Overview on the DIGSI 5 Information System
4.6 Copying and Deleting Messages
22.5.20 Info
22.6 Dialogs
22.6.1 No License
Related Topics
2.2.1 Starting DIGSI 5
2.2.10 Using DIGSI 5 Licenses
Create This button is used to accept the settings and close the dialog. A new project is
created.
Cancel This button is used to reject the settings and close the dialog.
Related Topics
5.1.1 Overview of Projects
5.1.2 Creating a Project
Related Topics
5.1.1 Overview of Projects
5.1.3 Opening a Project
Related Topics
5.1.1 Overview of Projects
5.1.8 Deleting a Project
This dialog is used to add a new offline configuration for a SIPROTEC 5 device to the project.
Select function-point You can use this list box to select the function-point class of the SIPROTEC 5 device.
class
Step 3: Select Application Template
You can carry out this step only if you have selected the device type and the device characteristics.
Application-template Standard: This tab displays the standard application templates. Select the application
selection template you wish to use as a basis for your configuration from this list box.
• Application templates of all versions are displayed in the list view for a CP200
device only if you created the device with the DDDs version older than V7.80.
• Application templates starting from V6.00 and higher are displayed in the list
view for a CP300 device.
User-defined: This tab displays the user-defined application templates.
Related Topics
6.1.1 Overview of SIPROTEC 5 Devices
6.1.4 Adding and Manually Configuring a SIPROTEC 5 Device
6.1.3 Adding a SIPROTEC 5 Device and Specifying with Product Code
The Compare devices dialog displays the options to select the device and settings for comparison.
Element Explanation
Selected device Displays the device name of the selected device for comparison.
Compare with Displays the following options:
• Offline device: You can select this option to view the offline devices available
for comparison.
• Online device: You can select this option to view the online devices available for
comparison.
Content of compar- Displays the following check box options for selecting the parameters for comparison:
ison
• All
• Settings
• Protocols
• CFC
• Information routing
• IEC 61850 structure
• Device information
• Safety and security
• Measuring-points routing
• Function-group connections
You can select the desired option for comparison and view the differences in the
22.5.16 Device Comparison.
Related Topics
8.2.5 Comparing Parameters of Different Devices
22.5.16 Device Comparison
You can use this dialog to add an offline configuration to a new function chart (CFC).
Select function chart This list box is used to change the task level currently set. The task level decides if a
(CFC) task function will be executed cyclically or event-triggered. With the selection of a task
level, you therefore also determine the priority in the processing of the function chart
(CFC).
You can select between the following task levels:
Related Topics
12.1.1.1 Meaning of CFC
12.1.1.2 Function Chart
12.1.2.1 Adding a CFC
22.6.9 Export
This dialog is used to export the data of an individual offline configuration or an entire project.
Comment You can enter a comment in this text box. This comment is displayed before the data
is imported. Describe the content of the exported data in this comment, so that you
can find the correct information again when importing.
This text box is available for the following data formats.
• TEA-X
• DSP5
• SEQ5
• DEX5
• ICD
• IID
• RIO
• IID
• DIGT103
• DIGT104
• DIGMOD
• DIGDNP
• SIM
• UAT
Export contents If you click this information, additional interface elements will be displayed. The type
of interface elements displayed depends on the data format selected.
The information Export contents is available for the following data formats:
• TEA-X
• DSP5
• SEQ5
• RIO
• ICD
• IID
• MICS
• SIM
• UAT
Edition to export: For ICD, IID, and MICS, you can select the edition to export by
selecting the following SCL schemas:
• SCL_2003
• SCL_2007B
• SCL_2007B4
Devices to export The check boxes in this area are used to define the offline configurations that are
exported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected one of the data formats TEA-X, ICD, IID, or MICS
• You have clicked the information Export contents so that the additional inter-
face elements are displayed.
The area shows the names of the offline configurations that can be exported:
• If you select one of the data formats, TEA-X, ICD, IID, or MICS and you wish to
export a project, those are the names of all the offline configurations within the
project.
• If you select the TEA-X data format and you wish to export a single offline
configuration, this is the name of the offline configuration that you have marked
in the project tree.
One check box is assigned to each name of an offline configuration. This check box
can be used to select or clear offline configurations for export. All offline configura-
tions are selected after opening the export dialog. Use the Select all check box to
select or clear all offline configurations at once.
IEC 61850 device The options in this area are used to set whether an international character set or a
description restricted character set is to be used for the IEC 61850 device description. If you select
the international character set, the description texts are exported in the set editing
language. If you select a restricted character set, the description texts are always
exported in the English language. If you select a setting, regardless of whether the
receiver or export file, for example an automation system, an international character
set or only a restricted character set can be interpreted. As standard, the international
character set is selected.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected one of the data formats SCD, SED, ICD, IID, or MICS
• You have clicked the information Export content so that the additional interface
elements are displayed.
Display pages to The check boxes in this area are used to define the display pages of an offline configu-
export rations that are exported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
Enter RIO export You can use the entry fields in this area to set parameters for the RIO export. All
settings settings are set to 0 as default.
You can set the following settings:
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.2.1 Preparing and Starting the Export
18.2.2 Configuring the TEA-X Export
18.2.3 Configuring the DSP5 Export
18.2.8 Configuring the SEQ5 Export
18.2.4 Configuring the RIO Export
18.2.5 Configuring the ICD Export
18.2.6 Configuring the IID Export
18.2.7 Configuring the MICS Export
22.6.10 Import
This dialog is used to import data from a file in an offline configuration or a project.
Element Explanation
File This text box contains the name of the import file current selected. The file name is
displayed along with the file path. If you wish to select another file, click the ...
button.
... This button is used to open a file dialog. You can select another import file with this
dialog.
Date This field contains the date on which the data in the selected file was exported.
Comment This field contains a comment included in the import file.
Contains This field contains information on the integral data categories, for example, Func-
tion setting or Routing settings.
Destination This field contains the destination of the import, that is, the name of the project or
an offline configuration.
Import contents If you click this information, additional interface elements will be displayed. The
type of interface elements displayed depends on the data format of the file
selected.
The information Import contents is available for the following data formats:
• TEA-X
• SCD
• DEX5
• DIGSI 4-CFC (ST)
• ICD
• IID
• ASC
• UAT
Subsets to import The check boxes in this area are used to define which data categories are imported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
Devices to import The check boxes in this area are used to define which SIPROTEC 5 devices are
imported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected a file with one of the data formats (for example, SCD).
• You have clicked the information Import contents so that the additional inter-
face elements are displayed.
The area shows the names of the offline configurations that can be imported:
• If you have selected a file with the respective data format and wish to import a
project, this is the name for all offline configurations within the project.
• If you have selected a file with the respective data format and wish to import a
single offline configuration, this is the name of the offline configuration
marked in the project tree.
One check box is assigned to each name of an offline configuration. You can use
this to select or clear an offline configurations for import. All offline configurations
are selected after opening the import dialog. Use the Select all check box to select
or clear all offline configurations at once.
Action These options are used to select how the device data is processed during importing.
Device data in an import file can either be saved as a new offline configuration in
the project or imported into an existing offline configuration in the project. The
option Create as new device(s) is selected as the default. A selected option is
always valid for all offline configurations. If you wish to import data into an indi-
vidual offline configuration, the option Update matching device(s) is preselected.
If you wish to import the data of an individual offline configuration into a project,
the option Create as new device(s) is preselected.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected a file with one of the data formats DEX 5, or SCD.
• You have selected the information Import contents so that the additional
interface elements are displayed.
Importing primary If you activate this check box, the data from the primary topology will be imported.
topology In this case, the existing topology will be overwritten. A precondition for this is that
the import file must contain primary topological data.
The check box is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected a file with one of the data formats SCD or DEX5.
• You have clicked the information Export content so that the additional inter-
face elements are displayed.
• The import file contains primary topological data.
Display pages to import The check boxes in this area are used to define the display pages of an offline
configuration that is imported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
Test sequences to The check boxes in this area are used to define the test sequences of an offline
import configuration that is imported.
This area is displayed under the following conditions:
• You have selected a file with the data format DIGSI 4-CFC (ST).
• You have clicked the information Import contents so that the additional inter-
face elements are displayed.
A check box is assigned to each function chart. This check box can be used to select
or deselect function charts for import. All function charts are selected after opening
the Importing dialog. Use the Select all check box to select or deselect all function
charts at once.
Importing UAT With the Apply settings from user-defined application template dialog, you can
select the import options (Create missing objects / Delete objects not existing in
UAT) and the function-group mapping (respective source for example, UAT), func-
tion-groups to import to respective target (for example, the project-device function
groups).
If the selected device has no matching function groups, the import dialog does not
open. Instead, an error message is displayed.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
This dialog is used to apply certain function-group data (setting values, child structure, custom texts) from the
user-defined application templates to the matching function groups in devices in the project.
Element Explanation
Delete objects not existing in UAT If you select this check box, the child objects in the target that do
not exist in the source are deleted from the target during import.
Map all function groups With this button, you can map all available FGs at once.
All cells between matching source and target FGs (instead of source
and target FGs of the same type and name) are marked with an X
indicating that these FGs are mapped and are a part of the import
action. A source FG can be mapped to multiple target FGs, a target
FG can only be mapped to one source FG. Only FGs of identical
types can be mapped. If the source and target type are different,
the cell is read-only. Thus, a row can only contain one X, a column
may contain several. The superordinate cell (device row) also is
marked as mapped (*). All rows are expanded. If a target device
contains several FGs of the same type (and therefore several non-
read-only cells in a row), your selection is kept. Otherwise, the
target FG of the same name is mapped. Source and target FGs are
considered matching when they are of the same DCF type; the
automatic mapping, however, only maps pairs with identical
(display) names (Pairs of identical DCF type but with different name
can be mapped manually, but are not mapped automatically via the
map-all function).
Unmap all function groups With this button, you can remove all mappings of all available FGs
at once. All cells become empty. During import, none of the target
FGs are considered.
Target FGs This column displays the target FGs for the respective target device
or devices.
With the context menu, you can also map or unmap all function
groups.
If you select the option Map all function groups from the context
menu, all suitable target FGs under the selected device are marked
with an X. Suitable here means that source and target FGs are of
same type and name. Mappings previously set by you are kept.
Subordinate rows of the selected device are expanded. Cells in the
device row are also marked as mapped (*) if the corresponding
target FG is mapped.
Each device node in the tree (first column of the grid) can be
selected. If you select the option Unmap all function groups from
the context menu, all mappings of the selected device are removed.
All the cells become empty.
Element Explanation
Source FGs This column displays the source FGs with the respective mappings
for the respective target device.
With the context menu, you can also map or unmap all function
groups.
If you select the context menu Map, the cell is marked with an X.
The corresponding cell in the superordinate (device) row is marked
with *. Also, X can be inserted in each editable cell (only 1 per
row). The corresponding cell in the superordinate (device) row is
also marked with *.
If you select the context menu Unmap, the cell becomes empty.
The corresponding cell in the superordinate (device) row becomes
empty (if no other target FGs are mapped). Also, X can be deleted
from the cell. The corresponding cell in the superordinate (device)
row becomes empty as well (if no other target FGs are mapped).
If any invalid text is inserted in the editable cell, an error message is
displayed and the cell keeps its old value (mapped or unmapped).
The bays are not really relevant for the import. They are just a
container for the FGs. Thus, some FGs are contained under Bays,
some directly under the Application. For FGs under Bays, the addi-
tional parent layer is visible in the dialog.
The Import dialog displays the following:
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats
18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
This dialog is used to import device drivers for DIGSI 5. Device drivers are required to add offline configura-
tions of SIPROTEC 5 devices of a certain type to a project or establish an online connection to a certain device
type. The device drivers imported are available for all projects.
... This button is used to open a standard file dialog. You can select another driver file
with this dialog. You can also select several driver files, whose contents are then avail-
able for simultaneous import.
Device-driver versions This list box contains the device-driver versions available for import. These are struc-
tured in a hierarchical manner. The scope of the display depends on the selection in
the Filter area. As with the project tree, you can navigate through the structure and
show or hide individual levels.
A check box is located to the left of each entry. If you mark this check box, you thus
select the associated device drivers or all device drivers belonging to a level for
import. You can only select device drivers that are not yet imported. Symbols to the
right of the entries indicate that a device driver is already imported.
Filter This area contains 2 check boxes which you can use to filter the display in the Device-
driver versions field.
The following filter options are available:
Related Topics
2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers
22.6.13 Preview
This dialog is used to check your selection of the device drivers to be installed and start the import.
Related Topics
2.2.7 Importing Device Drivers
Related Topics
8.2.3.6 Adding or Deleting a Function Block
Related Topics
9.5.1 Adding a User-Defined Signal to the Application
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.3 Changing the Confirmation ID
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.4 Changing the Connection Password
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.8 Entering a Confirmation ID
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.7 Entering a Connection Password
You can use this dialog to generate a new connection password and to activate the same.
Related Topics
17.8.1 Overview of Confirmation IDs and Connection Password
17.8.6 Activating and Deactivating a Connection Password
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.7.1 Opening a Template
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.1.7.2 Adding a Template
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.3.3 Determining the Preview Scope
22.6.24 Print
This dialog is used to select a printer, a document template, and a cover page and then start the printout.
Related Topics
19.1.1 Overview for Designing and Printing Documents
19.2.1 Starting the Printing
This dialog is used to generate a user-defined filter with which you can filter column contents. A filter consists
of one or more expressions linked with logical operators.
Element Explanation
Cell Use this list box to select a condition for an expression in the form condition - value.
You can select from the following conditions:
• Equals
• Does not equal
• Begins with
• Does not begin with
• Ends with
• Does not end with
• Contains
• Does not contain
Value Use this list box to select a value for an expression in the form condition - value. The
values that can be selected correspond to the values that can occur in the column to
be filtered. However, you can also specify other values, for example, digits or letters,
directly in the entry field of the list box.
AND/OR Select one of the logical operators AND and OR with which you wish to combine 2
expressions. If a filter consists only of a single expression, you do not have to select a
logical operator.
Add to filter This button is used to add an expression to the filter. The expression is displayed in
the Filter field. The logical operator currently selected is not included in the 1st
expression. With all further expressions, the logical operator currently selected is also
added and displayed in the Filter field.
Filter expression This field contains the current expression or the current combination of expressions.
Clear filter This button is used to delete all expressions in the Filter field.
OK This button is used to apply the filter created and close the dialog. The display of the
content is updated in relation to the filter you have created. This button does not
become active until you have created and added to the filter at least 1 expression.
Cancel This button is used to reject the filter created and close the dialog.
Related Topics
3.2.5 Creating a User-Defined Filter
3.2.4 Filtering Column Content
This dialog gives you information about the output of various operations, for example, the output of the
import of device drivers or the output of device drivers or the output of loading offline configurations.
Related Topics
3.4 Using the Status Dialog
Note:
You can add multiple current-measuring points at a time depending on the allowed
limit for the respective device and on the existing configuration.
OK This button is used to accept the selection and close the dialog. A current-measuring
point of the selected type is added.
Cancel This button is used to reject the selection and close the dialog.
Related Topics
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
Note:
You can add multiple voltage-measuring points at a time depending on the allowed
limit for the respective device and on the existing configuration.
OK This button is used to accept the selection and close the dialog. A voltage-measuring
point of the selected type is added.
Cancel This button is used to reject the selection and close the dialog.
Related Topics
8.1.4.1 Overview of Connections
8.1.5.5 Adding Measuring Points
With this dialog you change the name of a signal marked in the signal catalog.
Related Topics
9.5.2 Renaming a Signal
22.6.30 Import
This dialog is used to import data from a TEA-X file in an offline configuration or a project.
Element Explanation
Next This button enables you to proceed further to the next dialog.
Cancel This button is used to reject the selection and close the dialog.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats18.3.2 Configuring the TEA-X Import
18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
This dialog is used to import data from a TEA-X file in an offline configuration or a project.
Related Topics
18.1.1 Overview of Formats18.3.2 Configuring the TEA-X Import
18.3.1 Preparing and Starting the Import
22.7 Toolbars
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the DIGSI 5.
Element Explanation
This button is used to open the 22.6.2 Create a New Project dialog. This dialog is used to
define key data for a new project.
This button is used to open the 22.6.3 Open Project dialog. With this dialog, you select the
projects last opened.
This button is used to save the opened project. This button is only active if the data has
changed.
This button is used to print project and device data. If in 3.1.2 Project Tree the project name
or an offline configuration is selected, the 22.6.24 Print dialog opens. Otherwise, the
printout starts directly.
This button is used to copy a marked object (element or value) to the clipboard. If you paste
the object at another permissible location, it will be deleted at the current position. This
button only becomes active if at least one suitable object is marked.
This button is used to copy a marked object (element or value) to the clipboard. You can
then paste a copy of the object at another permissible location. The original object is
retained here. This button only becomes active if at least one suitable object is marked.
This button is used to paste the content of the clipboard at another permissible location. This
button only becomes active if the clipboard contains at least one suitable object.
This button is used to delete a marked object (element or value).
This button is used to undo the most recent change and revert back to the previous value.
This button is active only if you modify any values in the 22.1.9 Settings Editor.
This button is used to reverse the change made by the Undo operation. This button is active
only if you perform the Undo operation in the 22.1.9 Settings Editor.
This button is used to open the tab 22.2.1 Tasks. The Tasks tab contains operator elements
for the Search/Replace function.
This button is used to open the 22.6.9 Export dialog. This dialog is used to select a data
format, determine additional format-relevant settings, and start the export. This button is
active only if the name of either the project or a SIPROTEC 5 device is marked in the project
tree.
This button is used to open the Select file for import dialog. This dialog is used to select an
import file and then open the 22.6.10 Import dialog. This button is active only if the name of
the project is marked in the project tree or a offline configuration is marked.
This button is used to start the compilation process for function charts (CFC). This button
only becomes active if one of the following requirements is met:
Element Explanation
This button is used to divide the working area horizontally. This allows you to arrange
2 editors or editing tools below one another. This button only becomes active if exactly 2
editing tools are opened.
This button is used to divide the working area vertically. This allows you to arrange 2 editors
or editing tools next to one another. This button only becomes active if exactly 2 editing
tools are opened.
This button is used to start the consistency check. This button is active only if the name of
the project or an element is marked in the project tree.
Related Topics
3.1.1 DIGSI 5 User Interface
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Single-line editor.
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the display of the single-line configuration.
This button is not active if you can no longer zoom out the display.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the display of the single-line configuration. This
button is not active if you can no longer zoom in the display.
This list box is used to scale the display in percent. For this, open the list box and select a
specified percentage value or a definite final state. Alternatively, enter an integral
percentage value between 50 and 500 in the entry field of the list box. If you click outside
the list box with the mouse or press the <Enter> key the display will be updated.
This button is used to rotate an element marked in the single-line configuration by 90º clock-
wise. This button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked. You cannot rotate any
device symbols or busbars.
This button is used to rotate an element marked in the single-line configuration by 90º coun-
terclockwise. This button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked. You cannot
rotate any device symbols or busbars.
This button is used to synchronize the transformer values set in the single-line configuration
with the function settings. This button becomes active only if a device symbol is marked, to
which at least 1 transformer is connected.
This is button is used to generate one or more display pages from one or more bays. This
button becomes active only if either a bay or a device symbol with at least one connected
bay is marked.
This list box is visible only for busbar devices (for example, 7SS device type). This list box
enables you to view the filtered view of the busbar device.
This button is visible only for busbar devices (for example, 7SS device type). This button
enables you to set/reset the filter for device specific view.
This button is visible only for busbar devices (for example, 7SS device type). This button
enables you to show/hide the measured value.
Related Topics
22.1.2 Single-Line Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Project-texts Editor.
Related Topics
22.1.8 Project Texts Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Network view.
This button is used to show or hide the IP addresses of the individual Ethernet interfaces.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the display of the Network view. This button is
not active if you can no longer zoom in the display.
This button is used to activate the selection tool allowing you to select a definite section for
zooming in. Then drag open a rectangle, holding the mouse button down in the Network
view. The section defined in this way is zoomed in.
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the display of the Network view. This button is
not active if you can no longer zoom out the display.
This list box is used to scale the display in percent. For this, open the list box and select a
specified percentage value or a definite final state. Alternatively, enter an integral
percentage value between 50 and 500 in the entry field of the list box. If you click outside
the list box with the mouse or press the <Enter> key the display will be updated.
Related Topics
22.1.6 Network View
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Device view.
Related Topics
22.1.7 Device View
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Data flow of a function chart (CFC).
• No sheet bars
• Static sheet bars
• Dynamic sheet bars
Changes between single and double numbers of rows in the sheet bar.
Shows or hides the sheet borders (not working if sheet bars are shown).
Element Explanation
Inserts a new subchart in the CFC chart.
Changes to the 22.1.13 Control Flow. The data of a block marked in the Data flow is empha-
sized by a colored area in the Control flow.
Incrementally zooms in the display of the function chart. This button is not active if you can
no longer zoom in the display.
Displays the function chart completely with optimum scaling in the working area.
Activates the selection tool with which you can select a defined section for zooming in. With
the mouse button pressed, form a rectangle in the function chart. The section defined in this
way is zoomed in.
Incrementally zooms out the display of the function chart. This button is not active if you can
no longer zoom out the display.
Scales the display in percent. Therefore, open the list box and select a specified percentage
value. Alternatively, enter an integral percentage value from 10 to 200 in the entry field of
the list box. If you click outside the list box with the mouse or press the <Enter> key, the
display is updated.
Opens the latest offline analysis output.
Deletes all trace points in all the function charts (CFC) created under a device.
Starts the automatic optimization of the order of the blocks in the function chart.
Sorts the objects according to the data flow. Siemens recommends saving the project before
sorting.
Displays the default values assigned for the input signals in the function charts (CFC).
You can view the default values of CFC input signals (for example, Chart name, Terminal,
Signal name, Type, and Default value) by selecting the desired function chart.
Synchronizes the signals between function charts (CFC) and the 22.3.2 Information Routing
Editor. This function is helpful if inconsistency signals are shown in function charts, for
example, after copying a CFC from different device. After instantiating missing functions or
user-defined signals in the device with pressing this button, this function searches for the
matching signals in the 22.3.2 Information Routing Editor and resolves the inconsistency of
the signal in CFC.
Locks the function charts (CFC) to set them to read-only. A dialog opens to enter a password.
If the chart is write-protected, a dialog opens to enter the password. If the password is
correct, the function chart is unlocked and enabled for writing. If you click the lock button
once again after unlocking, the same password will be used without opening the password
dialog.
This button enables you to create an interface for a selected CFC block terminal in the
22.1.11 Function-Chart (CFC) Editor.
Related Topics
22.1.12 Data Flow
12.4 Analyzing Function Charts (CFC)
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Control flow.
This button is used to show or hide the elements of a module in the list of the Control flow.
This button is used to change to the 22.1.12 Data Flow . A block previously marked in the
Control Flow is emphasized by a colored area in the Data flow.
Related Topics
22.1.13 Control Flow
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Display editor and in the Symbol editor.
This button is used to show or hide the grid on the display page.
This button is used to activate the tool for adding a dynamic field.
This button is used to rotate a marked element clockwise. The rotation is 90º in the Display
editor. This button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked.
This button is used to rotate a marked element counterclockwise. The rotation is 90º in the
Display editor. This button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked.
This button is used to activate the tool for drawing lines.
Symbol Editor
This button is used to rotate a marked element clockwise. The rotation is 90º on selecting all
the elements in a state. The rotation is 22.5º on selecting a single element in a state. This
button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked.
This button is used to rotate a marked element counterclockwise. The rotation is 90º on
selecting all the elements in a state. The rotation is 22.5º on selecting a single element in a
state. This button becomes active only if exactly 1 element is marked.
This button is used to activate the tool for selecting elements.
This button is used to activate the tool for adding connecting points. You can connect the
elements in the display page to lines via connecting points.
This button is used to activate the tool for free-hand drawing.
Element Explanation
This button is used to activate the tool for drawing rectangles.
This button is used to activate the tool for drawing elliptical curves.
This list box gives you access to curves in 4 defined alignments. Open the list box and select
one of the 4 curves. This lets you activate the tool for adding the selected curve. The associ-
ated symbol is adopted in the toolbar.
This list box gives you access to triangles in 4 defined alignments. Open the list box and
select one of the 4 triangles. This lets you activate the tool for adding the selected triangle.
The associated symbol is adopted in the toolbar.
This list box gives you access to semicircles in 4 defined alignments. Open the list box and
select one of the 4 semicircles. This lets you activate the tool for adding the selected semi-
circle. The associated symbol is adopted in the toolbar.
This button is used to activate the tool for adding or removing a filling for a closed element,
for example a circle.
This button is used to activate the text entry tool.
This list box is used to change the size of the text elements. It is enabled only if you add a
text element in the Symbol editor and select the text box.
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the drawing area. This button is not active if
you can no longer zoom out the display.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the drawing area. This button is not active if
you can no longer zoom in the display.
Related Topics
22.1.14 Display Editor
22.1.16 Symbol Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor Fault-display configuration.
Related Topics
22.1.17 Fault-Display Configuration Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor Test sequences.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which all states of a test sequence need to be saved. You can select
between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click on Save, the data is saved in the format
selected.
This button is used to accept the final values of the previous state as the initial values for the
state selected currently. This button is not active if you have selected the 1st state.
Related Topics
22.1.22 Test-Sequences Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor IEC 61850 structure.
This button is used to hide all elements in the IEC 61850 interface.
This button is used to show all settings in the IEC 61850 interface. If you select this option,
the settings will be included in the IID export file which is used for data exchange with the
IEC 61850 System Configurator with some exceptions.
This button is used to hide all settings in the IEC 61850 interface. If you select this option,
the settings will be excluded from the IID export file which is used for data exchange with
the IEC 61850 System Configurator with some exceptions.
This button is used to show all SIPROTEC extensions in the IEC 61850 interface. If you select
this option, Siemens-internal data objects and logical-node information will be included in
the IID export file which is used for data exchange with the IEC 61850 System Configurator
with some exceptions.
Element Explanation
This button is used to hide all SIPROTEC extensions in the IEC 61850 interface. If you select
this option, Siemens-internal data objects and logical-node information will be excluded in
the IID export file which is used for data exchange with the IEC 61850 System Configurator
with some exceptions.
This list box is used to switch between the SIPROTEC 5 view and that similar to the
SIPROTEC 4 view. The selection of a different view has an impact on all areas in DIGSI 5 in
which the IEC 61850 objects are displayed.
Related Topics
22.1.21 IEC 61850 Structure Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Settings/Favorite Settings editor.
This button is used to copy the settings of the selected comparison settings group to the
parameters group selected for editing a marked function block. This button is active only if a
comparison parameters group is selected.
This button can be used to show or hide the settings numbers.
Related Topics
22.1.9 Settings Editor
22.1.10 Favorite Settings Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Graphics window of the Settings editor.
Element Explanation
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the display of the Diagram window. This
button is not active if you can no longer zoom out the display.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the display of the Diagram window. This button
is not active if you can no longer zoom in the display.
This list box is used to scale the display in percent. For this, open the list box and select a
specified percentage value or a definite final state. Alternatively, enter an integral
percentage value between 60 and 200 in the entry field of the list box. If you click outside
the list box with the mouse or press the <Enter> key the display will be updated.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which the graphic displayed needs to be saved. You can select
between the BMP and JPG formats. If you click on Save, the graphic is saved in the format
selected.
This button is used to copy the displayed graphic to the clipboard.
This button is used to open the 22.6.23 Print Preview dialog. This dialog is used to select a
document template and a cover page and finally start the print operation.
This button can be used to show or hide the grid in the Graphics window.
Related Topics
22.1.9 Settings Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor Operations Safety and Access Control.
Related Topics
20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for wiring.
Related Topics
22.1.23 Test Editor for Wiring
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for communication modules.
Related Topics
22.1.24 Test Editor for Communication Modules
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for analog inputs.
Related Topics
22.1.25 Test Editor for Analog Inputs
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for control functions.
Related Topics
22.1.28 Test Editor for Protection Functions
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for circuit breaker.
Related Topics
22.1.27 Test Editor for Circuit Breakers
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for protection functions.
This button can be used to show or hide the grid in the Diagram window.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the display of the Diagram window. This button
is not active if you can no longer zoom in the display.
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the display of the Diagram window. This
button is not active if you can no longer zoom out the display.
This list box is used to scale the display in percent. For this, open the list box and select a
specified percentage value or a definite final state. Alternatively, enter an integral
percentage value between 60 and 200 in the entry field of the list box. If you click outside
the list box with the mouse or press the <Enter> key the display will be updated.
Create snap- This button is used to create snapshot of currently shown indications in the assigned offline
shot configuration.
Clear list This button is used to clear the list of received spontaneous indications.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which the test settings and results needs to be saved. You can select
between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click on Save, the data is saved in the format
selected.
Related Topics
22.1.28 Test Editor for Protection Functions
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Test editor for communication protocols.
Related Topics
22.1.29 Test Editor for Communication Protocols
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Document editor.
This button is used to activate the hand tool. This tool is used to move the template vertically
and horizontally in the working area.
This button is used to incrementally zoom in the display of the template. This button is not
active if you can no longer zoom in the display.
This button is used to incrementally zoom out the display of the template. This button is not
active if you can no longer zoom out the display.
This button is used to activate the selection tool allowing you to select a definite section for
zooming in. Then drag open a rectangle, holding the mouse button down in the template.
The section defined in this way is zoomed in.
This button is used to activate the tool allowing you to dynamically scale the template. Then
keep the mouse button pressed. If you move the mouse away from you the template will be
zoomed in. If you move the mouse towards you the template will be zoomed out.
This list box is used to scale the display in percent. For this, open the list box and select a
specified percentage value or a definite final state. Alternatively, enter an integral
percentage value between 10 and 800 in the entry field of the list box. If you click outside
the bay with the mouse or press the <Enter> key the display will be updated.
Related Topics
22.1.18 Document Information Editor
This toolbar gives you fast access to the actions and settings in the configuration selection.
Element Explanation
Shows all the rows. All the levels of the component hierarchy are displayed. This button is
not active if all rows are shown.
Hides all the rows. Only the uppermost level of the component hierarchy is displayed. This
level corresponds to the names of the offline configurations. This button is not active if all
rows are hidden.
Selects all the offline configurations in the list. This button is not active if all offline configu-
rations are selected.
Deselects all the offline configurations in the list. This button is not active if no offline
configuration is selected.
Starts updating the device settings. All offline configurations selected in the list are trans-
mitted to the SIPROTEC 5 devices assigned. This button is active only if at least 1 component
is selected.
Exports the data to a spreadsheet.
Related Topics
22.5.18 Configuration Selection
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the firmware and protocol selection.
Related Topics
22.5.17 Firmware Selection
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor Upgrade Project Devices.
Related Topics
22.5.19 Upgrade Project Devices
2.2.8 Managing Device Drivers
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Device information toolbar.
This button is used to reset all LEDs and binary inputs of a SIPROTEC 5 device. This button is
active only if you have opened the device information for an online device.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which the entries of the 22.5.7 Logs tab need to be saved. You can
select between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click on Save, the data is saved in the
format selected.
This button deletes all log entries of the selected type from the device after loading them
into DIGSI 5.
Related Topics
22.5.4 Device Information
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Hardware catalog.
Element Explanation
In this text box, enter the name of the hardware component you wish to find in the Hard-
ware catalog.
This button is used to start searching for the hardware component whose name you have
entered in the Search text box. The Hardware catalog is searched through from top to
bottom.
This button is used to start searching for the hardware component whose name you have
entered in the Search text box. The Hardware catalog is searched through from bottom to
top.
Related Topics
22.2.4 Hardware Catalog
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Signal catalog.
This button is used to start searching for the signal whose name you have entered in the
Search text box. The Signal catalog is searched through from top to bottom.
This button is used to start searching for the signal whose name you have entered in the
Search text box. The Signal catalog is searched through from bottom to top.
This button is used to open the 22.6.15 Add New Signal dialog. You can add a new signal to
the Signal catalog with this dialog.
Related Topics
22.2.5 Signals
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Logs table.
This button is used to delete all indication logs in the SIPROTEC 5 device.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which the indication logs marked need to be saved. You can select
between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click on Save, the data is saved in the format
selected.
Element Explanation
This button allows you to set a marked indication as a reference for the relative time of the
usual indications. The marked indication then contains the relative time 0 ms. The relative
times of the other indications are calculated from their respective timestamps. If a indication
has a negative time value, then this indication is encountered in time before the reference
indication. If a indication has a positive time value, then this indication is encountered in
time after the reference indication. This button is active only if a indication is marked.
This button can be used to show or hide the Alternative name column.
This list box is used to select one of the display modes primary, secondary, or percent.
Depending on your selection, all values are shown as primary, secondary, or percentages.
Related Topics
22.4.1 Log
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Records table.
This button is used to download the selected records from SIPROTEC 5 device.
This button is used to select all displayed records in the list. This button is not active if all
records are selected.
This button is used to deselect all records in the list. This button is not active if no offline
configuration is selected.
This button is used to generate a test fault record. This button is active only if you have
opened the Records table for an online device.
This button is used to close the currently visible fault record window. The button only
becomes active if a Fault-record window is opened.
This button is used to delete all fault records and fault indications in the SIPROTEC 5 device.
This button is used to delete all fault records and fault indications saved in the offline config-
uration.
This button is used to open the Export fault record dialog. This dialog is used to define a
name and path for a file. If you click Export, a marked fault record is saved in COMTRADE
format in this file. This button is active only if a fault record is marked.
Element Explanation
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path
and format of a file in which the fault records displayed need to be saved. You can select
between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click Save, the data is saved in the format
selected.
With this list box, you can select the COMTRADE version to view the records in the desired
COMTRADE formats:
• COMTRADE 1999
• COMTRADE 2013
The default value of the list box in the Records Editor is the same as the value selected for
the COMTRADE revision year setting in the Fault Recorder Settings Editor. Any change in
the setting value in the Fault Recorder Settings Editor leads to the change in the default
value of the list box.
Note
This option is not available for the 7KE device type.
By default, the list box is disabled and only the COMTRADE format COMTRADE 1999 is
displayed for devices created with the version older than DIGSI 5, version V7.80.
Related Topics
22.4.2 Records
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Measurements table.
Related Topics
22.4.5 Measurements
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Indications table.
Element Explanation
This button is used to generate a snapshot of the spontaneous indications displayed. As a
prerequisite for this, the online device must be assigned to a suitable offline configuration in
an open project.
This button is used to delete all spontaneous indications in the online device.
This button is used to activate or deactivate the auto-scrolling behavior. Activate the auto-
scrolling behavior so that the table entries are automatically shifted down when a new indi-
cation arrives. The new indication is then always visible as the top entry in the list.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path,
and format of a file in which the spontaneous indications displayed need to be saved. You
can select between TXT and CSV formats. If you click Save, the data is saved in the format
selected.
This button allows you to set a marked indication as a reference for the relative time of the
usual indications. The marked indication then contains the relative time 0 ms. The relative
times of the other indications are calculated from their respective time stamps. If an indica-
tion has a negative time value, then this indication is encountered in time before the refer-
ence indication. If an indication has a positive time value, then this indication is encountered
in time after the reference indication. This button only becomes active if an indication is
marked.
Related Topics
22.4.3 Indications
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Indication snapshot table.
Related Topics
22.4.4 Indication Snapshot
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Measured-value snapshot table.
Element Explanation
This list box is used to select one of the display modes primary, secondary, or percent.
Depending on your selection, all values are shown as primary, secondary, or percentages.
Snapshot This button is used to save the snapshot of the current measured values in the assigned
offline configuration.
Reset This button is used to reset all values of the current view.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path,
and format of a file in which the current (instantaneous) measured values displayed need to
be saved. You can select between the TXT and CSV formats. If you click Save, the data is
saved in the format selected.
Related Topics
22.4.6 Measured-Value Snapshot
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Print Preview.
Element Explanation
This button is used to change to the next page of the document. This button is not active if
the last page is displayed.
This button is used to change to the last page of the document. This button is not active if
the last page is displayed.
Related Topics
22.5.2 Print Preview
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Information routing matrix.
This button is used to show the information routing in the reduced column view.
This button can be used to show or hide the Alternative name column.
This button can be used to show or hide the CFC and Display columns.
Element Explanation
You can use this list box to filter the scope of information displayed, sources and destina-
tions with predefined display profiles. You can select from the following display profiles:
• All entries
There is no constraint regarding the display of pieces of information, sources and desti-
nations.
• Tripping
Only signals connected with tripping are displayed. All other information is hidden. This
also applies to complete function groups, if these do not contain at least one signal that
is connected to tripping. All sources and destinations are displayed.
• Measured/ metered values
Only measured and metered values are displayed. All other information is hidden. This
applies also to entire function groups, unless these contain at least one measured or
metered value. Only a limited number of sources and destinations are displayed.
• Device I/O
Only input and output signals of the SIPROTEC 5 device are displayed. All other informa-
tion is hidden. This applies also to entire function groups, unless these contain at least
one input and output signal. Only a limited number of sources and destinations are
displayed.
• Configuration of the menu levels
Only the device menu levels are displayed. All other information is hidden. This also
applies to all function groups. Only the source Function keys are displayed. All other
sources and destinations are hidden.
You can use this list box to filter the scope of the signals displayed with predefined display
profiles. You can select from the following display profiles:
• Routed (*)
• Not routed ()
• Binary I/O routed (*)
• Binary I/O not routed ()
• F-keys routed (*)
• F-keys not routed ()
• LEDs routed (*)
• LEDs not routed ()
This button is used to reset all column filters. The Information routing matrix is displayed in
the standard view.
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path,
and format of a file in which the information routings or communication mappings need to
be saved. You can select desired format (for example, TXT and CSV) and click Save to save
the data in the desired location.
If you select this check box, the alternative names defined for the signals under the Alterna-
tive name column are used in the logs and records instead of the hierarchical names.
Related Topics
22.3.2 Information Routing
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Communication mapping matrix.
You can use this list box to filter the scope of the signals displayed with predefined display
profiles. You can select from the following display profiles:
• All Entries
There is no constraint regarding the display of pieces of information, sources, and desti-
nations.
• Trips
Only signals connected with tripping are displayed. All other information is hidden. This
also applies to complete function groups, if these do not contain at least one signal that
is connected to tripping. All sources and destinations are displayed.
• Measured and Metered Values
Only measured and metered values are displayed. All other information is hidden. This
applies also to entire function groups, unless these contain at least one measured or
metered value.
The following sources are displayed:
– GOOSE
– CFC
The following destinations are displayed:
– Fault records
– Event log buffer
– Menus in the device display
– CFC
– Display
All other sources and destinations are hidden.
• Device I/O
Only input and output signals of the SIPROTEC 5 device are displayed. All other informa-
tion is hidden. This applies also to entire function groups, unless these contain at least
one input and output signal.
The following sources are displayed:
– Binary inputs
– GOOSE
The following destinations are displayed:
– Binary outputs
All other sources and destinations are hidden.
• Configuration of the menu levels
Only the device menu levels are displayed. All other information is hidden. This also
applies to all function groups. Only the source Function keys is displayed. All other
sources and destinations are hidden.
Element Explanation
This button is used to reset all column filters. The Communication mapping matrix is
displayed in the standard view.
You can use this list box to reduce the number of columns displayed specific to the protocol.
Depending on the protocols selected in the offline configuration, the list may contain the
following entries:
• All protocols
• DNP3
• IEC 60870-5-103
• IEC 60870-5-104
• Modbus TCP
• PROFINET IO
• n devices protection-data communication (n = 2 to 6)
This button is used to open the Save as dialog. This dialog is used to define the name, path,
and format of a file in which the information routings or communication mappings need to
be saved. You can select desired format (for example, TXT and CSV) and click Save to save
the data in the desired location.
Related Topics
22.3.1 Communication Mapping
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Function-group connections matrix.
Related Topics
22.3.4 Function-Group Connections
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Measuring-points routing matrix.
Related Topics
22.3.8 Measuring-Points Routing
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Manage device drivers view editor.
This button enables you to download the withdrawn DDD information from the SIPROTEC 5
download area and to update the withdrawn status of the imported DDDs imported in DIGSI
in the 22.1.33 Manage Device Drivers View editor. The text box next to the refresh button
displays the source of the last update.
This button enables you to delete all the imported DDDs.
Related Topics
2.2.8 Managing Device Drivers
22.1.33 Manage Device Drivers View
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Global libraries palette.
Element Explanation
This button is used to create a folder in the user-defined global DIGSI 5 library under the
Types folder and/or Master copies folder. This button is active only if you select the Types
folder and/or the Master copies folder.
This button is also available in the Project library palette.
With this list-box option, you can apply a context-related filter to the display to increase the
clarity of extensive libraries.
You can select the following options using this list box:
• Documentation
• All
• Devices & networks
• Context-driven filtering
This button is also available in the Project library palette.
Related Topics
3.3.1 Overview of Libraries
3.3.6 Filtering the View
3.3.5 Using Elements of the Global DIGSI 5 Library
3.3.3 Working with the User-Defined Global DIGSI 5 Library
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor CFC cross-reference list.
This button enables you to export the table with contents in the CFC cross-reference list
editor.
This toolbar gives you fast access to actions and settings in the Editor Security Event Logging.
Related Topics
20.3 Security Event Logging Editor
20.2 Operations Safety and Access Control
C Compact 32, 36
Company logo 768
Cabling 544 Compare 244, 247, 371, 371, 372, 373, 374, 374, 375,
Calendar 566 376, 377, 377, 378, 379, 380, 381, 381, 985
Catalog 933, 934, 1021 Comparing 254
Cell 77 Comparison 976
Center 340 Compatibility 544
CFC 56, 318, 318, 318, 320, 321, 322, 323, 525, 763, Compile 100, 353, 980
824, 824, 825, 826, 826, 827, 828, 829, 829, 830, 831, COMTRADE 703
896, 903, 904, 905, 986, 988, 1010, 1011, 1032 Configuration 201, 642, 643, 646, 646, 647, 648, 751,
Chain structures 544 751, 753, 753, 978, 1003, 1013, 1019
Change 533 Configuration file 703
Change the number 533, 533 Configuration strategy 320
Changing 782 Configure 128, 230, 320, 558, 559, 559, 560, 573,
Channel protocols 832 580, 684, 710, 748, 749, 749, 750, 750, 752, 755, 756,
Character set 752 760, 762, 763, 763, 764
Characteristic curve 251 Configuring 566, 568, 568
Chart 209 Confirmation ID 679, 707, 707, 707, 727, 728, 730,
Chatter blocking 257 731, 732, 998, 999
Chatter idle time 257 Connect 161, 163, 168, 197, 198, 199, 225, 227, 229,
Chatter tests 257 549, 550, 552, 633
Check 350, 351 Connection 199, 225, 551, 581, 630, 639
CID 738, 739, 751 Connection line 169
Circle 174 Connection password 727, 728, 729, 730, 731, 732,
Circle segment 175 999, 999, 1000
Circuit breaker 229, 656, 919, 1017 Connection point 168, 177, 198, 199, 200
Circuit manual 768 Connector 343
Circuit-breaker interaction 230 Consistency 350, 353
Class 223, 223, 285, 286 Constellation 572
Client 543 Constellation measured values 570
Clipboard 144, 144, 146, 147, 148, 253 Consumption 224, 960
Clock signal 439, 466 Continuous Function Chart 320, 325, 325, 326, 328,
Close 109 328, 330, 335, 338, 338, 340, 340, 342, 348, 349, 349,
CMV 313, 870 353
Collapse 252 Control 306
Color 258, 817 Control display 56
Column 70, 78 Control flow 905, 1011
Column content 74, 75 Control function 658, 918
Column width 70 Control functions 1017
Command 260 Control output 192
Commissioning mode 649, 651 Convert 105
Commissioning Mode 649 Copy 147, 167, 178, 196, 220, 237, 240, 249, 326,
Common 361 338, 587, 642, 647, 783
Communication 141, 542, 542, 544, 544, 552, 554, Copying 135, 136, 242, 253, 531
585, 630, 723 Cosine 364
Communication channel 572, 573 Count 480, 481, 482
Communication Channel 572 Count down 480, 482
Communication Log 709 Count up 481, 482
Communication mapping 49, 574, 583, 583, 584, 584, Cover page 774, 784, 789, 1001
585, 586, 587 Cover pages 774
Communication module 148, 542, 542, 543, 544, 545, Cover Pages editor 769
558, 571, 579, 916, 1017 CPU 118, 351
Communication name 286 Create 104, 164, 1004, 1004
Communication protocol 49, 545, 558, 664, 841, 841, Creating 134, 982
842, 843, 843, 844, 847, 849, 850, 852, 853, 854, 854, Credit balances 224
922 Cross reference list 1032
Communication Protocol 561, 834 cross-reference list 896
Communication protocols 1018 CSV 539, 676, 681, 705, 713
M
J Magnitude 535, 536, 538
Manage 1031
JPEG 780 Managing 51, 224
JPG 253 Mapping settings 583, 586, 587
Mark 77, 166, 175, 194, 781
Matrix 77, 225, 231, 584, 1027
Maximizing 69
K Maximum 469, 470
Maximum 382
Keyword 94 Maximum value 671, 672, 674
Mean value 671, 672, 674
Measurand 676
Measured value 260, 668, 671, 673, 674, 675, 676,
L 954, 1025
Measured Value 675
Labels 786 Measured-value acquisition 141
Language 40, 63, 111, 112, 130, 956 Measured-value snapshot 954, 1025
Later Binding 614 Measurement 305, 952, 1024
Layout 329, 768, 768, 768, 769, 774, 824, 860, 861, Measuring point 198, 225, 227, 231, 231, 232, 233,
862 234, 236, 238, 535, 581, 1004, 1004
LD 859 Measuring Point 534
LED 258, 302, 478, 817, 817 Menu bar 58
LEDs 786 Merging Unit 622
Level 247 Message 100
Libraries 932, 1031 Metadata 776
Library 48, 80, 81, 81, 87, 88, 170, 190, 191, 193 Metered value 671, 674, 675, 676
Library elements 49 Metered Value 260, 674, 675, 676
License 982 MICS 736, 745, 748
License file 719 Minimizing 69
Licenses 53 Minimum 468, 469
Limiting value 381, 382 Minimum 382
Line 174, 329, 546 Minimum value 671, 672, 674
Line routing 198 Minuend 356, 356
Linear classification 772 MLFB 55
Link 440, 442, 443, 443, 444 Modbus TCP 545, 743, 853
Links 441 Mode 39, 246, 649, 649, 650
List 997 Mode of dispatch 719
LN 857 module 723
LN0 858 Module 542, 832, 832, 834, 836, 837
Load 224, 642, 643, 719, 721, 724 Module information 832
Loading 725, 977, 978, 1003, 1013, 1019 Modulo 359
Structure Editor 283 Test sequence 528, 528, 530, 530, 530, 531, 533, 533,
Subchart 497 533, 534, 534, 535, 536, 538, 538, 539, 746, 752, 912,
Subnetwork 544, 549, 550, 551, 552, 554, 838 1014
Subnetwork mask 552 Test Sequence 531
Subsequent test time 257 test signal 535
Substation 201 Test signal 534, 536
Subtract 356, 356, 367 Test system 741
Subtrahend 356, 356 Text 114, 115, 160, 171, 338, 779, 826, 861, 861
Summand 354, 355 Text box 338, 341, 341, 772, 777
Summands 366 Text Box 825, 860
SUP 849 Text field 826, 861
SUP-Ethernet 546 Text parameter 245
Switch 543 Text size 172
Switch function group 213, 229 Texts 900
Switching threshold 818 Tick 351
SWPC 880 Tie line 200
Symbol 173, 173, 174, 175, 175, 176, 176, 177, 177, Tie lines 177
178, 178, 195, 907 TIFF 780
Symbol editor 169 Time 566, 961, 970
Symbol Editor 171, 172 Time delay 475, 476
Symbol part 176 Time information 961
Symmetrical components 671 Time Information 565
Synchronizing 205 Time interval 473
Synchronous 544 Time intervals 474, 477
Synchrophasor 545, 854 Time reference 545
System 49 Time setting 564
System resources 465, 466, 466, 467, 468 Time settings 970
Time source 561, 566, 568, 568
Time Sources 562
Time stamp 680, 705, 712, 824
T Time stamping 683
Time synchronization 542, 544, 546, 566, 568, 568
Tab 59, 81, 92, 98, 100, 897, 897, 899, 899, 904, 905, Time Synchronization 561, 571
924, 924, 931, 932, 933, 934, 935, 957, 959, 961, 961, Timer 473, 474, 477
962, 979, 979, 980, 981 Timing master 567
Tab view 68 Timing Master 561
Table 77, 679, 950, 950, 951, 952, 952, 954, 1022, Title bar 58, 62, 66
1023, 1024, 1024, 1025, 1025 TLS 631
Tabs 66 Tolerance of impedances 750
Tangent 365 Tolerance of time zones 750
Target settings group 249 Tool tip 92
Task area 81 Toolbar 58, 62, 66, 1007, 1008, 1009, 1009, 1009,
Task card 59, 65 1010, 1011, 1012, 1013, 1014, 1015, 1015, 1016,
Task level 321, 348 1016, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1018, 1018, 1019,
Task sequence 321 1019, 1021, 1021, 1022, 1022, 1023, 1024, 1024,
Tasks 931 1025, 1025, 1026, 1027, 1031, 1032
TEA-X 736, 736, 748, 749, 755, 756 Toolbar view 68
Template 170, 193, 769, 770, 773, 774, 775, 777, 779, Tooltip 246, 587
780 Topology 201, 202, 202, 203, 206
Template size 772 Topology information 668, 897
Templates 320 Topology recognition 570
Terminal 551, 829 Transfer 612
Test 275, 653, 654, 656, 658, 660, 664, 665, 666, 667, Transformer value 205
668, 669, 914, 916, 917, 918, 919, 921, 922, 923, 924, Transmit 642, 646
924, 1016, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1018, 1018 Tree 330
Test editor 1016, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1017, 1018, 1018 trend display 506
Test equipment 528, 741 Trend display 504, 926
Test fault record 700 Triangle 175
Test generator 528
U
X
UAT 736, 747, 748, 753, 755
UINT 525 XML 736, 737, 744, 745, 746
Unit 49
Unit of measure 774
Unit of measurement 772
Update 642, 646, 715, 721 Z
US 49
USART 571 Zone 247
USB 542 Zone diagram 251
User 974
User Information 811
User interface 38, 58
User interface language 40, 46
User label 203
User Log 709
User-defined 76, 267, 671, 672, 676, 1002
User-Defined 80, 81
User-defined Application template 125
User-defined Application Template 994
User-defined filter 1002
user-defined signals 307
UTC 545, 564, 565
V
Validation 209
Validity 275
Variable 770
Variant 36
Variants 32
Vector graphic 189
Version 725
View 88, 113, 142, 231, 252, 272, 284, 293, 330, 548,
584, 700, 702, 703, 721, 723, 770, 790, 1031
Viewing 601, 605
Voltage input 192
Voltage level 201
Voltage-measuring point 1004
W
Warning indication 351, 353